Professional Documents
Culture Documents
Manual of Irrigation Practice (Mip) - Volume-I
Manual of Irrigation Practice (Mip) - Volume-I
(MIP)
Volume - I
(Revised 2017)
ACKNOWLEDGMENT
Foremost, Project Management Office (PMO) - Punjab Barrages, wants to extend this
endeavor to Almighty ALLAH for the prudence bestowed upon us, in order to suffice
the standard of this revised Manual of Irrigation Practice (MIP).
It is pertinent to mention that the completion of this task was attainable owing to the
exemplary knowledge and arduous efforts of our renowned authors (Syed Mansoob
Ali Zaidi, Mr. Sajjad Hussain Naseem, Dr. Bagh Ali Shahid, Malik Ahmed Khan, Mr.
Muhammad Azam Chaudhry, Mr. Muhammad Ehsan, Mr. Ahmad Khan Bhatti, Mr.
Habibullah Bodla, Mr. Muhammad Shamshad Gohar, Mr. Ghulam Hussain Qadri and
Mr. Shafiq Ali).
Revision of the MIP according to latest theories and practices is a cumulative effort to
generate valuable document, however, comments and suggestions for further
improvement of the revised MIP would be appreciated.
Amjad Saeed
Head/Project Director
Project Management Office (PMO)
Punjab Barrages Rehabilitation &
Modernization Projects,
Punjab Irrigation Department,
Lahore
FOREWARD
MIP contains engineering tools and concepts that have proven useful in
planning, constructing, maintaining and operating the irrigation infrastructure
successfully. The manual is not a text book but contains sufficient background
knowledge so as to act as single book of theory and practice.
It is hoped that MIP would be a rich source of knowledge and guidance for
irrigation engineers.
ASAD ULLAH
Secretary to Government of Punjab
Irrigation Department
TABLE OF CONTENTS
Sr. No. Title of Chapter Author
Chapter 1: Definitions Syed Mahmood-ul-Hassan
Diagrams
1 Regime Slop Diagram for Discharge from 4 to 20,000 Cusecs and
Silt Factor From 0.4 to 1.6
2 Regime Dimension Diagram, Discharges from 100 to 20,000
Cusecs and Silt factor “f” 0.4 to 1.6
3 Data of Parent Channel U/S of Offtake
4 Regime Dimension Diagram, Discharges from 4 to 20,000
Cusecs and Silt factor “f” 0.4 to 1.6
5 Type Cross Sections of Distributaries
6 Type Cross Sections of Main Canal and Branches
7 Graph Showing Value of QR
MANUAL OF IRRIGATION PRACTICE i
DEFINITIONS
Chapter 1
DEFINITIONS
Compiled by
Reviewed by
1 DEFINITIONS1
A.
Abutments 1. For barrages and regulators these are structures built to
support the lateral pressure of an arch or span, e.g at the
end of bridge. For dams and bridges abutments are
substructure at the ends whereon the structure's
superstructure rests or contacts.
Accretion A process of sediment accumulation by flowing water due to
any cause, including Alluviation.
Acre foot A unit of volume used in irrigation practice. It means the
volume of water required to cover an area of one acre, to a
depth of one foot. It amounts to 43,560 cubic feet. A cusec
day is equal to 1.98 acre feet (ordinarily taken as 1 cusec
day= 2 acre feet).
Acre inch Is 1/12 of an acre foot defined above (and is almost equal to
one cusec hour).
Aeration (1) Aeration is the process by which air is circulated through
and mixed with or dissolved in a liquid / Water.
(2) The process of relieving the effects of cavitation by
admitting air to the affected section.
After Bay A tail race of water power plant, a stream, conduit, pond or
reservoir of a hydroelectric power plant at the outlet of
turbines.
Afflux Afflux is an increase in water level that can occur upstream
of a structure, such as a Dam, Barrage, a bridge or culvert,
that creates an obstruction in the flow.
Aggradation The raising of the surface of stream beds, flood plains, and
the bottom of other water bodies by the accretion or
deposition of material eroded and transported from other
areas. This is the opposite of degradation.
Angularity The correction to be made to an observed velocity when the
correction direction of the current is not exactly at right angles to the
discharge section line
Alluvial Pertains to alluvium deposited by stream or flowing water of
River.
Alluvial Stream A stream whose channel boundary is composed of
appreciable quantities of the sediments transported by the
flow, and which generally changes its bed forms as the rate
of flow changes.
1 The Definitions included in this Chapter have been mainly drawn from the “Manual of Irrigation
Practice” Public Works Department, Irrigation Branch printed in 1943 and reprinted in 1963. Where
found necessary additional definitions have been added. Some definitions are based on different web
based documents including but not limited to Wikipedia.
1-2 MANUAL OF IRRIGATION PRACTICE
DEFINITIONS
Alluvium A general term for all detrital deposits resulting from the
sediment transport of (modern) streams, thus including the
sediments laid down in riverbeds, flood plains, and stream-
created fans at the foot of mountain slopes.
Antidunes Bed forms which occur at a velocity higher than that which
forms dunes and plane beds. Antidunes commonly move
upstream, and are accompanied by , and in phase with
waves, on the water surface.
Apron A floor or lining of concrete/stone, etc., to protect a surface
from erosion, such as the pavement below weirs, falls or at
the toe of a bund.
Aqueduct A channel, in which water flows with ‘free” surface,
constructed to carry water above the natural surface level or
to convey water over an obstacle such as river or valley.
This structure is suitable when bed level of canal is above
the highest flood level of drainage. In this case, the drainage
water passes clearly below the canal. If the flow in drainage
barrel is under pressure, the aqueduct is called syphon
aqueduct.
Area-Assessed The area irrigated, on which water rates are levied
(generally the same as area matured).
Area-Cultivated Land which is under crop or fruit trees or has been under
crop or fruit trees in the previous three harvests.
Area-Culturable That portion of the culturable irrigable area which is
commanded (CCA) commanded by flow irrigation.
Area-Culturable Lift That portion of culturable irrigable area which can be
irrigated by lift.
Area-Discharge The area of the water-way of a channel at the discharge
section section line, expressed in square feet or square meters.
Area-Flow irrigation Area which can be irrigated from the source of water, by flow
under gravity alone.
Area-Gross Total Area Within the extreme limits set for irrigation by a
project, system or channel
Area-Gross That portion of the gross irrigable area which is commanded
Commanded by flow irrigation
(GCA)
Area-Gross lift. That portion of gross irrigable area which can be irrigated by
lift.
Area-Irrigated The area to which water has been applied.
Area-Lift Irrigation Area of which the level is too high to allow irrigation by flow
from the source, but which can be economically irrigated by
water raised to the necessary level at some point in the
supply system
MANUAL OF IRRIGATION PRACTICE 1-3
DEFINITIONS
Base, base days or The number of days in a crop season. In the Punjab it
base Period numbers 183 for kharif and 182 for rabi
Bed load Silt, sand, gravel or other detritus rolling along the bed of a
stream. Silt moving on the bed of the channel is known as
the bedload. This silt slides, rolls or jumps along the bed
depending upon the velocity near the bed. Certain grades
of silt are, however, capable of moving either in suspension,
or on the bed, depending upon the turbulence of flow.
Bed Load Sampler A device for measuring sediment moving on or along the
bottom of the river bed, or channel bed.
1-4 MANUAL OF IRRIGATION PRACTICE
DEFINITIONS
Bed-Material load Consists of particles that are generally found in the bed
or Bed Sediment material. Bed material load is the summation of the bed load
Load and the suspended load excluding the wash load. Bed
material load is also referred to as the total load.
Boil Sampler Sediment sample obtained immediately downstream of a
regulator or fall structure coupled with energy resistance
blocks is known as a boil sample. The characteristics of this
sample are that it contains all sizes of sediment, including
those which from bed material due to the churning action of
water caused by energy dissipation, where all sediments get
into suspension. A boil sample is collected to estimate the
total sediment load in the channel.
Berm (1) The space left between the upper edge of a cut and
the toe of an embankment.
(2) a horizontal strip of land or shelf built into or an
embankment to break the continuity of an otherwise
long slope, to improve stability.
Blocks Obstructions set in the path of high velocity water to
dissipate energy due to impact and prevent scour.
Branch This term is applied to a large channel taking its supply from
the main canal but whose functions are the same, viz., the
supply of water to distributaries and minor canals.
Breaching Section A section of a flood embankment or other flood protection
work which is designated for effecting a controlled breach to
release a part of flood under specific conditions
Bucket wheel The revolving portion of a current meter driven by the force
of the current and whose revolutions are an indication of the
velocity of that current
C
Caisson A structure used in underwater work, consisting of an airtight
chamber, open at the bottom and containing air under
sufficient pressure to exclude the water
Camber Camber is to arch slightly; bend or curve upward in the
middle
(overbuild) of the crests of embankment dams generally
provided, in addition to conventional freeboard allowances,
to accommodate anticipated post-construction settlements.
Canal An artificial channel constructed to convey appreciable
quantities of water
Canal-Inundation This term is ordinarily applied to a canal with or without
some form of head regulator, dependent upon the surface
level of the water in the river for its supplies. Generally the
inundation canals will only run when the supply in the river
rises to a level which permits of the feeding the canal
MANUAL OF IRRIGATION PRACTICE 1-5
DEFINITIONS
Cusec day A unit of volume used in irrigation practice and means the
volume of water resulting from a discharge of one cusec for
one day (24 hours). It amounts to 86,400 cubic feet of water
and is equal to nearly two acre-feet.
Cut-off A wall, collar, or other structure of impervious material (e.g.,
concrete, asphalted concrete, timber, steel sheet piling, or
impervious grout curtain) located in the foundation beneath
a dam or barrage intended to reduce percolation of water
along smooth surfaces or through porous strata
Cut off trench An excavation in the base of a dam or other structure filled
with relatively impervious material to reduce seepage
D
Dam A structure erected to impound water in a reservoir
Dam Arch A curved dam, convex upstream that depends on arch, or
arch and cantilever action for its stability. The load is
transferred by the arch to the canyon walls or other
abutments
Dam-Axis The horizontal centerline of a dam in the longitudinal
direction.
Dam-Buttress A masonry structure which carries the water load from an
impervious deck on the upstream face through buttresses
or counter-forts to the foundation.
Dam Cascade A number of dams constructed one after the other across
river channel are terms as a cascade of dams.
Dam Concrete A dam constructed with cement concrete.
Dam Earthfill A dam comprises an earth fill embankment as the main
structure.
Dam-Flat deck This type of dam is made of a flat reinforced concrete slab,
which transmits water pressure to a series of a parallel
buttresses which rest directly on the foundation or upon a
concrete slab resting on the foundation material.
Dam-Gravity A dam which depends for its stability, entirely on its weight.
It may be straight or slightly curved in plan
Dam-Gravel fill It is an embankment composed of gravel or shingle with the
downstream part made of relatively coarse material, and the
upstream, or water side part made of finer gravel and sand.
Dam-Hydraulic fill A dam composed of earth, sand, gravel, etc., sluiced into
place generally the fine materials are washed towards the
centre for greater imperviousness
Dam Large According to the definitions adopted by ICOLD any dam
having a height of 49.2 ft (15 meters) from the foundation
or, if the height is from 16.4 to 49.2 ft (5 to 15 meters), having
MANUAL OF IRRIGATION PRACTICE 1-9
DEFINITIONS
Density-Soil The density of a soil is its weight per unit volume. A soil
which consists of solids and pores has two densities that of
the mass termed “bulk” density and that of the solids termed
“absolute” density.
Depth-integrating An instrument that is moved vertically at an approximately
sediment sampler constant rate between the water surface and a point a few
inches above the streambed, which collects a
representative discharge-weighted water sediment mixture
at all points along the sampling vertical.
Depression in a semi-module, the depth below supply level of some
point of a semi-module fixed by its hydraulics such that as
supply level varies, a constant co-efficient multiplied by the
correct power of that depth gives the discharge
Depression ratio The ratio between the depression and the height of the
opening of an orifice outlet
Depth-Critical The depth of flow where energy is at a minimum for a
particular discharge.
Direction float A standard metal float carrying a small flag used for
indicating the direction of flow of a river so that the angle
that direction makes with the discharge section line at an
observation point may be measured
Direction peg line The line parallel to the discharge section line on which the
direction pegs are located
Direction pegs The points through which rays from the observation point
pass when converging on to the pivot point
Discharge The rate of flow at a stated site, i.e. the quantity of water
passing in unit time
Discharge section The line along which depths and velocities of water are
line measured between two points located one on each bank of
a channel
Distributary-Major (Commonly known as a distributary) A Government channel
taking its supply from a main line or branch canal, the
function of which is to supply water to smaller distributaries,
minors and outlets.
Distributary-Minor (Commonly known as a minor). A small Government
channel, usually taking its supply from a major distributary,
the function of which is to supply water to outlets
Distributary-sub- (Commonly known as sub-minor) A Government channel off
minor taking from one already defined as a minor
Diversity Factor The diversity factor of any electrical transmission system, or
part of a system, in the ratio of the sum of maximum power
demands of the sub-divisions of the system, or part of a
system, to the maximum demand of the whole system, or
MANUAL OF IRRIGATION PRACTICE 1-11
DEFINITIONS
Energy gradient The slope of energy line with reference to any plane
Energy head The elevation of the hydraulic grade line at any section plus
the velocity head of the mean velocity of the water in that
1-12 MANUAL OF IRRIGATION PRACTICE
DEFINITIONS
Gauge wells Gauge wells are provided to facilitate reading of water level.
They are generally rectangular in plan with stairs leading to
observing point from the top pavement.
Glacis The sloping floor below and in continuation of the raised
crest of a weir.
Government A canal or channel which is owned maintained and operated
channel exclusively by the Government
Gravel Sub-angular to rounded, mixture of different size of stone
mixed with sand and possibly some clay.
Groyne A spur (or groyne) is a structures constructed with
permanent materials, transverse to the river flow and extend
from the bank into the river. These are widely used for the
purpose of river training.
Guide bank The embankments forming the upstream and downstream
approaches of a weir to guide the flow to pass centrally
through the barrage or weir. Guide banks are placed in pairs
symmetrical in plan. The nose of a guide bank is heavily
armored to withstand river action
H
Head (1) The height of water above any point or plane of
reference. Used also in various compounds, such as
energy head, entrance head, friction head, static head,
pressure head, lost head, etc
(2) The term is usually applied to the control work
constructed at the off-take of a channel subsidiary to a
main canal.
Head-Available The minimum available difference between supply and delivery
working water levels.
Head-Energy See energy head
Head-Gross When applied to a dam – the gross head is the total fall or
difference between the upstream's surface water (headrace)
forebay elevation and the downstream's surface water (tail
water) elevation at the tail-race.
Head-Minimum The difference of water level or pressure between supply and
modular delivery sides, which is the minimum necessary to enable a
module or semi-module to work as designed.
Head-Net When applied to a dam –Net head is the gross head less all
losses in the conduit and tail race. (Losses within the turbine
easing the turbines and the draft tube are not included in the
conduit losses, being accounted for in the turbine efficiency).
Head race A channel leading water to a water-wheel, a fore-bay.
1-16 MANUAL OF IRRIGATION PRACTICE
DEFINITIONS
Limits of oscillation Is the width within which a river has ranged within historic
times.
Lining A protective covering over all or over a portion of the
perimeter of a conduit, or canal to prevent seepage losses,
or to withstand pressure to resist erosion. Conduits and
canals are sometimes lined to reduce friction or otherwise
improve conditions of flow
Liquid limit Is that moisture content expressed as a percentage of the
weight of oven-dried soil at which the soil will just begin to
flow when lightly jarred. At this stage cohesion and internal
friction are practically zero.
Load factor It is the ratio of the average load to the peak load. In each
case the interval of maximum load and the period over
which the average is taken should be definitely stated such
as a “half hourly, monthly” load factor.
Log line The weight and cord attached to it used for determining
depths at observation points where it is impossible to use a
sounding rod.
Losses-Absorption Losses from a canal or reservoir on account of evaporation
and percolation or seepage.
Loose stone apron A pervious protection against bed scour that launches into
the scour and protects the impervious structure, both on the
upstream and downstream.
Losses-Total The sum total of losses of water by absorption, percolation
and evaporation. The total loss in a channel may be defined
as the difference between the discharge at head of a
channel and the useful discharge, i.e., the sum of outlet
discharges.
M
Main line This term is applied to the principal channel of a canal
system off taking from a river or other source of supply.
Mean particle size The weighted average of different sediment size classes bh
or diameter wight.
Mean velocity The point lying between water surface and the bed of a
position channel at which the velocity is equal to the mean velocity.
Median size or Particles size of sediment for which 50 percent by weight is
diameter finer, obtained graphically by locating the diameter
associated with the midpoint of the particle size distribution.
Medium silt The particles of sediment below 0.07 mm diameter.
Meter Is a device for measuring quantities of water passed or the
rate of flow.
Meter-flume The device for measuring discharge from the direct
measurement of the depth of water flowing over it.
MANUAL OF IRRIGATION PRACTICE 1-19
DEFINITIONS
is given as total silt in cft silt intensity in cft per cusec day *
discharge in cft per sec.
Sliding factor Is the ratio of net horizontal force to net vertical load acting
on a structure.
Slit load All sediment material upto 3.6 mm diameter, whether in
suspension, or moving on the bed, or deposited on the bed.
Sluice 1. A conduit for carrying water at high velocity.
2. An opening in a structure for passing debris.
3. To cause water to flow at high velocities for wastage
for purpose of excavation or ejecting debris
Slope gauges Gauges fixed above and below a discharge section line for
the purpose or determining the water surface slope through
that discharge section line.
Sloping Apron Stone work to protect the side slopes of embankments,
canals, dams, dykes etc against erosion.
Soil Finely divided material composed of disintegrated rock
mixed with organic matter; the loose surface material in
which plants grow.
Soils-Alkali Soil that contains harmful concentration of alkaline mineral
salts.
Soil evaporation Evaporation of water from moist soils.
Sounding rod The graduated pole with which depths of water are
measured in feet at observation points.
Spillway A passage for spilling surplus water from a dam.
Spillway-Overflow It is a structure constructed at a dam site, for effectively
or Ogee disposing of the surplus water from upstream to
downstream and ogee spillway is an improvement upon the
“free overfall spillway”.
Ogee is an S-shaped line or moulding.
Spillway-Straight A straight drop or free overfall spillway is a structure is a low-
drop or free overfall height, narrow-crested weir with vertical downstream face
so that the water falls freely.
Spillway-Syphon Siphon Spillway is a closed duct connecting the upstream
and the downstream sides of a reservoir dam, thus enabling
flood waters to pass, as in the case of a bye-channel. The
hood level is higher than reservoir level. Hence, when
flowing full the water level in pipe is higher than the reservoir
level.
Spillway-Shaft or A shaft spillway is sometimes called a "morning glory"
morning glory spillway. It is a hollow tower or shaft, usually circular, which
has a funnel at its top.
1-28 MANUAL OF IRRIGATION PRACTICE
DEFINITIONS
Suspension rod The hand operated rod used in shallow water instead of a
Rack and Pinion.
Swivel The device fixed between current meter and its means of
suspension, so that it may be free to swing in a horizontal
plane.
Syphon A term applied in irrigation practice to an “inverted siphon”
a tube or “sealed” channel constructed to carry water at a
level lower than at which the open channel normally flows.
Syphon-Inverted A pipe line crossing over a depression or under a highway,
rail road, canal, drain etc. The term is common but
inappropriate, as no syphonic action is involved. The
suggested term “sag pipe”, is very expressive and
appropriate.
Storage Dead Is the capacity of a reservoir at the minimum level to which
is the reservoir is drawn down.
Storage Live Is the capacity of the reservoir above Dead Storage level.
T
Tail/Tail Cluster This term is usually applied to the work constructed at the
end of a channel for the distribution of the water, e. g. tail
cluster / tail regulator etc.
Tail Water Tail water refers to water level immediately downstream
from a hydraulic structure, such as a dam/barrage, bridge
or culvert.
Tail race The channel that leads water away from a turbine or water
wheel
Temporary to A temporary contrivance for measuring water surface level
along the gauge line of a permanent gauge when that
Permanent Gauge
gauge itself is left high and dry, and fixed so that it
measures as it was the permanent gauge.
Time-factor The ratio of the number of days the channel is in flow to
the base days.
Time lag Is the allowance that has to be made for time required for
the effect of change in indent at one site reaching another
indenting site.
Toe-wall A shallow wall constructed below the foundation level to
provide a footing for the pitching of the face of an
embankment. When the sub-soil water level is high the
toe-wall takes the form of a series of shallow wells.
Tractive Force Force exerted by flowing water on the sediment particle at
a standstill on the river bed, to induce movement.
Trap efficiency The proportion of the incoming sediment load deposited in
a lake or reservoir, in present.
MANUAL OF IRRIGATION PRACTICE 1-31
DEFINITIONS
Velocity-Central The rate at which the surface layer of water moves in the
Surface centre of a channel.
Velocity Critical Is the velocity in a stream corresponding to critical flow.
Froude Number of critical flow is 1.
Velocity Drift The velocity due to drift.
Velocity Mean The average rate at which all the layers of water move
between water surface and the bed of a channel at a
specified distance from one bank.
Velocity-Modified The velocity as observed after correcting for the drift
velocity and angularity.
Velocity overall The average velocity of the discharge through a discharge
sectional m
area i.e. Q/A=V
e
a
n
Velocity of approach The mean velocity in a channel immediately upstream of
a weir dam, venturi throat, orifice, or other structure.
Velocity rod A rod loaded with metal at one end so that it floats in a
vertical position and on being timed through a float run
gives the mean velocity of the water between water
surface and the bottom of the velocity rod.
Velocity rod The correction to be applied to a rod velocity in order to
correction convert it into mean velocity
Velocity-surface The rate at which the surface layer of water moves.
Vena Contracta The section at which the boundaries of a jet passing
through an orifice or over a weir become parallel.
1-32 MANUAL OF IRRIGATION PRACTICE
DEFINITIONS
W
Wall Breast or Face When applied to irrigation practice a well generally of
reinforced concrete or brickwork, immediately above the
face of a submerged orifice.
Wall-Curtain A cross wall built under the floor of a hydraulic structure
with the object of dividing the work into suitable
compartments, or to provide cutoffs.
Wall-Core A wall of masonry, sheet-piling, or puddle clay built inside
a dam or embankment to reduce seepage/percolation.
Wall-Divide See divide wall.
Wall-Flank The retaining walls in continuation of abutments both
upstream and downstream to provide a transition between
the vertical abutment and sloping guide bank.
Wall-Toe See Toe-wall
Water account Is an account maintained of distribution of supplies
between units of interlinked canals or different channels of
one canal.
Water allowance The outcome of all considerations of the duty of water
intensity proposed crop ratio, water, available etc., is the
fixing of the water allowance. Water allowance may be
defined as the number of cusec of outlets capacity,
authorized per 1,000 acres of cultural irrigable area. The
water allowance, therefore, not only defines the size of
outlet for each outlet area but also forms the basis for the
design of the distributing channels in successive stages.
Water course The term applied to an irrigators channel taking its supply
from a Government channel, from which fields are
irrigated directly.
Water logged A condition of land where the ground water stands at a
level that is detrimental to plants. It may result from over
irrigation, or seepage with inadequate drainage.
Water right A legal right to the use of water.
Watershed (1) The area drained by a steam or steam system.
(2) The divide between drainage basins.
Water table The upper surface of a zone of saturation in soil or
impermeable strata or beds.
Wave runup Wave run up is the maximum vertical extent of wave
uprush on a beach or structure above the still water level
(SWL). Wave run up is an important process in causing
and or promoting bluff erosion.
Weep holes Openings left in retaining walls, aprons linings, foundation,
etc. to permit drainage of accumulated seepage water,
reduce pressure etc.
MANUAL OF IRRIGATION PRACTICE 1-33
DEFINITIONS
Chak boundary Is the limit set for irrigation from any particular outlet.
Colaba A pipe outlet in which the pipe is of earthenware.
Ghair mumkin This term is reserved for barren land, land under buildings, roads
streams, canals, tanks, etc. Sandy or Kallar lands also come
under this category. It cannot be supplied water for irrigation.
Khadir River valley, low alluvial lands between high banks.
Khal A water-course
Kharif Kharif means Summer cropping season
Mogha Outlet. It passes water from a government channel to a water
course.
Nakka A cut in a water-course to pass water to the fields.
Nikal Is a term used in distribution of supply between different share-
holders of an outlet. It is the amount of supply left in the water-
course in between the nakka in use and the nakka to be used
next.
Rabi Winter cropping season
Rajbaha Distributary channel.
Rakkar Land with a low salt content but high PH values, i. e. an alkaline
soil.
Sailab Flood
Sem Seepage.
Shamilat Village common land
Tatil The period of closure of an irrigation channel
Zaid Kharif Late summer crop
Zaid Rabi Late winter crop
Zamindar Land owner
.
MANUAL OF IRRIGATION PRACTICE i
HISTORY OF IRRIGATION DEVELOPMENT IN PUNJAB
Chapter 2
HISTORY OF IRRIGATION
DEVELOPMENT IN PUNJAB
Compiled by
Reviewed by
Table of Contents
2 HISTORY OF IRRIGATION DEVELOPMENT IN PUNJAB .................................. 2-1
2.1 THE OLD IRRIGATION METHODS AND ANCIENT CANALS ........................................ 2-1
2.2 IRRIGATION DEVELOPMENT UNDER COLONIAL RULE (1850 - 1947) .................... 2-1
2.3 POST-INDEPENDENCE DEVELOPMENTS (1947 - 60) ............................................. 2-2
2.4 HISTORIC W ATER RIGHTS AND SYSTEM DESIGN .................................................. 2-3
2.5 EVOLUTION OF W ATER DISTRIBUTION AT FARM LEVEL: THE W ARABANDI SYSTEM ... 2-4
2.6 INDUS W ATER TREATY (1960) ........................................................................... 2-4
2.7 INDUS BASIN REPLACEMENT W ORKS .................................................................. 2-5
2.8 IMPLICATIONS OF THE TREATY ........................................................................... 2-6
2.9 WATER APPORTIONMENT ACCORD 1991 ............................................................ 2-7
2.10 MAIN FEATURES OF W ATER ACCORD (1991) ...................................................... 2-7
Box 2.1: Water Accord 1991.................................................................................. 2-7
2.11 POST ACCORD ISSUES ...................................................................................... 2-9
2.12 ANTI-WATER LOGGING MEASURES AND GROUNDWATER DEVELOPMENT ................. 2-9
2.13 PRIVATE TUBEWELL DEVELOPMENT.................................................................. 2-10
2.14 SCARP TRANSITIONING ................................................................................. 2-10
List of Tables
TABLE 2-1: DEVELOPMENT OF CANAL SYSTEM IN PUNJAB UNDER COLONIAL RULE ................ 2-1
TABLE 2-2: IRRIGATION DEVELOPMENT 1947-60 ................................................................ 2-2
TABLE 2-3: INDUS BASIN REPLACEMENT W ORKS (INDUS W ATERS TREATY CONSEQUENTIAL
WORKS) - DAMS..................................................................................................... 2-5
TABLE 2-4: INDUS BASIN REPLACEMENT W ORKS (INDUS W ATERS TREATY CONSEQUENTIAL
WORKS) - BARRAGES ........................................................................................... 2-6
TABLE 2-5: INDUS BASIN REPLACEMENT W ORKS (INDUS W ATERS TREATY CONSEQUENTIAL
WORKS) - NEW LINK CANALS ..................................................................................... 2-6
iv MANUAL OF IRRIGATION PRACTICE
HISTORY OF IRRIGATION DEVELOPMENT IN PUNJAB
MANUAL OF IRRIGATION PRACTICE 2-1
HISTORY OF IRRIGATION DEVELOPMENT IN PUNJAB
The development of irrigation in the Punjab during British rule transformed socio-
economic conditions in the province. Large tracts of land, which used to be
uninhabited, and uninhabitable, were soon converted into wide tracts of cultivation
dotted with villages that started to bristle with agricultural activity. Virgin lands began
to produce rich harvests, and a network of industry and infrastructure came up to
replace the wilderness. The continued development of irrigation has introduced
development features that have progressively contributed to improving the socio-
economic conditions and prosperity of the people. Recurrent famines, which occured
in the 18th and 19th centuries, are events of the past. The ripple effects of irrigation
development in the Punjab Province include improved law and order, general
improved welfare of the people, better living standards and improved education
facilities, as well as the development of industry, infrastructure and communication
networks.
2.3 Post-Independence Developments (1947 - 60)
After the Independence of Pakistan, the international border between Pakistan and
India divided the irrigation system. With this division, the source of supply of all the
rivers was located in India. Similarly, some of the headworks along the eastern rivers
also fell in Indian Territory, while parts of these canal systems irrigated areas in
Pakistan. Disputes over the river water, particularly that of managing truncated canal
systems, arose between the upper and lower riparians. The dispute could not be
resolved and Pakistan had to undertake emergency measures to provide irrigation
supplies to affected canal commands. In addition, new projects, as described below in
Table 2.2, were also undertaken.
Table 2-2: Irrigation Development 1947-60
Year Major Events / Canal Construction
1952 Construction of Shahpur Branch off-taking from LJC to irrigate
2,15,000 acres of CCA.
MANUAL OF IRRIGATION PRACTICE 2-3
HISTORY OF IRRIGATION DEVELOPMENT IN PUNJAB
1953 Construction of BS Link Canal to connect the Ravi and Sutlej rivers to
feed channels off-taking from Suleimanki.
1956 Construction of MR Link to transfer surplus water from the river
Chenab to the river Ravi.
1956 Construction of BRBD Link from the Upper Chenab Canal to feed the
truncated system of the eastern rivers.
1954-58 Construction of Taunsa Project with two off-taking canals;
Muzaffargarh Canal and Dera Ghazi Khan Canal.
2.4 Historic Water Rights and System Design
The traditional distribution of uncontrolled flows of hill torrents in tribal areas was based
on "Saroba-Paina", a system in which the farmers at the head reach had the right to
divert water up to their full requirements, and then passing the water on to the lower
riparians.
The earlier inundation canals were almost always constructed through the joint action
of rulers and farmers, and were thus recognized as the joint property or the state and
the irrigators. The state left the irrigators to manage the maintenance of works and the
distribution of water for themselves as much as possible. The state management was
generally exercised through village headmen and village revenue officials. In 1873,
the Government of India enacted "The Northern India Canal and Drainage Act"
applicable to the Punjab and NWFP (now Khyber Pakhtunkhawa) provinces, and the
"Sindh Irrigation Act" in 1879 for the Sindh region. Through these Acts, the
Government assumed the powers to regulate the use of water from rivers in the
interest of the public.
The Indus Basin, as a whole, is located in a water-scarce environment, where water
is a limiting resource for agricultural development. The water rights and system
designs have been historically evolved against this backdrop. The primary purpose of
the canal systems was protection against droughts and famines by bringing as large
areas under cultivation as possible, with thin water application. The historic irrigation
withdrawals were considered as legal water rights. With the construction of new
barrages and headworks, the canal withdrawals improved and their commands
acquired new water rights. To resolve regional water disputes, various commissions
also based their awards on historic withdrawals, rather than on crop water
requirements. The rules that serve the irrigation water allocation at a
watercourse/distributary level on canal commands were developed during British rule
over a century ago. Under these rules, water is delivered based on a predetermined
water allowance and size of the culturable commanded area (CCA). The canal outlets
are ungated structures and are designed to enable all the watercourses to draw the
allocated shares of water simultaneously under continuous flow conditions.
There has always been a demand for water in different provinces, states and regions,
particularly during critical periods of river flow shortages. The history of water disputes
date back to 1919, when some doubts were expressed about the availability of water
for the Sutlej Valley Project Canals. In order to examine the position of water
availability and allocation to various provinces/ states, a number of commissions were
set up between 1920 and 1977. The reports of the commissions were either shelved,
or their recommendations were selectively implemented, with the result that disputes
over the apportionment of river waters could not be satisfactorily resolved until 1991.
In the absence of a decision on water apportionment, adhoc arrangements were
followed for sharing of Indus Waters.
2-4 MANUAL OF IRRIGATION PRACTICE
HISTORY OF IRRIGATION DEVELOPMENT IN PUNJAB
Pakistan appointed Commissioners for Indus Waters, to serve as the regular channel
of communication on all the matters related to implementation of the Treaty.
Under the Treaty, restrictions have been placed on the design and the operation of
hydroelectric plants, storage works and other river works to be constructed by India
on the Western Rivers. India is required to supply Pakistan certain specified
information related to these works at least 6 months in advance of undertaking the
works so as to enable Pakistan to satisfy itself that the design conforms to criteria set
out in the Treaty. Within a specified period, ranging from two to three months, Pakistan
has the right to communicate to India, in writing, its objections that it may have
regarding the proposed design on the ground that it does not conform to certain criteria
specified in the Treaty.
The Treaty places restrictions on the irrigated cropped area to be raised by India in
the basins of Western Rivers. The Treaty also provides for a regular exchange of the
daily hydrological data and other data.
The Treaty provides for a self-generating procedure for the settlement of differences
and disputes. Any question which arises between the Parties concerning the
interpretation or application of the Treaty or the existence of any fact, which, if
established, might constitute a breach of the Treaty, is to be first examined by the
Commission, which endeavors to resolve the question by agreement.
2.7 Indus Basin Replacement Works
Under the Treaty, Pakistan was required to construct and bring into operation a system
of works on the Western Rivers in order to accomplish the replacement of water
supplies in irrigation canals in Pakistan, which at the time of partition were dependent
on water supplies from the Eastern Rivers. The replacement works comprised two
storages dams (one on Indus River and one on Jhelum River), six new barrages,
remodeling of two existing barrages, seven new inter-rivers link canals and remodeling
of two existing link canals. These works were implemented through the assistance
(grants and loans) by the friendly countries like USA, Canada, UK, Netherlands,
Germany, France, Italy, Australia, New Zealand, etc. The fund was called the Indus
Basin Development Fund and was set up and administered by the World Bank with
the assistance of Indus Basin Development Board, constituted by the Government of
Pakistan. India made a fixed contribution £ 62.060 million towards this Fund, which
was payable in ten years in equal installments. The estimated cost of replacement
works (1964 estimates) was US $ 1208.50 million. There was a transition period of 10
years during which Pakistan was to receive waters from the “Eastern Rivers” for use
in the aforementioned canals.
The works constructed under the Indus Basin Project are listed in Table 2.3, 2.4, 2.5
Table 2-3: Indus Basin Replacement Works (Indus Waters Treaty
Consequential Works) - DAMS
Live
Year of Height Storage
Dam River
Completion (Ft.) Capacity
(MAF)
Mangla Jhelum 1967 380 5.34
Tarbela Indus 1975 485 9.40
2-6 MANUAL OF IRRIGATION PRACTICE
HISTORY OF IRRIGATION DEVELOPMENT IN PUNJAB
then stagnated at this level up to 1989-90 and are now declining to around 104 MAF
due to reduction in reservoir capacities caused by progressive sedimentation.
Despite the positive impacts mentioned above, there have been some issues and
concerns related to the implementation of the Treaty. These include:
i). While planning and implementing the projects for hydroelectric power, India
continues to go ahead without taking into consideration the objections of
Pakistan.
ii). The Treaty does not provide for the required environmental flows in the Eastern
Rivers. This has resulted in serious environmental impacts in the long dry
reaches of these rivers including river channel aggradation, extinction of aquatic
life and gradual deterioration of groundwater quality.
iii). India has acquired capability to totally block the flows in river Chenab for
prolonged periods. This action is in contravention of the Treaty provisions and
has adverse implications for Pakistan.
iv). Issues have also been identified regarding provision of timely, adequate and
accurate hydrological data by India.
2.9 Water Apportionment Accord 1991
Development of water resources has remained frozen since 1976 and no new storage
or irrigation project could be constructed after the completion of the Tarbela Dam. This
stalemate has been due to the continuation of age-old disputes between the provinces
over sharing Indus waters. Signing of the Water Apporionment Accord between the
four provinces and the Federal Government in 1991 was a major step towards
resolving the longstanding water apportionment disputes, thereby promising to open
a gateway for irrigation development in the country. The salient features of the Accord
include clear definition of provincial shares in the existing river diversions, as well as
for future development projects, the establishment of an authority for regulation and
distribution of river water to the provinces, the recognition of the need to construct
storage for planned future agricultural development, and an agreement between
provinces to undertake new projects.
2.10 Main Features of Water Accord (1991)
The text of the Water Accord is presented in Box 2.1:
Box 2.1: Water Accord 1991
1. There was an agreement that the issue relating to apportionment of the
waters of the Indus River System should be settled as quickly as possible.
2. In the light of the accepted water distribution principles, the following
apportionment was agreed to:
Kharif Rabi Total
Province
(MAF) (MAF) (MAF)
Punjab 37.07 18.87 55.94
Sindh* 33.94 14.82 48.76
NWFP (now
3.48 2.30 5.78
KPK)
1.80 1.20 3.00
Civil Canals**
Baluchistan 2.85 1.02 3.87
2-8 MANUAL OF IRRIGATION PRACTICE
HISTORY OF IRRIGATION DEVELOPMENT IN PUNJAB
d) The provinces will have the freedom within their allocations to modify
system-wise and period-wise uses.
e) All efforts would be made to avoid wastages. Any surplus may be
used by another province, but this would not establish any rights to
such uses.
2.11 Post Accord Issues
The perceived benefits of the Accord however have not materialized so far because
of the delay in constructing of new storages. The existing river supplies are totally
committed to the existing projects. Therefore, in order for the Accord to be really
meaningful and for it to play an enabling role in irrigation development, there is a need
to initiate immediate steps to store surplus river water available during the high-flow
summer season, which is currently running waste into sea.
The other issues causing bitterness among the provinces relates to the differences
over interpretation of the procedure contained in Para 14(b) for sharing shortages and
surpluses. While the Sindh advocates post-Accord sharing according to the Para 2
allocations, Punjab holds the view that this would be operative when the available
supplies are equal to or more than the Para 2 allocations. In case the
available/utilizable supplies are less than Para 2 allocations, Punjab maintains that the
sharing may be in proportion to the existing uses.
Similarly, the study for determining the Kotri below escapages was inordinately
delayed and when conducted, the recommendations could not be implemented
without additional storages, as the existing supplies are fully committed.
2.12 Anti-water logging Measures and Groundwater Development
Before the construction of the extensive canal network, the groundwater was in a state
of natural equilibrium. After the construction of canals, the groundwater started to rise
due to seepage losses from unlined canals and watercourses and field application
losses. The annual rate of water table rises varied from 0.5 ft to more than 2 .0 ft,
depending upon the local environment. With rising water tables the menace of salinity
also developed. Various measures were undertaken up to 1950s to arrest the spread
of water logging and salinity, but these measures proved inadequate.
In 1961 the matter was discussed at the level of the Presidents of Pakistan and the
United States. As a result of this initiative at the highest level, various teams of US
experts visited Pakistan to help to plan anti-water logging measures. After
investigations and discussions, the expatriate experts proposed a new strategy, now
well known as the Salinity Control and Reclamation Project (SCARP) approach. This
approach envisaged the vertical drainage of land by pumping water through deep and
large capacity tubewells. In useable groundwater areas, the pumped water was
planned for use to supplement canal supplies. In addition, surface drainage systems
were augmented to address surface run-off problems. Soil reclamation was envisaged
through the drainage provided, and also by farmers' own efforts supplemented by
agricultural extension services.
With this concept, a large number of project units were planned and implemented. A
total of 10,196 tubewells, 8,260 in fresh groundwater and 1,936 in saline groundwater
areas, were installed. The number of operable tubewells, however, decreased to
around 9,000 by 1994, with annual pumpage of about 6 MAF. SCARP tubewells, by
and large, succeeded in curbing water logging problems in most of areas. The
2-10 MANUAL OF IRRIGATION PRACTICE
HISTORY OF IRRIGATION DEVELOPMENT IN PUNJAB
government's budget, however, has been taxed heavily on account of high operation
and maintenance (O&M) costs for tubewells, which is constantly increasing due to
rising electric tariffs. The overall performance of SCARPs is also on the decline due to
frequent power shut-downs and mechanical faults, fall in groundwater levels and
reduction in the specific capacity of the tubewells.
2.13 Private Tubewell Development
Concurrent with the development of public-funded SCARPs, there have been great
advances in private groundwater development in the Punjab Province. The demand
for additional irrigation water arising from increased cropping intensities and changes
in cropping patterns triggered a rapid growth of private tubewells. The number of
private tubewells, as such, increased from a mere 28,746 in 1965, to 147,995 in 1979,
to 213,408 in 1986 to 386,526 in 1994 and aggregates to around 1 million now. Fairly
generous credit facilities have provided the initial impetus and development of the local
industry, and indigenous methods have made it possible to continue and sustain
private tubewell development. The total pumpage from private tubewells has gradually
increased from 3.27 MAF in 1965 to 32.10 MAF in 1985-87. Currently, it is estimated
that public and private tubewells are contributing about 40-50 % of the total irrigation
water input in agriculture.
2.14 SCARP Transitioning
In view of the development of private tubewells and to avoid rapidly escalating
expenditure on O&M and replacement of fresh water SCARP tubewells, the
government adopted a policy to disinvest fresh groundwater (FGW) SCARP tubewells.
Under the SCARP transition pilot project, 213 FGW tubewells were replaced by 2,100
small capacity tubewells in the private sector. The pilot effort was replicated, through
subsequent SCARP transition projects resulting in transitioning of almost all the Fresh
Ground Water (FGW) tubewells. Currently public sector tubewells are being operated
for drainage of critical and Saline Ground Water areas.
References:
i) Irrigation Department Archives
ii) Indus Water Treaty 1960
iii) Water Apportionment Accord 1991
iv) IWARSI Publication 1995
MANUAL OF IRRIGATION PRACTICE i
PUNJAB’S IRRIGATION INFRASTRUCTURE
Chapter 3
PUNJAB’S IRRIGATION
INFRASTRUCTURE
Compiled by
Muhammad Ehsan
Reviewed by
Table of Contents
3 PUNJAB’S IRRIGATION INFRASTRUCTURE ............................................... 3-1
3.1 INTRODUCTION ............................................................................................ 3-1
3.2 PID INFRASTRUCTURE AND ITS EXTENT......................................................... 3-1
3.2.1 Water Diversion Structures.................................................................... 3-1
3.2.2 Irrigation Systems .................................................................................. 3-2
3.2.3 Drainage Systems ................................................................................. 3-2
3.2.4 Flood Protection Infrastructure .............................................................. 3-2
3.2.5 Territorial Spread of PID Infrastructure .................................................. 3-2
3.3 BARRAGES.................................................................................................. 3-3
3.4 LINK CANALS .............................................................................................. 3-6
3.4.1 Link Canals Constructed immediately after Independence ................... 3-7
3.4.2 Link Canals Constructed under Indus Basin Project ............................. 3-7
3.5 CANALS INFRASTRUCTURE ......................................................................... 3-10
3.5.1 Types of Canals .................................................................................. 3-10
3.6 DRAINAGE INFRASTRUCTURE...................................................................... 3-31
3.6.2 Surface Drainage Systems .................................................................. 3-33
3.7 SMALL DAMS............................................................................................. 3-84
3.8 FLOOD PROTECTION INFRASTRUCTURE ....................................................... 3-91
3.9 MAINTENANCE FACILITIES .......................................................................... 3-94
3.10 BUILDINGS ................................................................................................ 3-94
3.11 PLANTATION.............................................................................................. 3-94
List of Tables
Table 3.3.1: Barrages across the rivers in Punjab ................................................... 3-5
Table 3.6.1: List of the drains in Bahawalpur Zone ............................................... 3-33
Table 3.6.2: List of the drains in D.G. Khan Zone ................................................. 3-36
Table 3.6.3: List of the drains in Faisalabad Zone ................................................. 3-41
Table 3.6.4: List of the drains in Lahore Zone ....................................................... 3-53
Table 3.6.5: List of the drains in Multan Zone ....................................................... 3-68
Table 3.7.1: Cumulative statistics of small dams in Pothohar region .................... 3-84
Table 3.7.2: Particulars of Small Dams in Pothohar region ................................... 3-85
List of Figures
Figure 3.3.1: Diversion Structures in the Punjab Province ...................................... 3-4
Figure 3.4.1: Map Showing Link Canals .................................................................. 3-9
Figure 3.5.1: Irrigation Network of Punjab Province .............................................. 3-11
Figure 3.5.2: Bahawalpur Zone Irrigation Canals Network .................................... 3-15
Figure 3.5.3: Map of D.G. Khan Zone Showing Irrigation Canals Network ............ 3-18
Figure 3.5.4: Map of Faisalabad Zone Showing Irrigation Canals Network ........... 3-20
Figure 3.5.5: Map of Lahore Showing Irrigation Canals Network .......................... 3-23
Figure 3.5.6: Map of Multan Zone Showing Irrigation Canals Network.................. 3-27
Figure 3.5.7: Map of Sargodha Zone Showing Irrigation Network ......................... 3-30
Figure 3.6.1: Map showing the drains in Bahawalpur Zone................................... 3-35
Figure 3.6.2: Map showing the drains in D.G. Khan Zone ..................................... 3-40
Figure 3.6.3: Map showing the drains in Faisalabad Zone .................................... 3-52
iv MANUAL OF IRRIGATION PRACTICE
PUNJAB’S IRRIGATION INFRASTRUCTURE
Figure 3.6.4: Map showing the drains in Lahore Zone .......................................... 3-67
Figure 3.6.5: Map showing the drains in Multan Zone ........................................... 3-70
Figure 3.6.6: Map showing the drains in Sargodha Zone ...................................... 3-83
Figure 3.7.1: Location of small dams in the Punjab ............................................... 3-91
MANUAL OF IRRIGATION PRACTICE 3-1
PUNJAB’S IRRIGATION INFRASTRUCTURE
1
The application of water to the fields is made through surface (basins, furrows & ridges and sprinklers)
or sub-surface High Efficiency Irrigation Systems (Drip).
2 This component depends the types and operation of components (a), (b) and (c).
3-2 MANUAL OF IRRIGATION PRACTICE
PUNJAB’S IRRIGATION INFRASTRUCTURE
Feeder, which joins at the tail of Lower Chenab Canal Main Line Lower where it bifurcates into Jhang
Branch and Rakh Branch. Thus, only 14,500 cusecs outfalls upstream of Balloki Barrage.
11 To be increased from original design discharge of 645,000 cusecs while remodeling Trimmu Barrage
Discharge
Designed Name of off
River Barrage Year of of off taking
Sr.# Capacity taking
Name Construction Main Canal
(Cusecs) Channel (s)
(s) (Cusecs)
1. Ravi Balloki 380,000 1911-1914 Balloki 9,842
Barrage13 Sulemanki 24,50014
Link
Lower Bari
Doab Canal
2. Sidhnai 150,000 1967 Sidhnai 4,000
Barrage Canal 10,100
Sidhnai
Mailsi Link
1. Sutlej Sulemanki 325,000 1924-1926 Upper 6,600
Barrage15 Pakpattan
Canal 6,080
Eastern
Sadiqia 3,450
Canal
2. Islam 300,000 1922-1927 Fordwah
Bahawal 1,000
Barrage16 Canal 480
Qaim Canal
13 Was rehabilitated during 2013-2015, design capacity increased from 225,000 cft to 380,000 cft.
14 Was increased after the rehabilitation of Balloki Barrage
15 To be rehabilitated during 2014-2017
16 To be rehabilitated
MANUAL OF IRRIGATION PRACTICE 3-7
PUNJAB’S IRRIGATION INFRASTRUCTURE
from adjacent rivers. These are: (i) Trimmu-Sidhnai (TS Link); (ii) Sidhnai-Mailsi (SM
Link); (iii) Mailsi-Bahawal (MB Link); (iv) Rasul-Qadirabad (RQ Link); (v) Qadirabad-
Balloki (QB Link); (vi) Balloki-Sulemanki II (BS II Link), (vii) Taunsa-Punjnad (TP Link);
and (viii) Chashma-Jhelum (CJ Link). Beside construction of aforementioned link
canals the remodeling of (i) Marala-Ravi Link; (ii) Bombawala-Ravi-Bedian-Depalpur
Link;(iii) Balloki-Sulemanki-I Link was included in the Indus Basin Project.
3.4.1 Link Canals Constructed immediately after Independence
Marala-Ravi (M.R) Link: It offtakes from Marala barrage with the design capacity of
22,000 cusecs and is 333,135 ft. long. Before splitting into M-R Sub Link and main M-
R Link, it feeds 20 distrbutary channels and 16 Minors. Although its design discharge
is 22,000 cusecs but it has never carried more than 19,000 cusecs due to reduction
of its canal prism. This reduction is the result of its less silt carrying capacity due its
inadequate bed slope. The bed level at Dek Nullah syphon is constraint which does
not allow its regrading.
Bombawala-Ravi-Bedian-Depalpur (B.R.B.D) Link: Its starting point is the Tail of
Main Line Upper (Upper Chenab Canal) at RD 133. Its design discharge is 7,260
cusecs (205.580 cumecs) and it is 434,000± ft. long. It passes under the river Ravi
through Ravi Syphon. Its first reach of 260+000± ft. is unlined, middle reach of
113+000± ft. is lined followed by last reach of 63+000± ft. which is unlined.
Balloki-Sulemanki I (B-S I) Link: It offtakes from Balloki barrage which is located
across the river Ravi. It was constructed to supply water to some of those channels
whose control remained in India at Ferozepore Headworks. Its present design
capacity is 24,500 cusecs at its head regulator at Balloki Barrage. It outfalls in the river
Sutlej upstream of Sulemanki Barrage after traveling 266,600+ ft. Its first 73,000 ft.
length is unlined while the remaining length is brick lined.
Sub M-.R Link: It offtakes from M.R Link just before it outfalls into the river Ravi. Then
it joins B.R.B.D link before passing the Ravi syphon. It was constructed to augment
supplies in B.R.B.D link. Its design discharge is 5,000 cusecs it is 12,170±ft long.
3.4.2 Link Canals Constructed under Indus Basin Project
Trimmu-Sidhnai (T-S) Link: It offtakes from Trimmu barrage with the design capacity
of 12,500 cusecs (353.961 cumecs) and is 214,000+ ft. (65.23 Km) long. Its alignment
is parallel to the Haveli Canal, the offtaking canal on the left side of Trimmu barrage
at the time of its construction. A mechanical dredger was provided to clear the
sediment expected in the link canal. However, the need of its use did not arise due to
lesser quantity of sediment than was expected. It conveys water from the river Chenab
to the river Ravi upstream of new Sidhnai barrage, also constructed under the Indus
Basin Project.
Sidhnai-Mailsi (S-M) Link: It offtakes from new Sidhnai barrage with the design
capacity of 10,100 cusecs (286.000 cumecs) and is 250,420 ft. (76.33 Km) long. It
conveys water from the river Ravi to Mailsi Canal. Part of its design discharge (±5,590
cusecs) is conveyed through Mailsi Syphon, also constructed as part the Indus Basin
Project works, to Mailsi-Bahawal Link canal.
Mailsi-Bahawal (M-B) Link: It starts from left side of Mailsi Syphon with capacity of
5,590± cusecs (158.291 cumecs) and is about 125,000 ft. (38.10 Km) long. It conveys
water from tail of Sidhnai-Mailsi Link to augment discharge of Bahawal canal, which
offtakes from Islam barrage.
3-8 MANUAL OF IRRIGATION PRACTICE
PUNJAB’S IRRIGATION INFRASTRUCTURE
Rasul-Qadirabad (R-Q) Link: It offtakes from new Rasul barrage, also constructed
under the Indus Basin Project, with the design capacity of 19,000 cusecs (538.020
cumecs) and is 147,156 ft. (44.853 Km) long. It conveys water from the river Jhelum
to the river Chenab upstream of Qadirabad barrage, constructed as part the Indus
Basin Project works.
Qadirabad-Balloki (Q-B) Link: It offtakes from Qadirabad barrage, constructed
under the Indus Basin Project, with the design capacity of 25,000 cusecs (707.921
cumecs) and is 397,415 ft. (121.13 Km) long. A mechanical dredger was provided to
clear the sediment expected in the link canal. However, the need of its use did not
arise as the quantity of sediment was lesser than expected. It conveys water from the
river Chenab to the river Ravi upstream Balloki barrage.
Balloki-Sulemanki II (B-S II) Link: Balloki-Sulemanki I Link needed remodeling for
carrying more discharge after signing of “Indus Water Treaty 1960”. It was easier to
remodel B-S I Link in the unlined reach upto RD 73. But the lined reach from RD 73
to its tail at RD 266+600 could not be remodeled easily and economically. Bifurcation
into two link canals which were to run parallel to each other from RD 73 was the
preferred solution in order to pass discharge beyond the capacity of lined section in
the second channel. Thus, B-S II Link offtakes from RD 73 of Balloki-Sulemanki I Link
canal. B-S II Link has design discharge of 9,000 cusecs (254.852 cumecs) and is
193,000 ft. (58.83 Km) long. Like B-S I Link, it conveys water to the river Sutlej
upstream of Sulemanki to feed Sutlej valley canals whose water supply was stopped
by India under the Indus Water Treaty.
Taunsa-Punjnad (T-P) Link: It offtakes from Taunsa barrage with the design capacity
of 12,000 cusecs (339.802 cumecs) and is 191,000 ft. (58.22 Km) long. It conveys
water from the river Indus to the river Chenab in proximity of Multan, upstream of
Punjnad barrage.
Chashma-Jhelum (C-J) Link: It offtakes from new Chashma barrage, also
constructed under the Indus Basin Project, with the design capacity of 21,700 cusecs
(614.476 cumecs) and is 321,222 ft. (97.91 Km) long. It conveys water from the river
Indus to the river Jhelum 96.6 km upstream of Trimmu barrage. It also conveys ----
cusecs discharge for Greater Thal Canal, which offtakes at ------.The operation and
maintenance of C-J Link is not by PID.
Figure 3.4.1 shows the map of the link canals in the Punjab province
MANUAL OF IRRIGATION PRACTICE 3-9
PUNJAB’S IRRIGATION INFRASTRUCTURE
DEVELOPMENT
ZONE
LAHORE
ZONE
SARGODHA
ZONE
FAISALABAD
ZONE
MULTAN
ZONE
D. G. K H A N
ZONE
BAHAWALPUR
ZONE
water to two (2) distributary channels. Part flows of these distributaries are used for
supplying water to four (4) minor and three (3) sub minor channels. The cumulative
length of distributary and minor channels is 646,000±ft. (196.90 Km).
Malik branch is 117+000± ft. (35.66 Km) long and is designed to carry a discharge of
1,538 cusecs (43.551 cumecs). It feeds five (5) distributary channels, part flow of those
is used for supplying water to twenty three (23) minor and four (4) sub minor channels.
The cumulative length of distributary and minor channels is 1,440,000±ft. (438.91 Km).
Hakara branch is 257+000± ft. (78.33 Km) long and is designed to carry a discharge
of 2,400 cusecs (67.960 cumecs). It feeds sixteen (16) distributary channels and a
flood channel, part flow of those is used for supplying water to twenty three (23) minor
and four (4) sub minor channels. The cumulative length of distributary and minor
channels is 1,983,000±ft. (604.42 Km).
Panjnad Canal System: Panjnad canal off-takes from Panjnad Barrage. It is
277,000± ft. (84.43 Km) long and is designed to carry a discharge of 10,884 cusecs
(308.20 cumecs). Four (4) branch canals namely, Minchin branch, Rahim Yar Khan
branch, Sadiq branch and Dallas branch off-take from Panjnad Canal. It directly
supplies water to nineteen (19) distributary channels, part flows of these are used to
supply water to sixteen (16) minor and three (3) sub minor channels. The cumulative
length of distributary and minor channels is 1,222,000±ft. (372.47 Km).
Minchin branch is 155+000± ft. (47.24 Km) long and is designed to carry a discharge
of 1,527 cusecs (43.240 cumecs). It feeds fourteen (14) distributary channels part flow
of those is used for supplying water to twenty five (25) minor and two (2) sub minor
channels. The cumulative length of distributary and minor channels is 1,619,000±ft.
(493.47 Km).
Rahim Yar Khan branch is 187+000± ft. (57.00 Km) long and is designed to carry a
discharge of 1,291 cusecs (36.557 cumecs). It feeds nineteen (19) distributary
channels part flow of those is used for supplying water to seven (7) minor and one (1)
sub minor channels. The cumulative length of distributary and minor channels is
914,000±ft. (278.59 Km).
Sadiq branch is 254+000± ft. (77.42 Km) long and is designed to carry a discharge of
1,384 cusecs (39.191 cumecs). It feeds twenty two (22) distributary channels part flow
of those is used for supplying water to ten (10) minor and nine (9) sub minor channels.
The cumulative length of distributary and minor channels is 1,167,000±ft. (355.70 Km).
Dallas branch is 163+000± ft. (49.68 Km) long and is designed to carry a discharge of
2,604 cusecs (73.737 cumecs). It feeds twenty four (24) distributary channels part flow
of those is used for supplying water to forty one (41) minor and nine (9) sub minor
channels. The cumulative length of distributary and minor channels is 2,198,000±ft.
(669.957 Km).
Abbasia Canal System: Abbasia canal off-takes from Panjnad Barrage. It is
225,000± ft. (68.58 Km) long and is designed to carry a discharge of 1,394 cusecs
(39.474 cumecs). No branch canal off-takes from Abbasia Canal. It directly supplies
water to seventeen (17) distributary channels, part flows of these are used to supply
water to twelve (12) minor and two (2) sub minor channels. The cumulative length of
distributary and minor channels is 1,222,000±ft. (372.47 Km).
Map of Bahawalpur Zone showing irrigation canals network is given in Figure 3.5.2.
3-14 MANUAL OF IRRIGATION PRACTICE
PUNJAB’S IRRIGATION INFRASTRUCTURE
Map of D.G.Khan Zone showing irrigation canals network is given in Figure 3.5.3.
(c) Faisalabad Zone
Faisalabad Zone has only Lower Chenab Canal (L.C.C) System.
Lower Chenab Canal System Lower Chenab Canal L.C.C) off-takes from from left
side of Khanki Barrage. Its length is 140.000 ft. (42.67 Km) and is designed to carry a
discharge of 15,00017 cusecs (424.753 cumecs). There are ten (10) branch canals in
Lower Chenab Canal (LCC) System namely, Kot Nikka branch, Main Line Lower,
Upper Gugera branch, Lower Gugera branch, Burala branch, Mian Ali branch, Rakh
branch, Jhang branch Upper, Jhang branch Lower and Bhowana branch. It directly
supplies water to seven (7) distributary channels, part flows of these are used to
supply water to eighteen (18) minor and sub minor channels. The cumulative length
of these distributary and minor and sub minor channels is 585,000±ft. (178.31 Km).
Kot Nikka branch is 91,000± ft. (27.74 Km) long and is designed to carry a discharge
of 536 cusecs (15.18 cumecs). It supplies water to fourteen (14) distributary channels,
part flows of some of these are used for supplying water to seven (7) minor channels.
The cumulative length of distributary and minor channels is 484,000± ft. (147.52 Km).
Main Line Lower branch off-takes at RD 140+000 (tail) of L.C.C. It is 60,000± ft. (18.20
Km) long and is designed to carry a discharge of 3,000 cusecs (84.951 cumecs). It
supplies water to four (4) distributary channels and part flows of three (3) of these
distributary channels are used for supplying water to three (3) minor channels. The
cumulative length of these distributary and minor channels is 189,900 ft. (57.61 Km).
Upper Gugera branch off-takes at RD 140+000 (tail) of L.C.C. It is 282,000± ft. (85.95
Km) long and is designed to carry a discharge of 7,425 cusecs (210.253 cumecs). It
supplies water to seventeen (17) distributary channels and part flows of some of these
distributary channels are used for supplying water to twenty four (24) minor channels.
The cumulative length of these distributary and minor channels is 1,590,900 ft. (484.91
Km).
Lower Gugera branch off-takes at RD 282+000 (tail) of Upper Gugera branch. It is
388,000± ft. (118.26 Km) long and is designed to carry a discharge of 2,662 cusecs
(75.379 cumecs). It supplies water to thirty four (34) distributary channels and part
flows of some of these distributary channels are used for supplying water to twenty
seven (27) minor and one (1) sub minor channels. The cumulative length of these
distributary and minor channels is 1,885,000 ft. (574.55 Km).
Figure 3.5.3: Map of D.G. Khan Zone Showing Irrigation Canals Network
MANUAL OF IRRIGATION PRACTICE 3-19
PUNJAB’S IRRIGATION INFRASTRUCTURE
Lower Sohag branch canal is 213,000± ft. (64.92 Km) long and is designed to carry a
discharge of 1,456 cusecs (41.229 cumecs). It supplies water to twenty two (22)
distributary channels, part flows of some of which are used for supplying water to
twelve (12) minor channels. The cumulative length of these distributary and minor
channels is 982,000±ft. (299.31 Km).
Khanwah branch canal is 42,000± ft. (12.80 Km) long and is designed to carry a
discharge of 1,037 cusecs (29.36 cumecs). It supplies water to two (2) distributary
channels part flows of which are used to supply water to eleven (11) minor and sub
minor channels. The cumulative length of these distributary and minor channels is
731,000±ft. (222.81 Km).
Off-takes from B.R.B.D Link: Three (3) branch canals namely, Muridke branch,
Lahore branch and Main branch Lahore, off-take from B.R.B.D Link. Additionally, it
supplies water directly to twenty one (21) distributary channels, part flows of some of
these distributary channels are used for supplying water to forty six (46) minor and sub
minor channels.
Muridke branch is 60,000± ft. (18.29 Km) long and is designed to carry a discharge of
714 cusecs (20.22 cumecs). It supplies water to two (2) distributary channels and one
(1) minor channel directly. Part flows of these two (2) distributaries are used for
supplying water to fourteen (14) minor channels. The cumulative length of these
distributary and minor channels is 637,000 ft. (194.16 Km).
Lahore branch is 96+000± ft. (29.26 Km) long and is designed to carry a discharge of
403 cusecs (11.41 cumecs). It used to feed two (2) distributary and two (2) minor
channels. The cumulative length of these distributary and minor channels is 327,000
ft. (99.67 Km).
Main Branch Lower is 190,000± ft. (57.91 Km) long and is designed to carry a
discharge of 1,530 cusecs (43.32 cumecs). It supplies water to sixteen (16) distributary
channels, part flows of these are used for supplying water to seventeen (17) minor
channels. The cumulative length of these distributary and minor channels is 1,191,000
ft. (363.02 Km).
Off-takes from M-R Link: M.R Link feeds directly twenty (20) distributary channels
part flows of these are used to supply water to fourteen (14) minor and two (2) sub
minor channels. The cumulative length of these minors and sub minor channels is
935,000± ft.
(284.99 Km).
Map of Lahore Zone showing irrigation canals network is given in Figure 3.5.5.
Multan Zone: There are seven (7) main canal systems in Multan Zone: (i) Lower Bari
Doab Canal (L.B.D.C) System; (ii) Pakpattan Canal System; (iii) Bahawal Canal
System; (iv) Mailsi Canal System (v) Rangpur Canal System; (vi) Haveli Canal
System; and (vii) Sidhnai Canal System.
Lower Bari Doab Canal System: Lower Bari Doab Canal (L.B.D.C) off-takes from left
side of Balloki Barrage. It is 660,700 ft. (201.38 Km) long and is designed to carry a
discharge of 9,842 cusecs (278.694 cumecs). Only two (2) branch canals namely,
Gugera branch and 10-R Jahanian branch off-take from L.B.D.C. Gugera branch off-
takes from right side of L.B.D.C. at RD 58+818, and 10-R Jahanian branch from tail
L.B.D.C. at RD 660+700.
MANUAL OF IRRIGATION PRACTICE 3-23
PUNJAB’S IRRIGATION INFRASTRUCTURE
off-take from S.M.B Link, which existed in Bahawal canal command prior to
construction of S.M.B Link. Four (4) minor channels off-take from two of these
distributary channels. The cumulative length of these four (5) distributary channels and
two (2) minor channels is 132,000±ft (40.23 Km).
Karam branch is 21,000±ft. (6.40 Km) and is designed to carry a discharge of 630
cusecs (17.840 cumecs). It supplies water to six (6) distributary channels part flows of
four (4) of these distributaries are used for supplying water nine (9) minor channels.
The cumulative length of distributary and minor channels is 399,000±ft. (121.62 Km).
Mailsi Canal System: Mailsi Canal off-takes from RD: 250420/R of S.M.B. Link. It is
91,000 ft. (27.74 Km) long and is designed to carry a discharge of 3,705 cusecs
(104.914 cumecs). It bifurcates into two (2) branch canals at its tail structure namely,
Chit Dain branch and Lodhran branch. Seven (7) directly off-take from Mailsi Canal.
Part flows of two of these distributaries are used for supplying water to two (2) minor
channels. The cumulative length of distributary channels and minor channels is
353,000± ft. (107.59 Km).
Chit Dain branch is 94,000± ft. (28.65 Km) long and is designed to carry a discharge
of 1,819 cusecs (51.508 cumecs). It supplies water directly to ten (10) distributary
channels. Part flows of some of these channels are used for supplying water to
fourteen (14) minor and one (1) sub minor channels. The cumulative length of
distributary and minor channels is 741,000± ft. (225.86 Km).
Lodhran branch is 85,000± ft. (25.91 Km) long and is designed to carry a discharge of
1,246 cusecs (35.283 cumecs). It supplies water to fourteen (14) distributary channels.
Part flows of some of these channels are used for supplying water to six (6) minor and
three (3) sub minor channels. The cumulative length of these minor and sub minor
channels is 924,000± ft. (281.64 Km).
Rangpur Canal System: Rangpur Canal off-takes from right side of Trimmu Barrage.
Its design discharge is 2,710 cusecs (76.739 cumecs). Its total length is 442,000± ft.
(134.72 Km) out of which 30,000 ft. (9.14 Km) in the tail is located D.G. Khan Zone.
From RD 0+000 to RD 412+000 is located in Multan Zone. No branch canal off-takes
in this reach. The reach RD 0+000 to RD 320+000 supplies water to twelve (12)
distributary channels, one of these is a lift channel. Part flows of some of these
channels are used for supplying water to six (6) minor channels. No channel off-takes
in the reach from RD 320+000 to RD 412+000. The cumulative length of these
distributary and minor channels is 885,000±ft (269.75 Km).
Haveli Canal System: Haveli Canal off-takes from left side of Trimmu Barrage. Its
design discharge is 5,170 cusecs (76.739 cumecs). Its total length is 218,000± ft.
(66.45 Km). No branch canal off-takes in this reach. It supplies water to five (5)
distributary channels part flows of three (3) of these distributaries are used for
supplying water sixteen (16) minor and two (2) sub minor channels. The cumulative
length of these distributary and minor channels is 840,000±ft (256.03 Km).
Sidhnai Canal off-takes from tail of Sidhnai feeder at RD 35+561, which off-takes from
left side of Sidhnai Barrage. It is 122,139 ft. (37.23 Km) long and is designed to carry
a discharge of 4,005 cusecs (113.409 cumecs). Sidhnai Canal System contains four
(4) branch canals namely, Multan branch, Makhdoom Rashid branch, Shujabad
branch and Gajju Hatta Branch. Shujabad branch off-takes from RD 43+280/R of
Sidhnai Canal while Gajju Hatta branch off-takes from RD 300+418 (tail) of Shujabad
3-26 MANUAL OF IRRIGATION PRACTICE
PUNJAB’S IRRIGATION INFRASTRUCTURE
Branch. Sidhnai Canal bifurcates into Multan branch and Makhdoom branch at RD
157+700 (tail).
Sixteen (16) distributary channels directly off-take from Sidhnai Canal. Part flows of
some of these channels are used for supplying water to ten (10) minor channels. The
cumulative length of distributary channels and minor channels directly off-taking from
Sidhnai Canal is 883,000± ft. (269.14 Km).
Multan branch is 98,000± ft. (29.87 Km) long and is designed to carry a discharge of
775 cusecs (21.946 cumecs). It supplies water to eight (8) distributary channels. Part
flows of four (4) of these distributaries are used for supplying water to six (6) minor
and one (1) sub minor channels. The cumulative length of distributary and minor
channels is 857,000± ft. (261.21 Km).
Makhdoom Rashid branch is 39,000± ft. (11.89 Km) long and is designed to carry a
discharge of 425 cusecs (12.035 cumecs). It supplies water to four (4) distributary
channels. Part flows of two (2) of these distributaries are used for supplying water to
six (6) minor channels. The cumulative length of distributary and minor channels is
462,000± ft. (140.82 Km).
Shujabad branch is 300,418 ft. (91.57 Km) long and is designed to carry a discharge
of 1,918 cusecs (54.312 cumecs). It supplies water to sixteen (16) distributary
channels. Part flows of seven (7) of these distributaries are used for supplying water
to thirteen (13) minor and two (2) sub minor channels. The cumulative length of
distributary and minor channels is 947,000± ft. (288.65 Km).
Gajju Hatta branch is 78,000± ft. (23.77 Km) long and is designed to carry a discharge
of 700 cusecs (19.822 cumecs). It supplies water to eight (8) distributary channels.
Part flows of three (3) of these distributaries are used for supplying water to seven (7)
minor and two (2) sub minor channels. The cumulative length of distributary and minor
channels is 523,000± ft. (159.41 Km).
Map of Multan Zone showing irrigation canals network is given in Figure 3.5.6.
(a). Sargodha Zone
There are four (4) main canal systems in Sargodha Zone: (i) Upper Jhelum Canal
(UJC) System; (ii) Lower Jhelum Canal (LJC); (iii) Thal Canal Main Line Upper System;
and (iv) Thal Canal Main Line Lower System. In addition to these four main canal
system there is a non-perennial system namely, Kas Umar Khan System.
Upper Jhelum Canal System: Upper Jhelum Canal (UJC) off-takes from left side of
Mangla Headworks. It is 440,000± ft. (134.11 Km) long and is designed to carry a
discharge of 9,031 cusecs (255.729 cumecs). Only two (2) branch canals namely,
Gujrat branch and Phalia branch off-take from UJC. Twelve (12) distributary channels
off-take from UJC. Part flows of some of these channels are used for supplying water
to thirteen (13) minor and one (1) sub minor channels. The cumulative length of
distributary and minor channels directly off-taking from Sidhnai Canal is 855,000± ft.
(260.60 Km).
Phalia branch is 17,000± ft. (5.18 Km) long and is designed to carry a discharge of
376 cusecs (10.647 cumecs). It supplies water to four (4) distributary channels. Part
flows of these distributary channels are used for supplying water to twelve (12) minor
and two (2) sub minor channels. The cumulative length of distributary and minor
channels is 600,000± ft. (182.88 Km).
MANUAL OF IRRIGATION PRACTICE 3-27
PUNJAB’S IRRIGATION INFRASTRUCTURE
Thal Main Line Upper System: Thal Main Line (Upper) off-takes from left side of
Jinnah Barrage. It is 157,662 ft. (48.06 Km) long and is designed to carry a discharge
of 9,000 cusecs (254.852 cumecs). Two (2) branch canals namely, Mohajir branch
and Dullewala branch off-take from Thal Main Line (Upper). In addition a short Link
channel also distributes water. Thal Main Line (Upper) directly distributes water to
thirteen (13) distributary channels including three (3) lift canals, which directly off-take
from Thal Main Line (Upper). Part flows of some distributary channels are used for
supplying water to six (6) minor and one (1) sub minor channels. The cumulative length
of distributary and minor channels directly off-taking from Thal Main Line Upper Canal
is 546,000± ft. (166.42 Km).
Mohajir branch is 202,000± ft. (61.57 Km) long and is designed to carry a discharge
of 1,463 cusecs (41.428 cumecs). It supplies water to ten (10) distributary channels.
Part flows of these distributary channels are used for supplying water to twenty two
(22) minor channels. The cumulative length of distributary and minor channels is
1,099,000± ft. (334.98 Km).
Dullewala branch is 108,000± ft. (32.92 Km) long and is designed to carry a discharge
of 869 cusecs (24.607 cumecs). It supplies water to fifteen (15) distributary channels.
Part flows of these distributary channels are used for supplying water to sixteen (16)
minor channels. The cumulative length of distributary and minor channels is 991,000±
ft. (302.06 Km).
Link Channel is 21,000± ft. (6.40 Km) long and is designed to carry a discharge of 569
cusecs (16.112 cumecs). It supplies water to three (3) distributary channels. Part flows
of these distributary channels are used for supplying water to thirteen (13) minor
channels. The cumulative length of distributary and minor channels is 755,000± ft.
(230.12 Km).
Thal Main Line Lower System: Thal Main Line (Lower) off-takes from the tail of Thal
Main Line (Upper) at RD 157+662. It is 502,000± ft. (153.01 Km) long and is designed
to carry a discharge of 4,524 cusecs (128.105 cumecs). Three (3) branch canals
namely, Bakht branch, Indus and Munda branch off-take from Thal Main Line (Upper).
Thal Main Line (Upper) directly distributes water to twenty eight (28) distributary
channels. Part flows of some these distributary channels are used for supplying water
to forty one (41) minor and four (4) sub minor channels. The cumulative length of
distributary and minor channels directly off-taking from Sidhnai Canal is 3,265,000± ft.
(995.17 Km).
Bakht branch is 63,000± ft. (19.20 Km) long and is designed to carry a discharge of
524 cusecs (14.838 cumecs). It supplies water to three (3) distributary channels, part
flows of which are used for supplying water to four (4) minor channels. The cumulative
length of distributary and minor channels is 420,000± ft. (128.02 Km).
Indus branch is 51,000± ft. (15.55 Km) long and is designed to carry a discharge of
575 cusecs (16.282 cumecs). It supplies water to seven (7) distributary channels. Part
flows of four (4) of these distributary channels are used for supplying water to ten (10)
minor channels. The cumulative length of distributary and minor channels is
1,025,000± ft. (312.42 Km).
Munda branch is 112,000± ft. (34.14 Km) long and is designed to carry a discharge of
1,396 cusecs (39.530 cumecs). It supplies water to nine (9) distributary channels. Part
flows of six (6) of these distributary channels are used for supplying water to nineteen
3-30 MANUAL OF IRRIGATION PRACTICE
PUNJAB’S IRRIGATION INFRASTRUCTURE
(19) minor and eleven (11) sub minor channels. The cumulative length of distributary
and minor channels is 2,078,000± ft. (633.37 Km).
Kas Umar Khan System: Kas Umar System off-takes form the river Kurram. It
comprises two (2) distributary namely, Kas Umar Khan and Namal Distributary. Part
flows of these distributary channels are used for supplying water to four (4) minor and
one (1) sub minor channels. The cumulative length of distributary and minor channels
is 172,000± ft. (52.43 Km).
Map of Sargodha Zone showing irrigation canals network is given in Figure 3.5.7.
4,574.45 Km. and 1,332.40 Km. respectively. Total number of sumps in the two
schemes is one hundred thirty five (135).
(c). Tubewells
Tubewells provide vertical drainage of water-logged soils due to raised water table.
Installation of tubewells was commenced in the 1960s to combat the twin menace of
water logging and salinity under the Salinity Control and Reclamation Projects
(SCARPs). About 9,900 tubewells were installed in Punjab from 1960 to 1990 under
these projects of which around 1,600 were in saline groundwater areas. The SCARP
tubewells (STWs) not only provided the subsurface drainage relief but also
supplemented irrigation water in fresh groundwater (FGW) areas for conjunctive use
with canal water. Observing the double benefit that the tubewells were effective
dependable means of water supply and land reclamation through vertical drainage,
the farmers also started installing their own tubewells, which gave rise to the large
scale growth of private tubewells (PTWs) in the Province.
Notwithstanding the initial success of the STWs, their performance gradually
decreased with time. Over the period, the number of properly functioning SCARP
tubewells decreased as a result of poor operation and maintenance, which was due
to financial constraints. Whereas the number of private tubewells (PTWs) in Punjab
had grown to around 500,000 by the year 2007, which were successfully being
operated and maintained by the farmers due to individual personal care. The high cost
of operation and maintenance of STWs (largely due to increased electricity tariff), and
growing constraints on public sector investment led to the review of the government
policy with regard to groundwater development. In 1979 a Revised Action Programme
(RAP) for irrigated agriculture was prepared by WAPDA which recommended: (i)
transfer of responsibility for future groundwater development in fresh groundwater
areas to the private sector and replacement of existing STWs by PTWs of smaller
capacity; and (ii) STWs in saline groundwater areas (SGW) would continue to be
installed and maintained by the public sector. The government endorsed the RAP
recommendations and incorporated the same in its revised National Agricultural Policy
(NASP) in 1980. The Seventh Five Year Plan (1983-93) also placed a great reliance
on PTW development and gradual transition of STWs.
Recognizing the major contribution of the private sector in groundwater development,
the Government initiated a program to induce the private sector to invest in tubewells
through appropriate financial incentives and technical guidance. However before
proceeding with the large scale transition of STWs, it was considered prudent to
assess the farmers’ reaction and to study the feasibility of transition concept.
Accordingly, a Pilot Project was implemented in Khankah Dogran Scheme of SCARP-
I (1988-92). Under the pilot project 213 STWs were replaced with 2,100 PTWs by
providing necessary financial incentives and technical guidance to the farmers.
The enthusiastic response by the farmers prompted the Government to expand the
transition activity in the whole of SCARP-I area. Accordingly, under Second SCARP
Transition Project (SSTP) 1,452 STWs were transitioned and replaced by 4,700
PTWs/CTWs. Punjab Private Sector Groundwater Development Project (PPSGDP)
involved the transition of 4,230 STWs and their replacement with 6,300 Community
tubewells ( CTWs). The process of privatization of tubewells was continued. Presently
(year 2016), a nominal number public sector tube wells is operated by PID.
MANUAL OF IRRIGATION PRACTICE 3-33
PUNJAB’S IRRIGATION INFRASTRUCTURE
Drain 10- 11 3
5 Mastoi Drain 10- 35 5
Mastoi R.H Canal Drain 10- 13
6 Thal Hamza Drain 10- 19 8
Thal Hamza Sub Drain 10- 18 4
7 Gabool Main Drain 10- 29 10
Gabool Sub Drain 10- 18 5
8 Malkani Main Drain 10- 45 9
9 Umar Main Dain 10- 9 2
MANUAL OF IRRIGATION PRACTICE 3-35
PUNJAB’S IRRIGATION INFRASTRUCTURE
Discharge
Discharge
Width (ft.)
Width (ft.)
Name of Name of
(cusecs)
(cusecs)
Design
Design
Length
Length
(RD.)
(RD)
Drainage Drainage
Bed
Bed
System System
Darkhast
Project Circle 10- 4
34
Drain
Old
Manka 15+ 151 Drain No. I 10- 185
36
1
Bhatti Kapper
10- 8 15+ 77
37
Drain Drain
2
--- ---
I-L Bhatti
10- 2 New Maneka Drainage System
Drain
3
---
New
Chandia 10-
2 1 Manka 15+ 126
Drain 15
4
Salareen Tayyab
10- 9 2 10- 57
Drain Drain
5
--- ---
I-L
Darkhast
Salareen 10- 1 3 10- 43
Drain
6
2-L
Muhamma
Salareen 10- 4 4 10- 10
d Pur Drain
7
I-R
Leshari
Salareen 10- 3 5 10- 16
Drain
8
Sakhi Bukhari
10- 4 6 15+ 89
Drain Drain
9
--- ---
Daggar
10- 11 Muzaffargarh Circle
10
Drain
---
I-L
Dagger 10- 5 Ghazi Ghat Drainage System
11
Drain ---
1-L Ghazi
2-L
Ghat
Thatha 10- 75 10- 82 80
14
Branch
Drain
--- Drain
Chahan
10- 5 Kot Adu Drainage System
15
Drain
---
I-L
Kot Adu
Chahan 10- 1 15+ 138 500
16
Main Drain
Drain ---
I-R Budh
10-
Chahan 10- 1 Branch 88 175
17
15
Drain --- Drain
M.Garh
Choti 10-
11 Branch 10- 19 100
18
Drain 15
--- Drain
M.Garh
I-L Choti
10- 5 L/Branch 10- 13 50
19
Drain
--- Drain
3-38 MANUAL OF IRRIGATION PRACTICE
PUNJAB’S IRRIGATION INFRASTRUCTURE
2-L Choti
10- 4 Ali Pur Drainage System
20
Drain
---
I-L
1-L Branch
Jalohar 10- 1 10- 16 50
22
Drain
Drain ---
I-R
2-L Branch
Jalohar 10- 1 10- 17 50
23
Drain
Drain ---
Khatoo Saline
15 42 10- 123
24
Drain Ditch -
---
I-L
Khatoo 10- 2 Khan Ghar Drainage System
25
Drain ---
Drain 15 Drain
---
Khangarh
I-L Ziarat
10- 11 Sub Drain 10- 17 20
27
Drain
--- A
Khangarh
Bakhar
10- 6 Sub Drain 10- 15 32
28
Drain
--- B
Khangarh
Sultan
10- 7 Sub Drain 10- 9 12
29
Drain
--- C
Mianwala
10- 6 Hanjrai Drainage System
30
Drain
---
Jamal Sanawan
10- 3 10- 63
32
Drain Drain
--- ---
Drain Drain
--- ---
Figure 3.6.2 shows map of the drainage systems in D.G. Khan Zone.
3-40 MANUAL OF IRRIGATION PRACTICE
PUNJAB’S IRRIGATION INFRASTRUCTURE
Bed Width
Discharge
Discharge
Name of (1000 ft.) Name of
(1000 ft.)
(cusecs)
(cusecs)
Length
Design
Length
Design
Drainage Drainage
System System
Drain
Samundr
Sarwar
2 i Branch 10- 101 290 10- 101 121
Wali Drain
6
Drain
Ext:
Samundr Chaku
3 10- 17 - 10- 43 150
i Branch Drain
7
Drain
Samundr
Jagatan
4 i Try 10- 22 20 10- 31 27
Drain
8
Drain
1-R Try
Haripur
5 Drain of 10- 7 8 10- 14 14
Drain
9
SBD
2-L Try
Lundiawal
6 Drain of 10- 7 12 10- 8 5
10
a Drain
SBD
SBD Drain
Ahmeda
559/GB
8 bad Try 10- 11 10 10- 11 10
12
Try Drain.
Drain
3-42 MANUAL OF IRRIGATION PRACTICE
PUNJAB’S IRRIGATION INFRASTRUCTURE
Bed Width
Bed Width
Discharge
Discharge
Name of Name of
(1000 ft.)
(1000 ft.)
(cusecs)
(cusecs)
Length
Design
Length
Design
Drainage Drainage
System System
Madduan Jaranwala
10-
9 a Branch 277 1065 Drainage
15
Drain System
6-L Try Jaranwala
10 Drain of 10- 48 23 Main 15+ 366 1350
1
MBD Drain
Sub 6-L Jaranwala
11 Try Drain 10- 7 6 Branch 10- 80 149
2
of MBD Drain
Bismillah
Tarar Sub
12 pur Try 10- 5 15 10- 13 52
Br. Drain
3
Drain
Salooni
Moharanw
Try Dr.
13 10- 8 6 ali Branch 10- 20 42
RD 0-
4
Drain.
8000
Poliani
1-L of
14 10- 6 10 Branch 10- 41 89
MBD
5
Drain
Bahmniw Mananwal
15 ala Try 10- 18 10 a Branch 10- 210 42
6
Drain Drain
Sub 1-L Madah
16 10- 3 4 10- 16 46
of MBD Try. Drain
7
Dallah
5-L Try
17 10- 30 110 Jarmiana 10- 78 66
Drain
8
Try. Drain
II-R of Jatri Br.
18 10- 6 14 10- 58 85
MBD Drain
9
Drain drain
Ext: Sub
Dhilwan
20 5-L of try 10- 27 53 10- 14 6
11
Drain
Drain
MANUAL OF IRRIGATION PRACTICE 3-43
PUNJAB’S IRRIGATION INFRASTRUCTURE
Bed Width
Bed Width
Discharge
Discharge
Name of Name of
(1000 ft.)
(1000 ft.)
(cusecs)
(cusecs)
Length
Design
Length
Design
Drainage Drainage
System System
3-L Try
Drain of Dhilwan
21 10- 50 60 10- 2 1
12
Madduan Try. Drain
with Ext:
3-AL of
Madduan Nuakar
22 10- 10 8 10- 4 4
13
a Try try. Drain
Drain
3-BL of
Chuharka
Madduan
23 10- 15 16 14 na Try. 10- 4 4
a Try
Drain
Drain
4-R Try
Chuharka
Drain of
24 10- 9 66 na RH 10- 6 5
15
Madduan
Drain
a
Gidri Try
Sangla
Drain of 10-
25 10- 8 2 Branch 91 187
16
4-R Try 15
Drain.
Drain
Lathinwa
Gobind
26 la Try 10- 4 12 10- 58 111
17
Garh drain
Drain
Awagat
Langowal
27 Branch 10- 159 250 10- 24 32
18
drain
Drain
Gaddian
Maduana
28 Try Drain 10- 16 16 10- 36 10
19
drain
with Ext:
Qaisar Boree
29 10- 19 25 10- 16 15
20
Ratti Try
drain
Drain
Choranwa
Ratti Try
31 10- 7 10 la Feeder 10- 23 40
22
Drain
drain
3-44 MANUAL OF IRRIGATION PRACTICE
PUNJAB’S IRRIGATION INFRASTRUCTURE
Bed Width
Bed Width
Discharge
Discharge
Name of Name of
(1000 ft.)
(1000 ft.)
(cusecs)
(cusecs)
Length
Design
Length
Design
Drainage Drainage
System System
Jallandar
Shah Kot
32 Try Drain 10- 17 28 10- 10 23
23
Hill Drain.
with Ext:
Butti Try Daban try.
33 10- 2 8 10- 1 8
24
Drain Drain
Satiana Karyal
34 10- 17 28 10- 9 11
25
Try Drain Try. Drain
Ch
Haji Pur No.286/R
35 10- 14 14 10- 6 7
Try Drain 26 B Try
Drain.
7-R Try Ch
36 Drain of 10- 24 110 No.93/GB 10- 25 23
27
Try Drain
Drain.
Ext: Sub Marh Chiniot
38 7-R try 10- 21 35 Drainage
Drain System
Marh
Saduwal
Chiniot
39 a Try 10- 13 20 15+ 130 1900
Main
1
Drain
Drain.
Khushipu
r Try Dr.
Dabora
40 with 10- 3 8 10- 48 48
Br. Rain
2
Lined
Ch.
Jandiala
Badomali
41 Feeder 10- 21 32 10- 5 12
Try Drain.
3
Drain
Khurrian
Suddana
42 wala Try 10- 12 13 10- 24 44
Br. Drain
4
Drain
Ext: 4-R
Vanir Br.
43 Try Drain 10- 27 48 10- 24 40
Drain
5
of MBD
MANUAL OF IRRIGATION PRACTICE 3-45
PUNJAB’S IRRIGATION INFRASTRUCTURE
Bed Width
Bed Width
Discharge
Discharge
Name of Name of
(1000 ft.)
(1000 ft.)
(cusecs)
(cusecs)
Length
Design
Length
Design
Drainage Drainage
System System
Sukheki
Ext: 3-L 10-
44 10- 3 8 Branch 62 160
Try Drain 15
6
Drain.
Chak
Channi
No.27
45 10- 2 6 Sub Br. 10- 9 20
GB Try
7
Drain
Drain
Chak Bhobra
No.28 Sub
46 10- 4 3 10- 21 24
GB Try Branch
8
Drain Drain
Par
Jassuan
Ahmed
47 a Try 10- 36 40 10- 3 8
Branch
9
Drain
Drain
Par
Sub 4-R Nasiba
48 10- 9 10 10- 10 4.4
10
Par
A.K.N Drainage System Lakhia Try 10- 2 7
11
Drain.
Par
A.K.N.
Mausu
1 Main 15+ 143 750 10- 16 25
12
Branch
Drain
Drain.
AKN
Kot Khuda
Main 10-
2 109 196 Yar Try 10- 2 7
13
Drain 15
Drain
(U/S)
Par
Chiniot
Bhondi
3 Road 10- 13 14 10- 7 9
14
Branch
Drain
Drain.
Kot
Pindi
Khudahya
4 Bhattian 10- 29 18 10- 2 7
15
r Try
Drain
Drain.
3-46 MANUAL OF IRRIGATION PRACTICE
PUNJAB’S IRRIGATION INFRASTRUCTURE
Bed Width
Bed Width
Discharge
Discharge
Name of Name of
(1000 ft.)
(1000 ft.)
(cusecs)
(cusecs)
Length
Design
Length
Design
Drainage Drainage
System System
Ahmed
K.B.
Nagar
5 Jangla 10- 38 23 10- 2 5
16
Branch
Drain
Drain.
Paranwali
Rattiki
6 10- 49 78 Branch 10- 5 5
17
Drain
Drain.
Thatta
7 Raika 10- 15 60 Rati Drain 10- 5 5
18
Drain
Chani Br. Sauction
8 10- 37 66 10- 6 5
19
Drain Drain
Lakhia Delivery
9 10- 19 64 10- 5 5
20
nd Drain Drain
Marh
Ram
Chiniot
12 Nagar 10- 16 36 15+ 56 1704
23
Main
Br. Drain
Drain
Sagar Kubrika
13 Feeder 10- 2 4 Branch 10- 72 80
24
Drain Drain
1-R Try of
Sagar
14 10- 14 6 Kubrika 10- 9 5
25
Br. Drain
Drain
Hafizaba Daluwala
15 10- 12 6 10- 35 24
26
Bed Width
Bed Width
Discharge
Discharge
Name of Name of
(1000 ft.)
(1000 ft.)
(cusecs)
(cusecs)
Length
Design
Length
Design
Drainage Drainage
System System
Salotrianw
Gojra Khewra Project ala Try 10- 8 5
27
Drain
Out fall
Gojra Delivery
Main Channel
1 15+ 40 710 10- 6 5
28
Drain of Budh
R.D.0- Nallah
40062
Gojra
Main Bund
Drain along
2 15+ 350 710 10- 15 3
29
R.D.0- Budh
40062- Nallah
390379
Pacca
Ahmedab
Anna
3 10- 51 715 ad Try 10- 5 5
30
Branch
Drain
Drain
Bhail 1-LTry of
4 Branch 10- 84 15 Kubrika 10- 5 5
31
Drain Drain
1-R of Kalu
Gojra Tarrar
5 10- 12 13.5 10- 62 141
32
Main Chamb
Drain drain
1-L/1-R
Gojra Pindi Bore
6 10- 19 10.5 10- 22 51
33
Main Drain
Drain
Fatehpur
Akbar Try
7 Branch 10- 113 184 10- 2 4
34
Drain.
Drain
Fatehpur Marh Salar
8 Branch 10- 89 88 Drainage
Drain System
3-48 MANUAL OF IRRIGATION PRACTICE
PUNJAB’S IRRIGATION INFRASTRUCTURE
Bed Width
Bed Width
Discharge
Discharge
Name of Name of
(1000 ft.)
(1000 ft.)
(cusecs)
(cusecs)
Length
Design
Length
Design
Drainage Drainage
System System
1-R
Fatehpur
Salar 10-
9 Branch 10- 38 26 59
Drain 15
1
Drain
R.D.
Melluana
Khairwala Drainage System 10- 76 268
Br. Drain
2
Khairwal
a Main
Jallaliana
1 Drain 15+ 260 1042 10- 25 56
Drain
3
R.D. 0-
260200
Dijkot
Branch
Maryabad
2 Drain 15+ 222 564 10- 7 8
Drain
4
R.D.
221500
Nasrana
Branch
Mellay
3 Drain 15+ 70 162 10- 27 36
Drain
5
R.D. 0-
70000
Mangat
Chakbandi Drainage System 10- 15 20
Sub Drain
6
Chakban
Mian Ali
1 di Main 15+ 178 812 10- 34 12
Br. Drain
7
Drain
Drain Drain
(i) 1-R of
Pabbar
Gajjiang
3 wala with 10- 9 20 10- 14 11
Drain
9
leading
Channel
MANUAL OF IRRIGATION PRACTICE 3-49
PUNJAB’S IRRIGATION INFRASTRUCTURE
Bed Width
Bed Width
Discharge
Discharge
Name of Name of
(1000 ft.)
(1000 ft.)
(cusecs)
(cusecs)
Length
Design
Length
Design
Drainage Drainage
System System
Thatta
Gajjiang
4 Glotran 10- 37 27 10- 3 12
10
Link Drain
Br: Drain
1-R of
Thatta
Kassoki
5 Glotran 15+ 5 60 10- 52 152
11
Drain
Branch
Drain
Paharan
g Main Ajniawala
6 10- 196 656 12 10- 14 12
Drain Drain
R.D.
Ahmed Pur
Nillianwa
Vagh
7 la try 10- 11 20
Drainage
Drain
System
Sarangw Ahmed
ala Pur Vagh
8 10- 70 64 15+ 93 924
Branch Main
1
Drain Drain
Gunna Kalu Tarar
9 Branch 10- 25 64 Branch 10- 10 12
2
Drain Drain
Khai Kalu Tarar
10 Branch 10- 36 50 Chenmb 10- 62 141
3
Drain Drain.
Thattah
1-R
Deoka
11 Pharang 10- 4 7.7 10- 7 37
Branch
4
Try Drain
Drain.
Akal Garh
Nipalke Said 10-
12 10- 6 12 74 192
Try Drain Branch 15
5
Drain.
Bucha
Karriari
13 10- 7 28 Branch 10- 29 52
Try Drain
6
Drain.
3-50 MANUAL OF IRRIGATION PRACTICE
PUNJAB’S IRRIGATION INFRASTRUCTURE
Bed Width
Bed Width
Discharge
Discharge
Name of Name of
(1000 ft.)
(1000 ft.)
(cusecs)
(cusecs)
Length
Design
Length
Design
Drainage Drainage
System System
Fatha Pur
Phoolahi
14 10- 35 40 Feeder 10- 18 12
Tri Drain
7
Try Drain.
Chak
Feeder
No.195
15 10- 8 13 Try Drain 10- 4 7
R.B Try
8
No.1
Drain
Gojra Feeder 2
16 10- 10 24 10- 8 10
Drain Try Drain.
9 Kelianwal
Chak
a Chenmb
17 No.159 10- 9 13 10- 6 10
10
Branch
Try Drain
Drain.
Chak
Chak
Kharal
18 No.157 10- 8 2 10- 7 10
11
Branch
Try Drain
Drain
Chak
Kharal
Gatti
19 10- 12 16 Relocated 10- 7 10
12
Drain
Branch
Drain.
Chak
Gajir Gola
No.186
20 10- 27 39.1 Branch 10- 14 20
13
RB Try
Drain.
Drain
Sarfattu Shori
21 Delivery 10- 7 10 Branch 10- 15 24
14
Drain Drain.
Hinduan Jhatianwal
22 d Try 10- 14 12 i Branch 10- 25 20
15
Drain Drain.
Kalairwala
Aminpur
23 10- 33 32 Branch 10- 22 18
16
Drain
Drain.
MANUAL OF IRRIGATION PRACTICE 3-51
PUNJAB’S IRRIGATION INFRASTRUCTURE
Bed Width
Bed Width
Discharge
Discharge
Name of Name of
(1000 ft.)
(1000 ft.)
(cusecs)
(cusecs)
Length
Design
Length
Design
Drainage Drainage
System System
Kot Jan
Bux
Deg Nullah Drainage System 10- 7 14
17
Branch
Drain.
Deg Chakanwa
Nalluh li Feeder
1 15+ 362 1688 10- 7 5
18
Main Branch
Drain Drain.
Pindi Bore
Lurka
2 10- 21 104 19 Branch 10- 22 51
Drain
Drain
Ram Key
Shahpur
3 10- 7 42 Chattah 10- 9 9
20
Drain
Try Drain.
Bed Width
Discharge
Discharge
(1000 ft.)
(1000 ft.)
(cusecs)
(cusecs)
Length
Design
Length
Design
Name of Drainage
(ft.)
(ft.)
Name of Drainage System
System
35 11 6 -
10-
Drain between
1
10-
Drain
2
UCC
1-R seepage
(i) Bupra
20 13 Drain along 3 -
10-
10-
Drain
3
MRL
1-L seepage
(i) Bupra
10-15
10-15
33 84 14 Drain along 10 -
Drain
4
MRL
(ii) Jehan
20 20 Jourian Drainage System
10-
Shah Drain
5
10-
10-
Drain Drain
7
7-R Seepage
(v) Ratali
38 100 3 Dr: along 8 -
10-
10-
Drain
8
UCC
8-R Seepage
(vi) Harpalke
7 10 4 Dr: along 4 -
10-
10-
Bhatti Dr.
9
UCC
Reactivation 7-L Seepage
of Abundant 6 700 5 Dr: along 9 -
15+
10-
10
7-L Seepage
Sheikhupura Drainage System 6 Dr: along 5 -
10-
UCC
6-R Seepage
Sheikhupura
11 7 Dr: along 9 -
10-
10-
Drain
1
UCC
3-54 MANUAL OF IRRIGATION PRACTICE
PUNJAB’S IRRIGATION INFRASTRUCTURE
Bed Width
Bed Width
Discharge
Discharge
(1000 ft.)
(1000 ft.)
(cusecs)
(cusecs)
Length
Design
Length
Design
Name of Drainage
(ft.)
(ft.)
Name of Drainage System
System
6-R Seepage
Sheikhupura
10-15
36 8 Dr: along 4 -
10-
Drain
2
UCC
Jourian Dr:
Sheikhupura
116 400 9 between 5 -
15+
15+
Drain
3
10-
Drain
4
UCC
(ii) 6-L Seepage
Sheikhupura 13 - 11 Dr: along 3 -
15+
10-
5
10-15
8 12 Dr: along 7 45
10-
Drain
6
MRL
3-R Seepage
(iii) Bhikhi
10-15
20 60 13 Dr: along 11 -
10-
Drain
7
MRL
2-L Seepage
Sheikhupura
3 2 14 Dr: along 10 -
10-
10-
Try Drain
8
MRL
3-L Seepage
Rechna
31 400 15 Dr: along 15 25
15+
10-
Outfall Drain
9
MRL
Roras Try:
Warn Drainage System 16 4 -
10-
Drain.
Palkhu Out
10-15
Fall Drain
2
4-R Seepage
Warn Drain 19 112 2 Drain along 3 -
15+
10-
3
U.C.C.
5-R Seepage
Jandiala Sher
2 16 3 Drain along 3 -
10-
10-
Khan Drain
4
U.C.C.
Palkhu
Isherke Drainage System 4 59 388
15+
Nullah
5-L Seepage
Isherke Drain 5 Drain along 5 -
10-
10-
1
U.C.C.
MANUAL OF IRRIGATION PRACTICE 3-55
PUNJAB’S IRRIGATION INFRASTRUCTURE
Bed Width
Bed Width
Discharge
Discharge
(1000 ft.)
(1000 ft.)
(cusecs)
(cusecs)
Length
Design
Length
Design
Name of Drainage
(ft.)
(ft.)
Name of Drainage System
System
Central
10-15
Isherke Drain 6 Seepage 14
10-
12
2
Drain
Central
10-15
Isherke Drain 42 212 7 Seepage 12 92
15+
3
Drain
Drain System
4
Abidabad Begowala
10-15
15 52 1 54 1346
15+
Drain Drain.
5
Kot Daran
10-15
Gujranwala Drainage System 2 9 138
Drain.
92 3 8 -
10-
Drain Drain.
1
Sambrial
Gujranwala
78 700 4 Branch 8 -
15+
10-
Drain
2
Drain.
(i) Khan
Moulowali
Musalman 20 5 12 -
10-
10-
Drain.
3
Drain
(i) Khan
Drain along
10-15
Musalman 18 50 6 16 -
10-
pacca road.
4
Drain
9-R-Seepage
Dr. along
(ii) Ting Drain 14 16 7 UCC R/S 6 -
10-
10-
5
Begowala
Dr.
9-R-Seepage
Dr. along
(iii) Jaid Chak
10-15
10 8 UCC R/S 3 -
10-
Drain
6
Begowala
Dr.
3-56 MANUAL OF IRRIGATION PRACTICE
PUNJAB’S IRRIGATION INFRASTRUCTURE
Bed Width
Bed Width
Discharge
Discharge
(1000 ft.)
(1000 ft.)
(cusecs)
(cusecs)
Length
Design
Length
Design
Name of Drainage
(ft.)
(ft.)
Name of Drainage System
System
10-15
44 208 9 20 96
15+
Drain Drain.
7
8-L Seepage
(iv) Qila
Dr. UCC L/S
Dedar Singh 15 4 10 12 -
10-
10-
Sahowala
8
Drain
Dr.
15+
10-
10
Drain Drain
(vi) Naushera
11 11 2 Pasia Drain. 13 -
15+
10-
11
Virkan Drain
11-R
(viii)
Seepage
Muraliwala 13 34 3 5 -
10-
10-
12
Drain along
Drain
U.C.C.
12-R
(ix) Mir
Seepage
Shakaran 30 40 4 4 -
10-
10-
13
Drain along
Drain
U.C.C.
11-L
(x) Shahpur Seepage
3 16 5 5 -
10-
10-
14
12-L
(xi) Chak Seepage
12 25 6 5 -
10-
10-
15
Chak Kaka
Sangowali Drainage System 7 8 -
10-
Drain.
MANUAL OF IRRIGATION PRACTICE 3-57
PUNJAB’S IRRIGATION INFRASTRUCTURE
Bed Width
Bed Width
Discharge
Discharge
(1000 ft.)
(1000 ft.)
(cusecs)
(cusecs)
Length
Design
Length
Design
Name of Drainage
(ft.)
(ft.)
Name of Drainage System
System
10-R
Sangowali Seepage
167 1316 8 6 -
15+
10-
Drain Drain along
1
U.C.C.
9-L Seepage
(i) Ahmad
14 9 Drain along 4 -
10-
10-
Nagar Drain
2
U.C.C.
10-L
(i) Ahmad Seepage
10-15
65 168 10 4 -
10-
Nagar Drain Drain along
3
U.C.C.
(i) Ahmad
6 26.4 Hassri Drainage System
10-
Nagar Drain
4
42 43 1 116 4500
15+
Drain Drain
5
Drain No.1
6
10-15
12 4 7 104
Harkaran Dr. Drain
8
15+
(vI) Ratial
8 9 6 Ramke Drain 8 24
10-
10-
10
Drain
3-58 MANUAL OF IRRIGATION PRACTICE
PUNJAB’S IRRIGATION INFRASTRUCTURE
Bed Width
Bed Width
Discharge
Discharge
(1000 ft.)
(1000 ft.)
(cusecs)
(cusecs)
Length
Design
Length
Design
Name of Drainage
(ft.)
(ft.)
Name of Drainage System
System
15+
10-
11
Drain Drain
(vii) Bucha
10-15
15+
12
Drain
(vii)
Jhamwala 34 13 Independent Drains
10-
13
Drain
Dilawar
Cheema 39 92 1 Aroop Drain. 17 23
10-
10-
14
Drain
Goindke
Mangat Drain 31 40 2 37 42
10-
10-
15
Drain.
Mardana
Sethi Drain 15 3 33 332
15+
10-
16
Drain
Kotli Loharan
10-15
Sethi Drain 21 74 4 11 48
10-
17
Drain
Thatta Bajwa
Chichoki Mallian Drainage System 5 12 16
10-
Drain.
Chichoki Mehindwal
1 10- 33 6 13 -
15+
2 19 7 22
Mallian Drain 15 Drain
MANUAL OF IRRIGATION PRACTICE 3-59
PUNJAB’S IRRIGATION INFRASTRUCTURE
Bed Width
Bed Width
Discharge
Discharge
(1000 ft.)
(1000 ft.)
(cusecs)
(cusecs)
Length
Design
Length
Design
Name of Drainage
(ft.)
(ft.)
Name of Drainage System
System
Chichoki Pathanwala
3 15+ 55 365 8 58 320
15+
Mallian Drain Drain
15+
Drain Drain
(ii) Ghazi
5 10- 24 10 Nada Drain 7 -
15+
Drain
10-
Drain 15 Drain
10-
Drain Drain
(iii)
Palangpur
10-15
(iv)
Dharoke
9 Kanianwala 10- 6 9 14 9
10-
Drain
Drain
5 6 15 15 52
10-
10
Drain Drain
Philloke
Nikki Deg Drainage System 16 18
10-
Drain
233 2475 17 39
15+
Drain Drain
1
3-60 MANUAL OF IRRIGATION PRACTICE
PUNJAB’S IRRIGATION INFRASTRUCTURE
Bed Width
Bed Width
Discharge
Discharge
(1000 ft.)
(1000 ft.)
(cusecs)
(cusecs)
Length
Design
Length
Design
Name of Drainage
(ft.)
(ft.)
Name of Drainage System
System
15+
Nullah Drain Drain
2
10-
3
Drain Drain
10-15
Nullah Ext: 51 253 20 Cheema 32 92
15+
1
Drain Drain
Hudiara
(iii) Drajke
47 - Drainage
10-
Drain
2
System
Hudiara Main
(iv)
Drain
Khushalpura 21 - 1 170 3000
15+
10-
RD.138000-
3
Drain
308000.
Deo
(v) Malke Padhana
13 10 2 10 100
10-
10-
Drain Drain
4
RD.0-10000.
10-
Drain d Drain
5
(vii) Khark
10-15
2 - 4 Barki Drain 19 84
10-
Feeder drain
6
Chak Dheru
(viii) Harpoke
10-15
19 - 5 Drain 16 44
10-
Drain
7
RD 0-16000
Chak Dheru
(ix) Gagrana Drain,
29 16 6 9 32
10-
10-
Drain RD.16000-
8
25100
MANUAL OF IRRIGATION PRACTICE 3-61
PUNJAB’S IRRIGATION INFRASTRUCTURE
Bed Width
Bed Width
Discharge
Discharge
(1000 ft.)
(1000 ft.)
(cusecs)
(cusecs)
Length
Design
Length
Design
Name of Drainage
(ft.)
(ft.)
Name of Drainage System
System
(x) Gagrana
21 16 7 Alhu Drain 13 24
10-
10-
Ext: Drain
9
15+
10-
10
10-
11
Drain Drain
(xiii) Nangal
10-15
28 80 10 Khana Drain 14 16
10-
12
Sadhan Drain
(xiv) Raiwind
Khangoora 6 4 Drainage
10-
13
Drain System
Drain RD.0-143735
Raiwind
(xvi)
Main Drain
10-15
Chianwala 15 - 2 167
10-
15
RD.143735-
Drain
167000
10-
16
Drain RD.0-15000
(xviii) Kingra
Pipliwala 24 48 4 Seepage 14 21.6
10-
10-
17
Drain Drain
10-
18
Drain 15500
3-62 MANUAL OF IRRIGATION PRACTICE
PUNJAB’S IRRIGATION INFRASTRUCTURE
Bed Width
Bed Width
Discharge
Discharge
(1000 ft.)
(1000 ft.)
(cusecs)
(cusecs)
Length
Design
Length
Design
Name of Drainage
(ft.)
(ft.)
Name of Drainage System
System
(xix)
Pajian Drain
10-15
10-15
Eminabad 15 60 6 9 78
19
RD.0-8900
Drain
Pajian try
(xx) Khori
10-15
5 3 7 Drain RD.0- 4
10-
20
Drain
1000
Pajian try
(xxi) Jandiala Drain
20 28 8 5 66
10-
10-
21
Pajian try
Dalawagha Drainage System 9 Drain- I 3 12
10-
RD.0-2500
Burhanpura
Dalawagha
1 9 10 Drain RD.0- 15 120
15+
10-
Drain
15300
Burhanpura
Dalawagha Drain
10-15
10-15
2 29 84 11 7 96
Drain RD.15300-
22500
Burhanpura
Drain
10-15
RD.22500-
25000
Ladhaki
Gharial Drain 102 2738 14 25 95
15+
10-
Drain
1
44 200 15 5 20
10-
Drain Drain
2
MANUAL OF IRRIGATION PRACTICE 3-63
PUNJAB’S IRRIGATION INFRASTRUCTURE
Bed Width
Bed Width
Discharge
Discharge
(1000 ft.)
(1000 ft.)
(cusecs)
(cusecs)
Length
Design
Length
Design
Name of Drainage
(ft.)
(ft.)
Name of Drainage System
System
10-
3
Buchar
Gharial Try
12 8 17 Khana Drain 40 155
15+
10-
Drain
4
RD.0-40000
Buchar
Khana Drain
10-15
Abdal Drainage System 18 34 89
RD.40000-
74000
Ramkot
Abdal Drain 22 320 19 10 21
15+
10-
Drain
1
Turkwind
Daska Drain 57 250 20 25 96
15+
10-
Drain
2
Turkwind
R/S seepage
Drain
Drain alog 6 10 21 19 48
10-
10-
RD.25000-
3
B.R.B.D.
43950
8 16 22 32 76
10-
Drain Drain
4
Raja Jang
Lurrki Drainage System 23 8 40
10-
Drain
Lurrki Main
77 980 Pandoki Drainage System
15+
Drain
1
Pandoki
Dholewali
19 338 1 Main Drain 89 624
15+
15+
Drain
2
RD.0-89000
3-64 MANUAL OF IRRIGATION PRACTICE
PUNJAB’S IRRIGATION INFRASTRUCTURE
Bed Width
Bed Width
Discharge
Discharge
(1000 ft.)
(1000 ft.)
(cusecs)
(cusecs)
Length
Design
Length
Design
Name of Drainage
(ft.)
(ft.)
Name of Drainage System
System
Pandoki
Budha Main Drain
10-15
10 2 15 72
10-
Goraya Drain RD.89000-
3
104000
Pandoki
Budha Main Drain
10-15
13 62 3 28 49
10-
Goraya Drain RD.104000-
4
131775
Bharthanwala Jamman
10-15
9 90 4 58 217
15+
Drain Drain
5
Lurki Try
7 90 5 Hair Drain 6 12
10-
10-
Drain
6
6 6 14 12
10-
Drain Drain
7
Raja Ghuman
6 197 7 Julke Drain 16 15
15+
10-
Drain
8
16 70 8 6 31
10-
No.1 Drain
9
10-
10
Baddoki
Tannaelwah Drainage System 10 22 44
10-
Drain
Tannelwah Thaman
73 292 11 25 68
15+
10-
Bed Width
Bed Width
Discharge
Discharge
(1000 ft.)
(1000 ft.)
(cusecs)
(cusecs)
Length
Design
Length
Design
Name of Drainage
(ft.)
(ft.)
Name of Drainage System
System
1-R Seepage
Drain along 7 - 12 Lulliani Drain 10 16
10-
10-
2
U.C.C.
1-L Seepage
Ibrahimabad
Drain along 10 - 13 23 13
10-
10-
Drain
3
U.C.C.
Neelwah
10-15
10-
Nullah Drain
4
Rukhanwala
Dhallewali
3 15 Drain RD.0- 8 48
10-
10-
Drain
5
8000
Raokhanwal
Dhallewali
10-15
6 16 a Drain 5 24
10-
Drain
6
RD.0-5300
Shahabpura
Dhallewali
10-15
2 65 17 Drain RD.0- 11 60
15+
Drain
7
11000
Shahabpura
Drain
10-15
Gondal Drain 36 - 18 13 35
10-
RD.11000-
8
23900
Pandoki
Rodial Drain 8 - 19 52 2000
15+
10-
outfall Drain
9
Independen
Durgi Drainage System
t Drains
Chathianwal
Dugri Drain
10-15
20 1 a Drain 21 99
15+
No. 1
1
RD.0-20500
Chathianwal
Dugri Drain a Drain
10-15
63 2 17 56
15+
No. 1 RD.20500-
2
37000
3-66 MANUAL OF IRRIGATION PRACTICE
PUNJAB’S IRRIGATION INFRASTRUCTURE
Bed Width
Bed Width
Discharge
Discharge
(1000 ft.)
(1000 ft.)
(cusecs)
(cusecs)
Length
Design
Length
Design
Name of Drainage
(ft.)
(ft.)
Name of Drainage System
System
Chathianwal
Dugri Drain a Drain
10-15
13 - 3 9 40
10-
No. 2 RD.37000-
3
46100
10-
4
R/S 47000
10-
5
L/S 21774
Connecting
Drain
6 - 6 Bhasin Drain 20 56
10-
10-
between
6
10-
7
UCC 15000)
4-L seepage
B.S.Link - II
Dr: along 3 - 8 4 10
10-
10-
(RD.0-3800)
8
UCC
2-R seepage
Dr: along Chaunian
17 - 9 5 32
10-
10-
Dugri No. 1
2-R seepage
Rakh
Dr: along
3 - 10 Chunian 25 5
10-
10-
10
UCC L/S of
Drain
Dugri No. 1
MANUAL OF IRRIGATION PRACTICE 3-67
PUNJAB’S IRRIGATION INFRASTRUCTURE
Bed Width
Discharge
Discharge
(1000 ft.)
(1000 ft.)
Bed Width
(cusecs)
(cusecs)
Design
Design
Length
Length
Name of Drainage Name of Drainage
(ft.)
(ft.)
System System
Drains
Sukhrawa Drainage System 5 Dangra Drain 10 14 12
Sukhrawa Main
1 15+ 455 816 6 Kaura Drain 10 15 19
Drain
Jhilwala
2 10- 66 100 7 Basira Drain 10 28 27
Branch Drain
Qadirabad Try:
3 10- 9 14 8 Forest Drain 10 24 32
Drain
Colyana 10-
4 30 77 9 Madi Drain 10 40 41
Branch Drain 15
Kharar Branch 10-
5 15 63 10 Ghagh Drain 10 45 147
Drain 15
Renala Branch 10-
6 31 113 Multiple Drains
Drain 15
Satghara Try: Dhaya Main
7 10- 27 46 1 15+ 85 296
Drain Drain
Ruklan
Renala Try:
8 10- 18 24 Branch 10- 20 32
Drain
Drain
Renala Chak-44
9 10- 12 30 2 10- 20 34
Cunnette Drain Drain
Hazara Branch Shahbore
10 10- 40 64 15+ 72 208
Drain Drain
Hayatpur 10- Shergarh
11 23 82 3 15+ 91 308
Branch Drain 15 Drain
Kohla Try: Shergarh
12 10- 34 52 10- 11 28
Drain Try Drain
6-1-R Dhulinai
13 10- 6 5 26-D Drain 10- 23 36
Drain
MANUAL OF IRRIGATION PRACTICE 3-69
PUNJAB’S IRRIGATION INFRASTRUCTURE
Kamman
14 10- 37 50 4 Hujra Drain 10- 40 62
Baranch Drain
Khokhar Khanka Br.
15 10- 21 68 10- 11 10
Branch Drain Drain
Nankana
16 10- 22 44 5 Jajja Drain 10- 5 20
Branch Drain
10-
17 Kalasan Drain 28 174 Balloki Drain 10- 10 100
15
18 Hallah Drain 10- 13 10 Independent Drains
Hallah Branch 10-
19 5 60 1 Aujla Drain 15+ 20 188
Drain 15
Rakh Halla Budh Dhakku
20 10- 10 32 2 10-15 24 36
Drain Drain
Sukhnai Out Sherwala
21 15+ 180 2000 3 10- 12 32
Fall Channel Drain
T.S.M.B. Drainage System 4 Kalasan Drain 10-15 28 174
T.S.M.B. Main 10- Tulamba
1 91 232 5 15+ 17 200
Drain 15 Drain
Berianwala
2 Aruti Drain 10 26 17 6 15+ 32 144
Drain
T.S.M.B.
3 10 99 5 7 Gunnu Drain 10- 52 96
Leading Ditch
4 Darkhana Drain 10 55 52 8 Towrian Drain 10- 7 64
3-70 MANUAL OF IRRIGATION PRACTICE
PUNJAB’S IRRIGATION INFRASTRUCTURE
Bed Width
Bed Width
Discharge
Discharge
(1000 ft.)
(1000 ft.)
(cusecs)
(cusecs)
Design
Design
Length
Length
Name of Name of
(ft.)
(ft.)
Drainage System Drainage System
Bed Width
Bed Width
Discharge
Discharge
(1000 ft.)
(1000 ft.)
(cusecs)
(cusecs)
Design
Design
Length
Length
Name of Name of
(ft.)
(ft.)
Drainage System Drainage System
Bed Width
Bed Width
Discharge
Discharge
(1000 ft.)
(1000 ft.)
(cusecs)
(cusecs)
Design
Design
Length
Length
Name of Name of
(ft.)
(ft.)
Drainage System Drainage System
Tattaha
10- 2 Muhammad 10- 15 16
Panah Drain.
Sub / 1-R
Chak 108,109,
Miana Gondal 15+ 1 150 10- 31 50
NB Br. Drain.
Drain.
Chak -30
Gidder Khadi
Shadiwal 14 16 10- 20 28
Br. Drain.
Drain.
Dera Br.
Bhiko Drainage System 10- 4 -
Drain.
Budhewala Br.
1 Bhiko Drain. 15+ 188 830 10- 41 73
Drain.
Chachoka
Pandowal 10- 4 10- 13 21
330 Drain.
Drain.
10-15 13 Sabha Drain. 10- 14 21
Sher Garh
10- 25 10- 4 -
Gojra Drain. 430 Drain.
10-15 45 Dedhar Drain. 10- 137 130
Bhikki Pond
10- 60 230 10- 30
Drain.
Kot
Rerka Drain. 10- 23 48 Choughatta 10- 18 40
Drain.
Mamdana
10- 12 10-15 19
Drain.
Jahanabad
Baryar Drain. 10- 15 2 15+ 116 252
Drain.
Chak Alam Ahmad Yar
10- 10 10- 10 33
Drain. Drain.
Budhi Nullah Drainage System Jalpana Drain. 10- 4 16
Budhi Nala
Drain, Budhi Shahzad Pur
1 15+ 151 4200 10- 20 33
Nala Fall & Old Br. Drain.
Budhi Nala
Maggowal
10- 29 58 Wadhi Drain. 10- 8 15
Feeder Drain.
3-74 MANUAL OF IRRIGATION PRACTICE
PUNJAB’S IRRIGATION INFRASTRUCTURE
Bed Width
Bed Width
Discharge
Discharge
(1000 ft.)
(1000 ft.)
(cusecs)
(cusecs)
Design
Design
Length
Length
Name of Name of
(ft.)
(ft.)
Drainage System Drainage System
Bed Width
Bed Width
Discharge
Discharge
(1000 ft.)
(1000 ft.)
(cusecs)
(cusecs)
Design
Design
Length
Length
Name of Name of
(ft.)
(ft.)
Drainage System Drainage System
Bed Width
Bed Width
Discharge
Discharge
(1000 ft.)
(1000 ft.)
(cusecs)
(cusecs)
Design
Design
Length
Length
Name of Name of
(ft.)
(ft.)
Drainage System Drainage System
(Feeder #1 of
1-R Feeder of
Punjan)
10- 2 Mankiwala 10- 8 -
No.2 Try
Drain.
Drain.
1-L Feeder of
Panjan #2 Try
10- 2 40 Mankiwala 10- 6 -
Drain.
Drian.
2-R Feeder of
2R Disty
10- 7 Mankiwala 10- 4 -
Drain.
Drain.
1R of 2R Disty Hayatpur
10- 4 10- 24 33
Drian. Drain.
Chimber Khanpur
10- 8 10- 10 12
Drain. Drain.
Khori Ring Kot Bahi
10- 7 10- 6 12
Drain. Khan Drain.
Khori Village Kalra Try
10- 2 10- 43 25
Out Fall Drain. Drain.
Khori Br. Kot Kambo
10- 8 10- 11 13
Drain. Drain.
Raju Main Kalra Pond
10- 5 10- 7 14
Drain. Drain
Raju Sub Br. Lodhianwala
10- 2 10- 23 37
No. 1 Drain
1-R
Raju Sub Br.
10- 1 Lodhianwala 10- 10 12
No. 2
Drain
Link Drain
Raju Sub Br.
10- 1 along Maken 10- 7 89
No. 3
Canal
Raju Village Hayat Link
10- 1 10- 5 33
Sub Drain. Drain.
Hassan Br Mari Br.
10- 13 10- 61 140
Drain. Drain.
Jhanda Mari Tri
10- 25 475 10- 50 115
Chohan Drain. Drain.
MANUAL OF IRRIGATION PRACTICE 3-77
PUNJAB’S IRRIGATION INFRASTRUCTURE
Bed Width
Bed Width
Discharge
Discharge
(1000 ft.)
(1000 ft.)
(cusecs)
(cusecs)
Design
Design
Length
Length
Name of Name of
(ft.)
(ft.)
Drainage System Drainage System
Bariwala
15+ 12 10- 34 45
Drain.
Sivia Try Chak. 15
10- 17 34 10- 9 -
Drain. Drain.
Chhoranwala Mari Feeder
10- 16 10- 10 33
Drain. Drain.
Chhani Mast Chak 54
10- 24 73 10- 16 35
Br Drain. Drain.
Kot
Chak 52
Multaniawala 10- 24 10- 7 25
Drain.
Drain.
Chak 52
Santhal Drain. 10- 23 10- 2 -
F.Drain.
Makhanwali Chak No. 66
10- 27 119 10- 13 -
Drain. Drain.
Nawan Lok Chak No. 58
10- 60 115 10- 13 64
Drain. Drain.
Kot Islam Nawabpur
10- 6 10- 19 34
Drain. Drain.
Dhok Murad Sulki Mills
10- 10 10- 14 -
Drain. Drain.
Main Phalia
10- 23 88 Bola Drainage System
Drain.
Bohat Drain. 10- 19 28 10-15 34
Jiasukh 1 Bola Drain. 584
10- 22 45 15+ 33
Dhaya
Delivery
10- 2 Kund Drain 10- 19 136
Drain.
Parallal Drian Bola Link
10- 3 10- 7 -
No. 1 Drain.
Parallal Drian
10- 5 Hadali Drain. 10-15 23 256
No. 2
Chak Kamal
10- 10 73 Khushab Drainage System
Drain.
Khushab Main
Halki Nullah Drainage System 1 15+ 49 284
Drain.
3-78 MANUAL OF IRRIGATION PRACTICE
PUNJAB’S IRRIGATION INFRASTRUCTURE
Bed Width
Bed Width
Discharge
Discharge
(1000 ft.)
(1000 ft.)
(cusecs)
(cusecs)
Design
Design
Length
Length
Name of Name of
(ft.)
(ft.)
Drainage System Drainage System
Bed Width
Bed Width
Discharge
Discharge
(1000 ft.)
(1000 ft.)
(cusecs)
(cusecs)
Design
Design
Length
Length
Name of Name of
(ft.)
(ft.)
Drainage System Drainage System
Maggowal
10- 3 - Deowal Drain. 10- 9 -
Sub Drain.
Wan Branch
Pauranwala
10- 17 - Below X-ing 10- 32 -
Drain.
Drain.
Panjan No. 1 Machar Khadi
10- 2 - 10- 47 -
Syphon Drain.
Panjan No. 2 Kalayar
10- 13 - 10- 14 -
Syphon Drain.
Sadowal
Khori Drain. 10- 8 - 10- 50 -
Drain.
Chimber
10- 4 - Mustafa Drain. 10- 15 -
Syphon
Bheko Out Jalal Br.
15+ 45 - 10- 10 -
Fall Lower Drain.
Bheko Hadda Outfall
15+ 84 - 15+ 37 -
Remoding Drain.
Chak Alam Hadda
10- 48 - 15+ 31 -
Upper Drain. embankment
Kot Sher Hadda Main
10- 6 - 15+ 108 -
Muhammad Drain.
Khanewala 1-R Hadda
10- 20 - 10-15 51 -
Drain. Drain.
B. Drain. 10- 100 - Shahjewana 10-15 20 -
10- 33 - Drain 15+ 29 -
Bhekhi Drain.
15+ 26 - 10- 4 -
Jassowal
10- 12 - 10-15 40 -
Drain. Sahiwal Drain.
Bhekho
15+ 11 - 15+ 24 -
Extension
Jewanwal
10- 24 - 10- 58 -
Drain.
Pind Mako Tarkhanawala
10- 15 - 10-15 8 -
Drain. Drain.
2-L Mona
10- 5 - 15+ 26 -
Bhera
3-80 MANUAL OF IRRIGATION PRACTICE
PUNJAB’S IRRIGATION INFRASTRUCTURE
Bed Width
Bed Width
Discharge
Discharge
(1000 ft.)
(1000 ft.)
(cusecs)
(cusecs)
Design
Design
Length
Length
Name of Name of
(ft.)
(ft.)
Drainage System Drainage System
1-R
1-L Mona
10- 2 - Tarkhanawala 10- 22 -
Bhera
Drain.
Ajjowal Jahaniashah
10- 35 - 10-15 16 -
Exlusion Drain.
1-R Drain. 10- 2 - 10- 35 -
Attowana
1-L Drain. 10- 2 - 10-15 11 -
Drain.
2-R Drain. 10- 2 - 15+ 13 -
Mittah Tiwana
2-L Drain. 10- 2 - 15+ 196 -
Drain.
Ghag No. 1
3-L Drain. 10- 7 - 10- 4 -
Drain.
Chak 33 Ghag No. 2
10- 22 - 10- 21 -
Drain. Drain.
Chak 16
10- 39 - Rajar Drain 10- 36 -
Drain.
Malakwal
10- 44 - Kaura Drain. 10- 7 -
Part-II
Rajar Pond
Halki Drain. 10- 37 - 10- 8 -
Drain.
Link Chennal
Majra Drain. 10-15 34 - 10- 10 -
No. 7 Drain
Link Chennal
Faqrian Sillanwala Drainage System 10- 11 -
No. 8 Drain
Link Chennal
10-15 23 10- 13 -
Faqrian No. 9 Drain
1 471
Sillanwali Drain. Chak No. 55
15+ 323 10- 12 -
MB Drain.
Chak No. 57
1-L F.S Drain. 10-15 26 49 10- 15 -
MB Drain.
1-R New F.S River Creek
10- 10 38 15+ 10 -
Drain. Drain
1-R Old F.S
10- 15 38 Sadral Drain. 10- 37 -
Drian.
Islamabad Sobagha Main
10- 7 - 10- 6 -
Drain. Drain
MANUAL OF IRRIGATION PRACTICE 3-81
PUNJAB’S IRRIGATION INFRASTRUCTURE
Bed Width
Bed Width
Discharge
Discharge
(1000 ft.)
(1000 ft.)
(cusecs)
(cusecs)
Design
Design
Length
Length
Name of Name of
(ft.)
(ft.)
Drainage System Drainage System
Bed Width
Bed Width
Discharge
Discharge
(1000 ft.)
(1000 ft.)
(cusecs)
(cusecs)
Design
Design
Length
Length
Name of Name of
(ft.)
(ft.)
Drainage System Drainage System
Year of
2005 2004 1991 2005 1975 2005 1990 1979 1970 1986
Completion
PUNJAB’S IRRIGATION INFRASTRUCTURE
1,720 1,447 2,753 515 2,400 250 2,726 1,173 1,012 4,079
Live Storage
(AF)
Attock Division
2,400 1,687 2,702 860 2,835 600 3,765 1,958 1,950 14,320
Gross Storage
Capacity (AF)
900 450 1,494 400 200 300 1,050 1,500 2,000 1,250
Proposed
C.C.A. (Acres)
Actual C.C.A
MANUAL OF IRRIGATION PRACTICE
20 19 18 17 16 15 14 13 12 11 Sr. No.
Year of
1963 2012 1971 1970 2008 1971 2005 1964 1994 2005
Completion
241 3,960 959 416 2,930 1,128 1,350 267 3,550 2,820
Live Storage
(AF)
Rawalpindi District
560 8,100 1,760 682 3,900 1,820 2,050 568 5,679 5,000
Gross Storage
Capacity (AF)
100 3,500 250 300 2,160 850 548 140 4,200 2,300
Proposed
C.C.A. (Acres)
Actual C.C.A
MANUAL OF IRRIGATION PRACTICE
Rawalpindi - District./
Chakwal Chakwal Chakwal Chakwal Chakwal Chakwal Islamabad Rawalpindi Rawalpindi
Gujar Khan Tehsil
Dhok
Khokhar Zer Dhok Qutab Kot Raja Dhok Tahlian Khasala Name of the
Surla Dam Dam
Khai Dam Jamal Dam Sanday Mar Jawa Dam
Dam Din Dam Dam Dam Dam
Dam
Composite
Earthfill Earthfill Earthfill Earthfill Earthfill Earthfill Concrete (Earth + Earthfill Concrete Type of Dam
Concrete)
Year of
1979 1985 1991 1991 2002 2007 2005 1990 1994 1985
Completion
PUNJAB’S IRRIGATION INFRASTRUCTURE
2,602 1,555 827 1,344 1,110 2,106 1,286 518 900 1,498
Live Storage
(AF)
Chakwal District
3,312 1,905 1,737 2,844 1,808 5,920 1,860 651 1,575 2,415
Gross Storage
Capacity (AF)
1,480 1,200 800 835 650 1,800 1,488 550 800 1,250
Proposed
C.C.A. (Acres)
Actual C.C.A
MANUAL OF IRRIGATION PRACTICE
40 39 38 37 36 35 34 33 32 31 Sr. No.
Earthfill Earthfill Earthfill Earthfill Earthfill Concrete Earthfill Concrete Concrete Earthfill Type of Dam
Year of
2012 2004 2012 2012 2012 1983 2008 1990 2012 2007
Completion
Actual C.C.A
MANUAL OF IRRIGATION PRACTICE
Earthfill Earthfill Earthfill Earthfill Earthfill Concrete Earthfill Earthfill Type of Dam
Year of
1992 2005 1981 1994 1994 1967 1990 1995 1970
Completion
PUNJAB’S IRRIGATION INFRASTRUCTURE
Jhelum District
2,432 5,705 2,228 3,395 5,941
Gross Storage
1,380 1,140 7,400 679
Capacity (AF)
Actual C.C.A
MANUAL OF IRRIGATION PRACTICE
54 53 52 51 50 Sr. No.
Year of
2008 2007 2005 2008 2008
Completion
Actual C.C.A
MANUAL OF IRRIGATION PRACTICE
Chapter 4
ADMINISTRATIVE SETUP OF
PUNJAB IRRIGATION
DEPARTMENT
Compiled by
Israr ul haq
Reviewed by
Table of Contents
4 ADMINISTRATIVE SETUP OF PUNJAB IRRIGATION DEPARTMENT ........ 4-1
4.1 HISTORICAL DEVELOPMENT OF PUNJAB IRRIGATION DEPARTMENT .................. 4-1
4.1.1 THE EARLY HISTORY ................................................................................... 4-1
4.1.2 POST-INDEPENDENCE SET-UP (1947-55) ...................................................... 4-2
4.1.3 POST-INTEGRATION SET-UP ......................................................................... 4-2
4.1.4 CREATION OF WAPDA (1958) ..................................................................... 4-2
4.1.5 MAY 1962 REORGANIZATION........................................................................ 4-3
4.1.6 POST-1965 ADMINISTRATIVE CHANGES ........................................................ 4-3
4.1.7 1984 REORGANIZATION PROPOSALS ............................................................ 4-4
4.1.8 THE POST 1997 DEVELOPMENTS ................................................................. 4-5
4.2 OBJECTIVES AND FUNCTIONS OF IRRIGATION DEPARTMENT ............................ 4-5
4.2.1 INSTITUTIONAL SET-UP FOR IRRIGATED AGRICULTURE IN PAKISTAN ................. 4-5
4.2.2 OBJECTIVES OF THE PUNJAB IRRIGATION DEPARTMENT .................................. 4-6
4.3 FUNCTIONS OF THE PUNJAB IRRIGATION DEPARTMENT ................................... 4-8
4.3.1 IRRIGATION AND DRAINAGE: A PROVINCIAL SUBJECT...................................... 4-8
4.3.2 OFFICIAL FUNCTIONS ................................................................................... 4-8
4.3.3 CORE FUNCTIONS ....................................................................................... 4-9
4.4 BRIEF DESCRIPTION OF IRRIGATION-RELATED FUNCTIONS AND SPECIALIZED UNITS
4-10
4.5 ORGANIZATIONAL STRUCTURE.................................................................... 4-16
4.5.1 DEPARTMENT AS A W HOLE ......................................................................... 4-16
4.5.2 ORGANIZATIONAL STRUCTURE.................................................................... 4-16
4.5.3 ZONES ...................................................................................................... 4-16
4.5.4 CIRCLES ................................................................................................... 4-16
4.5.5 DIVISIONS ................................................................................................. 4-19
4.5.6 SUB-DIVISIONS ......................................................................................... 4-19
4.5.7 SECTIONS ................................................................................................. 4-21
4.5.8 PUNJAB IRRIGATION AND DRAINAGE AUTHORITY (PIDA) ............................... 4-21
List of Tables
Table 4.1: Chronological Sequence of Agency Development upto 1947 ................ 4-1
Table 4.2: Set-up of the Irrigation Department in 1947 ........................................... 4-2
Table 4.3: Global and Operational Objectives of Water Scheduling ........................ 4-7
List of Figures
Figure 4.1: Organizational Set-up of the Punjab Irrigation Secretariat .................. 4-17
Figure 4.2: Punjab Irrigation & Power Department Organizational Chart .............. 4-18
Figure 4.3: Organizational Chart of a Canal Division ............................................ 4-20
iv MANUAL OF IRRIGATION PRACTICE
ADMINISTRATIVE SETUP OF PUNJAB IRRIGATION DEPARTMENT
MANUAL OF IRRIGATION PRACTICE 4-1
ADMINISTRATIVE SETUP OF PUNJAB IRRIGATION DEPARTMENT
and the execution of all Replacement Works. Major new projects in the Water Sector
(along with anti-waterlogging and salinity measures) were also assigned to WAPDA.
4.1.5 May 1962 Reorganization
The post-integration set-up did not prove to be effective and efficient. Therefore, it was
decided to restore the original practice of appointing engineers as the head of
engineering departments in 1962. The province was divided into six regions and each
one was put under the charge of a Chief Engineer. Three of these regions comprised
areas of the former Punjab Province.
4.1.6 Post-1965 Administrative Changes
The administrative changes in the organizational set-up of the department after 1965
are summarized below:
Creation of the Multan Zone (1968): After the creation of the Agricultural Development
Corporation (ADC), some irrigated areas were transferred to that corporation on the
concept of a unified development of irrigation, agriculture and all other agricultural
inputs. In the Punjab Province, the Thal Canal and Muzaffargarh Canal Systems
(excluding the respective headworks) were transferred to the ADC in January 1965.
These canal systems were reverted to the Irrigation Department in March 1968 and
the ADC was later dissolved. Consequently, a new zone with headquarters at Multan
was opened in June 1968 and the boundaries of the existing zones were suitably
readjusted.
Creation of the Post of Chief Engineer Floods and Chief Engineer Central (1973): The
post of Chief Engineer, Drainage and Floods, was created in March 1973 to plan and
implement the flood works in the province and to coordinate processing of flood
schemes with the Federal Flood Commission for the approval and allocation of funds.
A new post of Chief Engineer, Central, was created in June 1973 with administrative
control over Mechanical Circle, Directorate of Land Reclamation, Design Directorate
and Small Dams Organization.
Creation of the Faisalabad Zone (1974): In June 1974, another readjustment took
place when the Faisalabad Zone under a Chief Engineer was created by splitting the
jurisdiction of the previously existent Sargodha Zone. This was done with a view to
cater for the increased work load and to have better co-ordination at the Civil Division
level.
Creation of the Post of Chief Engineer, Research (1975): In April 1975, the post of
Director Irrigation Research Institute was upgraded to the rank of Chief Engineer
Research.
Creation of the SCARP Circles: The completed SCARPs were transferred from
WAPDA to the Irrigation Department in the mid 70s. Four SCARP circles were
accordingly set up in the department for O&M of public tubewells.
Chief Engineer, Co-ordination (1983): A post of Chief Engineer, Coordination, was
created in 1983 to coordinate and monitor the implementation of rehabilitation/
management projects for irrigation and drainage systems. These projects were
financed by the World Bank and USAID. The projects aimed at rehabilitating the
irrigation and drainage network of the province, which had deteriorated due to
inadequate maintenance funding in the past two to three decades. The first phase of
the project was completed in 1988, with simultaneous launching of the second phase
4-4 MANUAL OF IRRIGATION PRACTICE
ADMINISTRATIVE SETUP OF PUNJAB IRRIGATION DEPARTMENT
Planning and Review Organization under Chief Engineer (Planning) was set-up. There
were adjustments in the functions of Chief Engineers at Lahore and the post of Chief
Engineer Central was renamed as Chief Engineer Development, with jurisdiction over
the Central Design Office, Small Dams Project Organization and the mechanical outfit
of the Department. The Zonal Chief Engineers and the O&M field staff remained
almost unchanged. Recommended expansion of field divisions and sub-divisions was
not carried out. Setting up a Board of Chief Engineers at Lahore also did not meet with
approval.
4.1.8 The Post 1997 Developments
The concept of Participatory Irrigation management (PIM) was introduced in 1997 as
part of the conditionalities under World Bank, Asian Development Bank (ADB) and
Japan International Cooperation Agency (JICA) financed National Drainage Program
(NDP). A new organization namely Punjab Irrigation and Drainage Authority (PIDA)
was established in 1997 under Punjab Irrigation & Drainage Authority (PIDA) Act 1997.
PIDA pioneered work of PIM by creating pilot Farmers Organizations (FOs) at
distributary level and Area Water Boards (AWBs) at Canal Command level.
A number of new projects were planned for implementation at the turn of the
millennium. The projects envisaged comprehensive rehabilitation of old and dilapated
irrigation infrastructure with the assistance of the World Bank, Asian Development
Bank (ADB) and Japenese International Cooperation Agency (JICA). These projects
included National Drainage Program (NDP), Rehabilitation of Lower Chenab Canal
Project, Rehabilitation of Barrages, and Rehabilitation of Lower Bari Doab Canal
System and Pakpattan Canal System. Exclusive Project Implementation Units were
created for these projects under development funding mode. Similarly the post of Chief
Engineer / Provincial coordinator was created for Greater Thal Canal Project.
During 2003, Development Circles and Divisions were established by closing the
SCARP circles due to the disinvestment of public sector tubewells in fresh
groundwater areas. The Development Circles and Divisions were thus staffed by
making internal adjustments. The purpose of Development outfits was to plan and
implement the major development schemes as well as the implementation of the
foreign aided projects.
During 2006, a comprehensive reforms framework was agreed with the World Bank
under Development Policy Loan. A Strategic Planning and Reforms Unit was created
for steering the program. Similarly, an exclusive Program Monitoring and
Implementation Unit (PMIU) was set up for improved monitoring of canal operations.
The PMIU has developed modern tools and performance indicators for on-line
computerized monitoring.
During 2011, the Power Wing of Punjab Irrigation & Power Department was detached
from the I&P Department and attached with the newly created Energy Department.
The I&P Department was accordingly renamed as Punjab Irrigation Department.
4.2 Objectives and Functions of Irrigation Department
4.2.1 Institutional Set-up for Irrigated Agriculture in Pakistan
A number of state agencies and departments share responsibilities for the
management of irrigated agriculture in Pakistan. The broad division of responsibilities
between irrigation and agriculture starts at the federal level, with two separate
4-6 MANUAL OF IRRIGATION PRACTICE
ADMINISTRATIVE SETUP OF PUNJAB IRRIGATION DEPARTMENT
ministries, and runs through the sector's whole structure up to the farm level. Irrigation
management in Pakistan, thus, follows a segregated organizational structure.
The Water and Power Development Authority (WAPDA), under the Federal Ministry
of Water and Power, is an autonomous agency responsible for the development of
water resources in the country. WAPDA managed construction of large storage dams,
construction of barrages and inter rivers link canals the Indus Basin Project
Replacement Works and installation of tubewells in Salinty Control and Reclamation
Projects (SCARPS). WAPDA operates the major reservoirs in consultation with the
Indus River System Authority (IRSA) and Provincial Irrigation Departments (PIDs)
according to the water rights and seasonal allocations of the provinces. After the
construction of schemes, except large storage projects, by WAPDA, the responsibility
for their operation and maintenance (O&M) is transferred to the respective Provincial
Irrigation Departments (PIDs).
The major responsibility for irrigation management rests with the PIDs, and some of
its elements are with Provincial Agriculture Departments (PADs). PIDs undertake
some construction works, but primarily attend to the rehabilitation and O&M of
irrigation facilities, extending from barrages and main canals to outlets, upkeep and
maintenance of drainage and flood works, assessment of water charges, and
resolution of conflicts among water users. On-Farm Water Management (OFWM)
Directorates of Agriculture Departments (PADs) carry out watercourse lining and on-
farm water improvements. PADs are responsible for agricultural research, extension
and productivity enhancement. On the other end, farm level decisions regarding
application of water and non-water inputs are made by the individual farmers. A host
of complex factors and the external environment impinge on farmers' performance and
decision-making processes.
4.2.2 Objectives of the Punjab Irrigation Department
Goals and objectives of irrigation management in Pakistan have not been explicitly set
out in any single document. The objectives listed below have been extracted from
various documents. The broader objectives, like increasing the agricultural production
or farm level objectives of improving the application efficiency, although quite relevant
in the context of overall irrigation management, extend beyond the functional
jurisdiction of the Irrigation Department. While irrigation water definitely helps to
increase the agricultural production, it is only one of the inputs. Other non-water inputs,
as well as farming and marketing policies, impact the productivity of the system.
Similarly, the jurisdiction of the Irrigation Department extends up to the outlet level and
beyond this; farmers manage their watercourses and field applications with the advice
/ input of the Agriculture Department.
In view of the foregoing, the objectives of the Punjab Irrigation Department are
presented below:
A. Planning Stage Goals
To develop vast tracts of barren land.
To provide livelihood to local inhabitants.
To improve the well-being of the rural population by stabilizing and
increasing agricultural production.
To overcome recurring famines.
To generate revenue earnings for the state.
MANUAL OF IRRIGATION PRACTICE 4-7
ADMINISTRATIVE SETUP OF PUNJAB IRRIGATION DEPARTMENT
c) Tubewells
d) Drainage schemes
e) Storage of water and construction of reservoirs
f) Flood control and flood protection schemes on rivers and hill
torrents
3. Basic and applied research in:
a) Irrigation hydraulics
b) Ground water and land reclamation
3. Survey of water bodies for data collection and analysis for future planning.
4. Distribution of canal water and assessment of water rates.
5. Training.
6. Human resources development including Engineering Training Academy.
7. Collection of tTolls on barrages & waterways.
[9A. Planning, designing, construction, maintenance and repair of all
buildings and related infrastructure under the administrative control of the
department.]
8. Strategic Planning.
9. Budget, accounts and audit matters.
10. Purchase of stores and capital goods for the Department.
11. Service matters except those entrusted to Services and General
Administration Department.
12. Administration of the following laws and the rules framed there-under:
i. The Canal and Drainage Act 1873
ii. Soil Reclamation Act 1952
iii. Land Improvement Tax Act, 1975
iv. Water Users Associations Ordinance 1981
v. The Punjab Irrigation & Drainage Authority Act 1997
vi. The Punjab Minor Canal Act
vii. Water User & Water Management Act
13. Matters incidental and ancillary to the above subject
4.3.3 Core Functions
The core functions of the Punjab Irrigation Department are summarized below:
Operation and upkeep of the irrigation and drainage infrastructure of the
province;
Planning and prioritization and implementation of maintenance works through
approved O&M Work Plans, and under third party top supervision;
Optimizing the use of water resources in the province by the equitable
distribution of irrigation water supplies (about 54 MAF) through 52,000 canal
outlets;
Assessing water rates by the revenue staff of the department;
Planning and implementing the development program portfolio and foreign-
aided projects;
Providing for and executing a plan for management of floods in the province,
and to construct and maintain flood protection programs/works;
Promoting the participation of the beneficiaries in the management of the
Irrigation and Drainage Systems of the province, in line with requirements of
the Punjab Irrigation and Drainage Authority (PIDA) Act, 1997; and
4-10 MANUAL OF IRRIGATION PRACTICE
ADMINISTRATIVE SETUP OF PUNJAB IRRIGATION DEPARTMENT
v). Tubewells
In order to control the twin menace of water-logging and salinity, about 10,000
tubewells were installed in the public sector under various SCARPs. These
tubewells were mostly of deep well turbine type. In some areas, tubewells with
centrifugal pumps under the 'Grow More Food' program had also been installed.
The SCARP tubewells in fresh groundwater areas have since been disinvested
and only saline groundwater tubewells are presently working for controlling
waterlogging in the critical areas. For this purpose, the Department has
employed exclusive staff comprising operators, mechanics and properly
qualified mechanical engineers, who take care of daily operation, as well as
special and emergency repairs of the tubewells. The operators are stationed at
tubewells for proper operation of tubewells as per operating schedules and local
needs. The Ddepartment also has workshops for the expeditious repair of
tubewells. The record of the running hours, actual discharge of tubewells and
sub-soil water levels is also monitored.
vi). Flood Protection Works
The construction of flood protection works, viz. flood embankments, spurs,
studs, etc., is required to protect irrigation infrastructures and to safeguard
agricultural lands, and abadies (towns) from the onslaught of floods.
Departmental activities in this regard include both, short term measures
(temporary protection against river erosive action along its banks), as well as
long-term measures (training river flow). For optimal results, precise planning
of protection works between the control points on the basis of model studies
and then implementing the package in one working season, is recommended.
Financial constraints and delays in approval formalities, however, do not allow
this and the packages are only partially implemented. This restricts the
usefulness of the flood works. The Department is also responsible for the
proper upkeep of the existing bunds, spurs and other flood protection works.
Flood watching and flood fighting during the flood emergencies is another
important function of the department. In addition, the restoration of damages
caused by floods is also the responsibility of the Irrigation Department.
vii). Drainage Schemes
As a consequence of the development and intensification of canal irrigation, the
necessity to construct surface drainage schemes was felt. Accordingly, a large
surface drainage network with an aggregate length of around 5,000 miles has
been constructed to facilitate the drainage of rain and seepage water. Major
drainage projects are implemented by WAPDA, which are handed over to the
Irrigation Department for subsequent O&M. Smaller drains are planned and
constructed by the Irrigation Department. The main functions of the
Department, therefore, relate to proper functioning and maintenance of
completed drainage schemes, as well as monitoring the planning and
implementation of new drainage projects undertaken by WAPDA. Maintenance
activities include weed and debris clearance; bed clearance; maintenance of
banks inlets, bridges, outfalls and other structures; and monitoring the drain
flows to evaluate its effectiveness and identify the need to remodel.
MANUAL OF IRRIGATION PRACTICE 4-13
ADMINISTRATIVE SETUP OF PUNJAB IRRIGATION DEPARTMENT
Currently, there are three Drainage Circles in the Lahore, Faisalabad and
Sargodha Zones. In the other three field zones, drainage divisions and/or sub-
divisions look after the local drainage network.
viii). Land Reclamation and Groundwater Monitoring
Soil and water quality and its suitability for irrigated agriculture has an important
bearing on the development and sustainability of irrigated agriculture. The
Department has developed research facilities over the last 45 years to
determine water and soil standards and measures for the reclamation of salt-
affected soils. Both, biological and chemical methods have been developed and
demonstrated.
The Land Reclamation Directorate is equipped with research laboratories and
experimental field stations spread all over the province. Research studies
pertaining to soil deterioration, soil survey and land classification, water quality,
irrigation water management and water requirements of crops, cropping
patterns with regard to the physio-chemical aspects of salinity control and other
features of land improvement, are undertaken by this Directorate.
The Land Reclamation Directorate has also been entrusted the work of
groundwater monitoring. The monitoring is carried out both for the level and
quality of groundwater. For this purpose, a network of monitoring prints has
been established throughout the province for pre-monsoon and post-monsoon
observations. Based on the monitoring results, groundwater maps for levels
and quality are also prepared and displayed on the Department website.
ix). Construction of Small Dams
The development of barani areas has been specifically addressed in the
strategies of the previous five-year plans, with special reference to agriculture.
As one of the measures for increasing agricultural production in rainfed (barani)
areas of the Pothohar Plateau in the Punjab Province, a program to construct
small dams was initiated in the early 1960s.
A common feature of rainfed areas is that agriculture is not developed due to
erratic and uncertain precipitation and loss of rain water due to rapid run-off.
The high velocity rain water flow generated by steep slopes of the plateau also
causes acute problems of erosion of fertile topsoil. In order to address the
problem of soil erosion and to conserve rainwater for agricultural development,
the construction of small dams offers promising prospects. In order to plan and
implement the construction of small dams in the barani areas of the Punjab
Province, a Small Dams Organization has been established in the Department.
This organization is responsible for identifying potential dam sites, collecting
hydrological, hydraulic, geo-technical and other needed data, conducting
feasibility studies, preparing detailed designs, constructing small dams and
allied irrigation network.
The Department, with the assistance of the World Bank, is currently planning a
comprehensive project for integrated development of Pothohar plateau. The
initiatives include rehabilitation of existing dams, watershed management,
rainwater harvesting, construction of small and mini dams and local ponds for
water storage, on-farm water management and planned agricultural
development by growing high-value crops and plants suited to the Pothohar
area.
4-14 MANUAL OF IRRIGATION PRACTICE
ADMINISTRATIVE SETUP OF PUNJAB IRRIGATION DEPARTMENT
and gearing, etc. The post-independence division of irrigation assets left only
the Moghalpura workshop to the share of the PID. Later, another workshop was
opened at Bhalwal to meet the increasing needs of repair and maintenance of
mechanical components of gates and gearings and the earth moving
equipment.
With the gradual replacement of manual and donkey labour for earthwork by
units of earthmoving machinery to attain speed and quality, the fleet of
departmental machinery had to be expanded, both in scope and size, for the
procurement, operation, and maintenance of such machinery. The expansion
took place gradually as the needs arose. A Mechanical Circle was established
in 1944 to meet the larger work load of workshop and machinery. The
mechanical fleet of the Irrigation Department was enlarged and modernized
through the USAID-assisted Irrigation Systems Management Project during the
1980s. To further improve the operation and management of machinery units,
an exclusive Machinery Circle was created in 1984 as part of the reorganization
of the Irrigation Department.
xiii). Administration of Canal and Drainage Act
The Canal and Drainage Act was promulgated in 1873 to regulate and control
the development of irrigation and the distribution of canal water. The Act was
modified in 2008.The rapid population increase has resulted in mounting
pressure on land, increasing competition for canal supplies. The Canal Act is
administered by the officers of the Irrigation Department. The divisional and
sub-divisional canal officers have been given magisterial powers and legal
authority for the expeditious resolution of water disputes among shareholders,
effective administration of the Act, control of encroachments and equitable
distribution of irrigation supplies. The proceedings under the Act are deemed
as quasi-judicial, requiring adherence to the prescribed procedure and a proper
understanding of the law.
The main functions of the Department under the Canal and Drainage Act
include application of water for public purposes, construction and maintenance
of irrigation works, supply of water, water rates, recovery of charges, drainage,
internal water distribution, control of offenses and penalties. Most work
connected with the administration or the Canal and Drainage Act relates to the
settlement of mutual differences among the shareholders (Section 68), supply
of water for new area or change of source of water supply (Section 20), water
rates and liability for unauthorized irrigation (Section 33-35), and offenses under
the Act (Section 70).
xiv). Assessment of Water Charges
Every irrigation system needs financial resources to cover the O&M costs. This
is done by collecting water fees from the farmers for irrigation water supplied to
them. In the Punjab Province, service charges are recovered from individual
farmers in the form of Occupiers' Rates or Abiana. This charge is currently in
the form of a flat rate applicable to the area included in the Culturable Command
Area (CCA).
For the purpose of assessing water rates, there is an exclusive revenue set-up
in the Department. The revenue wing arranges the records on which canal
revenue is assessed and collected. Demand slips (Parchas) are prepared for
4-16 MANUAL OF IRRIGATION PRACTICE
ADMINISTRATIVE SETUP OF PUNJAB IRRIGATION DEPARTMENT
the owners/cultivators, with details of the area finally assessed. These are
delivered to the "Lambardar" for distribution among the cultivators. The demand
statements (Khataunis) are prepared from the Parchas. The demand
statements are prepared by villages / tehsils / districts, and are supplied to the
civil administration for the collection of water rates. The district administration
collects revenue through village headmen (Lambardars), who are allowed to
retain a certain percentage of the collected amount.
4.5 Organizational Structure
4.5.1 Department as a Whole
The Punjab Irrigation Department is headed by the Secretary Irrigation under the
governance of the Minister for Irrigation and overall control of the Government of
Punjab. Secretary is the overall head of field and functional set up of the Department
being run by various Chief Engineers. Six Chief Engineers have territorial jurisdiction
over different parts of the irrigation system, while other 6 Chief Engineers have
functional duties. For example, the Chief Engineer Research is responsible for
research in the hydraulic problems and other allied fields connected with soil and
water, and the Chief Engineer Development provides services such as excavation
machinery and workshop facilities required in the field. In addition, there are a number
of Project Management Units in the Department for planning and implementation of
mega and foreign-aided projects. The schematic representation of the organizational
structure of Punjab Irrigation Department is depicted in Fig. 4.1.
Each Zone is headed by a Chief Engineer. There are a number of Circles under the
Chief Engineer. Each Circle is headed by Superintending Engineer. In each Zone,
there are two to three Canal Circles and some subject specific Circles such as
Drainage, Link Canals, and Development Circles. The Circles are divided into
Divisions, Sub-Divisions and Sections as described below.
4.5.2 Organizational Structure
The Secretary is assisted by three Additional Secretaries (Administration, Technical
and Budget/Operation) and five Deputy Secretaries in charge of five wings, i.e.,
Administration, General, Operation, Budget and Development. The Deputy Secretary
level wings have been further sub-divided into Sections, under the charge of Section
Officers under Secretaries. The secretariat has about 200 members as support staff.
Figure 4.2 portray the organizational pattern of the Irrigation Secretariat up to the level
of Section Officers.
4.5.3 Zones
Under the Secretary, there are 10 Chief Engineers (C.Es) who carry out various
functions of the department. Six Chief Engineers have territorial jurisdiction over
different parts of the irrigation system, while the remaining C.Es have functional duties.
As seen from the schematic diagram, each Zone headed by a Chief Engineer has a
number of Circles, each under the charge of a Superintending Engineer (S.E), as
depicted in Figure 4.1.
4.5.4 Circles
Canal Circle is a complete unit responsible for operation, maintenance, regulation of
water distribution, recording of irrigated area and assessment of abiana (water rate)
of one canal system under its charge. A Superintending Engineer (SE), being the head
MANUAL OF IRRIGATION PRACTICE 4-17
ADMINISTRATIVE SETUP OF PUNJAB IRRIGATION DEPARTMENT
of the circle, is responsible for all operations concerned with one canal system. While
the subject specific circles look after work in their respective jurisdiction.
A Superintending Engineer has powers under the Canal and Drainage Act VIII of 1873,
as Superintending Canal Officer, to hear irrigators' appeals against the decisions of
Divisional Canal Officers (Executive Engineers) under Section 20, 33 and other
relevant sections.
Figure 4.1: Organizational Set-up of the Punjab Irrigation Secretariat
4-18 MANUAL OF IRRIGATION PRACTICE
ADMINISTRATIVE SETUP OF PUNJAB IRRIGATION DEPARTMENT
4.5.5 Divisions
For operation and maintenance of a canal system, a Circle is further divided into two
or three Divisions. An Executive Engineer (XEN) is in-charge of a canal Division under
the administrative control of the Superintending Engineer. The Division is the basic
executive unit for operational activities, and the Executive Engineer is the "kingpin" of
the Department. The engineers above him are controlling and directing officers, while
engineers and staff under his supervision are to assist him in performing his field
duties. He is the custodian of basic records and monitors the regulation and water
distribution of all channels in the Division.
On financial and accounting matters, an Executive Engineer, as Head of a Division, is
independently responsible to the Audit Department. For this purpose, the Audit
Department posts a Divisional Accountant as its representative to assist the Executive
Engineer to maintain the accounts of the Division properly, and to exercise financial
checks.
To administer the canal supplies and to settle irrigators' disputes, an Executive
Engineer is so designated as a "Divisional Canal Officer" under the Canal and
Drainage Act of 1873. He is declared Canal Magistrate to perform his duties under the
Canal and Drainage Act relating to canal offences. All claims, disputes and complaints
of irrigators are decided by him as the Divisional Canal Officer.
An Executive Engineer also performs duties to assess water rates. For this purpose,
a Revenue Wing headed by a Deputy Collector is placed under his control. In this
capacity, he is responsible for assessing abiana and preparing demand statements
for the collection of water rates at the end of each crop season. These demand
statements are submitted to the District Civil Administration for collection of revenue.
Figure 4.3 shows the organizational structure of a canal division and illustrates the
hierarchical arrangement involving different levels of staff in a typical division.
4.5.6 Sub-Divisions
A Division is further sub-divided into three or four sub-units known as Sub-divisions,
each headed by a Sub-divisional Officer (SDO) who is a qualified engineer or an
experienced diploma holder in Engineering. He is also designated as the Sub-
Divisional Canal Officer under the Canal and Drainage Act of 1873, and has the
powers of a Magistrate to adjudicate cases concerning the canal offenses under the
Act and to settle disputes among irrigators. He holds delegated administrative and
financial authority for his area as a sub-unit of the Division.
The SDO is responsible for the operation and maintenance, distribution of water, and
water rate assessment in the portion of canal commands in his charge, under the
administrative control of the Executive Engineer of the Division. A Sub-division,
ordinarily, consists of three or four Engineering Sections and two to three Zilladari
Sections, as depicted in Fig 4.3.
4-20 MANUAL OF IRRIGATION PRACTICE
ADMINISTRATIVE SETUP OF PUNJAB IRRIGATION DEPARTMENT
4.5.7 Sections
The smallest unit on the Engineering side is a "section". The head of a Section is a
Sub Engineer who is basically a diploma holder in Engineering. He is responsible for
the operation of the channels, maintenance of infrastructure and the recording of
discharges in the distributary/minor canals. Sub-engineers' offices are located in canal
colonies along the channels to ensure more intimate surveillance over canal
operations and irrigation supplies. The Sub-engineer, who is assisted by Misteries,
Mates (a Mate is the head gauge man) and Canal Patrols/Beldars for maintenance
and watching of channels, and gauge readers for regulation and observation of water
flow. Each canal colony has a rest house where inspecting officers stay, and a
telegraph/telephone office to transmit gauge readings and other important regulations
and urgent messages.
The smallest unit in the PID's revenue organization is the Zilladari Section, headed by
a Zilladar, the canal official who supervises the work of about 10 Patwaris (Irrigation
Record Keepers). Each Patwari supervises and assesses irrigated area of 3,000 to
5,000 acres, and thus, a Zilladar's supervision covers an area of about 50,000 acres.
Zilladars' offices are also located in canal colonies, along with that of the Sub-engineer
to facilitate easy access for irrigation.
4.5.8 Punjab Irrigation and Drainage Authority (PIDA)
The performance of the irrigation sector all over Pakistan has been unsatisfactory
mainly due to inadequacies in operation and maintenance (O&M) of the key
infrastructure, which is considered largely to be the result of lack of adequate funding.
Because of the increasing share of staff and overhead costs in the overall O&M
budgets, lesser funds were becoming available for actual maintenance and repair
works. The funding constraints mainly stem from the fact that the ‘abiana’ is insufficient
to meet O&M costs, requiring subsidies out of scarce provincial revenues. As the
collected abiana flows into the general revenue and O&M subsidy is not linked to
system performance. Beneficiaries were generally reluctant to involve themselves in
the O&M facilities or pay for their O&M, as they perceive these facilities as public
property. Also with the introduction of intensive agriculture, the irrigation sector could
not keep pace with the demand of water due to massive increase in population and
pressure on land could not cater for the additional needs of food and fiber. The quality
of surface water and groundwater resources is deteriorating because of agriculture
intensification, urbanization and industrialization.
The Government of Pakistan after conducting several studies and detailed discussions
with the World Bank and other donors introduced institutional reforms in the water
sector so as to achieve equity in distribution of supplies, improve cost recovery and
encourage participatory management of the irrigation and drainage system. In
consultation with the provinces, the Government of Pakistan in August 1995
evolved a strategy for institutional reforms in the water sector, which envisaged that:
(i) Provincial Irrigation Departments would be transformed into
autonomous, self-accounting and self-financing Provincial
Irrigation and Drainage Authorities (PIDAs).
(ii) Below the PIDAs, financially self-accounting Area Water Boards
(AWBs) would be created, preferably along canal commands, for
managing and operating the irrigation and drainage systems. It
4-22 MANUAL OF IRRIGATION PRACTICE
ADMINISTRATIVE SETUP OF PUNJAB IRRIGATION DEPARTMENT
5 BARRAGES
Detection of cavity formation or loose contact under the barrage floor .. 5-252
Vibrating wire peizometers ..................................................................... 5-252
Piezometer Observations ....................................................................... 5-257
5.24 ACCIDENTS ON BARRAGES .................................................................. 5-260
Suggestions for Prevention of Accidents ................................................ 5-260
Boats ...................................................................................................... 5-261
Rafts and other vessels .......................................................................... 5-261
Accidents in workshops .......................................................................... 5-261
Workshop fires ....................................................................................... 5-263
First Aid .................................................................................................. 5-263
5.25 REHABILITATION OF PUNJAB BARRAGES ........................................... 5-264
Introduction ............................................................................................ 5-264
Major issues ........................................................................................... 5-264
Safety Evaluation ................................................................................... 5-264
Analysis and Redesign Proposals .......................................................... 5-264
Taunsa barrage ...................................................................................... 5-265
Jinnah Barrage ....................................................................................... 5-267
Balloki Barrage ....................................................................................... 5-267
Sulemanki Barrage................................................................................. 5-268
Trimmu Barrage ..................................................................................... 5-269
Panjnad Barrage ................................................................................. 5-270
Islam Barrage ..................................................................................... 5-270
Khanki Weir ........................................................................................ 5-270
5.26 BARRAGES FAILURES ............................................................................ 5-271
Introduction ............................................................................................ 5-271
Causes of failure .................................................................................... 5-271
Undermining through piping due to excessive exit gradient ................... 5-271
Eruption / blow up of floor caused by excessive uplift ............................ 5-271
Formation of deep scours ...................................................................... 5-272
Faulty regulation..................................................................................... 5-272
Faulty construction ................................................................................. 5-272
Overtopping............................................................................................ 5-273
Outflanking ............................................................................................. 5-273
Record of failures and remedial measures ......................................... 5-273
Data to be collected in the event of a failure ....................................... 5-273
5.27 DUTIES AND RESPONSIBILITIES OF BARRAGE STAFF ...................... 5-275
Executive Engineer ................................................................................ 5-275
Sub Divisional Officer Head Works ........................................................ 5-276
Sub Engineer Headworks ...................................................................... 5-278
Sub Engineer Hydraulic ......................................................................... 5-279
Sub Engineer Mechanical ...................................................................... 5-280
Head Jamadar........................................................................................ 5-281
Naib Jamadar ......................................................................................... 5-282
Head Boatman ....................................................................................... 5-282
Headworks Mistry................................................................................... 5-283
References: 5-284
MANUAL OF IRRIGATION PRACTICE 5-vi
BARRAGES
List of Tables
List of Figures
Figure 5-1: Original head regulator of upper Jhelum canal also called Mangla
Headworks (old) ................................................................................................... 5-1
Figure 5-2: Overall views of open weir at Khanki .................................................... 5-2
Figure 5-3: Overall views of Taunsa Barrage .......................................................... 5-2
Figure 5-4: Typical Plan of a Barrage ...................................................................... 5-5
Figure 5-5: Typical Cross through a Barrage .......................................................... 5-6
Figure 5-6: USBR Curve to determine stone size ................................................. 5-20
Figure 5-7: Gradation envelope for apron stone .................................................... 5-21
Figure 5-8: Sediment distribution profile for normal / laminar flow ......................... 5-23
Figure 5-9: Typical plan of an excluder ................................................................. 5-31
Figure 5-10: Typical cross section across an excluder .......................................... 5-32
Figure 5-11: Types and general shapes of guide bunds ....................................... 5-36
Figure 5-12: Typical plan of guide bank ................................................................ 5-38
Figure 5-13: Typical cross section of guide bank .................................................. 5-40
Figure 5-14: Typical details of pitched island ........................................................ 5-42
Figure 5-15: Typical cross sections of marginal bund ........................................... 5-43
Figure 5-16: Typical details of gabions retaining wall ............................................ 5-44
Figure 5-17: Alignment of spurs ............................................................................ 5-47
Figure 5-18: Types of spurs .................................................................................. 5-50
Figure 5-19: Typical details of sloping spurs ......................................................... 5-52
Figure 5-20: Plan of guide head spur .................................................................... 5-55
Figure 5-21: Typical mole head spur with cast-in-place concrete piles ................. 5-56
Figure 5-22: Typical cross section of studs ........................................................... 5-59
Figure 5-23: Design of Freeboard (Reference-7) .................................................. 5-63
Figure 5-24: Embankment phreatic surface (Casagrande’s solution) .................... 5-65
Figure 5-25: Lacey’s method – calculation of scour .............................................. 5-76
Figure 5-26: Chart for estimating Fbo (after blench, 1969) ..................................... 5-79
Figure 5-27: Suggested component mean velocities for significant bed movement of
cohesionless materials (after Neill, 1973).............................................................. 5-81
Figure 5-28: Typical details of stone pitching protection and stone apron ............. 5-88
Figure 5-29: Typical details of stone pitching protection and stone apron ............. 5-91
Figure 5-30: Typical details of stone pitching protection and stone apron ............. 5-92
Figure 5-31: Wave run-up ratios VS wave steepness and embankment slopes (A.T.
Ipen & Muir wood) ................................................................................................. 5-98
Figure 5-32: Typical details of stone pitching protection and stone apron ........... 5-102
Figure 5-33: Energy of flow curves (AMR Montague) ......................................... 5-116
Figure 5-34 (b): Hydraulic jump ........................................................................... 5-117
Figure 5-35: Hydraulic jump curves (AMR Montague)......................................... 5-118
Figure 5-36: Diagram showing observed and computed positions of the hydraulic
jump .................................................................................................................... 5-120
Figure 5-37: Characteristic forms of hydraulic jump related to the Froude number
(USBR Standard 288-D-2423) ............................................................................ 5-123
Figure 5-38: Free flow discharge ......................................................................... 5-129
Figure 5-39: Submerged discharge ..................................................................... 5-131
Figure 5-40: Crumps method for fixing stilling basin level ................................... 5-136
Figure 5-41: Sketch for stilling basin design ........................................................ 5-138
Figure 5-42: Types and details of stilling basins (USBR) .................................... 5-141
Figure 5-43: Types and details of stilling basins .................................................. 5-142
MANUAL OF IRRIGATION PRACTICE 5-viii
BARRAGES
List of Annexures
Figure 5-1: Original head regulator of upper Jhelum canal also called Mangla
Headworks (old)
Now a day “Headworks” is a general term and includes the other two types of
regulators i.e. open weirs and barrages introduced in the following.
Open Weir
At locations where the river water level has to be raised to feed an off-taking canal, a
hump or an ungated barrier is provided across the river channel to raise the water level
in the river channel. Mostly it is without gates but at some locations where it is
advisable to keep the hump crest low, shutters or flash boards are provided. A real
example is old Khanki Weir, which is now being replaced with a new barrage.
MANUAL OF IRRIGATION PRACTICE 5-2
BARRAGES
2. Regulation gates are necessary in undersluices only. The rest of the structure
has only a raised crest or small shutters / flash boards, no more than 6’ in
height.
5.1.4.2 Demerits
1. High crest level induces heavy silting on the upstream.
2. The flow patterns cannot be controlled as needed.
3. There has to be a trade-off between High Flood Level (HFL) and Normal Pond
Level (NPL).
4. Operation of shutters is cumber some and sometimes even dangerous.
5. No bridge is available for trans river movement of heavy equipment for
emergencies.
6. The trolley system is hazardous, even for inspecting personnel.
7. Since the shutters can be operated in groups only, the discharge intensities
with in a bay differ radically i.e. zero in some (shutters up) part and maximum
in the others (shutters down). This imbalance of discharge intensity stresses
the downstream glacis and stilling basin differently in different sections which is
hazardous and should not be accepted.
An open weir is now not favoured and has been phased out in favor of a barrage.
Merits and Demerits of a Barrage
5.1.5.1 Merits
1. With low crest levels, the afflux is also low and manageable.
2. With regulation gates provided in the entire length, flow patterns can be
controlled as required through judicious operation of gates.
3. Discharge intensities can be regulated in different sections of the barrage, as
necessary.
4. The barrage always has a road bridge and in some cases, a railway bridge also
(e.g. Taunsa and Panjnad barrages) to facilitate all types of traffic.
5. With a bridge in place, movement of maintenance material, equipment and
machinery is facilitated.
5.1.5.2 Demerits
The only disfavoring element is a slightly higher cost but it is more than offset by the
advantages the barrage possesses over other competitive type (open weir).
Selection of Type of Structure
In view of the above, the barrage has become a structure of choice and is now the
most favored intervention for feeding the off-takes and river channel control.
MANUAL OF IRRIGATION PRACTICE 5-4
BARRAGES
out walls or flared out walls (also called warped walls) and facilitate the expansion of
flow from the end of abutment to the guide bank width/profile.
5.2.6.17 Gauge Wells
Gauge wells are provided on both flanks to facilitate reading of water level. They are
generally rectangular in plan, with stairs leading to the observation point from the top
pavement.
Recently, water level sensors have been provided at some barrages as pilot
undertaking. If successful, they may replace the gauge wells which are expensive to
construct and maintain.
Canal Head Regulators
The canal head regulator is a structure similar to a barrage constructed on the river
flank to regulate the water supplies let into the canal (withdrawals).
Subsidiary Weir
A subsidiary weir is a concrete weir constructed to raise the water level on the
downstream of a barrage to a value required to counter the effects of retrogression of
levels i.e. produce an adequate depth on the downstream of the barrage for formation
of hydraulic jump at proper location. It is needed at only those barrages that are
affected by extraordinary retrogression of levels.
Bridge Decks
These include the decks of highway, railway or maintenance bridge to facilitate the
trans- river road traffic, railway bridge to facilitate the railway operations and regulating
bridge deck for movement of gate operation /maintenance staff and required
equipment.
Mechanical and Electrical Works
Mechanical and electrical works at a barrage comprise:
a) Regulating gates;
b) Hoists and gearing and related gadgets;
c) Electric motors, pumps, lighting and wiring circuits;
d) Electric transmission and distribution lines and circuits;
e) Transmitters and receivers for piezometer readings.
Appurtenant Works
5.2.11.1 Chute Blocks
These are triangular concrete blocks, provided at the toe of downstream glacis for
energy dissipation.
5.2.11.2 Friction Blocks or Baffle Piers
These are cubical or trapezoidal or arrow shaped RC blocks provided in the stilling
basin for dissipation of energy.
5.2.11.3 End Sill or End Baffle
It is a raised trapezoidal RCC obstruction placed at the end of the stilling basin to
enhance energy dissipation by providing additional flow depth in the stilling basin (d 2).
MANUAL OF IRRIGATION PRACTICE 5-10
BARRAGES
stages. Usually the downstream divide wall is extended up to the end of the
downstream apron.
iii. The upstream divide wall may also have a length that keeps the heavy attack
on its nose away from the upstream protection of the sluice bays.
iv. The curvature of the river at the site of head-works plays an important part in
deter- mining the length of the divide wall. Thus, if the pocket lies on the outer
side of permanent approach curve, the length of the divide wall may be
reduced; otherwise, it may do more harm than good.
Piers
Piers are support walls provided between any two adjacent bays. The gates operate
through the grooves provided in the pier sides. Usually there are two grooves, the
upstream one is called the stoplog groove and the downstream one is called the main
gate or service gate groove. Sometimes there may be a third groove also for
emergency purposes. The bridge of the gate-hoisting mechanism is also installed over
the piers. Wherever necessary, dummy piers are provided in between the main piers
to add load on the floor against uplift pressure. Sometime to reduce the size of the
gates, dummy piers are introduced between the main piers.
The piers are constructed either monolithic with the floor (raft) or made independent
with their own foundations. In the latter case, seals are provided all around to prevent
leakage between the floor and the piers.
The thickness of pier varies from 5’ for canal head regulators and 7’-10’ for the barrage.
The thickness should be adequate to resist the moments created and also
accommodate the embedded parts for the main gate and stoplog grooves.
The upstream cut-water usually has a semicircular shape and downstream ease-water
has an equilateral, trough shape with circular curves. The upstream and downstream
vertical ends are sometime given a batter of 1 in 20 depending on the architectural
requirements.
The piers have to be high enough to hold the gates clear off the maximum flood while
making ample allowance for passing the floating debris under the gate. The height of
the piers should also be viewed from any additional dead weight required while
computing the overall stability of the structure. The height of the pier in the zone where
gate hoisting mechanism are located, is usually higher than the other zones and it
constructed with the same material as the rest of pier, i.e. concrete or masonry. But in
earthquake regions, constructing higher portion of the pier with concrete or masonry
is to be avoided so that extra earthquake horizontal moments are avoided. Instead,
steel trestles of required height can be erected so that the moments are reduced due
to light weight structure. In locations where fixed wheels are provided for gate
movement, it is customary to provide an inspection gallery in the pier with approach
from top of the pier. The detailed design of piers as is clear from the above narration
is quite complicated and beyond the scope of this treatise.
Abutments
The abutments are the end structures of the diversion structures and their layout
depends on the project features and topography of the site. The length of the abutment
is generally kept the same as the length of the floor. The top of the abutment should
have adequate free board above the upstream and downstream water levels. From
MANUAL OF IRRIGATION PRACTICE 5-14
BARRAGES
upstream to downstream the top of the abutment may be sloping or stepped. The
thickness of the abutment must be adequate to accommodate the grooves as well as
and bridge bearings. Due to different intensities of loading and to avoid damages due
to any possible differential settlement, generally the abutments may be divided into
different blocks such as upstream, gate bridge, road bridge, downstream blocks etc.
Each block is separated from the other by joints and provided with seals both vertically
and horizontally. The top slab of the foundation block of the abutment usually forms
part of the raft of the end bay adjacent to the abutment and separated from the raft by
longitudinal joint provided with seals. The foundation of the abutments should be at
least at the same levels as those of the floor of the Main diversion structure and
preferably a little lower. The foundation of the abutments should provide a boxing of
the diversion structure. Cross cut-off or sheet piles are continued from upstream to the
downstream end of the floor and are well connected to the upstream and downstream
cut-offs or sheet pile lines.
The abutments of the barrage and the regulators are designed as reinforced concrete
retaining walls with counterforts. The vertical face of the wall is considered as a
continuous slab supported by counterforts. The lower section is loaded most heavily
and thickness diminishes towards the top. The base of the counterforts is also
considered as a slab, spanning across the counterforts. The front face of the wall is
provided with a small batter to allow for any small differential settlement of the base
owing to earth pressure behind the wall. The earth pressure acting on the wall is
calculated using the conventional soil mechanics methods, and the stability of the wall
is checked for safety against overturning and sliding.
Fish Ladder
Fish ladder is provided to enable the migratory fish to move across the barrage from
downstream to upstream and vice versa. It is located near the divide wall in view of
the availability of water throughout the year in the river downstream of the under
sluices. Fish ladders are also called as fish ways or fish passes in several countries.
There are several types of fish ladders such as pool and jet fish-way; paired obstacle
fish way; alternate obstacle fish way; Denil fish way and others. A brief description of
each follows:
5.3.7.1 Alternate Obstacle Fishway
Alternate obstacle Fishway is generally a straight rectangular channel with obstacles
or baffles placed alternatively along the sides producing a jet deflection in the
horizontal plane. This type of fishway has been built in an almost unlimited variety of
baffle shapes, spacing and angles. The flow is confined to a zig-zag path which is
much longer than the fishway. The width of passage is effectively less than its
measured width because of its tortuous form. Velocities are sharply localized for mild
slopes, this type performs quite satisfactorily. Compared with Denil type, equal number
of fish use both these two types.
The Denil fishway which incorporates side as for energy dissipation and is generally
adaptable to any particular set of local conditions and requirements.
The Denil and Pool and Submerged Orifice fishways are generally recommended for
slopes upto 25 percent and heights upto about 2 ft. When the velocity increases, by a
proper reduction of the slope, the size of the fishway could be adjusted. Paired
Obstacle Fish way adopts itself to a considerable range of head water elevation.
MANUAL OF IRRIGATION PRACTICE 5-15
BARRAGES
Where the majority of fish is of the catfish variety, Denil type may be advantageous.
An Alternate Obstacle Type may be preferable for herbivorous variety.
5.3.7.2 Selection of Type
Considering the various factors and site conditions, the alternate obstacles type has
been provided at almost all the barrages in Pakistan.
5.3.7.3 Design Requirement
The success of a Fish ladder in attracting the migratory fish primarily depends on its
location. A number of factors such as physical features of the section, the height to be
overcome and the available water supply may influence the design of a fish way.
The design of a fish way involves collection and analysis of different types of data and
prevalent fish habits. The design is complicated and beyond the scope of this manual,
however brief guidelines are recorded below. Interested readers may refer to, Design
of fishway by Dr. Mushtaq and U.S. Army Corps of Engineers manual.
In order to keep the velocity of water emanating from the fish entrance constant
(approximately 6 ft./see). Irrespective of the upstream and downstream water levels,
it is arranged such as downstream water level rises and progressively drowns the
lower pools additional water can be supplied from a separate supply channel through
a system of ducts and chimneys controlled by sluice valves. The velocity can be
maintained at a predetermined level.
The hydraulic design of the fish ladder entails producing flows, velocity and flow
pattern attractive for the fish to travel upstream without difficulty. Upstream water level
is pond level and allowance is made for possible minor variations in levels.
Downstream water level depends on the conditions in the river. Maximum and
minimum values likely to occur during the period when the fish are migrating are
selected to correspond to the limits of flows expected in the river at that time.
The fish ladder parts (starting from the downstream end) are:
i. Fish entrance and entrance section
ii. Pool and weir section, part below maximum downstream water level and part
above it. Control pool with constant water level, between orifice and their
section
iii. Exit section of pool and orifice
iv. Supply channel for adding water; this runs parallel to and adjacent to the fish
ladder.
5.3.7.4 Fish Entrance Section
The fish entrance should be a vertical slot about 4 feet wide. Velocity of water through
entrance slot is around 6 feet per second for all probable downstream water levels.
This velocity, together with the accompanying fall in water level (about one foot) should
serve to attract fish from the river to the fish ladder. Inside the entrance section, water
is supplied from the supply channel through four control gates and diffusers. This water
supplements the flow for fish ladder and provides the required velocity through the fish
entrance.
MANUAL OF IRRIGATION PRACTICE 5-16
BARRAGES
where in:
C = Coefficient of discharge for weir overflow condition normally taken as
3.09-3.3
h = Working head at the submerged orifice
L = length of notches in feet
H = total head in feet (including head of velocity of approach)
Cd = coefficient of discharge taken as 0.63 for small openings and as 0.65 for
large openings.
A = area of orifice in square feet.
It must be mentioned that in problems of this kind the actual flow patterns are complex
and depend in part on the interaction of one section on its neighbors.
It is therefore, important, that approximate computed results are verified by suitable
model tests.
Navigation Lock
This has been introduced in an early paragraph. It facilitates the passage of different
types of water craft across the barrage. Latest lock designs envisage several attributes
but mostly the simple reinforced concrete type has been adopted in Pakistan. The
detailed design is complicated and beyond the scope of this manual. However the
design should provide the following basic requirements for operation:
i. Sufficient depth for movement of crafts in the navigation channel and lock.
ii. Adequate widths in the channel and lock for maneuvering of crafts at the
desired speeds.
iii. Freedom from hazardous currents; and
iv. A minimum required time for the passage through the lock. The hydraulic
design generally ensures adequate of water supply for lockage, fix top level of
the components of the structure, provide approach structures, provide efficient
filling and emptying system and to fix other necessary feature. It is always
desirable to conduct hydraulic model test to accomplish lockages with
reasonable and avoid excessive turbulence and hawser stresses.
5.3.8.1 Lock Dimensions
The size of the lock depends on the size of the largest water craft or boat, it is designed
to accommodate. Suitable clearances are provided to allow the vessel to negotiate the
lock safely. The minimum clearances required are usually 3 ft. on each side.
5.3.8.2 Structural Design
The lock walls are usually monoliths and joints are provided between them. They are
located according to the requirements of the particular element that the monolith
supports or contains. Each monolith should be completely stable without depending
upon the adjacent units for support. The length of a monolith is generally less than 50
ft. The length of monoliths containing the gate anchorage, valves, filling and emptying
system components and other machinery may be more.
MANUAL OF IRRIGATION PRACTICE 5-18
BARRAGES
Stability at all horizontal planes of the structure where either the applied loads or the
section change abruptly as well as the stress conditions at points where other planes
of weakness may be anticipated should be checked. Usually analysis is done for unit
length of wall. However the monoliths subjected to gate loads, line pulls, vessel impact
etc and loaded in more than one axis, are analyzed as a whole. The stability of the
lock walls is checked for three different conditions, namely (i) Normal operating
condition taking into account the worst combination of loads during o complete lockage
cycle, (ii) Extreme operating, maintenance and emergency condition taking into
account unusual loads such as vessel impact, extreme operating saturation levels,
drawdowns, earthquakes, etc. Safety factors and stresses could be relaxed in this
condition and (ii) Construction condition taking into account earth pressures with or
without uplift and surcharge loads. The analysis has to be done for the worst
combination of the loads and moments.
PCC Blocks / Inverted Filter
As a transition between the impervious floors and the pervious protection, an inverted
filter is provided. It generally consists of 4ft x 4ft x 4ft concrete blocks resting on the
graded filter. There are small gaps (jharies) between the Blocks so that the residual
pressure from underneath the barrage could be released through the inverted filter
and joints without dislocating the blocks.
The filter is graded so as to permit free movement of water but prevent the movement
of fine particles of soil. It consists of four layers of (i) coarse sand, (ii) shingle or stone
crush ¼” to ¾”, (iii) ¾” to 1½” and (iv) 1½” to 3” each 6” thick resting directly on the
bed soil. This filter bed of layers of increasing porosity, from bottom to top, is protected
by the heavy concrete blocks (with open joints) against the action of surface flow. The
length of this section is one half of the length of stilling basin.
PCC Block Apron or Settling Blocks
The length of this apron depends on the depth of scour which is calculated using the
Lacey’s formula, i.e.
1
q2 3
R 0.9 x ............... 5-3
f
where:
R = Lacey’s regime depth
q = discharge per foot width with 20% concentration.
f = silt factor
For calculation of the length of block apron, the scour factor of 1.25 for the upstream
apron and 1.5-1.75 for the downstream apron is used. To calculate horizontal length
of block aprons, factors of 1.0 and 1.5 are used for upstream and the downstream
aprons respectively. Application or otherwise of discharge concentration should be
decided based on the site conditions.
These blocks are also called as “Settling Blocks”.
Cut-Off Walls
Concrete cut-off walls of 8’ height are provided as separators between the two block
aprons and the loose stone apron. These walls are provided with, have the standard
minimum steel reinforcement.
MANUAL OF IRRIGATION PRACTICE 5-19
BARRAGES
The length and thickness of the loose stone apron is determined by assumption of the
following conditions:
Apron will launch to a slope between 2H:1V and 3H:1V depending upon the
characteristics of the river bed material.
Thickness of stone apron when launched should not be less than 3 feet.
The stone size limits are depicted in Fig. 5-6.
The hyperbolic curve contained in this Fig. has been plotted with the data observed
for various prototypes and laboratory tests. Its locus can also be traced using the
following equation established by N.K. Berry and adopted by USBR.
𝑽𝒃 = 𝟐. 𝟓𝟕√𝒅 ............... 5-4
where
Vb = Bottom velocity in the channel in FPS; and
d = Stone particle diameter in inches
with specific gravity of 2.65.
Another equation by Mavis & Laushly given below yields similar results.
𝟏
𝑽𝒃 = 𝟐 √𝒅𝟏 √𝒔 − 𝟏 ............... 5-5
where
d1 = Diameter of stone particle in mm
S = specific gravity of the stone particle.
The scour factor for aprons varies from 1.25 to 1.75 for the upstream and from 1.75 to
2.25 for the downstream aprons. Application or otherwise of discharge concentration
is decided on the basis of site conditions.
Flared Out Walls
As already introduced in section, the flared out warped walls are counterfort type
retaining walls with a compound slope on the water side to provide a transition from
vertical face of the abutments and the wing wall to guide bank sloping face (2:1 slope).
Silt Excluder
The idea of silt excluder was originally presented by Mr. H. V. Elsden, whose paper,
published in 1922, first brought the idea of silt excluder before the Punjab Engineers.
The basic principle on which silt excluders are designed lies in the fact that in a flowing
stream carrying silt in suspension, the concentration of silt in the lower layers is greater
than in the upper ones. Consequently if we can escape the lower water without
interfering with the silt distribution, the remaining water will have less silt in it per unit
volume, than the water upstream of the escape structure/excluder.
Fig. 5-8 exhibits the distribution of sediment charge in laminar or regime flow, bottom
up in percentage for various types of soils/sediment sizes (sediment grades). It
establishes that larger the size of sediment, remains closer to bed. However it is
different for finer grades of 30 microns or less. This fine sediment remains in
suspension and the distribution is more or less uniform over the whole depth of flow.
Soil particles of these sizes thus do not settle in the canals as well and are carried to
the off-takes where velocity is the only criterion for their settlement.
MANUAL OF IRRIGATION PRACTICE 5-23
BARRAGES
This Fig. 5-8 also shows that coarse grades / sizes remain in the lower half, generally
below 40% of depth, with maximum intensity and grade at the bottom.
These indicate that given the conditions of laminar flow the coarse or settling grades /
sizes can be escaped through the excluder tunnel openings by as much as 95% of the
percentage of exclusion for various sizes / grades being (approximate) as depicted in
the following table 5-2:
Table 5-2: Sand sizes in suspension
Type of Sediment Size %age at 40% depth
up from bottom
Very find sand 62 to 125 microns 65%
Fine sand 125 to 250 microns 65%
Medium sand 250 to 500 microns 80%
Coarse sand 500 to 1 mm (1000 microns) 92%
Very coarse sand > 1 mm (1000 microns) 95%
These percentages are however approximate but give a fair idea of sediment
distribution in a vertical plane for a laminar/close to laminar flow.
Elsden's design for effecting this, comprised a regulator divided into two portions by
means of a horizontal diaphragm over which the upper water guided into the canal
while the heavily silt laden lower water passed through tunnels to waste. With
modification in detail, this form of construction is found in all excluders constructed to
date.
Elsden also advanced the idea that the amount of silt entering the canal might be
regulated by varying the supply passing through the lower tunnels. He also suggested
the need of a hinged flap at the upper end of the diaphragm, in order that the line of
separation of the two streams might be varied to permit the separation to take place
without disturbance, of the approaching flow. This idea being impractical did not find
favour with the hydraulic engineers and was dropped/abandoned.
Elsden died shortly after publishing his paper and for many years his ideas remained
untested in practice. However, they were not lost sight of. Messers King and Gram
prepared a very elaborate design for an excluder for the Headworks of the Lower
Chenab Canal at Khanki, about 1926, which was based on Elsden's principles. The
chief feature of this design was that the diaphragm was to cover half the undersluice
pocket.
The construction of the first excluder at Khanki was followed by rapid development on
the Upper Jhelum Canal, where Mr. Crump designed and built three extractors and
two excluders. The distinction between an extractor and an excluder, is that the latter
is placed at the head of the canal in the pocket and consequently excludes a proportion
of the silt from the water before it enters the canal, while the former being placed at
some distance down the canal extracts or ejects silt which has entered the canal.
The excluders located on the Bong and Jaba level crossings, exclude the torrent silt
from the canal and follow the Khanki type more closely, but considerably more care is
taken in the design of the tunnel and their orifices to secure uniformity of velocity of
the escapage across the canal, at the line of separation.
After Khanki two more improved excluders have been constructed at Trimmu and
Kalabagh Barrages. These structures are briefly introduced in the following:
MANUAL OF IRRIGATION PRACTICE 5-25
BARRAGES
Operation of later structures indicates that the optimum escapage through excluder
tunnels (effective) rests at about 40%. The escapage above 100% of canal discharge
generates turbulences and increase in the coarser sediment induction while
discharges less than 15% tend towards choking of tunnels.
(B) Separation of escapage from canal supply
The separation of the escapage water from the canal supply at the edge of the
diaphragm should obviously be arranged without disturbing the silt distribution. It is
easy enough to arrange this for fixed canal and escapage discharges by placing the
diaphragm at a height such that it divides the normal stream into the correct proportion.
For full supply conditions the stream lines is horizontal. If, however, it is required to
run the canal supply full, while sufficient water is not available for the escapage
discharge or if the escapage is run full when canal supply is low we shall have stream
lines somewhat as below:-
In the region AB there may be a certain amount of turbulence set up which will cause
a less favourable silt distribution. The question is, whether this disturbance is so
serious that it would necessitate to have the height of the edge of the diaphragm
variable or fixed.
In case the d50 of the suspended sediment is less than 150 microns, the distribution in
the vertical planes is generally uniform and the use of silt excluder becomes
unproductive.
5.3.14.5 Tunnel Design
(A) Tunnel Velocities
The tunnels are designed to evacuate the escapage at a high velocity, for effective silt
flow say 5 to 10 ft/s. They must also provide control of the discharge so that the same
velocity is secured at the entrance to each tunnel.
The tunnel roof should be designed to take full water pressure above it with the
maximum pressure which may occur inside it, assuming the entrance to be blocked. If
the tunnels act as a weir for the canal supply, the possibility of uplift occurring with the
tunnels closed at the downstream end, and a velocity depression over the roof should
be studied. The escapage if less than full supply is regulated by gates on the down-
stream end of the tunnel. At Madhopur a surge chamber was provided at the down-
stream end of the tunnels. Such situation can also be addressed by providing pressure
release holes in the concrete diaphragm (Tunnel roof slab).
(B) Efficiency of Excluders
MANUAL OF IRRIGATION PRACTICE 5-27
BARRAGES
The efficiency of excluders is calculated for conditions of with and without excluder
and is defined as:-
S
Efficiency 1 C 100
SO ............... 5-6
where So is the silt entering the canal (in PPM) with no excluder and Sc is the silt
entering the canal (in PPM) when an excluder is in operation. To make the excluder
work efficiently all measures which increase bed shear stress and throw more
sediment into suspension must be avoided and all measures which help in dropping
down of sediment into the lower layers should be used. These are:
i. Decrease the tractive force by flattening the river slope in the approach channel.
ii. The canal discharge and excluder tunnel discharge should not be increased
beyond a limit permissible for creating more bed shear than the normal.
iii. All obstructions, protuberances and roughnesses that have the effect of
throwing up towards surface a certain quantity of water should be avoided as
such as possible, because any disturbance caused in a laminar flow would
result in an upward rush of coarser sediments which normally (as reported by
researchers) once disturbed do not attain laminarity / normalcy in less than a
length of 50 times the depth of flow.
iv. An excluder in front of an intake located on the outside of a curve in a parent
channel will not have maximum efficiency for considerations of discharge, and
may beeven not needed.
The following aspects are considered for a specific site:
i. Efficiency of excluder in relation to its discharge extraction
ii. The best shape of the excluder.
iii. The efficiency of excluder over and above the still pond system; indicates that
the excluder efficiency at an optimum escapage/extraction of about 40% of
canal discharge remains in the range of 30 to 60%.
5.3.14.6 Hydraulic Design
The fact that the bottom layers of a channel carry the major part of the sediment load
has led to evolution of silt excluders as means for excluding excessive amount of
sediments from the water being diverted into canals off taking from barrages. Silt
excluders divide the pocket into two portions by means of a horizontal diaphragm, over
which the upper water passes into the canal while heavier silt laden bottom water
passes through tunnels downstream of the undersluices.
Discharge capacities of various tunnels are calculated after making due allowance for
the head losses inside the tunnels. With reference to Articles 227 and 228, Pressure
Flow in Outlet Conduits (Design of Small Dams, USBR 1987), various head losses
inside the tunnels are computed by using the loss coefficient listed in the following
Table 5-4:
Table 5-4: Loss Coefficient
i. Entrance 0.5
ii. Contraction 0.1
MANUAL OF IRRIGATION PRACTICE 5-28
BARRAGES
vi. The openings of tunnels have to be uniform i.e. same except in special
conditions with the approval of the Chief Engineer.
vii. To facilitate the gate opening / regulation process, tables and graphs which give
discharges and velocities for various gate openings for the structure are to be
prepared and used. These will help the operator for correct regulation of
discharge through the excluder tunnels.
5.3.14.9 Observations
The following observations are made daily or as prescribed by the Executive Engineer
and reported upto Chief Engineer level.
i. Discharge of the canal at head regulator.
ii. Discharge through excluder tunnels.
iii. Total discharge through the pocket.
iv. Sediment charge in the supply entering the pocket from upstream of the tunnel
entrance/intakes.
v. Sediment charge passing downstream of the tunnel exits.
vi. Sediment charge and the canal carrying capacity of the canal for the current
discharge in the canal.
vii. X-sections of the canal at 250 ft intervals in the 1st 2500 ft then 500 ft upto 5000
ft and then 1000 ft upto 10000 ft length. These X-sections is super imposed on
the previous ones and submitted to the Executive Engineer on the day next to
the observations. The Executive Engineer will keep a watch on the canal bed
configuration and take additional suitable measures (ejector operation) in
consultation with Chief Engineer. The frequency of these observations will be:
a. Upto 2500 ft on alternate days;
b. Upto 5000 ft twice a week;
c. Upto 10000 ft once a week;
The above frequency may be varied by the Executive Engineer in consideration of
various site conditions.
5.3.14.10 Inspection and Maintenance
Generally the excluder remaining under water all the time except during closure (and
that too rarely) can only receive maintenance attention during closure. It is therefore
of-utmost importance to give special attention to the excluder during closure. The
structure is inspected visually if possible or through divers. Although no problems are
expected, inspections are, however, necessary. The result of inspection and measures
taken to address any deficiency is reported in the annual closure report.
Typical plan and cross section of an excluder appear as Figs. 5-9 and 5-10.
Bridge Decking
The bridge decks are normally concrete structures classified as the following:
i. Simple supported slabs, cast in place or precast
ii. Slabs with girders (Tee decks)
iii. Balanced cantilever type
MANUAL OF IRRIGATION PRACTICE 5-30
BARRAGES
Selection of type depends on the site requirements. The decks are designed using
AASHTO standards and maintained as such.
The type classification with reference to customary loadings are:
i. Foot bridge loading (self-load with a light live load of 100 lb/sf uniformly
distributed).
ii. Class C – 9 ton loading. This is an old type for village carts etc and is now
obsolete.
iii. Class B – 18 ton loading. This type capable of handling 10 ton trucks has also
became obsolete and not constructed any more.
iv. Class A – or 30 ton loading, are used for inter village or village to town
connections.
v. Class AA – or 70 ton loading is used for district and arterial roads.
vi. Special class for NLC / environmental loads. Design calculations are based
on Pakistan Highway design code.
MANUAL OF IRRIGATION PRACTICE 5-34
BARRAGES
In special situations, other suitable form may be provided after confirmation by the
model studies.
MANUAL OF IRRIGATION PRACTICE 5-36
BARRAGES
Side slopes
a) Country side = 3H:1V
b) River side = 2H:1V (Armoured)
A six (6) inch (150 mm) thick compacted gravel and sand surfacing should be
placed on the crest of guide bank for protection against rainfall and traffic wear
and tear to keep it motorable for inspection and maintenance vehicles.
The embankment has to be protected with stone pitching, underlain with graded
spall and filter layers, and flexible stone apron on the riverside slope, upstream
head and downstream end.
The final geometry of the guide banks is determined by the physical model
studies to suit the site requirements.
Freeboard of top (crest) would be 9 ft for Indus and 7 ft for other rivers over the
HFL (Highest recorded flood level in Pakistan.
Pitched Islands
The pitched island is used as a river training measure due to its ability to cause re-
distribution of velocity and tractive force. The tractive force near a pitched island
begins to increase rapidly, with the result that deep scour begins to form round the
island and gradually draws the main river channel towards it and holds it permanently.
Pitched island is used either singly or in series, for the following purposes:
Correcting oblique approach upstream of weirs, barrages and bridges by
training the river to be axial.
Altering the river flow pattern and to stabilize its course.
Redistributing harmful concentration of flow for relieving attack on guide banks,
marginal bunds and river bends.
Sometimes, advantage may be taken of an existing natural island (a bela) which can
be reshaped and pitched accordingly.
Pitched islands exist upstream of Sulemanki barrage and Empress Railway bridge
over Sutlej near Bahawalpur.
Scour at the toe of a steeper slope is deeper than at the toe of a flatter slope. Different
side slopes are prescribed/specified for the pitched island when it is used for
redistribution of concentration of flow. The steeper slope (usually 2H:1V) is adopted
on the side on which a concentration of flow is desired, while flatter slope is provided
on the side where a deflection is required.
In the case of wide and shallow rivers, where obstruction caused by the island would
be very small, scour will not develop a readily round the island. Similarly in flashy
rivers, there is not enough time for the development of scour around the island. In such
cases, the pitched island may not achieve the desired results.
The pitched island is usually shaped as elliptical or egg-shaped, as shown in Fig. 5-
14. The upstream nose is round and broad, while downstream end is provided with a
narrow tail. Generally, its body consists of compacted river bed material, protected
with stone pitching, underlain with graded spall and filter layers, on the side slopes
and flexible stone apron. The final length and shape of the island is determined by
physical model studies to suit the site requirements.
Design of pitching and apron follow the method adopted for guide banks.
MANUAL OF IRRIGATION PRACTICE 5-40
BARRAGES
Generally, marginal bunds are aligned by placing them a mile or two away from the
active channel prism. The marginal bunds are normally anchored to the guide banks
or start from about five hundred (500) feet upstream or downstream of the gate-line of
the barrage. They are anchored into / connected with high land or an existing flood
bund, where no spill due to end effect is anticipated.
Since the rivers change their course, it is not necessary that a particular alignment of
the marginal bund safe for a particular flow condition will remain safe for changed river
flow conditions with passage of time. When such contingencies develop, proper river
training works are needed to contain the river channel / spill within the provided Khadir
(Active flood plain) width.
In reaches, where current attack or wave-wash are anticipated the riverside slope of
the bund are generally protected with stone pitching, with a stone toe or apron.
Typical cross-sections of normal earthen marginal bund and bund with slope
protection are presented in Fig. 5-15. The following section parameters for the
embankment are kept as prescribed by the Federal Flood Commission:
Crest top width = 25 ft.
Free Board 6 to 7 ft over the HFL (7 ft for Indus and 6 ft for other rivers)
Riverside slope, earthen = 3H:1V
Riverside slope, protected = 2H:1V
Landside slope = 2H:1V
The cross-section of the embankment is generally designed to accommodate
the hydraulic gradient of 6:1 (for sandy or silt loam) at the design flood level
(HFL). The hydraulic gradient line should have a minimum cover of two (2) feet
at landside toe of the embankment in natural grand and 4 ft for made up slope.
Where not practicable, some drainage solution is adopted. Design of drainage
measures is beyond the scope of this manual.
A six (6) inch (150 mm) thick compacted gravel and sand surfacing is now
also placed on the crest (top) for protection against rainfall traffic wear and
tear and in rare cases of wave splash.
Deflecting Spur
(c)
Replacing Spur
(b)
Attracting Spur
(a)
With flattening/lengthening of the tail end slope of the spur head the scour hole
shifts lower down from the tail end of the spur.
v. When the spur head is placed parallel to the main current the flow approaches
tangential to the spur head and runs almost parallel to it. With the development
of scour hole at the spur head nose, embayment starts forming upstream of the
spur head and deepens with time and increase in river flow. At this stage, the
main current is slightly deflected towards the opposite bank and an eddy
develops along the upstream end of the spur head. With the deepening of the
embayment, the flow concentration and intensity of eddy increases and
becomes dangerous to the spur head. However, with the increase in angle of
orientation of spur head, the flow concentration at the spur head nose and the
eddy along upstream portion of the spur head reduce generally till the eddy is
eliminated completely. But at the same time an eddy develops at the back of
the spur which gains strength with increase in the angle of orientation and
poses a threat to the downstream face of the unprotected shank. The maximum
angle of orientation is recommended to be ten (10) degrees.
5.4.7.4.8 J-Head spur
This type is very similar to a (a close variant of) Tee-cum-hockey-sloping spur
developed with a mild change in the spur head shape.
The hydraulic behaviour is also similar but it is less massive and more cost effective.
This type has thus gained greater acceptance and tee cum hockey sloping type has
been virtually abandoned in favour of J-head.
5.4.7.4.9 Guide-head spur
The guide-head spur is a combination of Guide bank nose, T-spur, hockey spur and
sloping spur Fig. 5-20. The spur design elements are:
i. Hockey-part: optimum radius of the spur head at the upstream end.
ii. T-part: availing alignment and length of the spur head.
iii. Sloping-part: optimum slope for the downstream end of the spur head.
iv. Stone-apron: effective dimensions and stone size on the spur head and
upstream face of the shank.
For selecting the length of shank and spur head, the, angle, shape etc, can best be
finalized from physical model studies. However, the typical behaviour characteristics
of guide-head spur are similar to those of J-head type with the addition of the current
guiding function. This type is now preferred over others on the basis of model test
results.
5.4.7.4.10 Spur head with cast-in-place concrete piles
A typical mole head spur with cast-in-place concrete piles is shown in Fig. 5-21. In
piles head spur, the piles constitute the main verticals, placed down to anticipated
scour depth plus embedded length in the river bed. The pile top is kept at the crest
level of the spur head. Piles are spaced at 30 inches centre to centre. This
arrangement can be used for any spur type depending upon the site suitability.
MANUAL OF IRRIGATION PRACTICE 5-55
BARRAGES
Figure 5-21: Typical mole head spur with cast-in-place concrete piles
MANUAL OF IRRIGATION PRACTICE 5-57
BARRAGES
Stone and brush-wood filling is provided between the pile verticals. When the channel
bed scours along the piles, some small stones will slip through the vertical gaps into
the scour holes. This loss depresses the stone filling between the pile verticals.
Replenished stone during the period of channel bed scouring.
The basic design criteria for the cast-in-place concrete piles are:
Pile diameter = 24 in
Point of fixity is at the anticipated maximum scour level
Concrete type = RCC, 3000 psi (1:2:4)
Reinforcement = Grade 40, deformed bars. Minimum longitudinal
bars are provided at one percent (1.0 %) of the concrete area
Concrete cover = 3 in. (75 mm)
Design forces = self-weight, hydrodynamic force and active
pressure from stone filling.
Embedded length = to sustain self-weight and moments from design forces
Spacing of piles = 30 inches C/C
This type is new and is expensive but gives a highly sustainable structure. However it
has not been tried in practice due to its high cost.
5.4.7.5 Choice of Type of Spur
Various factors which influence the choice and design of spurs:
i. Gradient and velocity of river.
ii. Available construction materials.
iii. Type of bed material carried by the river (i.e. shingle, sand or silt).
iv. Sediment silt load in river flow.
v. River width or waterway available at high, medium and low discharges.
vi. Depth of waterway and flood hydrograph.
Permeable spurs are best suited to erodible bed rivers, normally carrying heavy-silt-
laden flows. These are not suitable for small rivers, having steep gradients or deep
rivers carrying light-sediment load.
Impermeable spurs are most suitable for confining a river to a defined channel.
Spurs may be aligned perpendicular or inclined to the bank line, pointing upstream or
downstream. The determination of angle of spur with respect to current axis requires
physical model study.
In a straight reach of a river, a series of spurs are required to provide bank protection.
A curved reach of the river may be trained by a limited number of spurs.
Studs
The studs are short bar-spurs used for protection against the spill flow causing erosion
along the river bank or flood embankment. These are placed in series at suitable
locations in the spill flow channel along the bank. They reduce erosion by deflecting
the high velocity currents away from the eroding bank. For anchoring of studs, they
are well extended into the bank, having similar section as that placed in riverward
portion.
MANUAL OF IRRIGATION PRACTICE 5-58
BARRAGES
The studs are repaired and additional studs are constructed from time to time
depending upon the conditions of the river during and after a flood. A series of studs
are often used in lieu of direct bank protection, because they are more economical
and do not disturb the near-bank environment.
Depending upon the flow velocity, the following four types of studs are used:
i. Earthen stud; in spill flow channel with low velocity.
ii. Earthen stud with stone protection; in spill flow channel with medium velocity.
iii. Earthen stud with stone protection and armoured leading nose; in spill flow
channel with high velocity or leading nose under current attack of main channel.
iv. Solid stone stud; when main channel current attacks the bank.
The typical cross-sections of different types of studs are shown in Fig. 5-27. The basic
design criteria for the studs are:
Crest width
o Earthen stud = 12 ft
o Earthen stud with stone protection = 12 ft
o Solid stone stud = 8 ft
Side slopes
o Earthen stud = 3H:1V
o Earthen stud with stone protection = 2H:1V
o Solid stone stud = 2H:1V
Length: As per site conditions but not exceeding 500 ft
Spacing: As already stated in an earlier paragraph the spacing may be 3 to 6
times the length of the stud
Apron: The need and size are established by site conditions and
expected scour
Design of River Training Works
5.4.9.1 Freeboard
In the design of water containing structures, the crest of the embankment is to be kept
higher than the level of water to be contained. This margin is necessary for safety
against overtopping due to rise in water levels on account of disturbances in water
from breaking waves and wind set-up in river ponds. At river curves the river set (or
super elevation) also needs to be taken into consideration. Where river bed accretion
is regular due to sediment deposition (like in the lower reaches of Indus River), the
design flood level is established by adding two feet to the recorded high flood level.
For other cases, a small freeboard is also necessary for contingent requirement as a
factor of safety.
The following formulae are used for calculating the wave run-up, wind set-up and river
set and the freeboard:
MANUAL OF IRRIGATION PRACTICE 5-59
BARRAGES
where:
R = wave run-up (or ride) (ft)
H = wave height (ft)
K = surface roughness coefficient for the embankment slope (ft)
= 2.3 ft. for smooth surface
= 1.8 ft. for earthen surface
T = wave period(s)
ℒ = embankment slope angle with horizontal (degree)
g = acceleration of gravity (ft./s2)
5.4.9.3 Wind Set-Up
An appreciable rise in water level may be caused on the slope of reservoir or pond by
wind action, particularly in shallow water. The wind set-up can be estimated by Zui-
Der-Zee formula:
𝑼𝟐 𝑭
𝑺 = 𝟏𝟒𝟎𝟎 𝑫 𝐜𝐨𝐬 𝜽 ............... 5-8
where:
S = set-up above still pond level (ft)
U = wind velocity (mile/hour)
F = fetch (mile)
D = average water depth (ft)
θ = angle of fetch and wind (degree)
For combined effect of wind set-up and storm wave the total rise in water level is equal
to wind set-up plus two third of wave run-up.
5.4.9.4 River set or super elevation
At a curve the deepest point of the river cross-section is near the concave (or outer)
bank and the water surface there is higher than that at the convex (or inner) bank. The
“river set” may cause a super elevation of the water surface at the concave (or outer)
bank and this can be estimated by Schoklitsch formula:
V2 R2
h 2.3 .log ............... 5-9
g R1
Where:
h = river set (ft
V = average velocity at the upstream straight reach (ft/s)
g = acceleration of gravity (ft./s²)
R1 = radius of curvature of convex (or inner) bank (ft
R2 = radius of curvature of concave (or outer) bank (ft
The “Government of Sind Bund Manual” indicates that “river set” may cause a rise of
the water surface at the concave (or outer) bank as much as 2.0 feet.
MANUAL OF IRRIGATION PRACTICE 5-61
BARRAGES
TRAINING
STRUCTURES
Current flow, river set, Straight andconvex
-Rivers bank protection sediment deposition, storm bank=6.0
wave and wind set-up Concave bank=7.0
(*) The recommended minimum freeboard values include one foot additional
freeboard for contingent requirement as factor of safety.
S h2 d 2
............... 5-10
a d 2 h2 d 2 h2 cot2
Where:
S = length of parabolic line of seepage (or phreatic line) from riverside water
entrance point to the toe of landside slope (ft)
h = design flood depth on riverside slope (ft)
d = horizontal distance from riverside water entrance point to the toe of
landside slope (ft)
a = landside slope angle with horizontal (degree)
= length of surface of seepage upward from the toe landside slope (ft)
The phreatic line is taken as boundary between the below saturated and above dry
embankment soil properties for use in the stability analysis of side slopes.
ii. Pore water pressure
Pore pressure ratio (ru),which is defined as the ratio of pore water pressure to vertical
load at the base of each slice, is used for the slip circles analysis for all given conditions
except for riverside slope at flood draw-down condition. For this condition only pore
water pressure is used. The pore water pressure equation is:
u = ru h ............... 5-11
where:
u = pore water pressure
ru = pore pressure ratio
= total unit weight of soil (dry weight above phreatic line and saturated
weight below phreatic line)
h = depth of soil from top surface
The Simplified Bishop Method computer package may be used to compute the pore
pressure ratio. For draw-down analysis the pore water pressure is determined by the
above equation and utilized for determining the pore water pressure.
For common soils the value of “ru” ranges between 0.3 and 0.1
MANUAL OF IRRIGATION PRACTICE 5-65
BARRAGES
e) Surcharge
A surcharge of 200 lbs. per ft2 (975 kg/m2) on the top surface of embankment is applied
for stability analysis.
f) Earthquake load
The acceleration due to earthquake is selected on the basis of fifty percent (50%)
reduction for the horizontal and vertical components for calculation by the pseudostatic
method. For example, the effect of a maximum ground acceleration (in central Punjab
area) due to an Open Basis Earthquake (OBE) of 0.16g (pseudostatic) in the free field
issued for the stability analysis. Thus on the basis of 0.16g OBE and fifty percent (50%)
reduction in accelerations the earthquake loads adopted for analysis will be:
Horizontal acceleration = 0.08g
Vertical acceleration= 0.04g
These earthquake forces act at the center of gravity of the slice.
For OBE values no major damages may be expected for the hydraulic structures in
general. The OBE values for particular scheme is adopted on the basis of specific
related earthquake zone criterion.
g) Critical conditions for stability analysis
The stability analysis of the embankment is carried out by using laboratory test values
and characteristics of selected materials for determining the “Safety Factors” under
critical conditions relating to the various parameters under design requirements. The
recommended minimum safety factors against shear failures are listed in the following
table 5-7:
Table 5-7: Minimum safety factor
Minimum safety factor
Condition Without
With earthquake
earthquake
During and end of construction 1.4 1.2
Rapid river draw-down 1.3 1.1
River low flow level 1.2 1.0
Design flood 1.5 1.2
Source: HASKONING and Delft Hydraulics
For overall stability of the embankment, during construction stage and under different
river flood levels, the proposed slopes of the embankment is analyzed for the stability
under the following three loading conditions:
Gravity
Seepage (or pore water pressure)
Earthquake
The potential failure surfaces is analyzed for the following four critical conditions
against the pore water pressure by considering gravitational loading with and without
earthquake:
End of construction
Design flood level with steady seepage
Flood draw-down
MANUAL OF IRRIGATION PRACTICE 5-67
BARRAGES
Table 5-8: Combination of data input for slope stability analysis of embankment
Surc
S Eart
Soil harg
r. Side h- Pore water
Case Prop e Remarks
N Slope qua Pressure
erties (lb./f
o ke
t2)
END OF
CONSTRUCT
1 ION H;V fill - 200 ru construction
“ru” important
2 Riverside H:V fill - 200 ru
construction
3 Landside H:V fill H & 200 ru “ru” important
V
4 Earthquake – H:V fill 200 ru earthquake
Riverside H & important
V
Earthquake – earthquake
Landside important
RAPID RIVER
DRAW-
5 DOWN H:V fill - 200 pore water pore water
pressure pressure
6 Riverside H:V fill H&V 200 contours important
RIVER LOW
FLOW LEVEL
9 H:V fill - 200 ru For major part
Riverside of structure life
1 H:V fill - 200 ru
0 Landside For major part
H:V& - 200 ru of structure life
assum
MANUAL OF IRRIGATION PRACTICE 5-69
BARRAGES
DESIGN
FLOOD
1 H:V fill - 200 ru “ru” important
2 Landside
H:V fill H&V 200 ru earthquake
1 Earthquake - important
3 Landside
Source: HASKONING and Delft Hydraulics
The foundation investigations is planned to provide information about the type and
nature of the materials in the river bed, the depth and extent of possible
openwork/surface armoured layers in the formations and rock level below the alluvium.
These investigations include possible drilling, excavation of test pits, trenches and field
and laboratory testing.
As a general rule the extent and depth of investigation depends upon the importance
and height of embankment above the river bed level. A subsoil depth equal to about
the proposed height of embankment should be investigated through test pits and
boreholes. Investigations in the river bed are confined to periods of low river flows
when the drilling and other auxiliary equipment could be mobilized and deployed in the
river bed. The investigation essentially provides the following information:
Material type and zoning
Permeability of river bed material
In-situ density
Hardness of cobles and boulders
Bearing pressure capacity
5.4.9.8 Hydraulic Gradient
After the size of flood embankment has been established with a given top width and
side slope, the existing practice is to test the cross-section against hydraulic gradient
and if necessary, a back berm (or pushta) is provided to keep the hydraulic gradient
within the cross-section. The hydraulic gradient is an assumed line of saturation in the
embankment body. Normally, for common soils, it is assumed as 6:1 and 2 feet
minimum cover is provided over this line as pushta if it exits on the landside.
The present practice of providing pushta on landside, however, does not adequately
solve the problem of seepage flow through embankments placed on pervious
foundation. Such provisions are only advisable where the duration of steady flood level
against the embankment is not more than the period of saturation required for the
cross-section with respect to the permeability of the fill material. Cases where duration
of flood water standing against an embankment is more than the required period of
saturation, the provision of pushta simply increases the period to a limited extent and
does not ensure safety of the structure against piping. The position becomes graver
MANUAL OF IRRIGATION PRACTICE 5-70
BARRAGES
d) Morphological Conditions
In non-cohesive sediments, such as sand and gravels, the particle size and material
density are the dominant material parameters for sediment transport. Bed material
which is widely graded is more resistant to scour than uniform material of the same
median grain size. During a flood, the finer grains of a non-uniform bed material are
eroded first leaving coarser grains in bed. This increases the median grain size of the
bed material and the process is called as armouring of bed.
e) Geotechnical Conditions
The maximum scour depth and areal extent increases gradually until an equilibrium
phase is established. However, this continuous process may suddenly be disturbed
by geotechnical instabilities along the scour side slopes. The extreme case of
instability may involve large masses of sediment and may cause major change in the
shape of scour slopes in a relatively short period of time.
f) Design Process
The design process involves the development of solutions of various problems in an
interactive manner. Though an optimum solution may not be obtained, the adopted
design process provides a systematic approach. To produce a safe and reliable
design, all the possibilities of failure should be considered at the conceptual level, and
various failure probabilities should be integrated in a single approach. The bed
protection has to prevent or slow down a change in the bottom of the foundation. A
failure of the bed protection does not directly result in the loss of structure. However,
if the sub-soil becomes unstable due to a well-developed local scour, the resistance
of the foundation is reduced.
g) Protective Measures for Local Scour
Placing a flexible bed protection (or flexible stone apron) downstream or around the
hydraulic structures is a common method of local scour protection. The scour occurs
in the area of the bed beyond the flexible stone apron and as a scour hole is formed
the apron slides down into it. Local scour can be reduced or prevented by either
reducing the loading parameters or by increasing the strength parameters as
summarized in Table 5-10.
Table 5-10: Protective scour measures
Load Reduction Strength increase
- Lengthening bed protection - Compacting sub-soil
- Roughening bed protection - Grouting sub-soil
- Streamlining hydraulic structure - Protecting bed/scour slope
- Energy dissipaters
- Wave dissipaters (berms,
vegetation, reed etc.
Source: Hoffman, Bkema and Verhaij – scour manual (1997)
Local Scour
The local scour results directly from the impact of the structure on the flow. The
development of the scour process depends on the flow velocity, turbulence intensity
and bed materials. Therefore, it is difficult to prescribe a direct for prediction method
local scour. It is recommended to calculate the local scour by several available
MANUAL OF IRRIGATION PRACTICE 5-73
BARRAGES
methods and then use engineering judgment to select the preferred results of establish
using the maximum value by the most applicable methods.
a) Flow Characteristics
For predicting the severity of local scour at or around hydraulic structures the
interaction of the three types of flow are listed in table 5-11:
Table 5-11: Flow characteristics
Geometry Interaction ( Type of flow )
b/ho< 0.5 A strong interaction: vortices are generated intermittently from a
separation point at the sides of the structure.
0.5 < b/ho< 1.5 A weak interaction
c 1157 .6
m / (R )½ ............... 5-12
where:
Bazin’s m= 1.54 for earth channels in perfect condition
= 2.36 for earth channels in ordinary condition
= 3.17 for earth channels in rough condition
R= hydraulic radius (ft
The slope “ S” is given by the following Lacey’s formula;
5
3
s f
1 ............... 5-13
1844 Q 6
where:
f = Lacey’s silt factor = 1.76 (Dm)1/2
Dm = Median grain size of bed material (mm)
Mean flow depth:
1/ 3
Q2 / B2
d m 2 ............... 5-14
C .S
d) Modified form of Chezy’s formula:
V C RS ............... 5-15
Field tests are carried out to establish “Dm” for flow reach of the individual hydraulic
structure. For guidance the values of Lacey’s silt factor “f ” for various soil types are
listed in the following table:
Table 5-12: Medium grains and silt factor
Soil Type Dm Lacey’s silt factor
(mm) “f”
Large boulders and shingle 129.13 20.00
Boulders and shingle 72.64 15.00
Boulders and gravel 50.44 12.50
Cobbles / small boulders, shingle and sand 32.28 10.00
Coarse gravel 26.15 9.00
Gravel 7.28 4.75
Heavy sand 1.29 2.00
Coarse sand 0.73 1.50
Medium sand 0.51 1.25
Standard silt/Fine sand 0.32 1.00
Medium silt 0.16 0.70
Fine silt 0.08 0.50
Very fine silt 0.05 0.40
Source: Lacey’s method 1930 – Regime Approach
i. Lacey Method (1930) (regime approach)
R 0 .9 ( q 2 / f ) 1 / 3 ............... 5-16 (Fig. 5-25)
where:
MANUAL OF IRRIGATION PRACTICE 5-75
BARRAGES
Location “x”
Right angled bend of channel 2.50
Upstream floor of structure 1.75
Downstream floor of structure 2.25
Nose of guide bank 2.50
Transition from nose to straight of guide bank 1.75
Straight reach of guide bank 1.50
Pier nose (Consultants recommendation) 2.00
Nose of spur, depending upon the location and river approach 2.50– 3.00
(Consultants recommendation)
d f d i q f / qi
m
............... 5-23
d s Zd m
where:
df = scoured depth below design flood water level (ft)
di = average depth at bankful discharge in incised reach (ft)
qf = design discharge intensity (cusecs/ft)
qi = bankful discharge intensity in incised reach (cusecs/ft)
m = exponent varying from 0.67 for sand to 0.85 for coarse gravel
ds = depth of scour below stream bed (ft)
Z = multiplying factor for predicting maximum scour depth
MANUAL OF IRRIGATION PRACTICE 5-79
BARRAGES
iv. Values of Multiplying Factors, “Z”, for Lacey, Blench and Neill Equations
(regime methods)
Table 5-15: Multiplication factors for Neil, Lacey and Blench equation
Value of “ Z ”
Condition Neill Lacey Blench
ds=Z df ds=Z dm ds=Zdfo
EQUATION TYPES A AND B
Straight reach 0.50 0.25
Moderate bend 0.60 0.50 0.6 1/
Severe bend 0.70 0.75
Right angle bends 1.00 1.25
Vertical rock bank or wall 1.25
d s 1.32HT q0.54 dm
0.225
............... 5-26
where:
ds= depth of scour below stream bed (ft
HT=head across the structure (ft)
q = discharge flood intensity (cusecs/ft)
dm= downstream mean water depth (ft)
MANUAL OF IRRIGATION PRACTICE 5-82
BARRAGES
ds 1.95q
0.82
/D85
0.23
d m /q
2 / 3 0.93
dm ............... 5-27
where:
ds= depth of scour below stream bed (ft)
q= discharge flood intensity (cusecs/ft)
D85= particle size for which 85 percent is finer than (mm)
dm= downstream mean water depth (ft)
Other Methods
i. Molesworth and Yenidunia Equation (rational method)
d s 1.41q
0.61
............... 5-28
where:
ds= depth of scour below stream bed (ft)
q= discharge flood intensity (cusecs/ft)
ii. Farraday and Charlton Equation (regime approach for gravel – bed rivers)
d m 0.47V y / D90
0.8 0.12
............... 5-29
where:
dm= depth of scour below stream bed (ft)
Vy= discharge flood intensity (cusecs/ft)
D90 = particle size for which 90 percent is finer than (mm)
iii. Inglis Method (1949) (regime approach)
Sir Inglis using the Lacey’s regime equation analyzed the prototype data and
developed the following scour equations:
Ds x.d m d o
d m 0.47Q / f ............... 5-30
1/ 3
where:
Ds= depth of scour below stream bed (ft)
x = multiplying factor for predicting maximum scour depth
dm= mean depth at design discharge (ft)
Q = design discharge (cusecs)
f= Lacey’s silt factor
do= mean flow depth
Table 5-17: Multiplication factors for CC Inglis method (1949)
Location “x ”
Nose of pier 2.00
Straight spur facing upstream, sloping at 1.5H:1V 3.80
Large radius guide bank 2.75
Spurs/groynes along river banks, depending upon severity of 1.57 to 3.80
attack (*)
MANUAL OF IRRIGATION PRACTICE 5-83
BARRAGES
D1.32Q/ Cr
3/10
............... 5-32
(Maximum scour depth = 1.7 D)
Rivers and torrents subject to sudden and short lived spates:
D1.0Q/ Cr
3/10
............... 5-33
Rivers subject to fluctuating flood discharge throughout the year:
D 0.78Q/ Cr
3/10
............... 5-34
Rivers and torrent in gorges with inerodible / rigid banks and a deep alluvium
bed:
D1.32Q/ Cr
3/10
for gorge width > 2.4 (Q/Cr)½ ............... 5-35
D 2.25Q/Wr .Cr
3/ 5
for gorge width < 2.4 (Q/Cr)½ ............... 5-36
where:
D= maximum scour depth from design flood level to down (ft)
Q= design flood discharge (cusecs)
Cr= Kennedy’s velocity ratio
Wr = width of gorge (ft)
Table 5-18: Kenedy’s velocity ratio
ym ho 1
............... 5-37
ho 1 m
where:
ym= scour depth in constriction (ft)
ho= flow depth upstream of constriction (ft)
m = B2/B1
B1 = upstream width of river (ft)
B2 = constriction width of river (ft)
= coefficient : ranging 0.67 to 0.80
For bank overflow of upstream river, the above equation may be written as:
MANUAL OF IRRIGATION PRACTICE 5-85
BARRAGES
ym ho 1 Q
............... 5-38
ho 1 m Q Q f
where:
Q= total flood discharge (cusecs)
Qf= bank overflow (cusecs)
b) Bend Scour
Excessive scour occurs in the outer part of bends as a result of spiral flow. The scoured
depth at a bend maybe calculated using the following formulae:
i. Thorne Equation (1993), (empirical relation)
y m / ho 1.07 - log (R/B -2) for 2 < R/B < 22 ............... 5-39
where:
ym= scour depth at river bend (ft)
ho= flow depth in upstream straight reach of river (ft)
R = radius of curvature at the center-line (ft)
B = water surface width in the upstream straight reach of river (ft)
ii.Alvarez Equation
Alvarez equation for the maximum flow depth in the bend follows:
H m ax EH re ............... 5-40
where:
Hmax= maximum depth of flow in the bend (ft)
Hre= flow depth in upstream reach of river (ft)
E= coefficient depending on B/R ratio
B= water surface width in upstream straight reach of river (ft)
R= river bend center-line radius (ft)
Table 5-20: Coefficient “E” for Alvarez equation
B/R “E”
0 1.27
0.166 1.48
0.200 1.84
0.250 2.20
0.333 2.57
0.500 3.00
Source: Copeland – Strain bank protection (USACE)
c) Confluence Scour
At the function of two branches of a river, both the angle of confluence and water level
may change. The scour downstream of a confluence may be computed using the
following equation (Breusers and Raudkivi, 1991):
Ym/ho = Co + 0.037 ............... 5-41
where:
Ym = scour depth at confluence (ft)
ho= average flow depth of the two branches (ft)
MANUAL OF IRRIGATION PRACTICE 5-86
BARRAGES
Co = coefficient depending on river bed material properties in river bed (1.29 for fine
sand to 2.24 for gravel)
ʋ= angle between the two upstream branches (degree)
d) Swirl Scour
Swirls are generated when fast moving water flows past a still water area. Depending
on severity, the swirls may cause abnormal deep scour. Since it is difficult to compute
the velocities in swirl creating currents, no definite analytical relationships have been
developed in this respect. In the absence of reliable calculations of the scour that a
swirl may produce the locations where swirls are likely to be generated should be
identified and provided with additional protection.
e) Maximum Design Velocity in Concave Bend
To calculate the maximum design velocity (Vmax) in a concave bend Salikov
recommended the following equation:
Vmax = 1.25 VCv ............... 5-42
where:
VCv= average velocity at the foot of the concave bend in the absence of a groyne
f) Protective Measures for Local Scour
Placing a flexible bed protection (or flexible stone apron) downstream or around the
hydraulic structures is a common method of local scour protection. The scour occurs
in the area of the bed beyond the flexible stone apron and as a scour hole is formed
the apron slides down into it. Local scour can be reduced or prevented by either
reducing the loading parameters or by increasing the strength parameters as
summarized below:
Table 5-21: Load reduction and strength increase methods
Load reduction Strength increase
-Lengthening bed protection -Compacting sub-soil
-Roughening bed protection -Grouting sub-soil
-Streamlining hydraulic structure -Protecting bed/scour slope
-Energy dissipaters - Reworking the foundation soil
-Wave dissipaters (berms, vegetation, reed etc
Stone Apron
The function of stone apron is to launch and cover the scoured subaqueous slope
below pitching level and prevent the possibility of damaging effect of scour reaching
close to the structure, with a possibility of undermining.
The calculated quantity of apron stone is laid horizontally along the bank toe, with its
top level at the river bed level for dry conditions or at par with the low water level (LWL)
of the river to form the working platform. When scour occurs, the hand packed stone
apron launches itself to act as revetment on the scoured subaqueous slope.
After launching action of stone apron, the stone pitching gradually slips down the bank
slope because of its diminished stable toe previously offered by the stone apron. A top
layer of suitable size gabions (or stone crates), depending upon the stone apron
thickness should be placed for one quarter width of the apron, starting from the stone
pitching toe. These gabions re-establish a stable toe to the stone pitching due to
MANUAL OF IRRIGATION PRACTICE 5-87
BARRAGES
launching action of the stone apron. These gabions also check the rolling away of
loose apron stones due to higher velocity in the proximity of stone pitching.
Typical details of stone apron and pitching are shown in Fig. 5-28.
a) Stone Apron Design
To design a stone apron, it is necessary that the volume of stone should be sufficient
to cover the local scour slope length in its fully developed state and also fill partially
the scour hole at toe of the subaqueous slope.
i. Launching Slope
The launching slope of apron maybe assumed as the angle of internal friction () of
the river bed subsurface saturated soil located near to the side slope of the structure.
The representative values of “” for various soil types in saturated condition are shown
in the following table:
Table 5-22: Values of internal friction angle “” for different saturated soils
Soil type “” (Saturated conditions)
Gravel 35º
Coarse sand 28º
Silty sand 25º
Fine sand 28º
Clayey sand 20º
Silt 20º
Source: Bolhales – Foundation analysis and design (1980)
The slope of the scour hole to be covered (or protected) is calculated on the basis of
the above data.
ii. Volume of Stone Apron
The volume of stone to be laid in apron should be enough to cover (or protect) the side
slope of the scour hole with a reasonable thickness, sufficient to ensure safety of stone
pitching of the structure head. Some of the empirical/research methods for determining
the value of stone apron presently used in Pakistan are in the following:
Manual of Irrigation Practice, Punjab (1943):
Quantity of stone (Qs ) in apron = 2.(5)1/2 .D (per ft)
= 4.48 D
or 4.50 D
where:
D = scour depth below the normal bed level (ft)
Spring (1903) presented the following formulae for the side slope 2H:1V of the
scour hole:
Cover thickness = 1.25 T
Length of slope = 2.24 D
Qs = 1.25 T x 2.24 D = 2.8 DT(per ft)
where:
D = scour depth below the normal bed level (ft)
T = thickness of stone pitching necessary to protect sand surfaces of various grades
of sands and slopes of rivers, as depicted in Table 5-23:
MANUAL OF IRRIGATION PRACTICE 5-88
BARRAGES
Figure 5-28: Typical details of stone pitching protection and stone apron
MANUAL OF IRRIGATION PRACTICE 5-89
BARRAGES
river bed level due to anticipated armouring of bed material (or degradation depth) is
added to the predicted maximum local scour depth.
The armouring layer thickness and depth from the original river bed to top of armouring
layer (or degradation depth) may be calculated using the following equations:
1
yd ya 1 ............... 5-45
p
where:
yd = depth from the original river bed to top of armouring layer or degradation depth
(ft)
ya = thickness of armouring layer (ft)
= 3Dc(three layer thickness at non transportable material to form an armour)
p = decimal percentage of original bed material larger than armour size, “Dc”.
Dc 1.88Vm2 ............... 5-46
where:
Vm = mean river velocity
Dc = diameter of armour materialin (mm)
c) Apron Stone Size
Two empirical methods, given below can be used to determine the apron stone size.
The larger stone size “(D50)” resulting from either of the two methods will is selected.
i. Isbash Method
The Isbash equation in an expanded form for determining the apron stone size is:
1/ 2
w
V C 2 g s D50 1 / 2
w
Where 1/ 3
............... 5-47
6W
D50 50
s
where:
V= average velocity (ft/sec)
γs= specific weight of stone = 165 (lbs/ ft3)
γw= specific weight of water = 62.5 (lbs/ft3)
W50= weight of stone, 50% weight of total material containing stone of less weight (lb)
D50= equivalent spherical diameter of stone having the same weight as W 50 (ft)
g= acceleration of gravity (ft/s2)
C=Isbash constant equal to 1.20, recognizing the low turbulence flow near stone apron
The related hydraulic design chart for “Velocity Vs Stone Diameter”, is reproduced in
Figs. 5-29 and 5-30.
ii. Maynord Method
The basic Maynord equation for determining the stone size at low turbulence is:
2.5
0.5
V
D30 S f .CS .Cv .Ct .d w
............... 5-48
0.5
s w K1 .g.d
MANUAL OF IRRIGATION PRACTICE 5-91
BARRAGES
Figure 5-29: Typical details of stone pitching protection and stone apron
MANUAL OF IRRIGATION PRACTICE 5-92
BARRAGES
Figure 5-30: Typical details of stone pitching protection and stone apron
MANUAL OF IRRIGATION PRACTICE 5-93
BARRAGES
where:
D30= stone size for which 30% is finer than (mm).
Sf= safety factor = 1.1
Cs= stability coefficient for incipient failure= 0.30 forangular stone
Cv= velocity distribution coefficient = 1.25 at end of dyke
Ct= blanket thickness coefficient = 1.0
d= discharge flow depth(ft)
K1=side slope correction factor = 1.0
s= specific weight of water = 62.5 (lbs/ ft3)
w= specific weight of stone 165 (lbs/ ft3)
g= acceleration of gravity (ft/s²)
V= average velocity (ft/s)
The expanded Maynord equation is:
2.5
V
0.5
where:
D50 = average stone size
D30, D85, D15 =stone sizes for which 30%, 85%, 15% respectively are finer than
iii. Minimum Stone Size
The function of stone apron is to launch and protect the scoured subaqueous slope
below pitching level. The stone size (D50/W 50) to be laid in apron should be at least of
same size or larger than that determined for the slope pitching.
d. Apron Stone Grading
The size gradation of apron stone shall be established as an envelope based on the
following relations and as shown in Fig. 5-7.
W100 (max = 4.0W 50(min
W100 (min = 2.0W 50(min
W50(max = 1.5W 50(min
W15(max = 1.0W 50(min
W15(min = 0.4W 50(min
the bank slope to satisfy soils stability criteria. For a steeper bank slope, a stone
protection has to be provided on the slope. It provides the strength and stability
required together with the flexibility, not weakened by slight movement of the
embankment resulting from settlement or other adjustments. The local damage or loss
is easily repaired by addition of stone where required.
For hydraulic structures located in the barrage pond or bank of a wide river or
embankment lying across the river flow the action of waves or current or a combination
of both are considered for stone protection on the bank slope. The stone protection
for all other hydraulic structures and river banks slope are designed against transverse
forces due to the velocity and turbulence of current action.
For all type of bank slopes the stone size gradation of 40 lbs (18 kg) to 250 lbs (113
kg) is used. The stone material is composed of angular quarried stone eighty (80)
percent of which by weight are equal and larger than W 50. The remaining twenty (20)
percent quantity may be lighter rock (W 15 to W30) to fill the voids between larger stones.
5.5.7.2 Design of Slope Protection
Till recently the structural measures for protection of slope of flood works has been
confined to hammer dressed stone pitching designed on the basis of the following
empirical relationships:
Old Manual of Irrigation Practices, Punjab (1943)
Stone thickness =1.3(ft)
Spall/Filter layer =0.7(ft)
Total thickness =2.0(ft)
IRI - A General Recommendation
Stone thickness =2.5(ft)
Spall/Filter layer =0.75(ft)
Total thickness =3.25(ft)
Spring (1903)
Spring prepared a table 5.15 based on channel slope and grain size of the
alluvium through which the river flows.
Gales
Stone thickness =3.25(ft)
Spall/Filter layer =0.75(ft)
Total thickness =4.0(ft)(1.2 m)
C.C. Inglis Formula
T = 0.06(Q)1/3 ............... 5-51
where:
T = thickness of pitching (ft)
Q = discharge (cusecs)
This equation yields normal results for discharges up to 300,000 cusecs (8,500
cumecs) but the thickness increases abnormally for discharges above 400,000
cusecs (11,300 cumecs).
Sethi Formula
T=K(Q/f)1/3 ............... 5-52
where:
MANUAL OF IRRIGATION PRACTICE 5-95
BARRAGES
b) Maynord Method
The basic Maynord equation for determining the stone size on a slope for low
turbulence is:
2.5
0.5
V
D30 S f .CS .Cv .Ct .d w
............... 5-56
s . . 0.5
w K 1 g d
where:
D30 = stone size for which 30% is finer than (mm)
Sf= safety factor= 1.1
Cs= stability coefficient for incipient failure = 0.30 for angular stone
Cv= velocity distribution coefficient= 1.0 for straight channels and inside of bends
= 1.283 – 0.2 log (R/W) for outside of bends (1.0 forR/W > 26)
R= center-line radius of bend(ft)
W= water-surface width at upstream end of bend( ft)
Ct= blanket thickness coefficient = 1.0
d=discharge depth at 20% upslope from toe of bank slope.
K1 = side slope correction factor
=-0.672 + 1.492 cot θ-0.449 cot2 θ+0.045 cot3 θ
θ= bank slope angle to the horizontal (degree)
γs= specific weight of stone= 165 ( 1bs/ft3)
γw = specific weight of water = 62.5 ( 1bs/ft3)
g= acceleration of gravity (ft/s2 )
V= average velocity (ft/s)
The expanded Maynord equation is:
2.5
0.5
V
D30 0.41d w
............... 5-57
s w K1 .g.d
0.5
i. Wind Data
Normally, wind data to establish the design wind velocity over land (U land) is obtained
from the meteorological station with nearest to the hydraulic structure. For cases
where wind data is not available from the nearby station then the value of “U land” may
be taken as 50miles/hour (80 km/hour), the value established for Taunsa Barrage by
Zaidi.
The wind velocities over water (Uwater), because of smoother and more uniform
surface, are considered to be higher than those over land (U land). The following table
5-24 lists the ratio of “Uwater“ to “Uland” as a function of fetch distance .
Table 5-24: Wind ratio’s for various fetches
Fetch (mile) Wind RatioU water
U land
0.5 1.06
1 1.13
2 1.21
4 1.28
5 (and over) 1.31
The “Uland ” are adjusted by the wind velocity ratio to obtain“ U water”.
Source: Ipen – Estuary hydrodynamics
ii. Effective Fetch (Fe)
The characteristics of wind-generated waves are influenced by the distance that wind
travels over the water surface in the fetch direction. For hydraulic structures there is
less water surface for the wind to act on. The value of “Fe” ranges from one (1) mile
(1.6 km) to ten (10) miles (16 km) depending upon the maximum straight line length
of water surface to which the face of the embankment is exposed.
iii. Significant Wave Height and Period
With the established “Uwater” and “Fe” the significant wave height and period in deep
water are computed from the following three equation;
Saville Method :
0 .47
gHs gF
2
0.0026 2e ............... 5-59
Uw Uw
0.28
gTs gF
2
0.46 2e ............... 5-60
Uw Uw
where:
Hs = significant wave height, the average of the highest 1/3 waves in the
spectrum (ft)
Ts = significant wave period, the average interval between successive crests or
troughs of groups of the higher waves (s)
Fe= effective fetch (ft)
Uw= wind velocity overwater surface (ft/s)
g= acceleration of gravity (ft/s2)
MANUAL OF IRRIGATION PRACTICE 5-98
BARRAGES
The Fig. 5-31 reproduced from Ippen and Wood presents relationship between
the wave run-up ratio (R/Hs) and wave steepness (Hs/Lo) for deep water include
definition of deep water
where:
R = wave run-up as vertical height (ft)
Lo= wave length = 5.12 Ts2( ft)
Figure 5-31: Wave run-up ratios VS wave steepness and embankment slopes
(A.T. Ipen & Muir wood)
Bretschneider Method
2
H s 0.0555(U w Fe ) 0.5
2
............... 5-61
Ts 0.50(U w Fe ) 0.25
where:
Hs = significant wave height(ft)
Ts= significant wave period( s)
Uw= wind velocity ( knot)
Fe= effective fetch ( nautical mile) (1.15 statue mile = 1.0 nautical mile)
Shallow water wave-height (Hs’) = 0.65 Hs Creager and Justin Method
MANUAL OF IRRIGATION PRACTICE 5-99
BARRAGES
F 0.37 .U 0.48
H ............... 5-62
3.41
where:
H = wave height (ft)
F= fetch (mile)
U = wind velocity (mile/hour)
The following table shows the wave heights (in ft) with reference to reservoir/ pond
fetch in miles and wind velocity in mph.
Table 5-25: Wave height versus fetch and wind velocity
Fetch Wind velocity Wave height
(mi) (mi/h) (ft)
1 50 2.7
1 75 3.0
2.5 50 3.2
2.5 75 3.6
2.5 100 3.9
5 50 3.7
5 75 4.3
5 100 4.8
10 50 4.5
10 75 5.4
10 100 6.1
Source: Seville et. Al. (May 1962)
b) Wave breaking on slope
When a wave strikes on the front slope of embankment, it breaks completely or is
partially reflected creating standing waves which are sometimes twice the height of
incident waves. To avoid these standing waves the front slope has to completely break
the wave train. The front slope competency could be checked by satisfying the
following equation:
0.5
8 H
tan s ............... 5-63
Ts 2g
where:
α= bank slope angle to the horizontal (degree)
Hs = significant wave height (ft
Ts = significant wave period(s)
g= acceleration of gravity(ft/s2)
c) Wave Run-up or Ride
The run-up “R” of a braking wave, measured vertically above the mean water surface
level, is given by “HUNT” as
𝑹 𝑲 𝒕𝒂𝒏𝜶
= 𝟖 ............... 5-64
𝑯𝟏 𝑯 𝟏
𝑻 𝟏 𝟐
( )
𝟐
Where
R = Wave run up (ride)
MANUAL OF IRRIGATION PRACTICE 5-100
BARRAGES
H = Wave height
K = Surface roughness coefficient for the embankment slopes which is usually
assumed as 2.3’ for smooth facing.
Refer sample calculations in Annexure B.
d) Free Board
In the design of water retaining structures the crest of the embankment / structure is
to be kept higher than the level of water to be contained. This margin is necessary for
safety against overtopping due to rise in water levels on account of disturbances in
water like, waves, wind setup, river set in case of river ponds and seiches. Some small
margin is also necessary for contingent requirement as factor of safety. In some cases
the depth of frost zone may be the controlling factor.
Refer sample calculations in Annexure C.
e) Protection Stone Size
The semi-empirical Hudson and Jackson formula for determining the required weight
of the stone is:
Wr H 3
W50 ............... 5-65
K RR S r 1 C ot
3
1/ 3
6W
D50 50 ............... 5-66
Wr
where:
W50 =median stone weight in gradation by weight (lb)
Wr=unit weight of the stone= 165 (lbs/ft3)
H=design wave height (ft)
Sr=specific gravity of stone = W r / W w
W w=unit weight of water = 62.5 (lbs/ft3)
θ=slope measured to horizontal (degree)
KRR =stability coefficient for graded angular stone = 2.0 for double stone units
armoured layer
D50 =equivalent spherical diameter of stone having the same weight as W 50 (ft)
The value of “H” may determine using the following equations,
H = 1.25 Hs ............... 5-67
where:
Hs = significant wave height (ft)
5.5.7.5 Stone pitching protection
The slope protection will consist of hammer dressed stone pitching underlain with
transition layer of well graded rock spall and filter layer of well graded gravel or crushed
stone, up to the crest level. Typical details of stone pitching protection on embankment
slope are shown in Fig. 5-32.
a) Stone Pitching Layer
All stones should be contained within the thickness of stone pitching layer to provide
maximum resistance against erosive forces. The larger stones should not protrude
above the general surface of the stone pitching. As a normal requirement the minimum
MANUAL OF IRRIGATION PRACTICE 5-101
BARRAGES
thickness of stone pitching layer is 1.5 feet (0.45 m) for containing the larger stone.
Minimum thickness of stone pitching layer =1.5D50 1.5 ft(0.45 m)
b) Rock Spall Transition Layer
It is recommended to provide standard six (6) inches (150 mm) thick rock spall
transition layer between the stone pitching layer and filter layer. The spall layer should
be well graded from two (2) to four (4) inches (50 mm to 100 mm). Not more than
fifteen (15) percent should be larger than four (4) inches (100 mm) and not more than
five (5) percent should be smaller than two (2) inches (50 mm).
MANUAL OF IRRIGATION PRACTICE 5-102
BARRAGES
Figure 5-32: Typical details of stone pitching protection and stone apron
MANUAL OF IRRIGATION PRACTICE 5-103
BARRAGES
c) Filter Layer
To prevent infiltration of the material susceptible to draining into the filter, the following
requirement are met:
D15 percent size of filter material 5(stability) ............... 5-68
D85 percent size of material being drained
D50 percent size of filter material 25 (segregation) ............... 5-69
D50 percent size of material being drained
where:
D15, D85, D50 = material size for which 15%, 85%, 50% respectively are finer than
To assure that the filter material is much more permeable than the material being
drainedthe following requirement is met:
Permeability:
D15 percent size of filter material 5 (permeability) ............... 5-70
D15 percent size of material being drained
The permeability of a soil is approximately proportional to the square of its D 15 particle
size. Therefore, the criterion given by above equation assures that the filter material is
at least twenty five (25) times more permeable than the material being drained.
The maximum six (6) inches (150 mm) thick filter layer of gravel or crushed stone
should be well graded from two (2) inches (50 mm) down. Not more than fifteen (15)
percent should be larger than two (2) inches (50 mm) and not more than ten (10)
percent should be smaller than one sixteenth (1/16) of an inch (1.5 mm).
Geotextile Filter
5.5.8.1 General
Geotextile filter may be used on bank slope protection where gravel or crushed rock
filter materials are not readily available or are not cost effective due to transportation.
However, a problem which may occur with geotextile filter is that overland flow beneath
the geotextile can cause the development of gullies in bank material and bulges in the
geotextile.
5.5.8.2 Geotextile Filter Design
The following two factors control the design of geotextile filter:
a) Filtration
The flow path through the geotextile mesh must be fine enough to prevent continuous
infiltration and passing of soil, yet large enough to allow water to pass freely. The
following criteria should be used to select the geotextile filter.
i. For filter geotextile to be placed adjacent to granular materials containing
fifty (50) percent or less fines as those soils that will pass a U.S. Standard
Sieve No.200 (0.074 mm), the following ratio should be satisfied:
W85 percent passing size of soil(mm) 1 ............... 5-71
EOS of geotextile filter No. (mm)
where:
EOS = the equivalent opening size of geotextile filter
To reduce the chance of clogging, no geotextile should be specified with an EOS
smaller than the opening of the U.S. Standard Sieve No. 100 (0.149 mm)
MANUAL OF IRRIGATION PRACTICE 5-104
BARRAGES
ii. For geotextile filter to be placed adjacent to all other type of soils, the EOS
should not be larger than the opening of the U.S. Standard Sieve No. 70
(0.211 mm). Also, the soil must have at least fifty (50) percent but not more
than eighty five (85) percent fines by weight.
iii. The “GR” of a given geotextile soil filtration system is the ratio of the
hydraulic gradient over the one (1) inch of soil immediately next to the
geotextile (if ) to the hydraulic gradient over the two (2) inches of soil
between one (1)inch and three (3) inches above the geotextile (ig).
if
GR 3 ............... 5-72
ig
b) Chemical and Physical Properties
The design selection of geotextile filter must ensure for its chemical and physical
(strength and slippage) properties. These two properties are
i. Chemical strength requirements
The plastic yarn used to manufacture geotextile filter should consist of a long chain
synthetic polymer and contain stabilizers and/or inhibitors added to the base plastic to
make the filaments resistant to deterioration due to ultraviolet and heat exposure.
ii. Physical strength requirements
The geotextile filter must conform to the following three physical strength
requirements:
Tensile strength(ASTMD 1682)
Puncture strength (ASTMD 751)
Abrasion strength (ASTMD 3834)
To control relative slippage between the soil slope and geotextile or the geotextile and
stone protection securing pins should be used to keep the geotextile in place.
The pins spacing and length are recommended to be as the following
Spacing:
Slope < 3H:1V = 2.0 ft(0.6 m)
Slope ≥ 3H:1V = 3.0 ft(1.0 m)
Pin length:
Firm soils = 18 inch long steel pin
Loose soils > 18 inch long steel pin
MANUAL OF IRRIGATION PRACTICE 5-105
BARRAGES
For un-gauged basins, Stochastic methods are used utilizing the rainfall data for the
river basin using the method of probability and return periods, like curve number and
unit synthetic hydrograph method.
For any un-gauged site the data of upstream and downstream sites if available can be
utilized through interpolation / extrapolation with reference to the gauged site data.
The above analyses not only determine the probable maximum flood (PMF) these
are also utilized for assessing the design discharge capacity of the barrage and
preparation of a gauge discharge relationship i.e. rating curve that may be used in
barrage design.
c) Sediment Data
It is necessary to know the sediment discharge (size and charge) of the river at various
points in time of the year to determine the requirement of sediment exclusion from the
canal withdrawal and ejection from the canal, and also to select the pond levels, both
seasonal and annual.
d) Surface and subsurface 0characteristics
These include:
i. Foundation capacity and geological characteristics of the alluvium at the
barrage location, which include Atterberg Limits and Shear / Plasticity of the
soil.
ii. If piers or abutments are to be designed with reinforced concrete pile
foundation, the bearing capacity of the piles should be determined by driving
test piles prior to finalizing the design of the pile system.
iii. In sandy strata, standard dynamic and static penetration tests should be done
below the position of each structure e.g. abutments, piers, divide walls, centre
of each bay etc. for estimating the bearing pressures, likely settlement and
necessity of settlement joints, etc and for boulder strata, plate bearing tests
should be done.
iv. Normally the both upstream and downstream flow of the barrage, are designed
as gravity floors to counteract uplift pressure. Wherever the main floor of the
structure is to be designed as an RC raft supported on an elastic medium, in-
situ tests to determine the modulus of sub-grade reaction at the proposed
foundation level should be conducted. If there is a wide variation in the
properties of the foundation material, the length of the structure should be split
up into suitable sections isolated from each other by means of double piers and
the modulus of sub-grade reaction must be determined at every section.
v. Soil samples should be collected at suitable depth intervals and their properties,
such as classification, unit weight, angle of internal friction, void ratio, specific
gravity, grain size distribution etc. should be determined by sieve analysis and
other laboratory tests.
vi. Wherever clayey strata is encountered, undisturbed samples of the clay layer
should be obtained, one from the proposed foundation level and another 5 ft
below the foundation level for each bay. These samples should be analyzed to
MANUAL OF IRRIGATION PRACTICE 5-107
BARRAGES
It has also to be noted that the course of the river has not changed for many years at
the prospective site of the structure. In the case of shifting river course, proper
measures are needed to contain the river in its present course.
5.6.4.3 River Slope
If some storage is envisaged on the upstream of the proposed barrage, the structure
should be located in a mild slope reach.
5.6.4.4 Conditions of the Banks
The river banks at the proposed location should preferably be firm or reasonably so to
avoid channel side protection works.
5.6.4.5 Confluence of Channels
The location should be reasonably downstream of the confluence of rivers / channels
to avoid hazardous channel interaction with in the guide bank zone.
5.6.4.6 Working head for the off-taking canals
The structure should be located to provide a reasonable working head across the
canal regulator because, higher the working head, higher the cost, however with lower
the working head the canal operation is sub optimal. A trade off scenario should
therefore to be adopted.
5.6.4.7 Alignment / Orientation
For the location and orientation of a barrage with respect to the river axis, the following
terms are used.
Khadir Axis - is a line passing centrally in the river course between the two high
banks for a length to which the back water effect is experienced.
Barrage length - is a line along the crest of the barrage.
River Axis - is a line parallel to the Khadir axis at the centre of the barrage
width between the abutments and perpendicular to the barrage
axis.
Barrage - is a line perpendicular to the barrage length at the middle of the
barrage length.
Special model studies in the Irrigation Research Institute indicated the Following
conclusions regarding the orientation and location of a Barrage may be drawn from
the special model studies conducted by the Irrigation Research Institute (IRI):
i. If the angle θ between barrage axis and river axis is large, invariably there is
concentration of flow on one side and island formation on the other within the
guide banks e.g. at Islam and Balloki. Maximum safe value of θ is 10°.
ii. If the river axis is to the right of the barrage axis, the concentration of flow is
generally on the left side with a tendency to form an island on the right and vice-
versa.
iii. When the barrage is located below the confluence of two rivers it should be
sufficiently below the confluence and due weight should be given as to which
of the two rivers is dominant.
MANUAL OF IRRIGATION PRACTICE 5-109
BARRAGES
iv. In case of only one river, the alignment of the weir for good approach conditions
should be such that the angle between headworks axis and river axis is
minimum.
v. Location of the barrage on one side of the “Khadir” enhances the tendency to
form a shoal along the guide bank on that side. Greater asymmetry increases
the tendency to form a shoal, and calls for expensive training works.
vi. The most suitable position of a barrage when constructed in the dry is just below
the outer side of a convex bend, upstream of which the river is straight for some
distance.
vii. An inappropriate site on the inside of a convex bend produces oblique
approach to the guide bank head forming an island along it within the guide
banks and considerably increases the sediment entry into the canal taking off
from that bank.
The above conclusion from model tests can be used as guiding principles for the
location of a barrage in an alluvial river. Model experiments are always necessary for
any new location.
Estimation of Design Flood
The design flood for any given return period is usually estimated by the following
frequency distributions.
Pearson and Log Pearson Type III distributions
Gumbel’s Extreme value distributions
Normal and Log normal distributions
Log Pearson Type III distribution has been adopted by United States Federal Agencies
whereas Gumbel distribution has generally been found to be suitable for most of the
streams in Pakistan.
Climate change effects
At present no definite models are available for estimation of climate change effects but
an addition of 10% to the 100 years frequency discharge is normally made, or a 200
year flood discharge is adopted whichever is higher.
Design Criteria
Before starting design computations suitable design criteria and methodology are
decided and shared with all concerned, parties/stake holders
5.6.7.1 Width of barrage
Following three considerations govern the width of a barrage, Design flood, Lacey
design width and the looseness factor. It is generally that by limiting the waterway, the
shoal formation on the upstream side can be eliminated. However, it increases the
intensity of discharge and consequently the section of the structure becomes heavier
with excessive gate heights and the cost increases, though the length of the structure
is reduced. A large variation in the seasonal discharges makes such determination
very difficult.
The design flood has been discussed in an earlier paragraph; the other two conditions
are discussed in the following paragraphs.
MANUAL OF IRRIGATION PRACTICE 5-110
BARRAGES
higher up the river than would otherwise be the case. As a result of this
progressive rise of bed levels, there is a tendency for the river to regain its
original slope.
v. A stage will come when upstream pond absorbs no further silt burden. Owing
to the off-taking canals drawing comparatively silt-free water, the excess of silt
passes downstream of the weir while the amount of water passing over the weir
is less than the normal due to canal withdrawals. The river below the weir will
thus, have to carry an excessive silt charge with a lower water discharge. This
results in progressive silting up on the downstream, an increase in tortuosity
and, therefore, a recovery of bed levels downstream.
The changes in the river regime discussed above are important for the design of the
weirs as explained below: -
In the first few years following construction of a barrage, the retrogression of bed levels
downstream is rapid and progressive. Generally it ranges between 4 and 7 feet. This
lowering of the bed levels in the early stages if improperly incorporated in design may
result in a failure like that of the Islam weir in 1929. The retrogression may undermine
the stability of a structure by an increase in the exit gradient beyond the safe limits. It
increases the destructive action of the hydraulic jump as with the increased fall and
decreased depth" of downstream water due to lowering of the water levels at that
location and, the jump will tend to travel down to the cement concrete blocks and loose
stone protection area.
As a result of the retrogression in levels, while the low water levels have dropped from
4 to 7 feet, the maximum flood levels have not dropped by more than 1 to 1.5 ft. The
initial magnitude of retrogression depends on the crest levels, discharge, sediment
load and extent of pond area.
5.7.3.3 Restoration of original slope upstream of the weir
With time, the river upstream regains its original slope which implies that the effect of
afflux due to the construction of the weir is not confined in magnitude and length to the
usually accepted distance as determined by the back-water curve. It travels further up
and is felt in the full, all that distance.
5.7.3.4 Recovery of downstream bed levels
Process of recovery of the downstream bed levels after the initial retrogression, is slow
but steady. It may take about 20 years but the bed levels in some cases may rise
higher than those existing before construction of the weir.
5.7.3.5 Provision in Design of Barrages
Provision for the mitigation of a retrogression of 3 to 4 ft is generally included in the
barrage design.
5.7.3.6 Effects of Retrogression
As the barrage is designed for the worst conditions, the extent of retrogression
experienced by the structure is a critical feature.
Lowering of tail-water levels below the designed minimum levels causes reduction in
the tail water depths. This naturally results in depths less than the conjugate depths
required for the formation of good hydraulic-jump at the proper place and level for
MANUAL OF IRRIGATION PRACTICE 5-113
BARRAGES
effective energy dissipation. The difference in actual and designed levels results in the
formation of an unstable jump, much below the required safe levels with a secondary
jump at the end of the impervious floor or on the block apron. This causes significant
amount of scour and negative pressures in the block area and loose stone apron and
consequently resulting in lifting and washing away of the stone and settlement of PCC
blocks. Several barrages have experienced such conditions.
5.7.3.7 Conclusion
A reasonable amount (say 3 to 4ft) of retrogression of downstream water levels is
incorporated in the design of any new barrage.
Accretion of Levels
Accretion of levels, in-fact creates effects that are contrary to retrogression. In this
phenomenon, sedimentation takes place on the downstream bed causing general
aggradation.
Interestingly, both the phenomena result in reduced discharge capacity of the barrage.
While retrogression limits the capacity due to unstable / washed out hydraulic jump,
the accretion raises the downstream water levels, renders the barrage non modular
with reduction in the coefficient of discharge and consequently the discharge capacity
reduces.
Both the phenomena are vexing maladies.
MANUAL OF IRRIGATION PRACTICE 5-114
BARRAGES
also be called as the limiting condition of flow surface curve wherein it tends to become
perpendicular to the stream bed.
It can also be defined as the phenomenon in which a jet of water moving with
supercritical velocity is converted into a body of water flowing at subcritical velocity,
with almost abrupt change in velocity and depth accompanied by loss (dissipation) of
energy of flow.
𝟐
The fundamental = n is 𝑫𝟐𝟐 − 𝑫𝟐𝟏 = 𝒈 𝒒 (𝑽𝟏 − 𝑽𝟐 ) ............... 5-76
where
q = discharge intensity / ft width
g = gravity constant (Acceleration due to gravity)
D1V1 + D2V2 are defined in the above Figs. 5-34 (a+b)
Theoretically the phenomenon takes place instantaneously. In practice surging and
turmoil, accompanied by aeration, occur below the hydraulic jump for a Considerable
distance and it is this single factor which causes difficulties in practice and damage to
works.
In theory the supercritical jet moves freely and un-obstructed until it reaches the point
at which the hydraulic jump occurs. In practice, the jump wave invariably falls forward
and covers the jet with a film of water of varying thickness which alters the
characteristics of the jumps itself. However, theoretical allowance can be made for
such film or load of water, on a static basis. In practice, the “load” of water is in constant
super-turbulent motion. This condition is called as a “loaded trough state”. The
theoretical phenomenon with no load is referred to as “Empty trough slate” and is
easier to analyze.
One of the characteristics of the jump with loaded through, is that there are limits of
discharge and drop below which the hydraulic jump does not form at all. If the hydraulic
jump does not form, the surplus energy can only be destroyed in friction in the Channel
and when this occurs in an earthen channel, violent erosion and scour takes place.
5.8.2.1 Empty Trough Analysis
To understand the problem of the hydraulic jump, it should be noted that the loss in
energy is due to a change in momentum which is due to a difference in pressures. For
many years, it was a compulsion to work out each problem on these lines. CBI
Publication # 4 also presents diagrams, loosely termed “Pressure plus Momentum”
diagrams, for the quick graphical solution of hydraulic jump problems, on these lines.
MANUAL OF IRRIGATION PRACTICE 5-116
BARRAGES
Depth “D” in
feet
This relationship defines the depths (and, therefore, velocities) above and below a
hydraulic jump in terms of q, the discharge per foot width of the channel.
These equations have been the subject of close study by many investigators. They
have been reduced to dimension less equations and plotted for rapid solution of
hydraulic jump problems.
The quantity most usually defined in practice is the “drop” or head loss i.e. the
difference in level between the total energy lines above and below the hydraulic jump,
i.e. HL. On this basis the most useful form of curves for graphical solutions, is due to
Blench. He depicts “q” on abscissae q Ef2 ordinates or in the curves for HL. AMR
Montague also produced such curves, refer Fig. 5-35.
MANUAL OF IRRIGATION PRACTICE 5-118
BARRAGES
𝟏 𝟏
𝒒𝟐
𝑯𝑳 = 𝑫𝑳 + 𝑫𝟏 − 𝑫𝟐 + 𝟐
(𝑫𝟏 − 𝑫𝟐 ) 𝟐
............... 5-82
𝒈
𝟐𝒒𝟐
𝑫𝟏 𝑫𝟐 (𝑫𝟐 − 𝑫𝟏 ) = = 𝟑𝑫𝟑𝒄 ............... 5-83
𝒈
where DL is the depth of the water blanket/load at the point where the hydraulic jump
forms.
It is to be noted that “for every value of HL there is a limiting value of q beyond which
a standing wave will not form”. This limitation is particularly important at low drop.
The second point for observation is that, for equal values of HL and q, the value of Ef2,
required is invariably large for a “loaded” trough.
For falls and barrages, the hydraulic jump is the most efficient phenomenon or tool for
energy dissipation on the glacis preceding the stilling basin.
Hydraulic jump superimposes a specific set of conditions. For instance, during the
maximum flood when the total head over the weir is no more than 3 feet. The uplift
pressures at any point of the weir due to sub-surface flow cannot exceed 3 feet. But
the hydraulic jump have troughs of 9.4’ and 11.2’ which represent the unbalanced
heads or uplift pressures at these troughs. The floor thickness will have to be designed
to withstand these pressures of 9.4 to 11.2 ft. Again, the hydraulic jump is not
stationary. It moves downstream with the retrogression of levels and reduction of
discharge per foot run. The depths of trough in all cases are about 10 ft. so that in the
region of the hydraulic jump the floor will have to be designed to withstand these uplifts,
with due allowance for spread.
Thus, the final thickness of the section at each point will have to be designed for uplift
due to sub-surface flow or the hydraulic jump, whichever is higher. The thickness of
the sloping floor could be very small if only the seepage flow were considered. But due
to the standing wave it has to be at least as large as, that of the horizontal floor.
Next consider the case of, the hydraulic jump forming on the permeable apron. The
unbalanced head in this case may be about 6 feet. This head will suck out sand from
beneath the loose stone and, to a smaller extent, from below the filter bed and will
soon lead to undermining of the floor with consequent risk to the structure. It has been
stated above that the position of the hydraulic jump forming on a smooth horizontal
floor is unstable. It can form on the pacca horizontal floor or can travel down to the
pervious floor downstream with its attendant dangers mentioned above. For a
structure to be safe, the hydraulic jump should, therefore, be confined to the sloping
glacis and not permitted to form on the horizontal lower down than the toe of the glacis.
MANUAL OF IRRIGATION PRACTICE 5-120
BARRAGES
Due to this downward force the thickness of the floor at the toe and some distance
above and below can be correspondingly reduced.
5.8.2.3 Efficiency of Hydraulic Jump
The ratio of the energy head after the jump (E2) to the energy head before the jump
(E1) is defined as the “efficiency of the jump”, and may be computed by using the
following equation:
E2
3
8F12 1 2 4 F12 1
E1
8F12 2 F12 ............... 5-84
Where:
F1= Froude number of flow before the jump
E1
Energy dissipation (%) = 1 .100 ............... 5-85
E2
Height of jump (hj) is given by the equation:
1
hj (1 8F12 ) 2 3
............... 5-86
E1 F12 2
For more details, consult relevant reference books like “Open channel hydraulic” by
Ven Je chow, “Open channel flow” by Hanif Chaudhary, “Hydraulics of open channels”
by Boris. A. Bakhmeteff, and research works of Sir CC Inglis et el.
5.8.2.4 Types of hydraulic jump
On the basis of physical model studies, the USBR has categorized the hydraulic jump
types as narrated in the following:
“Where the energy of flow in a spillway must be dissipated before the flow is
discharged into the downstream river channel, a hydraulic jump stilling basin is an
effective device for reducing the exit velocity to a tranquil state. The jump that occurs
in such a stilling basin has distinctive characteristics and assumes a definite form,
depending on the relation between the energy of flow that must be dissipated and the
depth of the flow.”
A comprehensive series of tests have been performed by the Bureau of Reclamation
to determine the properties of the hydraulic jump. The jump type and the flow
characteristics can be related to the kinetic flow factor, 𝜐 2 /𝑔𝑑, of the discharge
entering the basin; to the critical depth of flow, dc; or to the upstream Froude number,
υ/(𝑔𝑑)½ .
Characteristics forms of hydraulic jump with reference to various ranges of Froude
numbers are exhibited in the following Fig. 5-37 taken from “Engineering monograph
# 25-USBR). (May 1984)
When the Froude number of flow is 1.0, the flow is at critical depth and jump cannot
form
When the Froude number rises close to 1.7 surface rollers generate mild turbulence.
These rollers intensify and at a Froude number of 2.5, a very weak jump forms.
Between Froude number values of 2.5 to 4.5 an oscillating jump forms with damaging
surface waves carried far downstream of the structure.
MANUAL OF IRRIGATION PRACTICE 5-122
BARRAGES
For Froude numbers of 4.5 to 9.0 a stable and well balanced jump is formed.
For Froude numbers more than 9.0 rough and strong surface waves are formed and
carried beyond the jump.
MANUAL OF IRRIGATION PRACTICE 5-123
BARRAGES
Fane’s curve which is applicable to weirs having an upstream ramp and sloping
downstream glacis with 2H:1V or flatter: slope:
Table 5-26: Reduction in discharge coefficient due to submergence
“E2/E1 “ Value of “ Cr ”
0.80 0.99
0.85 0.99
0.90 0.98
092 0.96
0.94 0.90
0.95 0.84
0.96 0.77
0.97 0.71
0.98 0.61
Source: Fane and Sharma (1939)
The submerged discharge is given by the equation:
Q = 3.09. Cr .b .E11.5 ............... 5-96
where b = width of the weir (waterway)
5.9.1.3 Gibson’s Curve
Q C'.b.E1.5 ............... 5-97
where:
Q = submerged discharge over crest (cusecs)
C' = submerged discharge coefficient
b = width of weir (ft)
h1 = upstream depth of flow above crest (ft)
h2 = downstream depth of flow above crest (ft)
For submerged Condition the free flow discharge coefficient ( C 3.80 ) is multiplied
by a reduction factor ( C' C ). The reduction factor depends on the drowning ratio
(h2/h1). The values of reduction factor “ C' C ” given in the table below are from
Gibson’s curve.
Table 5-27: Reduction factor for ‘c’ per Gibson’s curve
h2/h1 C' C C'
0.70 0.86 3.27
0.80 0.78 2.96
0.90 0.62 2.36
0.95 0.44 1.67
Source: USBR and Cood & Partners (1963)
5.9.1.4 Regulated Discharge
The gates installed at regulating structures create an orifice flow condition when the
bottom of the gate is touching the water surface or dips in to water.
MANUAL OF IRRIGATION PRACTICE 5-129
BARRAGES
The limiting value of Cc as b/h approaches zero is 0.611 and it does not vary by more
than a few percent from this value over the entire practical range of b/h so long as the
jet is not affected by downstream effects. Thus the equation of Cd for free flow from a
sluice gate can be written as under:
0.611
Cd = ............... 5-101
1 0.611 b
h
The equation for Cd for a Tainter gate which is a function of Cc, b/h and lip angle β is:
𝑪
𝑪𝓛 = 𝟏+𝑪 𝒄𝒃/𝒉 ............... 5-102
𝒄
The coefficient of contraction Cc for Tainter gate is adopted from the following Table
for a given value of b/h and angle β.
Cc
Cd ............... 5-104
1 Cc b / h
Q = Submerged flow discharge over crest (cusecs)
b = Gate opening (ft)
L = Length of gate (ft)
MANUAL OF IRRIGATION PRACTICE 5-131
BARRAGES
gx2
Y x tan ............... 5-105
2(1.25V ) 2 Cos2
where:
x and y = horizontal and vertical coordinates measured from the beginning of the curve
(ft)
= angle between the horizontal and the floor at the beginning of the trajectory
(degree)
V = velocity at vena contracta (ft/s)
g = acceleration of gravity (ft/s2)
The value of “ ” is zero and equation 9.9 becomes:
gx 2
Y ............... 5-106
2(1.25V ) 2
The glacis profile given by the above equation (9.10) may also be compared with the
following equation established by Montague a well-known Chief Engineer of Punjab
Irrigation Department.
x = v (4y/g)1/2 + y ............... 5-107
where:
x = horizontal distance along the ordinate (ft)
y = vertical distance below the horizontal (ft)
v = initial velocity of water leaving the crest (ft/sec)
g = acceleration of gravity (ft/s2)
Both the above equations (9.10) and (9.11) produce parabolic profiles which
correspond to the falling jet trajectory. Due to construction difficulties the designers did
not like this type, and it was used only at Taunsa Barrage.
The 3rd type i.e. sloping profile has stood the test and is now in general use, but slopes
steeper than 3:1 are not used, because of flow problems.
Now, profiles of 1 in 3 to 1 in 5 slopes are normally used as this range is considered
to be work suitable both for the maximum energy dissipation and economy
Design of undersluices pockets
As already defined, “The undersluice pockets” in a barrage consist of depressed bays
near the head regulators of the off-taking canal/canals, separated from the main weir
by divide walls.
The undersluices / pockets bays may be provided on either or both flanks of the river
depending on the off-taking canals from both the flanks.
5.9.2.1 Functions
Some of the important functions of the pockets are:
i. To provide a quiet (almost still) pocket of water to enable reduction in sediment
entry into the canal.
ii. To sluice away the coarse sediments with suitable devices such as silt
excluders etc or through partial sluicing.
iii. To help development of a regular channel in front of the canal head regulators
and approach front.
MANUAL OF IRRIGATION PRACTICE 5-133
BARRAGES
iv. Facilitate the flushing of the silt deposited in the pocket if still pond system is in
use.
5.9.2.2 Layout of the undersluice pocket
The following guidelines help in determining the optimal layout:
i. The dimensions and bed levels of the pocket should be effective for reducing
silt entry into the off-taking canals.
ii. The diversions are conducive to maintaining a clear and defined channel
towards the canal head.
iii. The capacity is also influenced by the diversion requirements.
5.9.2.3 Size of the undersluice pocket
The size and layout of the undersluice pocket are finally determined through model
study. However a few general guide lines are:
1. To ensure a proper scouring capacity, the discharge capacity of the
undersluices at the selected pond level should not be less than twice the canal
capacity.
2. While there is no hard and fast rule for percentage of the barrage discharge to
be passed through the undersluices, usually the undersluices are designed to
pass 10% to 20% of the designed discharge of the barrage by each of the
undersluices.
3. The width of undersluices should be not less than 1.5 times the width of the
canal head regulators.
These are only guidelines for preliminary design; the final setup and design should be
confirmed through model studies because these are affected by configuration and flow
patterns of the river.
Stilling Basins
The stilling basin essentially comprises a horizontal depressed floor located in
continuation of downstream toe of glacis which connects to the crest of the structure
and is thus the end part of the impervious structure.
Functionally, the stilling basins can be classified as:
i) Impact type basins;
j) Jump type basins;
k) Combination of the above two types.
Till recently the stilling basins have been designed as impact type and provided with
appurtenances, such as, impact blocks and friction blocks etc. These basins mainly
depend on appurtenances for dissipation of energy which create intense turbulence,
rollers and jetting and thus sustain varying level of damages at high discharges.
In late 1970’s United States Bureau of Reclamation (USBR) conducted detailed
analytical and experimental studies and developed several types of jump basins as
discussed in later paragraphs. Based on prototype performance, the hydraulic jump
type basins have become popular and are freely used on large structures like
barrages.
MANUAL OF IRRIGATION PRACTICE 5-134
BARRAGES
e) The upstream (pre-jump) Froude number F1, it may be calculated from the
following relationship.
𝒒𝟑
𝑭𝟏 + 𝒈𝑫𝟑 ............... 5-109
𝟏
f) From the calculated values of d1 and F1 d2 can be calculated from the following
relationship.
𝒅𝟏
𝒅𝟐 = 𝟐
(−𝟏 + √𝟖𝑭𝟏 𝟐 + 𝟏) ............... 5-110
g) The required stilling basin level would be equal to the retrogressed water level
for that discharge minus d2.
h) Most likely the initially assumed stilling basin level (step b) and the calculated
stilling basin level (step g) may not be the same which indicates that the stilling
basin level assumed initially was incorrect and needs to be raised or lowered.
After assuming a modified stilling basin level, the various steps should be
repeated again till the assumed and calculated stilling basin levels match with
each other. The exact values of d1 and d2 will thus be known. This method is
also called as the “iterative” or a “trial and error method”.
Hence generally the trial and error method is preferred as it gives more accurate
results.
The stilling basin level can also be determined from direct calculations based on the
analytical method introduced in the publication titled “Open channel flow” by M. Hanif
Chaudhry (second addition) as the analytical method for direct calculation of stilling
basin floor level. An example appearing in the above reference is reproduced below:
Example
The reservoir level upstream of a 30-m wide spillway for a flow of 800 m3 /s is at EL
200m. The downstream river level for this flow is at El 100m. Determine the invert level
of a stilling basin having the same width as the spillway so that a hydraulic jump is
formed in the basin. Assume the losses in the spillway are negligible.
Given:
Q= 800 m3 /s
B= 30m
Upstream water level = El 200m
Downstream water level = El 100m
Determine:
Stilling basin invert elevation to form the jump?
Solution:
Let z be the invert elevation of the stilling basin. Then referring to below figure 5.41.
y2 = 100-z. Since the losses on the spillway face are negligible and assuming
y1 to be small,
𝐕𝟏 = √𝟐𝐠(𝟐𝟎𝟎 − 𝐳)
Now, Q = BV1y1 Hence
𝟖𝟎𝟎
𝐲𝟏=
𝟑𝟎 ×√𝟏𝟗.𝟔𝟐(𝟐𝟎𝟎−𝐳)
MANUAL OF IRRIGATION PRACTICE 5-138
BARRAGES
𝟔.𝟎𝟐
=
√𝟐𝟎𝟎−𝐳
𝟏𝟎𝟎−𝐳 𝟏
= 𝟐 (−𝟏 + √𝟏 + 𝟖 × 𝟎. 𝟑𝟑𝟐(𝟐𝟎𝟎 − 𝐳)𝟏.𝟓 )
𝟔.𝟎𝟐√𝟐𝟎𝟎−𝐳
2gz Ha d1 2
1
V1 q ............... 5-111
d1
where:
V1 = velocity of flow at the toe of glacis (ft/s)/jump formation location
q = discharge intensity (cusecs/ft)
d1= flow depth at the toe of glacis (ft)
Z = fall between upstream - level and stilling basin top level (ft)
Ha = approach velocity head
= V2/2g(ft)
V = approach velocity (ft/s)
g = acceleration of gravity (ft/s2)
For design calculations discharge intensity (q) is increased by twenty (20) percent for
possible flow concentration.
Also
d2 1
d1
1 8F12
2
1
2
1
............... 5-112
where:
d1 = flow depth at the toe of glacis (ft)
d2 = tail water depth above stilling basin (ft)
F1 =Froude number
1
= V1 /(gd1 ) 2
V1 = flow velocity at the toe of glacis (ft/s)
g = acceleration due to gravity (ft/s2)
For margin of safety the theoretical depth “d2” is multiplied by a factor 1.05.
Length of stilling basin without appurtenances = 1.05 x 5 (d2 – d1)
Length of stilling basin with appurtenances may then be determined using the
equation:
Figure 5-47: Proportion for Froude number 2.5 to 4.5 – (Basin IV)
The blocks may appear to be rather high and, in some cases, extremely long, but this
is essential as the jet leaving the top of the blocks must play at the base of the roller
to be effective. To accommodate the various slopes of chutes and ogee shapes
encountered, the horizontal top length of the blocks should be at least 2D. The upper
surface of each block is sloped at 5ᴼ in a downstream direction as it was found that
this feature resulted in better operation, especially for discharges lower than the design
flow.
5.9.3.6.3 Tail water depth
A tail water depth 5 to 10 percent greater than the conjugate depth is strongly
recommended for Basin IV. Since the jump is very sensitive to tail water depth at these
low values of the Froude number, a slight deficiency in tail water depth may allow the
jump to sweep completely out of the basin. The jump performs much better and wave
action is diminished if the tail water depth is increased to approximately 1.1 D 2.
5.9.3.6.4 Basin length and end sill
The length of Basin IV, which is relatively short, can be obtained from the upper curve
in Figs. 5-48 and 5-49 (2 sheets). No baffle piers are needed in the basin, as these
will prove a greater detriment than aid. The addition of a small triangular sill placed at
the end of the apron for scour control is desirable. An end sill of the type used on Basin
III is satisfactory.
5.9.3.6.5 Performance
If designed for the maximum discharge, Basin IV will perform satisfactorily for lesser
flows. Waves downstream from the stilling basin will still be in evidence but is of the
ordinary variety usually encountered with jumps of a higher Froude number. Basin IV
is applicable to rectangular cross sections only.
MANUAL OF IRRIGATION PRACTICE 5-148
BARRAGES
Sample calculations for atypical weir design for surface flow appear as Annexure D.
The second condition is that the weight of the structure at all points should be more
than the uplift pressure. Bligh also believed that the effect of creep length is the same,
be it horizontal or vertical, and that the pressure drop is proportional to distance of the
point under consideration when compared with the total creep length as the seeping
water loses the head along the creep length (seepage contact line with bottom surface
of the structure).
Due to its simplicity, Bligh’s theory received general acceptance, while some works
designed on the basis of Bligh’s theory failed and others survived.
The general criticism of Bligh’s method was:
1. The slope (hydraulic gradient) is considered to remain constant over the entire
creep length. Actually as the late developments in seepage theory shows, that
this gradient varies substantially at different points of the seepage path;
2. The creep length is the total path travelled by the seepage along the structure
contact line, be it horizontal or vertical i.e. there is no special effect of vertical
obstructions; and
3. It assumes the flow to occur along the line of contact of flow with the bottom
surface of the structure i.e. the total creep length = horizontal length + vertical
faces of the obstructions, i.e. cut-offs or sheet piles.
Lane’s Theory
During the next 30 years, it was gradually recognized that vertical sections of the line
of creep contribute more towards reducing the danger of piping than that of horizontal
sections of equal length.
To take into account the greater efficiency of vertical sections of the line of creep. Lane
modified the original Bligh’s procedure assuming that every horizontal section of the
line of creep was only one third as effective as a vertical section of the same length.
The calculation of weighted creep distance or percolation path is explained in the
following:
For flow passing under the structure:
h
Lu Vv ............... 5-115
3
For flow passing along the side of structure:
Ls 0.75Vq hh ............... 5-116
where:
Lu = weighted creep distance under the structure (ft)
L s = weighted creep distance along the side of the structure (ft)
V v = vertical path along vertical surface (ft)
q= horizontal path along horizontal surface (ft)
V h = horizontal path along vertical surface (ft)
h h = horizontal path along vertical surface normal to axis of structure (ft)
MANUAL OF IRRIGATION PRACTICE 5-152
BARRAGES
Surfaces inclined by forty five (45) degrees or more to the horizontal are considered
as vertical surface and surfaces at less than forty five (45) degrees are considered to
be horizontal for computing the creep length.
The weighted creep ratio is given by:
∑𝑯
+∑ 𝑽
𝑪𝝎 = 𝟑
............... 5-117
𝒉𝝎
where:
𝒉𝝎 is the maximum differential head
H is horizontal length of the structure and
V is the depth of vertical cut-off
In which 𝐶𝜔 is the Lane’s weighted creep ratio. Lane’s theory is based on his review
of the various works which stood the test of time and also those that had failed. Based
on an analysis of about 280 dam foundations of which 24 had failed, the values of
weighted creep ratio 𝐶𝜔 were suggested, which are listed in Table 5-30.
Table 5-30: Weighted creep ratio
Nature of Foundation material 𝐶𝜔
Very fine sand 8.5
Fine sand 7.0
Medium Sand 6.0
Coarse Sand 5.0
Fine gravel 4.0
Medium gravel 3.5
Coarse gravel 3.0
Boulders and gravel 2.5
Lane’s weighted creep approach is an improvement on Bligh, but still it is purely
empirical and leads to a design with an unknown factor of safety. According to Lane,
if there is lack of or poor contact, then water percolating along the line of creep meets
with less resistance than that which travels through undisturbed soil.
Lane’s theory is still popular in the USA and less- important dams are designed on its
basis. For important cases, result obtained by mathematical approach of subsoil flows
are accepted universally.
5.10.2.1 Appraisal of Lane’s theory
Lane’s theory an empirical approach based on long experience and a safe design is
possible by using thus theory but taking into consideration limitations. The factor of
safety of works designed on the basis of this theory would be is uncertain and the
design in some cases may be quite wasteful.
Modern approach to design of weir and barrages
The modern approach to the weir design is that:
a) seepage takes place according to the theory of seepage flow throughout the
underling strata; and
b) that the stability of granular particles depends on the limiting value of hydraulic
gradient at the upper surface of the granular material , and this gradient to
MANUAL OF IRRIGATION PRACTICE 5-153
BARRAGES
Khosla’s Theory
The distribution of uplift pressure is not linear. This, of course, follows from the fact
that seepage is governed by the Laplace equations and appropriate boundary
conditions. If the Laplace equations could be integrated for the given set of boundary
conditions, mathematical solution of the flow net is obtained for those conditions. This
equation however is subject to complex boundary conditions, particularly the shape of
the base of the foundation or an actual work.
The principle of the method of independent variables presented by Dr. A.N. Khosla
consists of breaking up a complex profile into a number of simple profiles, each of
which is independently amenable to mathematical treatment. Mathematical solutions
of flow are available for a number of such simple standard forms, the most useful of
which are:
a) A straight horizontal floor of negligible thickness with a sheet pile line at either
end;
MANUAL OF IRRIGATION PRACTICE 5-155
BARRAGES
b) A straight horizontal floor, depressed below the bed but with no vertical cut off;
and
c) A straight horizontal floor of negligible thickness with a sheet pile line at some
intermediate position.
The results of the mathematical solutions of these forms have been discussed in
publication No 12 of the Central Board of Irrigation and Power Index titled “Design of
weir on permeable Foundation” by Khosla, Bose, and Taylor (1936). The solutions are
given in the forms of curves from which the percentage residual head to the total
seepage head can be determined at Key points Fig. 5-50. The pressures at
intermediate points are assumed to vary linearly, which does not introduce any
appreciable error.
Khosla has shown that the percentage pressures observed from the curves for the
simple forms into which the profile is broken up is valid for the assembled profile as a
whole, subject to certain corrections as given below:
a) Correction for Floor Thickness: In the standard forms with vertical cut-off the
thickness of the floor is assumed to be negligible and hence the values
observed from the curves refer to the top level of the floor. However, due to the
thickness of the floor, corrections are to be applied for the points at the bottom
of the floor and these are interpolated by assuming a straight line variation. The
correction may be positive or negative according to the points under
consideration. In Fig. 5-51. The correction at point E1is negative and C1
positive.
b) Correction for Mutual Interference of Sheet Piles: The correction for the mutual
interference of sheet piles is given by the formula.
𝑫 𝒅+𝑫
𝑪 = 𝟏𝟗√ 𝒇 × ............... 5-118
𝒃𝑺 𝒃
where:
C is the correction as percentage of head.
bfS is the distance between the two pile lines (see Fig. 5-52)
D is the depth of the pile line, the influence of which has to be determined on
the neighboring pile of depth d, D is to be measured below the level at which
interference is desired.
MANUAL OF IRRIGATION PRACTICE 5-156
BARRAGES
1
Source: Central Board of Irrigation, India paper # 12 in 1936 “Design of Weirs on Permeable
Foundations”
MANUAL OF IRRIGATION PRACTICE 5-157
BARRAGES
b
E2 C2
E2 C2
bfs
D2
1:1 11.2
1:2 6.5
1:3 4.5
1:4 3.3
1:5 2.8
1:6 2.5
1:7 2.3
1:8 2.0
The correction is applicable to the point fixed at the beginning or at the end of the
slope. The percentage correction given in table 5-32 is to be multiplied further by the
ratio of the horizontal length of slope to the distance between the two pile lines in
between which the sloping floor is located.
Floor thickness
Having determined the percentage residual head at various desired points of the
structures, the residual head percentage is converted into the actual head at the
particular point by the following.
𝑹𝑯
𝑹𝒆𝒔𝒊𝒅𝒖𝒂𝒍 𝒉𝒆𝒂𝒅 𝒂𝒕 𝒕𝒉𝒆 𝒑𝒐𝒊𝒏𝒕 𝑯𝒑 𝟏𝟎𝟎 × 𝑯............... 5-119
Floor thickness at this point required to counteract the uplift pressure (Hp) is:
𝐻𝑝
For the point in dry condition: 𝑇 = 𝜌
𝐻𝑝
And for the point just submerged = 𝑇𝑑𝑟𝑦 = – (this value is mostly adopted)
𝜌−1
Where
H = Total operative head across
T = Floor thickness in feet
Hp = Pressure head in feet
𝜌 = Specific gravity of the construction material for concrete (plain) = 2.3 and for
reinforced concrete f = 2.4.
Typical / sample calculations for floor thickness appear as Annexure E.
2 Source: Central Board of Irrigation, India paper # 12 in 1936 “Design of Weirs on Permeable
Foundations”
MANUAL OF IRRIGATION PRACTICE 5-159
BARRAGES
5.10.6.2 Sedimentation
a) Sediment deposit upstream of the upstream sheet pile reduces the uplift
pressures under the upstream floor, but has little affect downstream of the crest
block.
b) Sediment deposit downstream of downstream sheet pile wall reduces the exit
gradient but increases the residual uplift pressures underneath the downstream
floor.
Sheet piles / sheet pile lines / sheet pile walls
Sheet piles are basically steel sheets, hot rolled or cold formed into various shapes
such as U,Z, AZ and straight with interlocks at both ends. When driven or installed
with interlocks sealed with an approved sealant, they from an impervious wall cutting
off all seepage. The main functions of the sheet pile walls are:
i. Lengthening the path of seepage and creep in the soil beneath the impervious
structure reducing the strength of piping action.
ii. As a sequel to the above reducing the exit gradients.
iii. They also affect the residual pressures under the structure in different ways.
iv. Mitigating the scour at the two ends of the impervious section of the structure.
The number of pile walls to be provided under a structure has been under discussion
over a substantial period. The necessity of two end piles was acknowledged from the
beginning of the pile wall concept but the necessity of intermediate piles was realized
much later for additional safety in case the end pile walls develop infirmities and
leakage, causing unfavorable variation in exit gradient and uplift pressures.
5.10.7.1 Upstream sheet pile wall
The upstream sheet pile wall is a protective structure mainly against scour and thus
its depth is designed to cover the anticipated scour. It has no ultimate effect on residual
uplift pressures under the downstream floor (stilling basin) although it does reduce the
uplift pressures under the upstream floor.
5.10.7.2 Intermediate Pile Walls
The intermediate pile walls are carried to the same depths as the upstream and
downstream end pile walls. Bottom level of downstream pile walls usually by the
amount of afflux provided with the structure, but this is not a firm rule and required
flexibility can be provided by the downstream pile wall.
The downstream pile wall provides a protection against scour and exit gradient at the
downstream end of the structure. The depth has to be an optimal trader off between
the two attributes because the deeper the downstream pile the lower the exit gradient
but higher the residual uplift pressures and vice versa.
Opinions differ as to the number of intermediate pile walls. However overtime,
provision of four pile walls, one at the upstream end, 2nd at the joint of upstream floor
and upstream glacis, the 3rd one at the joint of downstream glacis and the downstream
floor (stilling basin) and the fourth and the last one at the downstream end of the
impervious structures, has been / adopted by most designers.
In case four pile walls are provided, the depth of the two piles walls upstream of the
crest is governed by the scour depth on the Upstream of the structures. The depth of
MANUAL OF IRRIGATION PRACTICE 5-162
BARRAGES
the sheet pile walls on the downstream of the crest, normally have the bottom tip lower
than the tip of upstream pile walls by about the quantum of “Afflux” used for design,
but this is not a firm rule and required flexibility can be achieved by adjusting the depth
of all pile walls except the last pile wall on the downstream of the structure which
controls the exit gradient also.
Exit Gradient
5.10.8.1 Introduction
A weir is subjected to a static head equal to the difference of water levels on the
upstream and downstream sides, which causes seepage flow through sub-soil under
the foundation. Weir failure from seepage can occur by:
i. Undermining of the sub-soil.
ii. Uplift due to pressure under the floor being in excess of the weight or resisting
force on the floor.
Failure by undermining is most common. Therefore a knowledge of its causes and of
the measures to prevent it is of utmost importance both for design of new works and
for ensuring the safety of existing ones.
The undermining of the sub-soil starts from the tail end of the work. It begins at the
surface due to the residual force of seepage water at this end being in excess of the
restraining forces of the sub-soil which tend to hold the latter in position. Once the
surface is disturbed, the dislocation of sub-soil particles works further up and being
progressive, leads to the formation of cavities below the floor into which the latter may
collapse. According to the commonly accepted ideas, this undermining is supposed to
result from what is known as “piping”, that is, the erosion of sub-soil by the high
velocities of flow of water through it, when such velocities exceed a certain limit.
Moreover, water has a certain residual force at each point along its flow through the
sub-soil which acts in the direction of flow and is proportional to the pressure gradient
at that point. At the tail end this force is obviously upwards and tends to lift up the soil
particles.
Thus the force acting on any particle in the sub-soil consists of:
𝑑ℎ
i. a force 𝐹 = acting in the direction of flow and
𝑑𝑙
ii. the submerged weight of soil W = Wg (1-E) (ρ-1)
where W = Weight of unit volume of water
ρ = specific gravity of sand particles
E = pore space in unit volume
If at the exit end, the force F equals or exceeds the submerged weight W g, the soil
particles start to be lifted up and ‘float’. The gradient of pressure at which this occurs
is called the critical or flotation gradient and is given by:
𝑮𝑬𝟏 = 𝑾 (𝟏 − 𝑬)(𝝆 − 𝟏) ............... 5-120
Taking W=1, 𝜌=2.65 and E=0.4, failure theoretically occurs when the exit gradient GE
is 1. The frictional resistance, of the adjacent soil may be considered in certain cases,
but once the surface particles are disturbed, the resistance against upward pressure
of water is further reduced, causing a progressive erosion of the sub-soil and the
dislocation of particles is accelerated. The structure is thus progressively undermined.
MANUAL OF IRRIGATION PRACTICE 5-163
BARRAGES
1 1 2
............... 5-122
2
=b/d, and
b = Total floor length
Exit gradient being a ratio is dimensionless.
On the basis of calculations, Khosla prepared a graphical solution which appears as
Figs. 5-54 and 5-55 (2 sheets).
5.10.9.2 Malhotra’s time saving approximation:
Since calculation for takes some time, Malhotra worked out the following simple and
almost exact (about ± 1%) relationship;
𝑯
𝑮𝑬 = 𝟓𝒅(𝒃+𝒅) ............... 5-123
where
H is the maximum operative head,
d = depth of downstream sheet pile
b = total length of concrete structure
This gives acceptable results for a quick analysis of existing structures if b>5d.
MANUAL OF IRRIGATION PRACTICE 5-164
BARRAGES
Forchheimer’s method
Forchheimer proposed a graphical method for drawing flow net by trial and error. If on
two stream lines AB and CD (see Fig. 5-58) equipressure lines, Ǿ1, Ǿ2 ………… are
drawn to form a curvilinear seuqre with ℓ1 = a1, having a drop of head h=(Ǿ1-Ǿ2), then
if other equipressure lines Ǿ3, Ǿ4 ……… Ǿ8 are drawn in such a manner that between
any two consecutive equipressure lines, the head loss is the same and is equal to h,
Forchheimer proved that for such a flow net, any other mesh, say between Ǿ6 and Ǿ7
must have 16 = a6. As already shown, the discharge ∆q between two adjacent
streamlines is constant and the velocity is inversely proportional to the tube width,
taking depth perpendicular to the plane of the paper as unity.
Figure 5-58: Flownet sketching by trial and error drawing equipressure lines
on two stream lines
Writing Darcy’s equation:
𝑯
𝑸 = 𝑲𝑨 𝑳 ............... 5-124
For elements between (Ǿ1 - Ǿ2) and (Ǿ6 - Ǿ7), the loss of head between (Ǿ1, Ǿ2) =
…………(Ǿ6 and Ǿ7) = ………= h and discharge ∆q between the stream lines being
constant
𝒉 𝒉
∆𝒒 = 𝒌𝓛𝟏 𝓵 = 𝒌𝓛𝟔 𝓵 ............... 5-125
𝟏 𝟔
𝒂𝟏 𝒂𝟔
or = ............... 5-126
𝓵𝟏 𝓵𝟔
Since a1 = ℓ1 (by construction)
Therefor ∴ 𝒂𝟔 = 𝒍𝟔 ............... 5-127
which proves that the element between Ǿ6 - Ǿ7 is also a curvilinear square. For the
same reason meshes of the flow-net so constructed are also curvilinear squares.
Forchheimer's flow-net under a structure is reproduced in Fig. 5-59.
MANUAL OF IRRIGATION PRACTICE 5-169
BARRAGES
as in the first two streamlines to make the length and the width of each mesh equal
thereby forming curvilinear squares.
In drawing a flow-net as recommended above, care should be taken that (a)
equipotential lines meet the solid boundary of the structure nearly perpendicularly and
(b) these should cut the streamlines nearly orthogonally and (c) the first and last
equipressure lines where Ǿ =H and Ǿ = O must coincide with the upstream and
downstream permeable boundaries. The space between the equipressure line Ǿ=H
andǾ=O is divided into convenient integers, say 5, 8, 10,…25, so that each space
between any two adjacent equipressure lines represents a drop of H/5, H/8, H/10,
H,25, respectively.
If a first trial gives a fractional number of divisions of equipotential meshes, say 5.3, a
new retrial for drawing the flow-net should be made.
The flow-net can be extended in depth by drawing under each of the squares a new
square, the outside of this square will form the next stream line. The stream lines, as
they approach the outer limit, will have to be adjusted according to the dictates of
infinite or finite depth requirements stated above.
It has to be kept in mind that for a given structural design and boundary conditions,
one and only one flow pattern will be completely correct. After having drawn the flow
net, a check for curvilinear squares and right angle intersections of the two sets of
curves at all places is necessary. The accuracy however, depends on what we
understand by a curve linear square, how we can construct it or check the same. A
well-known method based on the principle that all intersections must be 90°and all
medians or diagonals must essentially be equal, forming a new set of squares in
themselves has been applied for drawing and checking the flow net for many problems
in fluid mechanics by different authors.
However for the problems of seepage under hydraulic structures Leliavsky considers
that this method has serious limitations and suggested a principle of circle method to
improve the accuracy of the flow-net. He defined the curvilinear square as “four curves
which intersect at right angles and are tangents to a central common circle”. Leliavsky
circle method useful for checking and improving the accuracy of the seepage flow-net.
A flow net for horizontal floor and a sheet pile is shown in above Fig. 5-60.
The graphical methods described above, give only approximate and indicative results.
The generation of flow nets from mathematical calculation is rather too complicated to
be included in this manual and is thus not included.
Determination of seepage discharge, uplift pressure and exit gradient
from Flownet
As indicated earlier, discharge between two stream lines in a flow net is constant and
between any two consecutive equipotential lines the head loss is the same. If there
are N number of Ǿ lines (N = 20, in Fig. 5-61), with a drop of dh between any two
consecutive Ǿ lines, the total loss of head H is given by:
H = NǾ dh ............... 5-128
MANUAL OF IRRIGATION PRACTICE 5-171
BARRAGES
𝒅𝒏 𝑯
And 𝒒 = 𝒌. 𝒅𝒔 . 𝑵 ............... 5-132
Ǿ
If there are NΨ stream lines (NΨ=6, in above Fig.the total discharge is equal to:
𝑸 = 𝑵𝜳 𝒌𝒅𝒉 ............... 5-134
Substituting for dh from Equation …….,
𝑵
𝑸 = 𝒌 𝑵𝜳 𝑯 ............... 5-135
Ǿ
𝑸 𝑵𝜳
or = ............... 5-136
𝒌𝑯 𝑵Ǿ
𝑸 𝑲𝟏 𝑵𝜳
= 𝟐𝑲 = ............... 5-137
𝒌𝑯 𝑵Ǿ
where K1 and K are elliptic integrals of the first kind with modulus m 1 and m. Again
comparing with Equation we have:
𝒒 𝒂 𝑲𝟏
= 𝟏 = 𝟐𝑲 ............... 5-138
𝒌𝑯
where a/1 is the ratio of the sides of a mesh of a flow net. The physical meaning of the
non-dimensional ratios of the parameters involved. Equation 5-138 is that the seepage
discharge depends only on k, H and the ratio of the number of the stream tubes and
equipressure compartments.
Example
Calculate pressure, exit gradient and discharge from the flow net in Fig. 5-61.
Pressure at Point P
Number of stream tubes NΨ = 6
Number of potential drops NǾ = 20
Total heads H = 30 ft
𝟐𝟎−𝟏𝟑
Loss of head at point P which is on 𝑵Ǿ𝟏𝟑 = × 𝟑𝟎 = 𝟏𝟎. 𝟓 𝒇𝒕
𝟐𝟎
Or pressure head, h = 30-10.5 = 19.5 ft head of water above downstream water level.
Exit gradient
The exit gradient at the toe is computed by dividing the loss of head dh between the
last pressure line and zero pressure line by the distance of last pressure line to the
one coinciding with the permeable boundary at the toe.
𝒅𝒉 𝑵Ǿ𝟏
Or [ 𝒅𝒔 ]
𝑶
ds = ab = 4.1 ft
dh = 𝑯/𝑵Ǿ𝟏 = 30/20 = 1.5 ft
𝒅𝒉 𝑵Ǿ𝟏 𝟏.𝟓
[ 𝒅𝒔 ] = = . 𝟑𝟔𝟔
𝑶 𝟒.𝟏
𝒅𝒉 𝟏.𝟓
Exit gradient 50 feet downstream of the toe at X GEX = = 𝟏𝟖.𝟕 = 𝟎. 𝟎𝟖
𝒅𝒔
Discharge
𝑸 = 𝒌𝑯 𝑵Ǿ /𝑵𝜳
If k = 5 x 10-1 per hour
NǾ = 20 and NΨ = 6
𝟏 𝟔
𝑸 = 𝟐 × 𝟑𝟎 × = 𝟒. 𝟓Cft per hour per foot width of structure.
𝟐𝟎
It is to be noted that the above calculations are for a limited number of flow lines. For
an unlimited depth of foundation, the calculation of exact seepage discharge is neither
possible nor essential.
MANUAL OF IRRIGATION PRACTICE 5-173
BARRAGES
Flow lines provide only approximate analysis and the values of residual pressure and
exit gradients, and in comparison with the available simple and accurate mathematical
methods are used only rarely.
MANUAL OF IRRIGATION PRACTICE 5-174
BARRAGES
= V2/2g; V is the actually observed flow velocity along the divide wall.
b) Downstream water level is above the crest (gates clear or no Gates)
In this case the fall over the crest is unobstructed and free. However, after the
formation of standing wave the water level on the downstream side is above the crest
by 'd'.
Q = C B (H + Ha)3/2 ............... 5-140
where
C = Variation in the coefficient due to drowning ratio as listed in Table 5-35.
Other notations B, H & Ha have the same meaning as defined earlier.
Table 5-35: Variation of discharge coefficient ‘C’ due to drowning ratio d/H
d/H C
deep and may be narrow while the one in the central part of the weir may be
wide and shallow.
The gate openings so that designed intensities for various water levels are not
exceeded in any case and hydraulic jump always forms above the toe of the
downstream glacis.
The following instructions are complied with for regulation of discharge through various
components. Any deviation will require written permission by the Executive Engineer,
who for major departures a deviations may consult higher authorities if he deems
necessary.
5.13.5.3 Pockets and undersluices
The maximum designed intensity per foot run should never be exceeded except in real
necessity and that too with specific approval from the Executive Engineer.
Generally the pockets are operated on a still pond system which requires the
undersluices to be kept closed and only decanted water allowed to enter the canals.
The canal regulator crests are normally set at about 50% of the pocket depth. The
level of settled sediment is kept under observation and when the depth of settled
sediment reaches about 35% of the pocket depth canals are closed and undersluice
gates opened to safe openings to flush out the settled sediment to the level of the
undersluice crests. Thereafter the undersluice gates are again closed to create still
pond conditions in the pocket and canals are reopened.
Still pond system is considered mandatory when the approach to the pocket is straight
and more or less central to the barrage. In the case of oblique approach, the still pond
system is replaced with partial sluicing to create such curvilinear flow conditions in the
pocket that place the Head Regulator of the canals on the outside of flow curves.
For high flood discharges, the undersluices are opened very gradually, keeping the
opening of the bays on both sides of the divide wall to be same. The gate opening in
the first and last bays should, however not exceed to 2 feet. Care should also be taken
that the head across the divide wall nose does not exceed the safe limit of 3 feet.
For silt excluders in the pockets, the regulatory instructions are prepared / to satisfy
the requirements of the silt excluders (Refer section 3.14 of silt excluder).
5.13.5.4 The Weir Section
The weir section gates can be operated as follows:
a) Uniform Gate Openings
This is suitable when the river approaches the barrage in a straight central stream.
b) Wedge Plan for Openings
The gates are opened with wedge shaped opening plan by keeping the central bay as
the pivot or nucleus. For rising discharges, the openings in central part are to be
maximum reducing towards flanks while in falling river discharge the order is reversed.
However in both cases, the openings of Bay on both sides of divide walls have to be
equal to minimize Head Across the noses of divide walls. The main aim of these
methods is to create three channels, two for feeding pockets and one for the weir.
c) The Need Basis
MANUAL OF IRRIGATION PRACTICE 5-179
BARRAGES
This is different from the other two, in that the openings are determined keeping in
view the river approach, requirement of canals and cross flow tendency in the
upstream pond. This method in conjunction with wedge method is more appropriate
for a more balanced regulation. The barrage gates are opened so that the
requirements are met and also no parallel flow is allowed to be generated on the
upstream of the Barrage.
To avoid jamming up of the gates, each gate which has to remain closed for more than
48 hours must be lifted for about 20 minutes daily and silt deposit upstream of the gate
flushed down. The difference between the openings of two adjoining gates should
never exceed 2 ft.
d) Navigation or Rafting Bay
A navigation bay is provided in each barrage along one of the divide walls. The main
lock gate on the crest of navigation bay is kept closed usually up to half the designed
discharge. When the discharge exceeds medium flood mark, both the gates may be
opened taking advantage of the bay to create more waterway during high floods.
No traffic should be allowed to pass through the navigation bay when the river is in
medium flood or above or when the adjoining Bays of the undersluices are functioning.
In exceptional cases, if unavoidable, the traffic should be allowed to pass with the
written permission of the Executive Engineer and under the personal supervision of
the Sub Divisional Officer Headworks. Care must be taken that the boats are safely
embayed before they are allowed to pass the navigation bay and Jamadar on duty is
present. In case of timber, good swimmers should handle them. Account or note of the
traffic passed through lock gate be kept in Log Book and in the form of monthly
statement in Divisional Office to serve as statistical record for the future e.g.
incorporation in the Annual Headworks Report.
e) Fish Ladders
Two fish ladders one on the right and one on left are generally provided for easy
movement of the fish across the barrage. The ladders provide zigzag extended path
and 1 ft. fall / jump after every compartment. Each compartment, as well as the entry
and exit have been provided with slots for regulation by stop logs / karries. When the
downstream exit is under water, the karries in the compartment next to last should be
put in to create suitable conditions on the upstream. The depth at entry and, therefore,
the flow, also needs regulation and the flow should be blocked systematically from
bottom upwards to avoid too high velocities.
5.13.5.5 Flood Warnings
Flood warnings are issued to all the stakeholders and concerned civil authorities in
addition to the normal departmental authorities to whom discharge and flood data is
supplied. For the flood warnings to the local civil authorities and other concerned
departments, the latest instructions on the subject issued by the Irrigation Department
should be adhered to. Wireless worked by Police department during flood season and
all available means of communication should be utilized during flood as necessary.
5.13.5.6 Rates of canal discharge variation
For all canals the rates of variation in discharge will be as follows:
For raising
Open with one fourth of the designed discharge or 2000 Cusecs
MANUAL OF IRRIGATION PRACTICE 5-180
BARRAGES
can be spared for ejection. Accordingly the decision to operate the ejector and the
amount of discharge that can be spared should be made by the Executive Engineer.
It would be necessary to ensure that all impediments restricting the flow either through
the barrels or escape channels are removed and the ejector with its mechanical parts
is in good working order. Therefore, the inspecting officers should check physically to
verify.
During each closure of canal and especially during annual closure of the barrage,
detailed inspection of the ejector including sounding and probing to detect damages
to its floor and aprons and their timely repairs shall be made. In this period any debris
or obstructing material (specially tree trunks etc which are heaped over the bed of the
canal or floor of the ejector or may be stuck up in the slit of the ejector, shall be
removed. This is necessary to avoid damage to the vortex tubes, tunnels, ejecting
barrels, gates and downstream floor of the ejector. During the closure observations to
determine the condition of bed on upstream and downstream of the ejector as well as
other masonry works shall also be made to decide about future operation of the
ejector.
While operating the ejectors it is necessary to ensure that it does not cause damage
to any other work. Besides the above, when difference in water level in the canal and
outside is less than a foot the silt ejector should be closed. Gates of the silt ejector
should never be lowered or raised so as to create difference in water level in the canal
more than 0.5 ft. and in the outfall channel more than 1 ft. at a time or per hour.
5.13.5.12 Sediment account/balance
The sediment account / balance at each ejector is determined as laid down in the
following. The sediment charge above 62 microns size is observed:
i. At 200 ft upstream of the ejector slit at three points in the channel prism i.e. at
the centre and two points 100 ft away from the centre at 0.8 (80%) depth from
the water surface i.e. 0.2 (20%) depth above the bottom.
ii. At 200 feet downstream of the ejector slit at three points in the channel prism
in a way similar to the upstream cross section.
iii. The sediment balance and account is calculated at the boil of each gate of the
outfall regulator with a D-49 depth integrating sampler.
Based on the discharges of channel at the upstream and downstream cross
section and discharge extracted through the ejector slit/tunnels.
This gives the sediment ejected compared to the extracted discharge, the
sediment in the canal on the upstream of the ejector and that still remains in the
flow downstream of the ejector, and help in determining the optimum extraction
ratio at the ejector and normal efficiency of the ejector.
This is done once a week in winter and thrice a week during kharif, i.e. 15 th April
to 15th October, at prescribed river discharges, with magnitudes of low and
above discharges.
MANUAL OF IRRIGATION PRACTICE 5-182
BARRAGES
i. The pond level at the barrage is lowered by maximum amount keeping in view
the safety of the barrage and allied structures to create as much storage
capacity as possible.
ii. Prepare a gate operation plan as the discharge rises.
iii. Get such topographic maps and cross sections of the river Khadir and
depressions that could share extra discharge and save as much area as
possible from destructive inundation.
iv. Inform all the Government functionaries and NGO’s related with floods to take
up and start their share of flood protection program/steps.
v. Evacuation of population to high spots is very heavy and will have to be started
immediately.
vi. Arrangement of food stuff and drinking water for at least one week will have to
be made at all high spots.
vii. Later air dropping of life saving supplies will have to be resorted to.
viii. Mobile and spot dispensaries will have to be setup to save the people taking
shelter at such high spot camps.
ix. Rescue operations isvery heavy and demanding and defence forces and other
helicopters will have to be deployed for evacuation job.
x. Additional police force will need to be deployed to ensure law and order.
xi. With the improvement in telecommunication system, several channels of
communication are now available. If normal land lines fail, one could use cell
phone, and if at some time the cell system also falters, Satellite phones and
long range wireless are also available. So there is no chance of complete
severance of communication and higher authorities are always contactable for
verbal confirmation of local decisions.
xii. The emergency instructions contained in the flood protection plan do not require
any confirmation from higher authorities and it is understood that during any
emergency, if a local officer losses contact with senior hierarchy, he has full
authority to take appropriate decision. He is however responsible for his
decisions.
xiii. It has already been mentioned earlier that the flood protection plan is revised
every year before start of the flood season.
xiv. All operating staff are fully trained in their duties including emergencies and the
O&M Manual lays down the action to be taken by the field staff. The O&M
Manual thus covers a good part of the emergency preparedness plan.
xv. Flood warning messages must be issued in time.
Flood Emergency Plan
Flood emergency plans for each barrage are prepared and approved annually under
the title “Flood Fighting Plan” for implementation during flood events / seasons. The
contents of such plans are:
a) General description of the particular barrage;
b) Administrative setup at the barrage;
c) River training works functioning as allied works;
MANUAL OF IRRIGATION PRACTICE 5-185
BARRAGES
Cracks and spalls noted during past examinations should be evaluated for any change
of condition. New cracks and spalls are noted and examined to determine the type,
such as tension or crushing, and the reasons for their existence. Photographic
documentation of a crack or spall condition aids in evaluating the changes from one
examination to the next.
All fill adjacent to the structure should be examined for subsidence or soil movement.
The contacts between the fill and the structure should be examined for evidence of
creep. All cut or fill slopes adjacent to the structure should be examined for unstable
conditions.
The bridges and hoist decks, along with their supporting members, should be
examined for condition and proper function. All guides for gates, or other mechanical
features should be in good condition, such as electric conduits, pipes, and fixtures.
The stain outlines, on the walls or piers of the structures for various discharges, should
be studied for an indication of flow characteristics through the structure.
5.15.2.4 Mechanical equipment
Mechanical and associated electrical equipment should be operated through the
maximum possible operation range under actual operating conditions to confirm that
the equipment performs satisfactorily. The equipment should be checked for proper
lubrication and smooth operation, without jamming, vibration, unusual noises, and
overheating. The adequacy and reliability of the power supply should also be checked
during operation of the equipment. Auxiliary power sources and remote control
systems should be tested for adequate and reliable operation. All accessible parts of
the equipment should be examined for damaged, deteriorated, corroded, cavitated,
loose, worn, or broken parts.
Wire ropes should be examined for proper lubrication. Deformed, broken, or rusted
wires and ropes should be noted. Rubber, neoprene or other gate seals should be
examined for deterioration, cracking, wear, and leakage. Hydraulic hoists and controls
(if existing) should be checked for oil leaks contamination and for rough areas that
could result in damages. Gate structure and couplings should be examined for
corrosion, broken or worn out parts, and condition of protective coating. Leaves, metal
seats, and seals of gates should be examined for damage due to cavitation, wear,
misalignment, corrosion, and leakage.
Operating instructions should be posted near associated equipment and checked for
clarity. Each operating device should be permanently and clearly marked for easy
identification. All equipment controls should be checked for proper security to ensure
that unauthorized persons do not have the access to operate or tamper with the
equipment.
Mechanical and associated electrical equipment should be examined for adequacy of
weather protection and for damage resulting from inadequate protection. Ventilation
and heating systems should be operated and checked for adequate capacity to control
damp environments for mechanical and electrical equipment. Access ladders,
walkways, and handrails should be examined for deteriorated or broken parts or other
unsafe conditions. Stoplogs, bulkhead gates, and lifting beams should be examined
to determine if they are available and in good condition. The availability of equipment
for moving, lifting, and placing of stoplogs and bulkheads, should also be verified.
During or after the site visit, discussions should be held with the operators to determine
if there are any unusual operating conditions or problems with the equipment. The
MANUAL OF IRRIGATION PRACTICE 5-189
BARRAGES
discussions and operation of equipment should be used to verify that the operator
understands and is qualified to operate the equipment. Maintenance and exercising
practices should also be discussed to determine that they are adequate and in
accordance with the DOC and SOP.
Auxiliary Power. An adequate auxiliary power supply should be available for
emergency operation of gates and other necessary equipment during periods when
the normal source of sufficient capacity to operate at the maximum intended load as
described in the DOC and SOP is not available. The fuel supply should be sufficient
to operate the auxiliary power unit for the maximum anticipated outage of the normal
power supply.
During an examination, the auxiliary power supply should be used to operate gates
and other equipment to determine if the system is operational and adequate. Fire
protection, proper venting of exhaust gases, and protection should be examined
against vandalism. Operating instructions, clearly describing the procedures required
to manually place the auxiliary power supply in operation, should be posted. Automatic
system should be checked for proper operation. These systems do not normally
require operating instructions.
5.15.2.5 Access roads
The safe operation of a barrage depends on adequate and safe means of access.
Usually the only access to a barrage is by road. The road should be of all weathers
construction suitable for the passage of automobiles and any required equipment for
servicing the barrage during any weather conditions. Surfacing material should be
adequate to support anticipated loads. All cut and fill slopes, should be stable under
all conditions.
5.15.2.6 Site visit notes
Each member of the examination Team should carry a checklist or a small notebook
during the examination. The checklist should be categorized by structure notes and
separated into individual items examined such as floors, walls, riprap,
5.15.2.7 Site discussions
Members of the examination Team should discuss the operation of each appurtenant
feature of the barrage with the barrage operators. The discussion may indicate if the
features are operating as designed. The discussion will also serve to pinpoint
problems which might require further investigations.
5.15.2.8 Frequency of evaluation visits to site
Evaluation visits to the site can be classified as follows:
5.15.2.8.1 Initial evaluation visit
An initial evaluation visit is the first inspection of a barrage/structure just after
commissioning, or when there has been a change in the configuration of the structure
(e.g. widening, strengthening or remodeling).
5.15.2.8.2 Routine evaluation visit
Routine inspections are regularly scheduled inspections consisting of observations
and / or measurements needed to determine the physical and functional conditions of
the barrage / structure to identify any changes from “Initial” or previously recorded
MANUAL OF IRRIGATION PRACTICE 5-190
BARRAGES
conditions, and to ensure that the structure continues to satisfy the current service
requirements.
Depending on the site location, size, age and condition, each barrage should be
assigned a schedule for the periodic evaluation. Normally every 5 years, a
multidiscipline team should conduct a formal safety examination of the barrage.
5.15.2.8.3 Emergent inspections
An emergent inspection is an unscheduled inspection to assess the structural
problems resulting from environmental factors or human action. The scope of
inspection should be sufficient to determine the need for emergency restrictions and
the level of effort necessary to effect a repair.
5.15.2.8.4 In-depth inspections
An in-depth inspection is a close-up, hands-on inspection of one or more members
above or below the water level to identify and record deficiencies, not readily
detectable in routine procedure.
5.15.2.8.5 Special inspections
A special inspection is an inspection scheduled at the discretion of the owner. It is
used to monitor a particular known or suspected deficiency, such as foundation
settlement or scour or other conditions specially after a strong earthquake or an
exceptionally high flood.
5.15.2.9 Evaluation report
An evaluation report is to be prepared upon completion of the site visit and submitted
to the owner within 30 days of the completion of site visit for his consideration and
appropriate action.
5.15.2.10 What to look for; features, events and evidence
5.15.2.10.1 General
The performance of barrages and allied structures depends on:
(1) their design,
(2) construction process and construction materials,
(3) the nature of their foundations,
(4) level of maintenance, and
(5) operational adequacy/capacity.
The fundamental objective of barrage safety evaluation is the detection of any existing
or developing structural or hydraulic weakness evident from the complex
interrelationships of the "performance controllers". For identifying these weaknesses,
barrage evaluators must recognize and understand the following:
5.15.2.10.2 Changes in the characteristics of material
Observe for defective, inferior, unsuited, or deteriorated materials. The quality and
durability must always be determined in each case and the need for such critical
examination and what to look for as depicted in the following be established.
5.15.2.10.2.1 Concrete
(l) Alkali-aggregate reaction, and pattern crazing and cracking,
(2) leaching,
MANUAL OF IRRIGATION PRACTICE 5-191
BARRAGES
recommendations. The report must be tailored to the specific conditions of the barrage
evaluated.
The terms satisfactory, fair, poor, and unsatisfactory indicate the following overall
evaluation categories:
5.15.3.3 Satisfactory
No existing or potential barrage safety deficiencies are recognized. Safe performance
is expected under all anticipated loading conditions, including such events as the MCE
(maximum credible earthquake) and the PMF (probable maximum flood).
5.15.3.4 Fair
No existing barrage safety deficiencies are recognized for normal loading conditions.
Infrequent hydrologic and/ or seismic events would probably result in a barrage safety
deficiency.
5.15.3.5 Reasonably fair
A potential barrage safety deficiency is recognized for unusual loading conditions
which may realistically occur during the expected life of the structure when
uncertainties exist as to critical analysis parameters which identify a potential barrage
safety deficiency; further investigations and studies are necessary.
5.15.3.6 Poor
A potential barrage safety deficiency is clearly recognized for normal loading
conditions. Immediate actions to resolve the deficiency are recommended; pond level
/ Head Across restrictions may be necessary until problem resolution.
5.15.3.7 Unsatisfactory
A barrage safety deficiency exists for normal conditions. Immediate remedial action is
required for problem resolution.
Photographs, particularly of irregularities, should be taken during the site visit;
referenced in the text, and included as an appendix to the Report. General drawings,
which show location, plans and sections of barrage and allied works, should also be
included.
Conclusions and recommendations
The finale of the evaluation Team's Report is the conclusions and recommendations.
Conclusions and recommendations must be supported by the reported findings. Each
conclusion should be identified, separately in sequence. Each recommendation must
result from a conclusion. Recommendations should be written concisely and identify,
to the extent of knowledge available to the Evaluation Team, the specific actions to be
taken. The first word in the recommendation should be an action word (e.g., "Prepare"
or "Perform" etc). The recommendations should address all the identified safety
concerns.
Selected items to be considered for inclusion in the inspection /
evaluation report
Instrumentation is used to monitor the behavior of the barrage and its foundation.
When instrumentation data is available, the results of the past performance should be
assessed. If instrumentation is lacking, the need for instrumentation to monitor specific
aspects of behavior during the operational cycles should be recommended. When no
MANUAL OF IRRIGATION PRACTICE 5-196
BARRAGES
instrumentation data or plots are available, an evaluation of the past behavior of the
barrage can only be determined by the site examination which is, at best, a surface
observation. Conclusions should be presented on instrumentation, and
recommendations made for specific items of structural performance.
MANUAL OF IRRIGATION PRACTICE 5-197
BARRAGES
i. Top Levels
ii. Unwanted Vegetation and Debris
iii. Encroachments
iv. Slope/Section Stability
v. Settlement
vi. Land Subsidence
vii. Damaged Armour
viii. Flood Wall Damage
ix. Runnels Caused by:
a. Old tree roots
b. Solutioning of Soluble Materials
c. Rodent burrows, holes and dens
d. Piping action through foundation alluvial materials.
e. Damage by river flow.
f. Erosion by wave action.
g. Ravines caused by heavy rains
h. Accidents
i. Vandalism
j. Sabotage.
The observations/findings of the inspection team should be briefly reported in a
checklist for quick overview. A sample generic format for such a checklist appears in
the following:
Frequency of Safety Inspections
The safety inspection in a normal or wet year should be carried out twice in a year; A
pre flood inspection during April / May and a post flood inspection during
October/November.
However in dry years the October/November inspection visit can be dropped.
Special Inspections can also be instituted after accidents and major rehabilitations,
up-gradation or new construction.
Inspection / Evaluation Report
After inspection, analysis and view sharing meetings will be amongst the team
members and incharge maintenance staff, the committee will formulate its
inspection/evaluation report and submit it to the owner/requesting authority within 15
days of the inspection.
This report will normally comprise an introduction, location of the training works,
analysis for design parameters, physical inspection results i.e. observation and
findings, conclusions and recommendations. The report will be signed by all the team
members and the officer incharge of the facility or his authorized representative. A
sample checklist for site inspection appears as Annexure H.
River Surveys
Periodic surveys of river channels and khadir (active flood plain) are to be carried out
every year after flood season in November. The survey includes:
MANUAL OF IRRIGATION PRACTICE 5-200
BARRAGES
season where this utter chaotic condition subsides. During the next flood season,
however, lesser chaotic condition are witnessed, till such time the river channel
increases its length by meandering and adjusts its slope and the silt conveying
capacity. This usually takes place by the formation of loops. The condition stabilizes
for a short period of time, when the next cut-off occurs and the process restarts.
Thus the river in alluvium remains in the quest for an equilibrium or regime moving
from one bank to the other, adjusting its length, sharpening the bends, developing the
cut-offs, and repeating the process over and over again.
MANUAL OF IRRIGATION PRACTICE 5-204
BARRAGES
Since the duties for actual measurements of all river discharges at specified location
(which include the site just downstream of the Barrage) have been assigned to the
staff especially employed with the Discharges Division Lahore. It is only the discharge
of the canals which has to be observed by Sub Engineer Hydraulic and Sub-Divisional
Officer Headworks as per schedule prescribed for them. River discharges passing
down the barrage are however calculated with formulae that are well established, but
their validity is often checked by comparing the results with those obtained through
actual observations by independent agency / staff of Discharge Division. Also the
discharges are determined each time when gate openings or condition of pond level
and water elevation on downstream side are changed.
5.17.3.1 Discharge observation sites and reference gauges
5.17.3.1.1 Discharge observation sites
Prior to actual observations of canal discharge, suitable discharge observation sites
are selected. In case of permanent locations, it would be preferable to construct meter
flumes in the head reaches of the canals.
Such sites are selected so that there are no curvature effects and the site is located in
straight reaches of the canals. The sites are also not influenced by the proximity of
masonry works and from the effect of turbulence or fluctuations in the water surface
elevation that is frequently prevalent the reaches in the immediate vicinity on the
downstream of canal head regulators.
5.17.3.1.2 Reference gauges
For canals the gauges are fixed in the gauge wells downstream of their head
regulators; and for river the gauge is located in the left gauge well downstream of the
Barrage.
Direct observation of discharges
The determination of discharge requires the measurement of the depth of water and
the mean velocity prevailing between the water surface and the bed of channel at a
number of predetermined points at a definite distance apart across the section. The
product of the velocities and corresponding areas added together gives the total
discharge. However, prior to actual observation of a suitable discharge site is selected.
5.17.4.1 Determination of depth of water
The depth of water can be measured in a number of ways but those commonly used
are either by sounding rod or by log line as explained in the following paragraphs:
5.17.4.1.1 By sounding rod
In this method, the depth at various verticals is measured by a rod marked in feet and
tenths and having base 6" or so in diameter to prevent the rod from going into the bed
of the channel. The rod is generally circular, but may be streamlined to reduce
obstruction to the flow of water. It is generally convenient to measure depths up to
about 15-20 feet with a sounding rod 25 feet long.
5.17.4.1.2 By log line
The log line consists of a flexible wire with a copper core, having a suitable weight tied
at the leading end to keep it taut and straight when immersed in water. The sounding
weights now used are the Columbus weights, commonly called the C type. The
weights are streamlined to offer minimum resistance to flowing water. Each weight has
MANUAL OF IRRIGATION PRACTICE 5-206
BARRAGES
a vertical slot and a drilled horizontal hole to accommodate a weight hanger and
securing pin. The weight hanger is attached to the end of the sounding line by a
connector. The current meter is attached beneath the connector. Since heavier
weights are difficult to manipulate. The weights commonly vary from 11 to 57 pounds
(5 kg to 26 kg).
The modus operandi is to throw the weight U/S, to let the line loose and to measure
the depth as soon as the weight touches the bottom. Considerable experience is
required for measuring depths in flowing water with a log line and only experienced
men are employed to do it. This method is used for taking soundings in depths greater
than 20 ft.
5.17.4.1.3 Sonar equipment
Recently sonographic equipment has become available to operate from boat and give
direct depth readings (digital). It is also capable of recording the depths graphically
giving a cross section. They are quite reliable and will rapidly replace the above
manual methods.
5.17.4.2 Use of current meters in determination of velocities
The most common method of velocity measurements at a given location is by use of
current meters; though other methods to determine the mean velocity are also in use.
Other methods, if current meter is not available include
a. usage of velocity rods
b. estimation from surface velocity
A current meter is an instrument used to measure the velocity of flowing water. The
principle of operation is based on the proportionality between the velocity of the water
and the resulting angular velocity of the meter rotor. By placing a current meter at a
point in a stream and counting the number of revolutions of the rotor during a
measured interval of time, the velocity of water at that point is determined.
The number of revolutions of the rotor is obtained by an electrical circuit through the
contact chamber. Contact points in chamber are designed to complete an electrical
circuit at selected frequencies of revolutions. Contact chambers can be selected
having contact points that will complete the circuit twice per revolution, to once per five
revolutions. The electrical impulse produces an audible click in a headphone or
registers a unit on a counting device.
The counting intervals are measured by a stopwatch. Current meters generally can be
classified into two main types, those meters having vertical-axis rotors and those
having horizontal-axis rotors. The comparative characteristics of these two types are
summarized below:
i. Vertical - axis rotor with cups or vanes.
a. Can operate in lower velocities than do horizontal axis meters.
b. Bearings are well-protected from silty water.
c. Rotor is repairable in the field without adversely affecting the rating.
d. Single rotor serves for the entire range.
ii. Horizontal-axis rotor with vanes
MANUAL OF IRRIGATION PRACTICE 5-207
BARRAGES
section. The cross section is therefore divided into suitable segments with appropriate
width of the segments. Depth of water and the mean velocity between water surface
and bed of channel at a number of points at a definite distance apart across the section
are observed. The product of velocities and the corresponding areas added together
gives the total discharge.
Previous practice in discharge observation
To divide the section into 5 main segments,
a) One central segment
b) Two side segments
c) Two slope segments.
This was done so that Simpson and Weddle's Rules could be applied to the central
and slope segments, respectively. Discharge observations on canals are governed by
the same principles as those applying to the observation of river discharge at sites
demarcated with wire ropes.
The central segments (6W3) is roughly of full surface width less three or four times the
general depth and if possible a multiple of 6, so that Ws was a whole number. If that
could not be arranged, it was kept a multiple of 3.
The width of the side segments W2 and W4 was equal to each other extending as
nearly as possible to the foot of the slopes, while the balance of full surface width i.e.
after deduction of the width of central segment was divided equally between the slope
segments W1 and W5.
Weddle's Rule was used for the central segments only and the area was calculated
as:
3 W (s umofodd) 5(s umofeven
) s umofeverthir ate, excludinge
y dor din
xtr emes
Area = 10 3 ..... 5-144
3 W ( D D D D ) 5( D D D ) D
= 10
3 3 5 7 9 4 6 8 6
............... 5-145
Simpson's Rule was used for the slope segments only where the base was divided
into any even number of equal parts, (which was two in case of canals) and depth was
measured at two points in each slope segment. So the area was determined as:
1 W1 4( D1 D11 ) D2 D10
Area = 6 ............... 5-146
In this method of observation the section selected was preferably to be in the middle
of a lined reach and soundings observed at each point of the section immediately
followed by velocity observation at 0.6 of the depth of water at that point.
Special forms bound into books are available for record of discharge observations of
canals with the above method.
Recent practices
More recently with the use of current meters however, the practice has grown to divide
the total section into a number of small or partial sections in such a way that
approximately not more than about 5% of the flow passes through each section. At the
same time the number of vertical section (which may not be equal on account of
restriction of discharge) are neither too large nor too small and work can be completed
within reasonable time. Generally the number of such sections is not less than 20.
MANUAL OF IRRIGATION PRACTICE 5-209
BARRAGES
There are two methods of current meters observation which are employed for
calculation of discharge. However, in both of them viz. Mean section method and Mid
section method discharge is the summation of the products of the partial areas of the
stream cross section and their respective average velocities.
Thus
Q = ∑(a v) ............... 5-147
where
Q = total discharge,
a = is an individual partial cross section area, and
v = is the corresponding mean velocity normal to the partial area
5.17.7.1 Mean section method
In the mean section method the velocities and depths at successive locations are
averaged whereas the section extends laterally from one observation point to another.
Therefore discharge is the product of average of the two mean velocities, the average
of the two depths and the distance between the location.
5.17.7.2 Midsection method
In this method if the cross section is defined by depths at location 1,2,3,4……10 as in
the Fig. below the partial discharges can be calculated as:
(b x b( x 1) (b( x 1) b( x )
qx Vx dx
2 2 ............... 5-148
(bx 1 b( x 1)
qx Vx dx
2 ............... 5-149
Where
qx = discharge through partial section x
Vx = mean velocity at location x
bx = distance from initial point to location x
b(x-1) = distance from initial point to preceding location,
b(x+1) = distance from initial point to next location,
dx = depth of water at location x.
MANUAL OF IRRIGATION PRACTICE 5-210
BARRAGES
EXPLANATION
1,2,3…………n Observation points
b1, b2, b3……bn Distance, in feet, from the initial point to the observation point
b1, b2, b3……dn Depth of water, in feet, at the observation point
Dashed lines Boundary of partial sections; one heavily outlined discussed in
text.
Thus, for example, the discharge through partial section outlined in fig. 1) is
(b b
q4 V4 5 3 d 4
2 ............... 5-150
The procedure is similar when x is at an end section. The "preceding location" at the
beginning of the cross section is considered coincident with location 1; the "next
location" at the end of the cross section is considered coincident with location n. Thus
(b b
q1 V1 2 1 d1
2 ............... 5-151
and
(b bn1
qn Vn n dn
2 ............... 5-152
The summation of the discharges for all the partial sections is the total discharge of
the stream.
Mid-section method as explained above is simpler and also slightly more accurate
than Mean section method as established by experiments
MANUAL OF IRRIGATION PRACTICE 5-211
BARRAGES
Velocity observations
Velocity measurements are taken by several different ways depending upon the kind
of support used by the observer / hydrographer in crossing the stream and manner in
which the current meter is held in the desired position in the water. The different types
of discharge measurements can be
Boat measurements
Bridge measurements
Cableway measurements
The velocity observations can however, be made in each vertical section by either the
2 point method or the single point method. In the two point method, velocity is
measured at 0.2 and 0.8 depth below the water surface. The average of the two
velocities gives the mean velocity in the vertical. In single point method (used for
smaller streams and canals) the velocities is observed only at 0.6 depth below the
water surface of the stream, because it has been shown experimentally that the mean
velocity lies at 0.6 of the depth measured from the water surface and thus the practice
has grown to observe a single velocity at 0.6 of the depth to obtain the mean velocity
in any vertical.
Equipment required for discharge measurements by current meter
In addition to the current meters other equipment for discharge measurements are
following categories:
Sounding equipment (Sounding rods, Log lines, Sounding weights etc
Width measuring equipment
The distance to any point in a cross section is measured from an initial reference point
on the bank. Cableways and bridges used regularly for discharge measurements are
commonly marked at 2, 5, 10, foot intervals by paint marks. Distance between
markings is estimated, or measured with a rule or pocket tape.
For the measurements made from boats, or from unmarked bridges, steel or metallic
tapes or tag lines are used.
Tag lines are made of 1/32, 1/16, 3/32, or 1/8 inch diameter galvanized steel aircraft
cord with tags at measured intervals to indicate distances. The standard arrangement
of the tags is
Number of tags Interval (feet) Arrangement or station
1 2 0-50
1 5 50-150 .
1 10 150 to end
2 0,10,20,40,50,150,250,350,450
3 100,200,300,400,500
the standard lengths of tag lines are 300, 400, and 500 feet, but other lengths can be
adopted
Equipment assemblies
Special equipment is needed for each type of current meter measurement, which may
be divided into the basic groups of cableway, bridges, boat, etc.
MANUAL OF IRRIGATION PRACTICE 5-212
BARRAGES
For measurement from a bridge, the meter and sounding weight may be supported by
a headline or by a sounding reel mounted on a micro crane trolley or bridge board. All
cranes trolleys are designed so that the super structure can be tilted forward over the
bridge rail far enough for the meter and the weight to clear most rails.
Measurements made from boats require special equipment not used for other types
of measurements. Extra large tag line reels are used on wide streams.
A utility line consisting of 30 feet of 3/22 inch diameter cable with a harness snap at
one end and a pelican hook at the other end is connected to the free end of the boat
tag line and fastened around a tree or post, thereby preventing damage to the tag line.
After the tag line is strung across the stream, the reel is usually bolted to a plank and
chained to a tree. The tag line is placed at appropriate intervals.
Special equipment is necessary to suspend the meter from the boat when the depths
are such that rod suspension cannot be used. A crosspiece reaching across the boat
is clamped to the center of the crosspiece extending out over the bow. The crosspiece
is equipped with a guide sheave and clamp arrangement at each end to attach the
boat to the tag line and make it possible to slide the boat along the tag and can be
attached to these clamps so that a tug on the rope will release the boat from the tag
line in an emergency. The boom consists of two structural aluminum channels, one
telescoped into the other. The boom is equipped with a reel plate on one end and a
sheave over which the meter cable passes on the other. The sheave end of the boom
is designed, so that by adding a cable clip to the sounding cable, a short distance
above the connector, the sheave end of the boom may be retracted when the meter
is raised out of the water. The raised meter is easy to clean and is in a convenient
position when not being operated.
In addition to the equipment already mentioned, the following items are needed when
making boat measurements:
A stable boat large enough to support the hydrographers and equipment.
A motor that can move the boat with ease against the fastest stream current.
A pair of oars for standby use.
A life preserver for each hydrographer.
A bailing device.
5.17.10.1 Miscellaneous equipment
Several other miscellaneous items that have not been described above are necessary
when current meter measurements are made. This equipment includes timers,
equipment, and waders boots.
Procedure for discharge measurements by boat (using current
meter)
5.17.11.1 Following procedure is followed
Estimate the width of the stream and string a tag line or measuring tape for
measurements. Sting the tag line at the measuring section by unreeling the line as the
boat moves across the stream. Some tag line reels are equipped with brakes to control
the line tension while unreeling. After a tag line without a brake has been stretched
across the stream, take up the slack by means of a block and tackle attached to the
reel and to an anchored support on the bank.
MANUAL OF IRRIGATION PRACTICE 5-213
BARRAGES
Determine the spacing of verticals, generally using. about 30 partial sections. With a
smooth cross section and good velocity distribution, fewer sections can be used,
although the ideal measurements is one which is not a partial section and has more
than 5% of the total discharge in it. However, this is very seldom accomplished when
about 30 partial section are involved. Make the width of the partial section less as
depth and velocities become greater.
After the cross section has been selected and the stationing determined, assemble
the appropriate equipment for the current meter measurements. If the depth of the
stream / canal is not large the meter is suspended from a suspension rod, which is,
either mechanically operated by a rack and pinion fixed on the boat. Both mechanical
and hand suspension rods are so marked that a foot on the rod is actually equal to
0.6'. This facilitates submergence of the meter to 0.6 depth.
The meter is attached to the suspension rod through a swivel whose length is such
that the horizontal axis of the bucket wheel remains at 0.6 ft. below the suspension
rod. Before submerging the meter it is essential that it is free to swivel. For a check
two meters are used, the second one being suspended from bracket fixed to the
suspension rod.
Prepare the measurements note sheet to record the observations. For each discharge
measurements record the following information:
Name of stream / canal and location to correctly identify the established
gauging station.
Date, party, type of meter suspension, and meter number.
Time measurement was started using standard time
Bank of stream that was the starting point.
Control conditions.
Gauge heights and corresponding times.
Water temperature.
Other pertinent information regarding the accuracy of the discharge
measurement and condition which might affect the stage discharge relation,
such as wind velocity direction etc.
Identify the stream bank by either LEW or REW (left edge of water or right edge
of water, respectively, when facing downstream).
Once the equipment and the note sheet have been prepared, start the measurement.
Mark on the note sheet the distance from the initial point to the edge of water.
After the meter is placed at the proper depth permitted to become adjusted to the
current before starting the velocity measurement, the time required for such
adjustment is usually only a few seconds if the velocities are greater than 1 ft. per
second.
Once the meter is adjusted to the current, count the number of revolutions made by
the rotor for a period of 40 - 70 seconds. Start the stopwatch simultaneously with the
first signal or click, counting "zero" not "one".
End the count on a convenient number given in the meter rating table column heading.
Stop the stopwatch on that count and read the time to the nearest second, or to the
nearest even second if the hand is on a half second mark. Record the number of
revolutions and the time interval.
MANUAL OF IRRIGATION PRACTICE 5-214
BARRAGES
at about the same velocity as the water, whereas, the coarsest sediment may move
only occasionally and remain at rest most of the time.
Thus the sediment supply from the stream or channel may be classified in the following
two types.
5.18.3.1 Bed load
"Bed load" remains essentially in contact with the channel bottom except when it is
forced to jump over large particles or other obstacle. Only on such occasions its
contact with the bottom may be interrupted but for a short distance. However,
depending upon the velocity of flow some coarse particles may even reach the water
surface at times.
5.18.3.2 Suspended load
In contrast to "Bed load", movement of suspended sediment is, in general, more
balanced. This is because sediment particles move at a velocity which is almost the
same as that of the water. So the particles travel for a great distance without coming
into contact with the bed.
However, the forces keeping sediment in suspension are subject to continuous
variations with corresponding variations in the quality and quantity of sediment load.
Thus the distribution of the suspended sediment sizes in vertical direction may vary
from stream to stream and from cross section to cross section within the same stream.
Generally, however, the finer sediments, are distributed uniformly throughout the
vertical and the coarser particles are concentrated near the stream bed. But if the force
keeping sediment in suspension is reduced the coarse particles gradually settle to the
bottom, whereas if the suspending force is increased further larger fractions may be
picked up. However such changes are gradual, less pronounced; and occur invariably
with certain transition.
Silt sampling at a barrage
Information on the bed material is generally required for research studies, i.e. for the
study of the long term changes in the channel condition and for use in computation of
total load. Thus in Punjab, samples of bed "silt" have only been taken and analyzed to
evaluate the nature of material forming the bed and also any periodical variation of its
grading. At the time of sampling, hydraulic data of the channel was also observed to
study Lacey's silt factor and other problems connected with the silt.
At headworks, observations for suspended sediments are made to determine the total
amount and concentration of specific sizes in the river in flow (entering into the
pockets), i.e. for working of silt excluders. Such observations of sediments passing
through each bay of the regulators are also made in order to supply the information to
the officer incharge of regulation as it facilitates his work. Similar observations are also
required in connection with the design and operation of silt ejectors.
Similarly analysis of Water: Sediment samples obtained from highly turbulent flow, i.e.
from the boils on the downstream of head regulators provide information on the total
quantity of sediments (bed plus suspended) that enters the canal and helps in deciding
if closure of the canal is needed to stop excess entry (more than permissible limit) of
such objectionable sediments that are likely to disturb the regime flow in the canal.
MANUAL OF IRRIGATION PRACTICE 5-217
BARRAGES
The mouth of the bottle should be kept open for the minimum time required to
fill the bottle.
If the bottle is kept open for a longer time than that required for actually filling
the bottle, coarse silt particles keep on falling into the bottle even after it is full.
Internationally the pressure improved suspended sediment samples are
classified into following general types.
o Depth integrating samplers
o Point integrating samplers
A simple depth integrating sampler collects samples continuously and accumulates
them as it is lowered to the bottom of the stream and reversed back to the surface. In
this process the sampler is however moved vertically at a uniform rate in given
direction but it is not necessary that to have equal in both the directions.
The point integrating sampler is, on the other hand, used to obtain a depth integrated
sample from deep or swift streams by holding the valve at a specific point in the
vertical.
Studies on the efficiency of samplers have resulted in the evolution of highly accurate
designs (e.g. the American samplers D - 43 and P - 46). The samplers DH - 48 and D
- 49 were introduced by the Oxford Sediment Laboratory of US Department of
Agriculture (USDA). The D - 43 may be considered to be a fore runner to the D - 49.
The sampler now being used at some barrage is D - 49 and is briefly described below.
A short description of P - 46, which is point integrating type, is also included for
reference purposes. It is recommended that while D -49 may be used for sampling in
the pockets P - 46 may also be used for observations of samples at specific single
points from boils on the downstream of regulators.
5.18.8.1 D - 49 Depth Integrating Suspended Sampler
It is a 62 lb. cast bronze sampler for taking samples of suspended sediment in streams
not deeper than 18 ft. It is 24 inches long and encloses a round pint-size milk bottle as
a sample container. To orient the instrument in the stream, it is provided with tail vane
assembly. It is also provided with a nozzle in the head and a port pointing downstream
on the side of the sampler's head for air to escape from the container.
To obtain a sample, the D-49 sampler is suspended with a steel cable and lowered at
a uniform rate from the water surface to the bottom of the stream. Without touching
the bottom, the movement of the sampler is reversed and the sampler is raised to the
water surface. The sample bottle is then taken out from the sampler and replaced by
a new bottle for the next sample collection. It is important that the movement of
sampler is at a uniform rate in the given direction but it is not necessary that rates in
both the directions are equal. This operation requires a well-trained person.
Samples of suspended sediment are usually taken at three vertical sections in the
stream, located in such a way that each represents approximately one third of the flow.
At low stages when the water is relatively clear, only one sample taken in the middle
of the stream may give the required results.
5.18.8.2 The P - 46 point integrating sampler
The USP - 46 consists of a 100 pound (46 Kg) streamlined cast bronze shell. an inner
recess to hold a round pint milk bottle, a pressure equalizing chamber and a tapered
MANUAL OF IRRIGATION PRACTICE 5-219
BARRAGES
three position rotary valve operated by a solenoid which controls the sample intake
and air exhaust passages. The three positions for the valve are:
Intake and air exhaust closed and pressure equalizing passage open
Intake and air exhaust open, equalizing passage closed
All passages closed
As the sampler is submerged, water enters the pressure equalization chamber through
a permanent opening in the bottom of the shell, and this compresses the air in the
chamber and sample container.
In this case, three samples may be taken at each vertical, one at the surface, one at
the middle depth and one near the bed of the stream. There are, however, no
restrictions on the number of vertical sections where samples are taken.
For streams with a stable cross section and a rather uniform lateral suspended
sediment distribution, sampling at a single vertical usually is adequate.
Precautions for the use of equipment
Before using the equipment at site it is desirable to check several items such as
nozzles, gaskets, and air exhausts on samplers as well as the other necessary
equipment. If a sample bottle does not fill in the expected time, the nozzle or air
exhaust passages may be partly blocked by bug nests, organic material etc. The flow
system can be checked by blowing through the nozzle with a bottle in the sampler. It
is desirable to use a short length of 1/4 inch rubber tubing to blow into the nozzle
because of contamination by the polluted water and because of possible blocking of
the nozzles hole. If air does not circulate freely, or not at all, check the nozzle first to
see if it is clear and remove and clean if necessary. If the air exhaust is closed for
reasons other than being damaged or broken, it may generally be cleared by using a
flexible piece of multi-strand wire. While checking the flow system of a point sampler,
make sure that the valve mechanism is in the sampling position.
In Punjab the D-49 depth integrating suspended sampler is preferred due to the site
conditions for varying the sediment flow conditions at all observation points. However,
the older types have to be phased out.
A handheld D H-59 sampler can also be used, but it requires more expertise and
experience for correct and reliable sampling and should be used only in exceptional
conditions.
Method of sample collection and transportation to the laboratory
After opening the box or sampler housing, the observer is to insert a clean sample
bottle into the sampler while taking samples. The sample bottles are usually standard
pint size glass milk bottles with a cap on top. So before inserting the bottle, the cap
must be removed. The sampler is then lowered to the water surface so that the nozzle
is above the water and the tail vane is in the water for proper upstream & downstream
orientation of the sampler. After orientation of the sampler, depth integration is
accomplished by lowering the sampler to the streambed at a constant travel rate.
When the bottom of the sampler touches the stream bed, the operator is to
immediately reverse the travel direction and raise the sampler to surface. Although it
is not necessary that both the rates for in lowering and lifting the sampler be same, but
both rates must be constant. The rates should be such that the bottle fills to near its
MANUAL OF IRRIGATION PRACTICE 5-220
BARRAGES
optimum level (approximately 2 inches below the top or 350 - 400 grams for the pint
size bottle).
When a stream is transporting heavy loads of sand, the observer should take at least
two bottles or complete depth integration as close together in time as possible. Each
bottle constitutes a sample, but for the purposes of the record, two or more bottles are
sometimes composited in the laboratory, where they are called a set. This set is then
a sample in time with respect to the record. If there is an unusually large quantity or a
difference in the quantity of sands between bottles, then another sample from the
same vertical should be taken immediately. The sample suspected of having too much
sand should not be discarded; but instead, an explanation, .such as "too much sand"
should be clearly written on the bottle. If by chance a bottle is overfilled, that is closer
than 1.5 inches (4 cm) from the top or if a spurt of water is coming out of the nozzle,
the sample should be discarded. A clean unused bottle is to be used for each sample.
The sample bottles are properly tagged before they are transported to the laboratory
(field laboratory set up at the barrage office). This makes their identification easy.
Bottles may be usually stored and transported in wire, wooden or fiber board cases
holding 20 to 30 bottles each. However, in the field it is desirable to use a small bottle
carrier which may hold six, eight or ten bottles as needed.
Analysis of samples
Natural sediments are irregular in shape and in most instances, even the
approximation of spheres is not possible. Thus one single dimension would obviously
be insufficient for characterizing the sediment. Yet as a single dimension is desirable
for practical considerations, the diameter and the terms "sieving" and "settling"
diameters are used almost exclusively for describing the sediment sizes. They are
defined as:
The sieving diameter: The smallest sieve opening through which the particle under
consideration just passes.
The settling diameter: The diameter of sphere having a specific gravity identical to that
of the particles, the fall velocity of which is the same as that of the particle under
consideration, assuming the fluids are identical.
The sediment classification generally recommended by American Geophysical Union
is also based on the grain size analysis. Thus the most obvious type of sediment
analysis and commonest of all tests for determination of grain size is by mechanical
analysis.
A number of grain size classifications have been proposed. Of these developed by US
Bureau of Soils, recommended by American Geophysical Union (AGU) and G. Gillboy
can be mentioned. The first one by AGU is most commonly used but the last one by
Gillboy is easier to understand and remember.
These classifications are summarized in the following table 5-36:
MANUAL OF IRRIGATION PRACTICE 5-221
BARRAGES
It may be noted that in the above table 19.1 various sub divisions or fractions chosen
for classification are purely arbitrary. They could be designated by numerical values
of their limiting diameters: would be advantageous in many respects to use this
system rather than names which has become the more common practice. Also the
names which have been given to various fractions sometimes constitute a second
meaning of the terms used, e.g. sizes falling under "clay" may not have other
properties attributed to them (such as plasticity etc). It is also not worthy that in Punjab
the word "silt" is commonly used to denote all sedimentary material upto 3.5 mm
MANUAL OF IRRIGATION PRACTICE 5-222
BARRAGES
Drying oven
Evaporating dishes (of China clay)
Pippets
Syringes
Clean dry cloth / dusters
Hydrometer
Filter papers
Analysis Procedure
The procedure for analysis will include following steps.
The analysis already washed and dry bucket be thoroughly cleaned with neat
dry cloth so as to remove any dust or other particles sticking to its inner surface.
Bottle(s) containing samples for analysis, should be well shaken so that the
sediments are thoroughly mixed with the water.
The sample bottle(s) are then emptied in the bucket.
While the sediments in the bucket have not yet settled in the water: sediment
sample is passed through a set of sieves the part passing through the sieves is
safely transferred to the graduated cylinder. Precaution should be taken so that
no part spills over in the process.
Reading on the graduations marked on the cylinder is noted for the volume of
sample in it.
Wash bottle is filled with the distilled water and sediments retained on each
sieve are collected / gathered at one end of the sieve by slightly tilting the same
to facilitate the movement of sediments.
The sediment contents from each sieve are then transferred to the graduated
silt measuring tubes. Separate tubes are required to be used for transfer of the
contents from each sieve but if the contents on anyone sieve are more than the
holding capacity of the tube additional tubes should be used. In this process
small pressure exerted in the wash bottle by blowing through the bent tube can
be helpful.
The readings for sediment contents in the silt measuring tube(s) which are
graduated to read up to 0.02 cc are then noted.
The weight of sediment in grams per liter is then calculated by using density of
sand as 1.4 in the formula
volume of sediment in the tube (in cc ) x 1.4 x 1000
Sediment in grams per liter = -------------------------------------------------------------------- ..... 5-153
total volume of water sample in the cylinder (in CC)
Wash the bucket, cylinder, beaker and tubes. Clean them with dry cloth before
storage for reuse.
An alternate method to determine the weight of the sediments retained on each sieve
would be through the use of drying oven and weighing balance by transferring the
sediment to evaporating pans instead of silt measuring tubes and weighing the oven
dried sample. A syringe can be used to draw the excess water passed with the
sediment into the evaporating pans before it is placed in the oven.
MANUAL OF IRRIGATION PRACTICE 5-224
BARRAGES
If the total sediments (including coarse and fine grained /colloidal sizes) contained in
the sample are also to be evaluated, the water sediment mixture in the cylinder should
also be utilized. A properly calibrated hydrometer may be used to determine the
concentration of sediments in the above. To this the portions of coarse sediments
already determined may be added.
However, during summer months (May to September) when incoming river discharge
swells, approach of the river may disturb the distribution of sediment charge and
fluctuations occur at various locations in their vertical places/sections. Changes in the
river discharge also occur frequently (sometimes even several times during the same
day). Thus the above process makes it necessary to adjust the above schedule in
order to effectively control the entry of sediments into the canals. For monitoring the
efficacy of the silt ejectors vis-a-vis induction of silt in the canals more than once daily
observation are made as indicated by site conditions.
MANUAL OF IRRIGATION PRACTICE 5-225
BARRAGES
corrective measures adopted. The protection works around the noses and shanks of
the divide walls should be checked up by sounding and replenished. The head across
the nose should be restricted design values.
5.19.4.5 Bridges
The beams, slabs and the wearing coats of the bridges should all be checked for
cracks, wear and tear, joint etc, and repairs carried out so that smooth traffic is
ensured.
5.19.4.6 Fish ladder
A part from the usual inspection necessary for the concrete structure of the fish ladder,
its effectiveness for the smooth movement of fish from upstream to downstream and
vice versa should be studied and corrective measure adopted wherever necessary.
5.19.4.7 Navigation Lock
The concrete structures of the navigation lack should be thoroughly inspected for
cracks, settlement, etc, and repairs carried out. If the lock chamber and also the
navigation channel are silted up, necessary desilting operations should be carried out.
It must be ensured that the filling and emptying times are able to be maintained as per
design values. Approaches to both the upstream and downstream part of the
navigation locks should be maintained properly to avoid any congestion and damages.
5.19.4.8 Head regulators
The inspection and maintenance of the head regulator are similar to those of the main
barrage weir.
5.19.4.9 Instruments
It is necessary that regular performance reports are prepared, based on the different
instrument observations. The observations could be broadly classified under (i) Uplift
pressure (ii) Suspended sediment (iii) Settlement (iv) Retrogression (v) Aggradation
and (vi) Discharger distribution and cross flow.
5.19.4.10 Retrogression
It is necessary to measure the retrogression on the downstream. If the prescribed
values are exceeded, necessary remedial measure be taken on time to ensure the
safety of the structure.
5.19.4.11 Discharge distribution and cross flow
Design assumes certain concentration of flow through the different bays of the
diversion structure. Hence it is necessary to know the discharge distribution through
the bays so that the design, could be checked up for the safety of the structure.
Similarly cross flow should also be observed and proper remedial measure taken for
ensuring the safety of the structure. This can be done by suitable modification of the
gate regulation pattern.
5.19.4.12 Inspection and maintenance of mechanical and electrical works
Like the civil works the mechanical and electrical works should also be inspected and
maintained regularly. If they are not kept tidy and in proper working order, they would
fail at the time of emergency leading to damages to the entire structure. Under the
mechanical and electrical works the following could be included (i) Gates (ii) gate
MANUAL OF IRRIGATION PRACTICE 5-227
BARRAGES
grooves and seals (iii) Steel wire ropes (iv) Roller train and fixed rollers (v)
Winches/hoist (vi) Flood lighting (vii) Bridge bearing and super structures etc.
5.19.4.13 Gates
The gates should be kept clear of the debris and silt accumulations and they should
not be allowed to rust. The upstream face of the skin plate coming into contact with
water should preferably be painted with suitable primer and subsequently with epoxy
paint for long life. While painting the surface, all necessary precautions should be
observed. The surfaces should be repainted whenever needed.
5.19.4.14 Gate grooves and seal
Gate grooves and particularly their machined faces should be kept clean and
lubricated well and all their sticky deposits should be prepared off before applying the
lubricant and also examined for wear and tear and deterioration. Their replacement
whenever necessary should be done immediately.
5.19.4.15 Steel wire ropes
All steel wire ropes should be cleaned to remove all the dust accumulation and
lubricated with suitable greases at least once a year. The portion of the wire ropes
submerged in water, after lubrication, should be wrapped with gunny bags which
should be securely fastened to the ropes. The clamping devices also should be
inspected for their efficacy.
5.19.4.16 Roller trains and fixed rollers
The roller trains and fixed rollers should be cleaned, free movement ensured and
greased for smooth operation. Worn out rollers and pins should be replaced and bolts
tightened etc.
5.19.4.17 Hoists
Hoists and lifting drums should be kept clean and greased properly for smooth and
easy operation. Alignment of shafts should be checked and coupling bolts tightened.
In the case of electrically operated hoists, all the electrical wirings, switches, bearings,
reducing gears, etc should be checked for a safe and trouble free operation. The
platform should be examined and properly protected.
5.19.4.18 Operation of gates
The gates should be operated according to prescribed guidelines. When the gate
operation is of wedge type the gates should be opened in installments not exceeding
12 inches at a time.
5.19.4.19 Flood lighting
During the flood season all flood lighting and site illumination should be checked daily
and during slack season, it may be done once in a week.
5.19.4.20 Bridge bearings and super structures
The bridge bearings over the piers and abutments should be cleaned and greased
once in a year after the monsoon season. The painting of super structures should be
done once in years.
MANUAL OF IRRIGATION PRACTICE 5-228
BARRAGES
5.19.4.21.4.2 Operation
Before start check the following:
Engine, alternator and controls;
Engine oil;
Fan and fan belt;
Filters;
Breaker terminals;
Battery connections;
LV cables connected with generators
After start during running check:
Line to Line Ampere
Phase to Phase Voltage
Phase to line Voltage
Power factor
RPM
5.19.4.21.4.3 Maintenance
Ensure the equipment is operated under normal conditions, "daily inspection" and"
periodical inspection" shall be performed to find out fault and deal with it in time. The
maintenance schedule provided by the manufacturer should be strictly followed.
A brief maintenance Schedule follows:
A Daily or every 8 hours
B Every 150 hours
C Every 250 hours or 6 months
D Every 1000 hours or 12 month
E Every 2000 hours
A B C D E Operation
• Check the quantity of coolant
• Check the condition and the tension of the drive belt
• Renew the element of the fuel filter
• Ensure that the atomizers are checked
• Check the amount of lubricating oil in the sump
• Check the lubricating oil pressure at the gauge
• Renew the engine lubricating oil
• • Clean or renew the air filter element
• Check water pump
• Ensure that the turbocharger impeller and
compressor
Casing are clean
Ensure that the alternator and the starter motor are
•
in order
MANUAL OF IRRIGATION PRACTICE 5-232
BARRAGES
The staff should be prepared to tackle works of category (i & ii) above and they can
take up these works as soon as the site conditions permit. However, for works falling
in category (iii) there is an element of surprise as the nature and magnitude of the work
will come to light only during the closure for which no previous preparation exists, but
such works may have to be taken up and completed within the closure period. Such
works are normally a test of the ingenuity, resourcefulness and management capability
of the officers and staff.
Detailed inspections of barrage floors, glacis, friction blocks, divide walls, fish ladders,
navigation bay, masonry works such as piers, abutments, canal regulators, excluder
and all other structures such as silt ejectors, inlets, and outfall structures on the canal
have to be carried out during the closure period to determine what deterioration, if any,
has occurred during the flow period. The major closure period inspections are to be
carried out by the SDOs and their staff. For minor structural defects and other
scheduled action should immediately be taken to prevent further deterioration. More
extensive repairs which cannot wait till next closure should be immediately brought to
the notice of higher officers. The Chief Engineer, Superintending Engineer (SE) and
Executive Engineer (XEN) will conduct sufficient inspections to check the condition of
the structure and facilities and to arrange their timely repairs. Detailed instructions in
this regard already exist as having been issued vide Secretary Irrigation & Power
Department letter No. SO(OP)2-1/88-83 dated November 07, 1983. It is absolutely
necessary that accurate and detailed records be kept and the results of each annual
inspection and repairs carried out be recorded in detail and kept on record and
submitted in annual closure report. It has however, to be clearly understood that:
i. The most lethal and hidden enemy of the safety of any hydraulic structure, is
"piping" caused due to excessive hydraulic gradient. Thus any unusual
occurrence, such as formation of springs or sand boiling anywhere on the
impervious floors of structures, on pervious floors or sand beds of canal or
rivers in their vicinity, on any part of the structure or at its back and / or near toe
of embankments must be brought to the attention of senior officers for decision
and guidance for remedial measures.
ii. All control structures have to meet the conditions specified on the as-built
drawings and / or as modified by subsequent authorized change orders and
marked appropriately on the drawings.
iii. All structures have to be maintained in good condition with no loose or missing
brick/rock, open cracks or other defects. Required repairs cannot wait for one
year.
iv. Cracks in the masonry works need to be immediately attended to and brought
to the notice of officers i.e. for their decision regarding repairs. New cracks
which cannot be repaired should be marked with tell tales and should be
watched (along with old ones) for their development and determination of
urgency and extent of repairs.
Protection works aprons of main weir, undersluices, divide walls and
guide bunds
i. All protection works must be brought to section during winter working season
before the floods.
MANUAL OF IRRIGATION PRACTICE 5-238
BARRAGES
ii. All flexible loose protections and pitching of guide bunds, the Barrage and
various other training works on its upstream and downstream, must be repaired
and replenished to authorized sections during winter, before the flood season.
iii. Flexible bed protection and pitching of canal head regulators, silt ejectors and
their outfalls, inlet and the cross regulator must be checked and inspected
whenever possible but necessarily during canal closures. In any case, these
have to be properly repaired before flow is let into the canals.
iv. D/S areas of all water control structures and bridges must be protected from
scour; both bank erosion and bed scour by accepted maintenance procedures,
riprap being the most convenient.
Later on, proper maintenance will require close and continuous examination of all
facilities and timely repair and replacement program.
For annual maintenance program, surveys and investigations, soundings and probing
are invariably to be taken in May, i.e. before the beginning of the flood season and
later during October, i.e. after the end of flood season. These observations should be
plotted and are to be submitted along with the Headworks report. The fixed line and
points where soundings and probing are to be taken are marked at site to facilitate
observations and repairs.
These observations shall form the basis of repairs for all protection works and loose
stone apron etc. as described earlier.
Additional instructions
Navigation equipment, such as launch, motor boats, country boats Sukkur type boats
have been provided at the Headworks and must be kept in working order for daily use.
For use in emergency life buoys or belts on both flanks and the launch and boats must
be available at site. All staff employed must be good swimmers.
Approved quantities of stone reserve stocks are to be kept in readiness to meet
emergency repair needs. A thorough inspection of the structures at the end of each
closure period should be carried out by Executive Engineer himself or SDO before
issuing orders for bringing them into operation. Other foreign material littered on the
floor or stuck in the mechanical structure is removed. Emergency lighting
arrangements should be kept ready for night watch repairs etc.
In the sprawling complex of the Headworks, the need of quick communication cannot
be over emphasized. In case of an emergency at some distance, quick communication
with the central control may prove to be a life saver. The project has a telephone and
wireless network to meet this objective.
Responsibility for maintenance
The officer incharge, Executive Engineer/SDO, are responsible for the maintenance
of the barrage and the connected work. The following must be attended to:
i. All protection works must be brought to section as designed during winter
season before the flood season.
ii. All flexible loose protections and pitching of guide banks, the barrage, the
defence bunds and spurs must be repaired and replenished to authorized
sections during winter before the flood seasons.
MANUAL OF IRRIGATION PRACTICE 5-239
BARRAGES
iii. All roads on top of banks, defense bunds are kept motor-able throughout the
year for easy approach and inspection of works.
iv. All area on and around Headworks are kept clean and all masonry works
maintained to proper section.
v. The plantation avenues along the bunds, the gardens, the grassy plots should
be maintained properly and developed.
vi. The gauge wells and fish ladders be kept clean and frequently checked by
officers to see that they are functioning properly.
vii. Prescribed quantities of reserve stock of stone should be kept in proper stacks
leaving regular passage on the top of guide banks and spurs:
viii. HFL on both the upstream and downstream of left and right flanks should be
marked as a line with value of RL marks on the piers to indicate the distance
below which the hydraulic jump standing wave should not be allowed to travel.
The barrage staff should also be vigilant and report any defect that they notice in the
facilities owned by others and losses on the barrage structures.
MANUAL OF IRRIGATION PRACTICE 5-240
BARRAGES
The main inadequacy lies in regular monitoring and periodic evaluation of safety which
so far have been insignificant.
No dedicated systems for effective and regular monitoring and periodical safety
evaluation are presently in place. These are absolutely essential and if not done
properly, result in accidents and damages to barrages and other hydraulic structures.
Although a lot of knowledge is available, it is scattered in patches.
There is a definite need for the regular, effective and careful monitoring and evaluation
of hydraulic structures, especially barrages and the implementation of safety
evaluation processes and procedures.
The safety evaluation processes thus include:
a) Design review;
b) Review of construction records;
c) Site visits if necessary;
d) Identification and recording the problems and weaknesses;
e) Data acquisition;
f) Review of technical records;
g) Review of design and construction reports;
h) Operation and maintenance procedures;
i) Aging aspects of component structures;
j) Problems and deficiencies identified through the above study.
The evaluation process can thus be initiated by the operating staff, carried out and
completed by a special monitoring team constituted for one structure, or a permanent
outfit to carry out the continuous evaluation process of various structures. The
evaluation report shall include:-
a) Data review;
b) Problems;
c) Site visits and discussions;
d) Conclusions;
e) Recommendations.
Some additional details are available in section 15. For further details, refer to relevant
references.
MANUAL OF IRRIGATION PRACTICE 5-250
BARRAGES
In rising flood when both upstream and downstream levels are rising the pressure
pipes reads relatively low. In a falling flood when both the upstream and downstream
levels are falling they will read high. However, if the gauges on upstream and
downstream remain steady for 48 hours, the results of observations are believed to be
reliable.
Method of analysis
The data, recorded in a printed standard form 5-38 is analyzed as below:
The pipes are grouped by "lines" i.e. pipes on a single section from upstream
to downstream of the weir are treated as one line
One page of the register printed on the standard form should be devoted to one
line of stand pipes.
For reference the data collected and recorded as mentioned above is plotted as
graphs. Since = P/H x 100 remains constant provided the temperature of the in-
flowing water and the nature and depth of silt deposit or scour on the upstream and
downstream pervious floors does not alter, it serves as the basis of plotting the results.
Thus any variation in its value from the normal will indicate trouble unless this variation
can be explained by the variations in temperature or silt level.
a) = P/H percent
b) River temperature
c) Subsoil temperature
d) Head = H
e) Downstream water level
f) Depth of silt or scour at upstream and downstream of the previous floors
These graphs showing the salient factors that are likely to influence the value of are
kept up-to-date for all key points viz., points just under the weir floor on the upstream
and downstream of each vertical cut-off pile line and under or just downstream of crest
so that any unfavorable developments/identified in the sub soil can be discovered as
soon as they occur.
Layout of Piezometers
The layout of peizometers is in the form of rows or lines in specific bays, normally on
both sides and bottom of each sheet pile line.
Standard residual pressures
The design is based on Khosla’s method of “Independent Variable”. The residual
pressure values can also be calculated by drawing of subsurface flow nets. These
measurements show reasonable agreement with the values calculated with Khosla’s
method.
Interpretation of seasonal variations
With earlier explanation and with the knowledge of local peculiarities it is possible to
interpret the results of pressure observations and to predict any abnormalities. A lack
of such knowledge might lead to a false sense of security or unnecessary panic.
Plotting the observed data helps in its analysis. As a rule the resistance from point to
point will rise or fall more or less proportionately throughout the sub-soil under a weir.
If suddenly the resistance becomes disproportionately small in any particular portion
the possibility of cavities under that part/portion is indicated. The pipes in that case
MANUAL OF IRRIGATION PRACTICE 5-252
BARRAGES
should be checked to see that they are functioning. If the pipes show no signs of
chocking the natural conclusion would be that an abnormality of some sort has
occurred.
Detection of cavity formation or loose contact under the barrage floor
The presence of loose contact under the barrage floor or cavity formation has been
found to cause concentration of flow lines towards such a location; and to reduce the
effective length of floor. Accordingly following peculiarities are associated with the
cavity formation.
a) Immediately above and below the cavity a gradient is steeper than normal
gradient
b) The gradient through the cavity is flat.
c) If the cavity happens to be near the upstream or downstream end of the floor
the hydraulic gradient at the entry or exit are steepened to a greater extent than
that for a cavity at any other location.
d) The effect of the cavity is local and cannot be felt at some distance from the
cavity.
Further analysis of pressures in such a condition is a complex process and beyond
the scope of this manual and should be referred for expert analysis.
Vibrating wire peizometers
The V.W. piezometers3 are a modern version of the water level measuring stand pipes
whom they are replacing gradually. The older version of direct measurement device
due to its constraints has yielded placed by the new version. The signals from the
measuring unit below the floor can be observe in direct reading units or in control room
through cable connections or the signals can be transmitted through were less
transmission to the control room where data loggers transform the signals into water
levels which are retrievable through computers in the control room. Such a system is
operational at Taunsa and Jinnah Barrages.
The description and process of installation of v.w. piezometers follows:
The VW piezometer has a rigid cylindrical body, enclosing the sensing element.
The later consists in thin flexible diaphragm where a steel wire is attached. All
parts of sensors other than the wire are machined from a high-grade stainless
steel. A standard internal thermistor allows measurement of the temperature.
The piezometer is also fitted with a surge protector and resists electrical and
radio frequency interference as determined by tests compliant to IEEE and CEI
specifications. The transducer is fitted with several protections against water
intrusion: watertight connector, pointing, watertight feed through header, and o-
rings. A diagram of a VW piezometer is shown in Fig. 5-65.
3 Length = 8 inch, diameter = 1.5 inch, Stainless steel filter ~ 50 microns, ~ 10 kPa low air entry
MANUAL OF IRRIGATION PRACTICE 5-253
BARRAGES
4 Porous plastic, Length = 6 to 12 inch, diameter = 3 inch, plastic filter ~ 50 microns, ~ 10 kPa low air
entry. -Rigid PVC standpipe, 0.75 inch diameter, -Teflon tape for sealing threaded joints. - PVC cement
for bonding PVC pipe to filter. - Silica sand. Pressure gages for artesian conditions. – Cap: plain, slip-
fit, vented
MANUAL OF IRRIGATION PRACTICE 5-254
BARRAGES
Table 5-40: Sample table for v.w. piezometers observational record (system
output)
TAUNSA BARRAGE INSTRUMENTATION
PIEZOMETERS DATA SHEET (MAIN WEIR / BARRAGE)
TIME START:- 09-30 AM READ OUT NO. Logger Net Date:-
18.06.2018
TIME FINISH:- 10.30 AM WEATHER:- Clear / Storm /Rain OBSERVER:- M. Ashraf
BARRAGE HYDROLOGY DATA
a Inflow (cfs) 226469
B Outflow (cfs) 199044
C Gauges Right Left Average Head Across (ft)
(A) (B)
U/S Gauges (ft) 446.20 446.20 446.20
14.35
D/S Gauges 432.20 431.50 431.85
VALUES IN PERCENTAGE
PRESENT HEAD
Sr. PIZO PRESENT
PIZOMETRIC LOSS DESIGNED DIFFERENCE
# Ref: (B-D)100/B= REMARKS
LEVEL (C) (A-B)=D (F) (E-F)=G
E
BAY NO. 3 PEIZOMETERS
1 BP-03-A 439.69 6.51 52.65 63.24 -10.59
2 BP-03-B 436.88 9.32 35.05 56.59 -21.54
3 BP-03-C 435.08 11.12 22.51 45.23 -22.72
4 BP-03-D 433.67 12.53 12.68 36.99 -24.31
5 BP-03-E 438.36 7.84 45.37 23.37 22.00 Not calibrate
6 BP-03-F 432.09 14.11 1.67 0.00 1.67
7 BP-03-P 434.03 12.17 15.19 0.00 15.19
8 BP-03-S 433.80 12.40 13.59 13.59 Stand pipe
BAY NO. 14 PEIZOMETERS
1 BP-14-A 434.93 11.27 21.46 63.24 -41.78
2 BP-14-B 434.98 11.22 21.81 56.59 -34.78
3 BP-14-C 434.44 11.76 18.05 45.23 -27.18
4 BP-14-D 432.80 13.40 6.62 36.99 -30.37
5 BP-14-E 432.59 13.61 5.16 23.37 -18.21
6 BP-14-F 431.40 14.80 -3.14 0.00 -3.14
7 BP-14-P 432.03 14.17 1.25 0.00 1.25
8 BP-14-S 433.30 12.90 10.10 0.00 1.-0.10 Stand pipe
The readers who wish to acquire more information about vibrating wire piezometers,
may refer to the manufacturer’s manuals for piezometers and read out units and other
equipment. Copies of the manufactures manuals for Roctest Telemec Canadian origin
v.w. piezometers (28 pages) are included as Annexures I & J.
Every manufacturer has a different manual and reference may be made to the
manuals of relevant manufacturer.
MANUAL OF IRRIGATION PRACTICE 5-260
BARRAGES
The following suggestions will assist the officer incharge of workshops to frame
suitable local rules:-
a) The following parts of transmission machinery shall be securely fenced if in
motion and within reach:-
a. All shafts, couplings, collars, clutches, toothed wheels, pulley driving
straps, chains and ropes, except such that are in the opinion of the
Inspector, by construction or position equally safe to every person
employed as they would be if securely fenced or guarded.
b. All projecting set screws, keys, nuts or bolts on revolving parts except
such as are countersunk or otherwise made equally safe.
c. The underside of all heavy overhead main driving bolts or ropes if there
is any probability of persons having to pass under them.
b) The following parts of machine tools shall be securely fenced:
“The back gears and change wheels of lathes, the back gears and level gearing
of drilling machines, and the gear wheels of planning, shaping, slotting and
milling machines which are within reach.”
c) All emery wheels and tool grinding machines shall be fitted with strong iron
hood guards and shall also have a plate glass shield so fitted as to prevent
flying particles from entering into the operator's eyes.
d) All personnel hoist (where provided) gates shall be self-locking and only
capable of being opened when the cage is opposite the floor.
e) All circular saws of more than 6" diameter shall be provided with a strong metal
hood guard at the back of the saw. The saw under the table shall also be
completely guarded.
f) All band saws shall be fitted with expanded metal cage guards enclosing the
upper half of the machine. The saw under the table shall also be completely
guarded.
g) Every opening in the ground or in a floor, which by reason of its depth, situation,
construction or contents could cause personal injury, shall be so fenced as to
prevent such injury.
h) All important pulleys shall be provided with belt hangers or perches.
i) Suitable striking gear shall be provided and used to move driving straps on all
fast and loose pulleys.
j) Service platforms and gangways shall be provided for overhead shafting and,
where required by the Inspector, shall be securely fenced with guard rails and
toe boards.
k) No machinery in motion shall be cleaned with cotton waste, rags or similar
material held in the hand. No shall clean or oil any part of a machinery whilst
that part is in motion.
l) Every shafting ladder shall be fitted with either hooks or some effective non-
skid device.
m) No person, engaged in oiling or adjusting belts or in any work whatsoever within
reach of unfenced transmission machinery, shall be allowed to work whilst
wearing loosely fitting clothes.
MANUAL OF IRRIGATION PRACTICE 5-263
BARRAGES
n) All water level gauge glasses of boilers of which the maximum pressure
exceeds 100 lbs. per square inch shall be securely guarded.
o) No additional weight shall be placed on the safety valve of any boiler unless
written authority has been received from the Boiler Engineer to do so.
Workshop fires
1. Every workshop shall be provided either with:
a. An ample supply of water maintained at a sufficient pressure to reach all
parts of the workshop together with the necessary hose pipes and
hydrants for making effective use of the water, during the time the
workshop is in operation, or
b. Both buckets and chemical fire extinguishers of the following scale:-
i. There shall be at least six buckets in every work- shop and, if the
floor space exceeds 6,000 square feet, an additional bucket for
every 1,000 square feet in excess of the first 6,000 square feet.
Buckets shall be painted red and kept permanently on stands.
They shall be kept filled with water or sand at the discretion of the
officer incharge of the workshop.
ii. One extinguisher of at least two gallons capacity of soda acid or
compressed carbon dioxide type for a floor pace of 6,000 square
feet and an additional extinguisher for every additional floor space
of 6,000 square feet or part thereof.
2. All apparatus for extinguishing fires shall be kept in good order and shall be
periodically examined and tested.
A few suggestions regarding storage of inflammable liquids such as oil and petrol will
perhaps be helpful.
a) Inflammable liquids, such as oil and petrol should be stored in specially
constructed godowns. Godowns, in which inflammable liquids are stored,
should be located at least 200 feet from residential or industrial buildings. The
godowns should be well ventilated.
b) Receptacles containing inflammable liquids should be stacked in such a way
as to permit free passage of air between the receptacles.
c) No naked lights should be allowed inside the godown and smoking inside or in
the vicinity of the godown should be prohibited.
d) Materials, other than inflammable liquids, should not be stored in godowns
specially provided for the storage of inflammable liquids.
First Aid
In every workshop first aid appliances containing an adequate supply of sterilized
dressings, sterilized cotton, wool and a tannic acid spray for cases of burns, should be
maintained. The appliances shall be kept in good order and they shall be placed under
the charge of a responsible person who understands how to use them and who shall
be readily available during working hours.
The words "First Aid" shall be clearly painted on the box, cupboard or other receptacle
containing these appliances.
MANUAL OF IRRIGATION PRACTICE 5-264
BARRAGES
Taunsa barrage
This barrage, constructed during 1953 – 1958 across Indus River 16 kilometers from
Kot Addu Town, had multiple problems, right from commissioning. These were:
a) Design deficiencies
a. The tail water rating curve erred on the wrong side, i.e. it showed higher
tail water levels resulting in some inbuilt retrogression of levels.
Additional retrogression of levels due to sediment dropping on the
upstream of the barrage aggravated the safety further. Resulting
instability/fluctuation of hydraulic jump caused repeated serious
damages to the impact, friction blocks and the reinforced 1.0’ thick skin
layer.
b. The specific gravity of concrete was assumed as 2.48 affecting the floor
thickness calculations for the stilling basin.
b) Construction Problems
a. The stilling basin floor was placed in two layers; the bottom one of 1:4:8
mix over lain by a one foot thick 1:2:4 reinforced concrete skin. The lower
low strength concrete layer developed cracks and leak paths and
transmitted the total uplift pressure to the thin skin which blew up
repeatedly resulting in a precarious situation, and had to be restored at
substantial costs with no sustained stability.
b. The skin was also not properly anchored to the bottom layer and was
thus susceptible to lifting and rolling over, and had to be replaced a
number of times at substantial cost.
c. Similarly, the friction blocks were not anchored ending up in uprooting.
c) Hydraulic Problems
a. The retrogression resulted in jump instability and uncertain quality of low
strength base concrete and RC skin damages.
b. The pulsating and slipping of hydraulic jump downstream of the toe of
glacis caused repeated damages to the skin, blocks etc due to excessive
turbulence and dynamic and trough effects.
c. Oblique approach of river channel caused angular exit currunts and
unstable flow.
d. Due to unstable jump the turbulence was carried far downstream and
caused settlement.
e. Most of the pressure pipes became in effective and needed replacement.
d) Structural problems
These included damages to the impact blocks and uprooting of the friction
blocks. Repeated damages to the stone apron.
e) Aging effects
The under sluice gates were damaged and needed replacement, alongwith the
hoisting system.
With the above state of safety, the barrage could collapse any moment and needed
heavy remodeling on an emergent basis.
MANUAL OF IRRIGATION PRACTICE 5-266
BARRAGES
During the implementation of the Indus Basin Plan, it was proposed to increase the
capacity of BS Link and therefore the barrage was remodeled in 1967, with major
amendment being the raising of the crest and addition of sheet piles on the upstream.
With time, the relevant analysis indicated that the barrage capacity needs to be
enhanced to forestall operation of breaching section in the right side flood
embankments. Meanwhile, it was also noted that the stilling basin of the barrage
needed rehabilitation as the stone top layer has become loose due to mortar erosion
by high velocities of flood currents. For providing some environmental flow below
Sulemanki, the discharge capacity of BS Link was proposed to be raised to 25,000 cs.
Some aging effects were also noted.
A rehabilitation proposal was therefore made to address the above shortcomings. The
proposal comprised the following:
a) In order to increase the barrage capacity construction of an auxiliary weir in line
with the existing barrage with a discharge capacity equal to the difference
between maximum design flood and the existing capacity of the barrage.
b) Rehabilitation of the downstream floor.
c) Addition of bays to head regulator of BS Link.
d) Miscellaneous rehabilitation works.
5.25.7.1 Implementation
The above proposal was approved and implemented through a Project Management
Unit (PMU) established for the execution of the Balloki-LBDC project with the financial
assistance of Asian Development Bank (ADB). The project is close to completion at
the time of rendering this write-up.
5.25.7.2 Post Rehabilitation Feedback
Since the rehabilitated works have not been commissioned as yet, the post
rehabilitation feedback is obtained later on after commissioning of the project.
Sulemanki Barrage
Sulemanki barrage was constructed across the Sutlej River near Haveli Lakha town
with discharge capacity of 325,000 cs in 1926. The width of the barrage between
abutments is 2223 feet.
The feasibility study and its upgradation established that:
i. The barrage capacity is less than the maximum flood discharge of 430,000 cs
established through a hydrological study.
ii. The barrage was heavily masked on the upstream side with a large bela build
up in the left half of the barrage. In addition the left side canals especially
Fordwah, suffered with high sediment entry and siltation of bed.
iii. The barrage did not have an upstream floor, nor a sheet pile at the beginning
of the upstream glacis.
iv. Due to abrasive action of high velocity currents, the downstream glacis and the
stilling basin floor had developed deep runnels, and in many areas even the
coarse aggregate had been dislodged.
v. The undersluice gates had been corroded badly and the hoisting systems and
grooves of the whole barrage needed major rehabilitation.
MANUAL OF IRRIGATION PRACTICE 5-269
BARRAGES
vi. The canal regulator Walton type gates were damaged frequently causing a
couple of emergencies every year.
vii. The pressure pipes were inoperative and needed replacement.
The updated feasibility study recommended the following modifications:
i. Provision of a level floor of 20 feet with a sheet pile line on the upstream.
ii. Covering the downstream glacis and downstream floor with 3 inch thick 4000
psi fiber reinforced shotcrete.
iii. Installing new vibrating wire piezometers in the downstream floor.
iv. Remodeling of undersluice gates.
v. Replacement of canal regulator gates.
vi. Rehabilitation of the weir gates and replacement of hoisting arrangements.
vii. Partial removal of the bela masking the upstream left side of the barrage.
viii. Raising of guide banks to provide adequate freeboard over the new designed
HFL.
ix. Improving the electrification system at the barrage.
x. Provision of a bye-pass spill weir system to dispose of the flood discharge in
excess of the design capacity.
A project including the above proposal except the last one was prepared and
approved. It was considered that item (x) could be constructed later with local funding.
5.25.8.1 Implementation
The project is being implemented with financial assistance from ADB through an
international contract and at the time of this write-up about 60% has been completed.
The project is planned to be completed by April 2017.
Trimmu Barrage
The Trimmu Barrage originally named as “Emerson Barrage” was constructed during
1936-1938 about 2 miles downstream of the confluence of Chenab and Jhelum rivers.
The designed discharge capacity of the barrage is 645,000 cs. The clear waterway of
the barrage is 2640 ft and the width between abutments is 3025 ft. Flood discharges
more than the design capacity have been experienced quite a few times requiring
operation of breaching section. With the development of the area, generally affected
by the escapage from breaching section, high resistance is likely to be exhibited by
the residents. The Feasibility Consultants proposed the following modifications:
i. Extension of the barrage waterway to accommodate the total flood discharge
of 800,000 cs with allied works of reconstruction of right guide bank, head
regulator of Rangpur canal and connected bridges.
ii. Rehabilitative repairs to the components of the existing barrage structure.
iii. Improving the road bridge deck; and
iv. Rehabilitation of regulating gates and gearings.
Based on the above, a project has been prepared and approved. The Consultants
have been retained and the construction contract signed with M/s. Sinohydro
Corporation of China. The project is planned to be completed in four years.
MANUAL OF IRRIGATION PRACTICE 5-270
BARRAGES
Panjnad Barrage
Panjnad barrage was constructed during 1928 to 1932 about 3 miles below the
confluence of Chenab and Sutlej rivers near Alipur Town in Muzaffargarh district. The
design capacity of the barrage is 700,000 cs. The clear waterway is 2820 ft and the
total 3400 ft between abutments. Like Trimmu, Panjnad has also experienced/passed
flood discharges over and above the design capacity necessitating operation of
breaching section on the right side causing heavy loss to private properties and public
infrastructures. Consequently, a feasibility study was carried out which mainly
recommended conversion of the junction groyne into low crested bays to raise the
barrage capacity to 865,000 cs.
The project PC-1 has been approved and the Consultants have been retained but the
construction contract is likely to be signed around July 2017.
Islam Barrage
Islam barrage also known as “Pallah Headworks” was constructed during 1926 to 1928
on the Sutlej river near Luddan village in Vehari district on the right side and Hasilpur
in Bahawalpur district on the left side. The barrage capacity is 300,000 cs.
According to the updated feasibility study, the barrage capacity has to be increased
and the sub-weir constructed in 1951-1952 has to be remodeled along with
replacement of dislodged friction blocks. The regulation gates also need major
rehabilitative repairs.
The project at the moment is dormant/inactive but is likely to be taken up on completion
of Trimmu barrage project.
Khanki Weir
Khanki weir is the fore runner of the canal feeding weirs completed in 1892 on the
Chenab river near Wazirabad town. The feasibility study established that the weir had
outlived its useful life and should be replaced with a new barrage. Accordingly a project
was approved for Rs. 23 billion and construction work is in progress through an
international contract with the financial assistance from ADB. The project is going to
complete by 30th June 2017.
MANUAL OF IRRIGATION PRACTICE 5-271
BARRAGES
inadequate drainage below the floor or any locked up pressure due to clay pockets or
the downstream cut-off embedded in to an impermeable layer.
Failures due to eruption of floor caused by uplift exceeding gravity have occurred in
Narora weir (1898), Marala weir (1934), Rasul weir on Jhelum river (1929), Deoha
barrage (1929), Khanki weir (1932) and sarda barrage (1956). Punjnad barrage came
close to such a situation in 1955.
Remedial measures for such failure include in increasing the thickness of the floor with
due consideration for adequate cistern level for proper energy dissipation, grouting of
cavities formed, if any, and lengthening the upstream floor so that the percentage
pressures at key points, especially over the trough region can be reduced by
increasing the seepage path.
Formation of deep scours
Sometimes deep scours occur either or both on the upstream and downstream of the
floor. Failure occurs if the cut offs both on the upstream and downstream, are not
provided for adequate depths. Deep scour is caused by high intensity of discharge
through the structure. This may be due to inadequate waterway or faulty gate
regulation. If proper flexible protections are not provided, the foundation soil is
removed due to deep scour and consequently the structure fails. Scours also occur
due to improper energy dissipation.
Failures due to improper energy dissipation and formation of deep scour have
occurred at Islam weir on the Sutlej river (1929), Khanki weir (1932), Anderson weir
(1935), Marala weir (1934), Sarda Barrage (1956) and some Mississippi weirs in USA.
When such a failure occurs, it is necessary to lower the cistern level and provide
adequate energy dissipating arrangements, such as end sill, dentated sill, friction
blocks, chute blocks etc. The depth of the upstream and downstream cut-offs should
be adequate for scour mitigation. The upstream and downstream aprons should be
properly replenished to the designed values. Steeper glacis slopes may need to be
flattened to at-least 3:1.
Faulty regulation
Failures have also occurred due to faulty operation of gates, resulting in high
concentration of flow through the structure. In such a situation, energy dissipation is
not proper and deep scour occurs. Sometimes damages may occur due to one or
other causes mentioned earlier, but the gates might have been lowered giving priority
to feeding the canals. This may ultimately result in major damages, as happened at
Islam weir on Sutlej river in 1929.
In 2012/2013, mal-regulation caused major damages to the downstream pervious
protections at Taunsa Barrage.
Failure due to faulty gate regulation can be prevented only by training the operating
personnel about the significance of proper regulation and proper maintenance of gates
and other hoisting arrangements.
Faulty construction
Failures of diversion structure due to faulty construction are common. Faulty
construction also leads to other causes of failures, such as piping below the floor,
uplifting of floor due to uplift pressure, faulty regulation etc. Various items for faulty
construction include (i) stratification of concrete layers in the pucca floor and improper
MANUAL OF IRRIGATION PRACTICE 5-273
BARRAGES
bond between different layers of concrete (ii) various construction and structural
design defects (iii) cracks in the downstream glacis leading to short circuiting of
seepage path (iv) improper foundation treatment leading to subsidence and
consequent disturbance in the alignment of gate track and jamming (v) cracking of
seal in the joints (vi) tearing of sheet piles and improper interlocking (vii) improper
foundation treatment of impervious layers leading to locked up seepage pressure (viii)
inadequate cover for reinforcement bars (ix) honey combing of bottom layers of floor
concrete and (x) improper concrete mix used resulting in structural failure.
In the recent past failures due to faulty construction include Islam weir (1929), Rasul
weir (1929), Anderson weir (1935), Marala weir (1934) and Taunsa Barrage several
times from 1962 to 2004.
Overtopping
Failures due to overtopping of the components of the diversion structure are mainly
due to estimation of the design flood. This results in more afflux than the estimated
amount and with less freeboard. There are a few instances where overtopping was
caused due to inadequate free board. Overtopping of guide bunds has occurred and
this coupled with faulty construction leads to collapse of the guide bunds and further
associate damages. When the top of the piers or abutments are not set properly,
damages to the bearings of road and rail bridges occur due to overtopping leading to
failures.
Remedial measures or rather preventive measures to avoid failures due to overtopping
include correct determination of the design flood for waterway and maximum flood for
free board and the provision of adequate freeboards all along.
Outflanking
Failures due to outflanking are related to the incorrect estimation of the flood discharge
and subsequent overtopping of afflux bunds, tie bunds, etc. Another reason may be
the improper location of the diversion structure in geologically weak spots, especially
the banks. On highly meandering rivers, if marginal embankments and jacketing of the
rivers are not done properly, failure due to outflanking cannot be ruled out. Improper
gate operation can also lead to outflanking and failures thereof. Inadequate length and
unsuitable geometry of upstream guide banks can also result into outflanking of the
barrage.
Record of failures and remedial measures
For each diversion structure, a barrage or weir, it is desirable to have a record of its
behavior, both hydraulic and structural. The record should contain, the relevant details
of its failures, if any, and remedial measures adopted from time to time. Necessary
relevant photos should also be available. These always help for future modifications,
needed for the structure and also for others components.
Data to be collected in the event of a failure
Whenever there is a failure of the diversion structure, necessary data have to be
collected for study and analysis so that suitable remedial measures can be adopted.
Such data includes the following:
i. Detailed drawings of the diversion structure, regulators, guide bunds, afflux
bunds, approach bunds, spurs, etc.
MANUAL OF IRRIGATION PRACTICE 5-274
BARRAGES
ii. Detailed notes on the damages including history and remedial measures
carried out if any.
iii. Development of the damages.
iv. Photographs taken if any.
v. Discharge and water levels at various locations along the guide bunds, afflux
bunds, approach bunds, spurs, abutments, etc.
vi. Flow pattern observed, i.e. concentration of flow through some bays or
otherwise.
vii. Sounding data both upstream and downstream at the ends of the impervious
structure, cement concrete blocks, stone protection, around divide walls and for
a distance of 200 ft or so at 50 ft intervals.
viii. Gate operation during floods and at other times.
ix. Any seismicity experienced prior to or during the floods.
x. Data on settlement of piers, abutments, flank walls etc.
xi. Data on tilting of piers, divide walls, abutments, flank walls etc.
xii. Quantity and quality of bed materials and floating debris during the flood.
xiii. Details of upstream and downstream spurs.
xiv. Data on traffic over the structure during the floods.
xv. Details of constructions materials used including quality of construction for
various components including the different bunds.
xvi. Instrumentation data.
xvii. Details about stages of construction.
xviii. Details of any field investigations done for detecting hollows if any, and, results
thereof.
xix. Previous history of any damages and remedial measures thereof.
xx. Recommendations of any Technical Advisory Committee from time to time and
compliance.
xxi. Hydraulic and structural designs with assumptions made if any.
xxii. Any other data relevant to the ease under investigations.
After working out the necessary remedial measures and implementing them, it is
desirable to publish the causes of failures and remedial measures adopted in an article
for the benefit of designers and project authorities of the department and other
professionals working in the field /area.
MANUAL OF IRRIGATION PRACTICE 5-275
BARRAGES
to leave his duty station, except under really pressing conditions and that too
with a proper substitute arrangement.
xv. To exercise control in selection and appointment of the working staff.
xvi. To prepare and submit reports pertaining to accidents to persons or property in
accordance with the rules or instructions in force.
xvii. To coordinate with other agencies and execute all measures necessary for the
security of the headworks complex that is a high category key point of National
Strategic importance for which he is the senior security officer and is the only
person having access to secret instructions for barrage safety.
xviii. During very high floods the Executive Engineer will camp at the barrage so as
to be available to meet any emergency without loss of time.
The above instructions are practiced in addition to the general administrative and
executive responsibilities of the Executive Engineer.
Sub Divisional Officer Head Works
The Sub Divisional Officer (SDO) Headworks is the officer in direct control of the
Headworks. He performs his duties under the administrative and technical control of
the Executive Engineer of the Barrage Division and shall be responsible but not limited
to.
i. To give and provide all necessary superintendence required in proper
maintenance, control and safe operation of the Headworks.
ii. To obtain instructions from the Executive Engineer as and when he is in any
doubt or encounters any difficulty.
iii. For speedy and methodical execution of all instructions issued by the Executive
Engineer.
iv. To assist the Executive Engineer in the selection and appointment of regulation
staff.
v. For the organization and discipline of the entire staff under him in all respects,
especially training, allocation of duties, performance, maintenance of discipline
etc.
vi. For regulation of the river and canals in accordance with the regulation rules,
instructions of the Executive Engineer or instructions of the Authority that may
be nominated from time to time for regulation of diversions into the canals.
vii. To issue all important instructions for regulation of the river and canals to the
Sub Engineer Barrage either in writing or by inscribing in the English Logbook.
viii. To inspect English and Urdu Logbooks as frequently as he visits the Headworks
(at least once a day) to ensure that the operational data is recorded properly
and accurately and to record his findings and orders in the Logbooks as and
when he inspects them.
ix. To complete and study weather forecasts or warnings, promptly discuss his
assessments thereof with the Executive Engineer and make a beneficial use of
them in programming the regulation.
x. To check and scrutinize the silt sounding registers daily during the high flow
period i.e. April through October and once a week during the low supply period
MANUAL OF IRRIGATION PRACTICE 5-277
BARRAGES
October through March and shall promptly bring all matters of concern to the
attention of the Executive Engineer for obtaining his instructions.
xi. To issue flood warnings to all concerned.
xii. To immediately communicate to the Executive Engineer of the Division,
personally when Executive Engineer is at Headquarters or by the speediest
possible means when Executive Engineer is out of station, all events of
significant importance like any damage to Headworks components, high flood
discharges and the action considered necessary to mitigate the damages, or
any accident of a serious nature to a person or property etc.
xiii. To ensure that the gates, and operating gears etc. are maintained and operated
in accordance with the instructions prescribed for each and shall cause
necessary checks to be made under his direct supervision.
xiv. To exercise frequent and effective field checks on the data observations,
sounding and surveys conducted in maintenance and operation of the
Headworks.
xv. To submit by the 5th date of each calendar month, a report about the
maintenance and operation of the Headworks during the preceding month.
xvi. To check in person and in accordance with the prescribed rules and instructions
the works proposed in maintenance, repairs and renewals.
xvii. To supervise in person once in a calendar month or as ordered from time to
time observations of piezometers and other support data.
xviii. To analyze the piezometer data and to promptly submit the record of
observations and his analysis to the Executive Engineer for his scrutiny and to
report immediately in person any unwary results to the Executive Engineer.
xix. To conduct in person testing and calibration of piezometers.
xx. He will not be away from Headquarters during high flood season from July
through September both months inclusive without written permission of the
Executive Engineer.
xxi. To stay all the time at the Headworks and to arrange regulation of the barrage
and regulators gates under his direct supervision as and when the flood
discharge is in the high flood or higher limits and to continue till the flood drops
below the aforesaid limit.
xxii. To exercise surprise check on the staff for duty between 10 P.M. and 4 A.M. at
least once a week during the high flow period and once in a fortnight during
other periods of the year and to record the findings of his check in the English
or Urdu Logbooks, and also report to the Executive Engineer.
xxiii. To arrange and ensure that telephone contact with the regulation room is
maintained with least disturbance and to take particular care during the flood
period of July through September that faults, if any, are speedily corrected.
xxiv. To act as the security Officer for the Headworks complex where he shall enforce
Security Standing Orders instituted from time to time by the Government under
guidance by Executive Engineer, the Senior Security Officer.
MANUAL OF IRRIGATION PRACTICE 5-278
BARRAGES
xvi. To maintain gates and gearing / hoisting equipment and other mechanical and
electrical installations in accordance with "Operating and Maintenance
Instructions for gates and gearing"
xvii. To arrange and ensure that the regulation staff is well trained in operation and
maintenance of the gates and operating gears and to frequently exercise
efficiency checks.
xviii. To frequently check the gates and operating gears by operation under his
supervision and to ensure that they all are in operational condition good to meet
any Flood emergency.
xix. To observe soundings, probing etc of all works in his charge in accordance with
the practices set in O&M Manual or as directed from time to time by Executive
Engineer or the SDO.
xx. To exercise regular checks on all works in his charge and to speedily execute
all works in repairs, maintenance and renewals that may be entrusted to him.
xxi. To observe piezometers in accordance with the instructions in practice,
complete residual pressure percentages from the observed data and to submit
the observed and computed data in prescribed Performa to SDO Headworks
and to bring any unwary increase residual pressures to the notice of SDO or
the Executive Engineer.
xxii. To immediately inform the SDO in case of any unexpected or unusual increase
in river discharge.
xxiii. Not to leave the Headquarters without written permission of the Executive
Engineer during the high flow period of June through September.
xxiv. To instruct the Head Boatman to place the boats and motor launch etc at
suitable berthing places when flood is expected.
xxv. To see that all the navigation equipment (motor launch, boats etcare in working
order; that life jackets are available on them.
xxvi. To maintain in good condition and to account for all the reserve materials in his
charge and also to maintain in best working order and account all the Tools and
Plants being used for operation and maintenance of the barrage.
xxvii. To see that rules governing fishing are properly enforced. This includes that
even licensees are not authorized to enter into the Headworks area without the
permission of Executive Engineer/SDO Headworks.
xxviii. To prevent any person other than an official on duty from approaching and
passing over the overhead bridge, regulation points, divide walls and entry in
the security area, two miles upstream and one mile on the downstream of the
barrage gate line.
xxix. To assist the SDO in enforcing Security rules at the Headworks.
Sub Engineer Hydraulic
Role of The Sub Engineer is to assist SDO Headworks with respect to the hydraulic
observations such as silt entry in the off-taking canals, silt depths in the pockets and
in the head reaches of canals as well as discharge observation for calibration of rating
curve. His responsibilities include among others the following:
MANUAL OF IRRIGATION PRACTICE 5-280
BARRAGES
i. Collection and analysis of water, sediment samples as well as bed load sample
from the pockets, downstream of head regulators of the off-taking canals;
upstream and downstream of silt ejectors in the canal and in their off taking
channels at least once every day or as directed by the SDO.
ii. Will immediately bring to the notice of the SDO Headworks and Sub Engineer
Headworks whenever silt entry (coarse and medium sand) in any canal
exceeds the carrying capacity of any canal.
iii. A regular and proper record of silt data shall also be maintained by him. The
resulting data and the efficiency of the ejector shall be worked out and recorded
in register to be maintained for the purpose of silt analysis at Divisional Office.
iv. Observation of silt depth in the pockets and head reaches of the three off taking
canals and plotting of results on weekly basis or as directed specifically by the
SDO.
v. Observation of meteorological data such as rainfall, temperature, humidity etc
and maintaining proper record for the same.
vi. Discharge observations at the demarcated sites of the canals on weekly basis
or as directed by the SDO.
vii. Sounding and probing before and after the floods at locations demarcated by
the SDO. This data along with previous observations shall also be plotted in
different colors to bring out the damages etc.
viii. After the flood season, say in November, he will start detailed annual river
survey in a reach 23 Km (15 miles) upstream & 15 Km (10 miles) downstream
of the barrage and observe spot levels on various cross section lines at 1.6 Km
(1mile) apart and delineate all the creeks and belas5.
ix. To maintain an account for the reserve stock of stone on works that may be in
his charge.
x. To check attendance as frequently as possible and performance of all the staff
under his charge.
Sub Engineer Mechanical
The Sub Engineer Mechanical shall be incharge of the Workshop and all mechanical
and electrical instructions. He shall perform his duties under the technical and
administrative control of the SDO Headworks and is responsible for but not limited to:
i. To operate and maintain the workshop and equipment installed there in
accordance with the established workshop practices, and to execute all other
tasks that may be entrusted to him from time to time by the SDO Headworks.
ii. To maintain and operate the mechanical and electrical plants such as pumping
plants, electric generator, compressors and welding equipment etc used in
operation and maintenance of the Headworks.
iii. To assist Sub Engineer Headworks in identification and rectification of the
defects in the Barrage gates and operating gears as and when directed by the
SDO Headworks.
5 Bela is a silt deposit in the form of a high level exposed shoal with vegetation
MANUAL OF IRRIGATION PRACTICE 5-281
BARRAGES
xii. Keep a watch on entry of unauthorized persons on the Barrage piers, fish
ladders and overhead bridge etc.
xiii. Keep a watch on the floating material approaching the barrage especially for
mines and subversive activities.
xiv. Keep a constant watch on the pond level. It should not be allowed to be abruptly
lowered or raised because in both the cases it can be dangerous to the barrage
components and hazardous to other works on the upstream and downstream.
xv. Make sure that while raising or lowering of upstream pond levels the head
across the barrage is within permissible limits. Even for short period, unless
requested in writing by the Executive Engineer, the limit shall not be exceeded.
xvi. Take extra care to guard against leakages through the bunds located on the
upstream of the barrage and/or sloughing of their slopes when pond level is
high.
xvii. Keep a constant eye on the formation of hydraulic jump (be it low supply period
or flood season) and no where in the undersluice or weir bay it should be
allowed to cross the toe of glacis. Also if there is abnormal turbulence on the
downstream pervious floor or river bed downstream of the floors it should be
reported to the officers.
xviii. Watch the working of Barrage gates by operating few of them every day so that
they can be easily raised and lowered at all times.
xix. Watch for any structural development and report them immediately to officers.
Naib Jamadar
He is responsible for:
i. Neatly maintaining the Urdu Log Book in accordance with the instructions in
force and to arrange and ensure that the entries made in the Urdu log book are
on the basis of physical observations and that all regulation messages and
instructions, weather conditions; river-conditions, floods etc are suitably
incorporated in the Log Book.
ii. Regular inspect of all gauges at the barrage and in the canals to ensure that
they are in serviceable condition.
iii. Obtaining regulation instructions from Head Jamadar, Sub Engineer / SDO
Headworks if and when there is any confusion or ambiguity.
iv. Reporting to the Sub Engineer Headworks any damage or injury to the property
or persons immediately as and when it is noticed by him or brought to his
attention.
v. Arranging and ensuring that no one except the duty staff is allowed to go up the
high deck or fish ladders etc, except with the permission of SDO Headworks.
Head Boatman
The head boatman is responsible for:
i. Maintenance and proper repairs of all the navigation equipment in his charge.
MANUAL OF IRRIGATION PRACTICE 5-283
BARRAGES
ii. Making sure that the crew under him is sturdy and excellent swimmers and well
conversant with the temperament and general behavior of the river they are
required to navigate.
iii. Every sort of misconduct or any indiscipline in the men under his charge.
Headworks Mistry
He must be a seasoned hand, well conversant with the maintenance of masonry
works, leveling, observations of pressure pipes and other observations as
soundings, probing so that he is able to help the SDO and Sub Engineers.
MANUAL OF IRRIGATION PRACTICE 5-284
BARRAGES
REFERENCES:
1. Ayoob S.M. and Ali C.M., Alignment and Shape of A Spur Head, Proceedings
of Pakistan Engineering Congress, (1975).
2. Verma C.V.J. et. al., River Behaviour Management and Training, Volume I,
Central Board of Irrigation and Power, New Dehli, India, (1989).
3. Chohan M.A. et. al, Some Experiments on Shape of Spurs, CIV-CON-87/5,
Institution of Engineers, Pakistan.
4. Sharma K.R., Irrigation Engineering, Volume I, India Printers, India, (1959).
5. HASKONING, DELFT HYDRAULICS and NESPAK, Joint Venture Consultants,
First Flood Protection Sector Project, Final Report, (1997).
6. Public Works Department, Government of Sindh, Bund Manual (4th Edition
2008).
7. Zaidi S.M.A., Wind Generated Waves and Their Effects on River Bunds,
Proceedings of Pakistan Engineering Congress. (1978).
8. Harr M.E., Groundwater and Seepage, McGraw-Hill Book Company, (1962).
9. Pakistan Engineering Congress, Golden Jubilee Publication 1963.
10. Spring F.J.E. River Training and Control of Large Rivers 1903.
11. U.S. Army Corps of Engineers, Waterways Experiment Station, Vicksburg,
Mississippi, USA, Hydraulic Design Criteria (1988).
12. Maynard S.T., Riprap Design Guidance for Channel Protection, Seminar on
River Training Works, Irrigation Research Institute, Lahore, Pakistan, (1996).
13. U.S. Army Corps of Engineers, Coastal Engineering Research Center,
Vicksuburg, Mississippi, USA, Shore protection Manual (1984).
14. Saville T. et.al., Freeboard Allowance for Waves in Inland Reservoirs,
Proceeding of ASCE, ( May, 1962).
15. Taylor K.V., Slope protection on Earth and Rockfill Dams, Commission
International Des Grands Barrages, Madrid , ( 1973).
16. Tomlinson. M. J., Foundation Design and Construction
17. Bell, F. G., Ground Engineer’s Reference Book
18. Peck, R. B., Hanson, W. E. and Thornburn. T.H. Foundation Engineering
19. Leonards G-E, Foundation Engineering hand book
20. HR Wallingford, August, Groynes and Training Works Affecting River Planform,
A literature Review, Report SR229, 1990.
21. Pugh C.A, Hydraulic Model Studies of Fuse Plug Embankments, USBR, (1985).
22. Luna B.A. and Choudhry M.A., Estimation of Discharge through Breach in Flood
Embankment, Technical Note, Irrigation Research Institute (IRI). Lahore,
(1973).
23. Teng W.C., Foundation Design, Prentice-Hall, Inc., USA.
24. Qureshi M.S. and Akbar A, Fundamentals of Soil Mechanics, A-One Publishers,
Pakistan, (1997).
25. Hoffmans G.J. C.M and Verheij H.J, Scour Manual, A. A. Blkema, Rotterdam,
Netherlands, (1997).
26. Pemberton E.L. and Lara J.M., Computing Degradation and Local Scour,
Technical Guideline, USBR, (1984).
27. Farraday R. V. and Charlton F.G., Hydraulics Research, Willingford, U.K.,
(1983).
28. Chaudhry G.Q. Thesis on Scour At River Training Wall and Bridge Pier ,
Department of Civil Engineering University of Newcastle upon Tyne, U.K.
,(1997).
MANUAL OF IRRIGATION PRACTICE 5-285
BARRAGES
Chapter 6
DESIGN OF UNLINED
CANALS
Compiled by
Reviewed by
Table of Content
6 DESIGN OF UNLINED CANALS ..................................................................... 6-1
6.1 IRRIGATION CANALS .............................................................................. 6-1
6.1.1 Design Discharge of a Canal ................................................................. 6-2
6.1.2 Cropping Pattern and Intensity .............................................................. 6-3
6.1.3 Crop Water Requirements ..................................................................... 6-4
6.1.4 Conveyance Losses ............................................................................ 6-10
6.1.5 Field Losses ........................................................................................ 6-11
6.1.6 Reclamation Requirements ................................................................. 6-11
6.1.7 Water Allowance ................................................................................. 6-12
6.1.8 Chakbandi ........................................................................................... 6-13
6.2 DESIGN WATER LEVEL......................................................................... 6-17
6.3 CANAL DESIGN THEORIES .................................................................. 6-21
6.3.1 Kennedy Theory .................................................................................. 6-21
6.3.2 Lindley's Approach (1919): .................................................................. 6-22
6.3.3 Lacey Regime Theory ......................................................................... 6-22
6.3.4 Classification of Regimes of Canals .................................................... 6-24
6.3.5 Simons and Albertson Regime Method (1957): ................................... 6-25
6.3.6 Kirmani Modifications for Design of Link Canals ................................. 6-26
6.3.7 Tractive Force Theory ......................................................................... 6-26
6.3.8 Practice for Design of Canals in Punjab Irrigation Department............ 6-27
6.4 SILT FACTOR FOR PUNJAB CANALS................................................... 6-34
SOURCE: IRRIGATION ENGINEERING BY DR. IQBAL ALI (1975 - PAGE 114) ................ 6-35
6.5 SEDIMENT EXCLUSION AND EJECTION ............................................. 6-35
6.5.1 Sediment Deposition ........................................................................... 6-36
6.5.2 Hydraulic Survey of Irrigation Channels .............................................. 6-36
6.5.3 Inspection of main canals and works during annual canal closure ...... 6-36
6.6 SOLVED DESIGN EXAMPLE FOR EARTHEN CANAL .......................... 6-37
6.7 DESIGN CURVES USED IN CANAL DESIGN ........................................ 6-40
6.8 BERM FORMATION ..................................................................................... 6-53
6.8.1 Longitudinal Spurs ............................................................................... 6-54
6.8.2 Cross Spurs......................................................................................... 6-55
6.8.3 Hanging Spurs..................................................................................... 6-55
6.9 OTHER CANAL STRUCTURES ...................................................................... 6-56
6.9.1 Foot Bridges ........................................................................................ 6-56
6.9.2 Village Road Bridges ........................................................................... 6-56
6.9.3 District Road Bridges ........................................................................... 6-56
6.9.4 Arterial Road Bridges .......................................................................... 6-56
6.9.5 Syphon ................................................................................................ 6-56
6.9.6 Culvert ................................................................................................. 6-56
6.9.7 Super Passage .................................................................................... 6-56
6.9.8 Drainage Inlet ...................................................................................... 6-56
6.10 CANAL ROAD ............................................................................................ 6-57
6.10.1 Patrol and Non-Patrol Banks for Canals .......................................... 6-57
6.10.2 Right of Way (ROW) and RD Mark .................................................. 6-57
REFERENCES CITED – UNLINED CANAL ......................................................... 6-61
iv MANUAL OF IRRIGATION PRACTICE
DESIGN OF UNLINED CANALS
List of Tables
TABLE 6.1: KHARIF FULL SUPPLY FACTORS ............................................................... 6-12
TABLE 6.2: SANCTIONED WATER ALLOWANCE FOR PUNJAB CANALS ......................... 6-12
TABLE 6.3: MINIMUM FREE BOARD (FB) .................................................................... 6-13
TABLE 6.4: CAPACITY STATEMENT ............................................................................ 6-17
TABLE 6.5: COMMAND STATEMENT ........................................................................... 6-19
TABLE 6.6: DRAW OFF STATEMENT........................................................................... 6-20
TABLE 6.7: VARIATION OF PERMISSIBLE TRACTIVE FORCE WITH TYPE OF SOIL ............. 6-27
TABLE 6.8: TRACTIVE FORCES RECOMMENDED FOR FINE NON-COHESIVE SOILS .......... 6-27
TABLE 6.9: RANGE OF RESISTANCE FACTORS ............................................................. 6-34
TABLE 6.10: AVERAGE VALUES OF SILT FACTOR ........................................................ 6-35
TABLE 6.11: RECOMMENDED W IDTH OF CANAL BANKS ............................................... 6-57
List of Figures
FIGURE 6.1: TYPICAL IRRIGATION CANAL SYSTEM ........................................................ 6-2
FIGURE 6.2: UNLINED CANAL IN OPERATION ................................................................ 6-3
FIGURE 6.3: TYPES OF CROPS .................................................................................... 6-5
FIGURE 6.4: TYPICAL FLOW CHART FOR ESTIMATION OF IRRIGATION W ATER
REQUIREMENTS FROM CLIMATIC DATA ................................................................. 6-6
FIGURE 6.5: BED FORMS IN ALLUVIAL CHANNELS ....................................................... 6-30
FIGURE 6.6: SCHEMATIC VARIATION OF FRICTION FACTOR Ƒ WITH BED FORMS [BASED ON
DATA ON D = 0.28 MM] ...................................................................................... 6-32
FIGURE 6.7: SCHEMATIC PROFILE OF T.P. LINK ......................................................... 6-32
FIGURE 6.8: UPPER DEPALPUR CANAL SYSTEM ......................................................... 6-33
FIGURE 6.9: TYPICAL SEDIMENT DEPOSITION AND BERM EROSION .............................. 6-53
FIGURE 6.10: REBUILDING BERM .............................................................................. 6-53
FIGURE 6.11: KILLA BUSHING TECHNIQUES ............................................................... 6-54
FIGURE 6.12: TYPICAL HANGING SPUR...................................................................... 6-55
FIGURE 6.13: TYPICAL SECTIONS OF MAIN CANAL & BRANCH CANAL .......................... 6-58
FIGURE 6.14: TYPICAL CROSS SECTION OF A W ATER COURSE ................................... 6-59
FIGURE 6.15: TYPICAL CROSS SECTION OF A DISTRIBUTARY....................................... 6-60
MANUAL OF IRRIGATION PRACTICE 6-1
DESIGN OF UNLINED CANALS
The cotton and rice crops needs relatively impervious soils. The crops needing more
water shall be grown in the season when rainfall is available. The market values of
crops are also helpful in the selection of the crop. The socio-economic aspects of the
region with special requirements can also be an important factor. The cropping pattern
in the Punjab province consists of Kharif and Rabi Crops and also the perennial crops
such as sugarcane and orchards (Figure 6.3 – Types of Crops). In the Punjab province
normally rice, wheat rotation is practiced in the upper part of the province and cotton,
wheat rotation is adopted in the southern part of the province. The selection of the
crops should be carefully made for the design of the system.
Intensity of irrigation is the percentage of the cultivable irrigation area, irrigated during
the given period of each year. The entire Cultivable Command Area (CCA) is generally
not irrigated. Normally irrigation intensity is fixed separately for Kharif crops (April to
September) and Rabi Crops (October to March). Generally in the Punjab Province
because of shortage of irrigation water, the design intensity for the year is adopted as
60 to 70% (Kharif to Rabi ratio 1:2). There are certain areas in the Punjab where the
average existing irrigation intensity is in the range of 125% to 150% and in some areas
it touches the figure of 200% where canal water is supplemented by ground water.
The general experience is as the intensity of irrigation increases the irrigation
management becomes difficult. Some of the times there is problem of salinity or of
water logging. The fertility of the soil is also decreased with time.
6.1.3 Crop Water Requirements
Crop water requirements may be defined as the depth of water needed to meet the
water loss through evaporation from the soil and transpiration from the plant of a
disease free crop, growing in large field under non-restricting soil conditions including
soil water and fertility and achieving full production potential under the given growing
environments. The combination of water lost from the soil surface by evaporation and
water used by the crop by transpiration is referred to as evapotranspiration (ET).
Computation of water requirements for irrigation crops is fundamental in design of an
irrigation canal system and for scheduling of irrigation in the project area. The pattern
of crop water use determines the capacities of the reservoirs. This information is also
used for determining the volume of the water required for meeting monthly and
seasonal water requirements for fields, farms and the project as a whole. In addition,
this information is essential for most water rights transfer from agriculture to other uses
and helps in regional allocation of irrigation water.
Water is essential for plant growth. However, too little and too much water adversely
affects plant growth. In areas of low rainfall, irrigation is applied to supplement crop
water needed. The main objective of irrigation is to supply the plant with the
appropriate amount of water at the proper time for its normal growth. The other
considerations, through equally important, are the control of groundwater at a safe
depth below the root zone and leaching of excess salts from the root zone area.
The Irrigation Delta values for important crops are as under:
Crop Irrigation Delta
Rice 44 inches (111.76 cm)
Sugarcane 40 inches (101.6 cm)
Cotton 20 inches (50.8 cm)
Wheat 12 inches (30.48 cm)
Maize 18 inches (45.72 cm)
MANUAL OF IRRIGATION PRACTICE 6-5
DESIGN OF UNLINED CANALS
The irrigation engineer or agricultural scientist should make sure that the definition of
Evapotranspiration, being used is completely understood and that written
documentation carefully identifies the basic definitions used in calculations, design, or
reports. Actual ‘E’ is estimated using equation here under:
Et = KcEtr or Et = KcEto
‘E’ refers to reference crop Et based on alfalfa and ‘E’ refers to reference crop
Et based on grass.
Figure 6.4: Typical Flow Chart for Estimation of Irrigation Water Requirements
from Climatic Data
Et is the principal factor in determining irrigation water requirements, but losses in
storage, conveyance and applying water, the inability to apply water uniformly, and the
need for soil leaching are additional factors. The planning and operation of irrigation
systems must take all these factors into consideration in determining water
requirements.
MANUAL OF IRRIGATION PRACTICE 6-7
DESIGN OF UNLINED CANALS
Water allowance may have to be determined for separate tracts if the project area is
very large and prevailing conditions differ substantially.
After working out the water allowance for the various portions, the capacity of each
outlet is determined on the basis of the area under the command of each outlet. The
design discharge for each outlet is added and then by adding the losses in each
portion, the design discharge for various canal sections is fixed. The bed width, depth
and slope are thus calculated for each portion, and all the information is provided on
a drawing given the profile or longitudinal section of canal.
6.1.4 Conveyance Losses
Water enters the main canal at the Head works / Barrage through the head regulator
and flows through the branches, distributaries and the water courses and finally
reaches the field. Throughout its journey, there are continuous water losses which
have to be accounted for the design of channels. These losses are considerable,
especially in unlined canals. In some cases, the losses may be as high as one-quarter
to one-half of the water diverted in the main canal.
The losses in irrigation channels are mainly of the following types:
Absorption losses
Percolation (or seepage) losses
Evaporation losses
Transpiration losses.
Absorption and Percolation losses from the canal mainly depend upon the following
factors:
i) Permeability of Soil: The greater is the permeability of the soil in the
bed and banks of the channel, the greater are the losses.
ii) Depth of Water: The greater is the depth of water in the canal, the
greater are the losses.
iii) Velocity of Water: The losses decrease with an increase in the velocity
of flow in the channel.
iv) Amount of Silt: The losses decrease with an increase in the amount of
silt carried by the canal water.
v) Temperature of Water: The losses increase with an increase in
temperature of water because its viscosity decreases and the
permeability of soil is also increased.
vi) Age of the Channel: The losses are large in newly constructed
channels and they reduce as silt gets deposited with the passage of time
and relatively impervious silt layer is formed on the bed. This is also
called natural sealing of pores of soil.
vii) Level of the Ground Water Table: The losses depend on the position
of the water table with respect to the canal bed. The losses are more
when the water table is deep.
The empirical formula to calculate seepage loss in earthen channels is as under:
K = 5 (Q) 0.0625
where K = absorption loss per million square feet of wetted area
Q = Discharge in cusecs in any reach
MANUAL OF IRRIGATION PRACTICE 6-11
DESIGN OF UNLINED CANALS
As per practice in the Department the conveyance losses are considered generally
taken as 8 cusecs for million square feet of wetted perimeter for design of new canal
system.
The conveyance losses can also be actually measured through inflow, outflow and
ponding methods. Further details of these procedures can be seen in any Book of
Irrigation Engineering.
For the design of a new channel the conveyance losses of the existing system (s) in
the vicinity can also be utilized. For the existing channels the conveyance losses are
reduced due to normal sealing process of voids by clay particles of flowing water. It
has been observed that a system operating for 100 years or so, the losses can be
reduced by 50% of the design values.
In Pakistan, the average losses to be adopted in design of the canal system are
mentioned as Percentage (%) of the authorized discharge and are as under:
Main Canal and Branches = 15 to 20%
Major and minor distributaries = 6 to 8%
Field channels = 20 to 22%
During application of water to fields = 25 to 27%
6.1.5 Field Losses
The field losses are the percentage of the irrigation water that is not available for
consumptive use by the crops. A large portion of irrigation water is lost and is called
field loss and it depends upon the following main factors:
Seepage and evaporation from the field channels
Breaches in the water courses / field channels
Percolation beyond the root zone
Surface runoff through breaches in the field
Poor land preparation
Poor design of farm irrigation system
Size of plots irrigated
These losses can be in the range of 25% to 27%.
6.1.6 Reclamation Requirements
The reclamation requirements depend on the following:
i) Soil characteristics
ii) Salt distribution in the soil profile
iii) pH value and total soluble salt content in soil
iv) Irrigation water quality and
v) Decrease in yield due to presence of salts
The leaching requirement is determined by the following equation:
LR = ECIw
ECdw
Where LR = leaching requirement (%)
EC = electrical conductivity (mmho/cm)
lw = irrigation water
dw = drainage water
During Kharif season when the extra water is available in the system, reclamation
shoots (pipes) are added to the outlets and extra water reclamation water allowed for
reclamation of salinity is supplied through these shoots. After the end of Kharif Season
this facility is discontinued and then from next Kharif season it is repeated and normally
6-12 MANUAL OF IRRIGATION PRACTICE
DESIGN OF UNLINED CANALS
it takes three (03) years to reduce the salinity in the outlet chak. Currently reclamation
shoots (pipes) are not being allowed by the Department.
6.1.7 Water Allowance
As defined earlier this represents the number of cusecs of outlet capacity authorized
for 1000 acres of CCA. This forms the basis for the design of the canal system. The
canals are designed for Kharif full supply factor at outlets.
The Kharif full supply factor for the important canals of Punjab is as under:
Table 6.1: Kharif Full Supply Factors
Name of Canal Fully Supply Factor at Outlet during
Kharif
Upper Chenab Canal 88
Lower Chenab Canal 58 to 98
Pak Pattan Canal 54 to 77
Depalpur Canal 54 to 55
Rangpur Canal 65.5
The sanctioned water allowance (cs/1000 acres) for perennial and non-perennial
important canals of the Punjab is shown in Table 6.2:
Table 6.2: Sanctioned Water Allowance for Punjab Canals
(cs per 1000 Acres)
Canal System Perennial Non-Perennial
Upper Jhelum Canal 3.03 3.25
Lower Jhelum Canal 2.84 4.30
Upper Chenab Canal 2.83 2.93
Lower Chenab Canal 3.17 4.30
Lower Bari Doab Canal 3.00 3.30
Haveli & Sidhnai Canals 3.00 4.80
Rangpur Canal -- 4.80
Depalpur Canal -- 5.50
Pakpattan Canal 3.60 5.50
Fordwah Canal 3.60 5.50
Malisi Canal -- 5.50
Bahawal Canal 2.50 5.50
Panjnad Canal 4.20 5.50
Abbasia Canal 4.25 5.50
Thal Canal 3.18 --
Muzaffargarh Canal -- 8.50
D.G Khan Canal -- 6.36
MANUAL OF IRRIGATION PRACTICE 6-13
DESIGN OF UNLINED CANALS
Normally for design of canal system a perennial water allowance of 3.5 to 4 cusecs is
recommended and for non-perennial as 4.5 to 5.0 cusecs may be adopted. There can
also be special allowance for military grass farms and also special water allowance for
sanctioned gardens and orchards. For the time being government has imposed
complete ban on sanctioned of extra water for special allowances.
The higher water allowance can cause water logging conditions in the system with a
operation of 10 to 15 years, so very high water allowance should not be taken up for
design in case of heavy soils.
The minimum recommended Free Board is given in the Table 6.3.
Table 6.3: Minimum Free Board (FB)
Full Supply Discharge (Cs) Free Board (ft)
5-250 1.0
251-500 2.0
501-1000 2.5
1001-5000 3.0
5001 and above 4.0
d. Exclude all unallocated crown waste lands until such time as they
are allotted.
e. Of the balance include in the CCA all commanded areas except
the following lands:
i. In where sub-soil water level is within 3 ft of the natural surface
and drainage facilities do not exist.
ii. Lands are provided with well (chahi) and the spring level is
within 10 ft the ground.
f. Un-commanded areas are allotted water only in the following
cases:
i. To small patches of a few acres in area surrounded by
commanded lands,
ii. To those areas for which it has been decided to provide lift
irrigation (Chief Engineer’s sanction is necessary).
Such lift chaks are kept distinct from chaks provided with gravity
flow irrigation.
From the known culturable commanded area and the project
water allowance, the capacity allotted to the chak is calculated.
Preparation of Capacity Statement
The first step in the design of a distributary is to determine the capacity of each outlet
and off taking minor. For this purpose a capacity statement is prepared as shown in
Table 6.4, more or less, on the following:
The information in Column No. 4 - 10 is obtained from the Chakbandi Missal and
Chakbandi Register. The limit between large and small blocks of un-commanded area
in Column No. 6 and 7 will depend on the orders applicable to each canal. On some
canals small blocks of un-commanded area are not excluded from C.C.A.
The exact form of the capacity statement varies from canal to canal depending on the
orders that are followed on that canal with respect to the areas that rank for water.
Preparation of Command Statement
The process of design of an irrigation channel is dual. The method of determining the
discharge of a channel in its various reaches has been described in the preceding
paragraphs. The next step is to determine the levels at which water should be run in
a distributary system so that it may be possible to irrigate all the area that is included
in Column 10 of the capacity statement. This is done by preparing a command
statement as shown in Table 6.5 considering the following:
Columns 1 to 3 of the command statement require no explanation. In Column 4 the
controlling level in the chak of the outlet is entered, or in other words, level of the area
requiring the highest water surface level at the head of the watercourse. In selecting
this controlling level, care must be exercised not to raise unduly the water levels by
selecting a small patch of high land. Such patches should be excluded. On the other
hand, it is advisable to make two or three tests both of the actual highest areas to be
irrigated and also of areas possibly a little lower in level but farther away from the
outlet, to determine that controlling level which actually requires the highest water level
in the watercourse.
The distance of this controlling point from the outlet is measured to determine the fall
in water level from the outlet to this controlling point. It is usual to adopt a slope of 0.2
per square or rectangle length which is about 1,000 ft. This is entered in Column 5.
6-16 MANUAL OF IRRIGATION PRACTICE
DESIGN OF UNLINED CANALS
The water surface level required at the head of the water course is determined in
Column 6. This is the sum of Column 4 and Column 5+3 inches for the field command.
On some canals it is usual to add a further 3 inches as a margin to cover silting in the
head reach of the watercourse. This is a valuable precaution, because in the absence
of such margin any silting in the watercourse must affect the modularity of the outlet.
Column 7 is filled in only when a command statement is being prepared for an existing
channel. The highest water surface level, or marks thereof, are actually surveyed and
the observed levels are entered in this Column. Ordinarily the value in Column 7 and
that in Column 6 should agree, but if the difference is very marked it is worthwhile to
investigate the reasons thereof. If it is revealed that the watercourse is in bad
maintenance and the working head can be improved if the deposited silt is properly
cleared, the observed levels could be ignored. But in other cases actual observed
levels should be preferred to the theoretical value determined in Column 6. Column 8
should thus be filled in very carefully.
In Column 9, the R.L. of the proposed full supply level in the distributary is recorded.
This is obtained from the L section which is described in the following paragraph.
The working head of the outlet that is difference in Columns 9 and 8 is recorded in
Column 10. This should be enough for the outlet to work modularly. At this place, it
may be stated, however, that the minimum working head normally required for an
outlet is 0.2 x the full supply depth of the distributary. This is what would be required
for an open flume outlet set at bed level. Thus as a rough guide the working head in
Column 10 should be in excess of 0.2 x full supply depth in the distributary at the point.
Preparation of Draw off Statement
Having determined the capacity of each offtake through the capacity statement, the
next step is to find the capacity of the channel reach by reach. This is done by
preparing a draw-off statement as shown in Table 6.6 in the following form:
The following explanatory remarks will explain the preparation of the draw-off
statement.
Column 1- all irrigating channels are marked from head to tail by distance marks
placed 1,000 feet apart. This permits ready identification of any point on the channel.
Column 2 – Except at the tail cluster, where there may be a number of separate outlets,
every outlet must be on the right or left hand side of a channel when facing
downstream.
Column 3 – In this Column is recorded the capacity of every outlet and other offtakes
as determined in the capacity statement.
Column 4 – In this Column, the running total of Column 3 is entered by reaches. The
matter of reaches requires careful attention. Convenient reaches must be selected and
the experience of the designer is almost the only guide to their selection. Towards the
tail of the channel, where the discharge is small, these reaches must be short. Near
the head, the reaches may be longer. The point of offtake of a minor should always be
the end of a reach.
The most important consideration in the selection of reaches should be that (unless
there is a masonry work at the end of a reach), the variation in the section of two
adjoining reaches of a channel is not very marked. As a rough rule, reaches should be
so fixed that the section of the channel does not alter by more than 10% (limited to six
inches in small channels) in width and by more than 10% (limited to 0.2 ft in small
channels) in depths, from one reach to the next below.
Column 5 – In this Column the absorption in the reach is to be entered.
MANUAL OF IRRIGATION PRACTICE 6-17
DESIGN OF UNLINED CANALS
Column 6 – In this Column is entered the total net draw-off in the reach plus the
absorption loss in the reach.
Column 7 – In this Column the actual discharge of the channel from point to point is
given.
Column 8 – 11 – Show the designed data of the channel in its various reaches.
6.2 DESIGN WATER LEVEL
The design water level of a main canal / branch canal / distributary is the sanctioned
water line and is important parameter for checking the discharge distribution to outlets.
The design water level is fixed with respect to field level of the command area with
minimum working head of the outlet chak as 3 inches. The design discharge and the
design water level are obtained after preparing the Longitudinal Section (L- section) of
the canal branch / distributary. The longitudinal section is prepared on a distorted
scale. The horizontal scale generally adopted is 2 inches to a mile or some time to a
scale of 1 inch to a mile. Vertical scale generally adopted as 1/100. For small
distributary or minor a scale of 1/50 may be adopted. The following tables of capacity
statement, command statement and draw-off statement are prepared from the
Chakbandi / revenue missal and then the Longitudinal Section (L-Section) is prepared.
Once the L-Section is prepared then its sanction is obtained from the competent
authority as the case may be (Executive Engineer, Superintending Engineer and Chief
Engineer). This approved L-Section gives the design discharge and design water level
at the head of the canal, and thereafter the design procedure for the canal is started.
Table 6.4: Capacity Statement
Serial No.
1
R.D. of
Outlet
2
Capacity Statement
Side, Left or
Right
3
Gross
Area
4
Ghair Mumkin
5
6-18
Capacity Statement
14 13 12 11 10 9 8 7 6
MANUAL OF IRRIGATION PRACTICE
DESIGN OF UNLINED CANALS
Command Statement
DESIGN OF UNLINED CANALS
Water Surface
Actual prevailing Fall in Water
Finally accepted Level Required Controlling
Maximum R.L. of Level from Side
Water Level at at Had of Water N.S Level of R.D. of Serial
water surface at Outlet to (Right or
Head of Course (column Land to be Outlet. No.
head of controlling Left).
Watercourse 4 + column 5 + Commanded
Watercourse. N.S. Level
0.25 ft)
8 7 6 5 4 3 2 1
Table 6.5: Command Statement
MANUAL OF IRRIGATION PRACTICE
6-19
6-20
10 9
6 5 4 3 2 1
Table 6.6: Draw Off Statement
MANUAL OF IRRIGATION PRACTICE
DESIGN OF UNLINED CANALS
MANUAL OF IRRIGATION PRACTICE 6-21
DESIGN OF UNLINED CANALS
the Channel in
Discharge of
the Reach
7
Slope
8
Draw Off Statement
Proposed Data
Bed width
9
10
F.S. Depth
Lacey ‘s “f” or
Kennedy’s
Velocity
11
Vo = 0.84 D0.64
where D = Full supply depth of channel (ft)
Vo = Critical Velocity (ft per second)
6-22 MANUAL OF IRRIGATION PRACTICE
DESIGN OF UNLINED CANALS
He also introduced a factor ‘m’ critical velocity ratio to account for variation of the silt
grade from the standard conditions of Upper Bari Doab Canal (UBDC).
V = m x 0.84D0.64
where m = V = Critical Velocity Ratio
Vo
For sand coarser than the standard silt at UBDC the value of ‘m’ ranges from 1.10 to
1.20 and that for finer the value of ‘m’ ranges from 0.80 to 0.90.
6.3.2 Lindley's Approach (1919):
Lindley carried out an extensive survey of the Lower Chenab Canal System. On the
basis of this data, he developed the following equations.
V = 0.95 D0·57
V = 0.57 B0.355
B = 3.80 D1.61
Lindley's main hypothesis was that the sediment load carried in a channel controls the
bed width in the same way as it unquestionably defined the depth. This study
demonstrated the important effect of the canal section geometry on its sediment
transport capacity.
In examining data collected at different points of a canal system that has run long
enough to attain regime, great variations are observable which are sometimes due to
regime having been disturbed and sometimes to regime at different points being
naturally different. The main causes of these variations are:
Silt clearance, berm cutting, the use of bushing and the working of
silting tanks
Use of cross-regulators in heading up more or less at different times
Running of feeder channels with varying discharges
Breaches which scour the bed locally
Difference between the silt drawing power of an off-take, not at present
measurable, but causing regime changes in the parent channel as well
as in the distributary; and
Effect of different rugosities in allowing regime velocities to be attained
with lesser or steeper gradients.
6.3.3 Lacey Regime Theory
Gerald Lacey, who retired as Chief Engineer of United Province, PWD Irrigation
Branch published his first paper through the Institute of Civil Engineers London in
1929. Subsequently he made a few changes which were published in 1939. He made
a systematic study of the observed data and derived some empirical relations. It would
be wrong to call these empirical laws a theory, but nevertheless they have been used
extensively in the sub-continent for the design of unlined channels and have been
found quiet satisfactory.
He introduced a silt factor “f” and assumed it was related to mean diameter of the bed
material. The set of equations he obtained can be readily used to calculate the velocity,
MANUAL OF IRRIGATION PRACTICE 6-23
DESIGN OF UNLINED CANALS
area of cross-section, slope, bed width and depth of channel for a particular discharge
and “silt grade”. He analyzed all available data on the basis of V and R and plotted it
on a logarithmic scale and obtained the formula:
V = K R1/2
V has the same significance as Kennedy’s V and K is a constant.
For many years, the “silt grade” upon which Kennedy founded his formula was
recognized as standard. Lacey accepted this standard, and designated a “silt factor”,
f = 1 for silt-sand beds in Pakistan. He developed the formulae:
𝑉2
fVR = 0.75 𝑅
A f2 = 4.0v5
P = 2.668Q1/2
where
fVR = silt factor derived from velocity relation
R = Hydraulic Mean Radius (ft)
Q = Design Discharge (cs)
P = Wetted Perimeter (ft)
f = Lacey’s Silt Factor
S = 1 f5/3
1840 Q1/6
S = bed slope (ft/ft)
These are the standard formulae upon which Lacey Regime Theory is based. They
are also referred to as Lacey Regime Equations. The great appeal that the Lacey
equationhas may be in one or more of the following:
1) they are simple to use;
2) they require no information on the incoming sediment load, which is
difficult to obtain at any time;
3) they require no decision on the type of strength of bank materials.
The width of the channels depend only on the discharge. The Lacey’s Method was
accepted officially by the Central Board of Irrigation in 1934as a standard practice for
designing regime canals. Some of the major canal systems in Pakistan that have been
designed on the basis of the Lacey formulae are Haveli canal (1939), Thal canal
(1946), BRBD Link (1951), Taunsa Canals (1958) and Guddu canals (1962). The total
diversion capacity of these canals is 152,000 cs. Also many older canals have been
successfully remodeled in accordance with the method. These equations are empirical
in nature and are applicable to canals that operate under conditions similar to those
from which these equations were derived, namely steady operational discharges,
small bed load material, steep cohesive erodible banks, uniform sections, mild slope,
low Froude number, smooth alignments and bed material in sand size range. Lacey
tried to relate the silt factor to d50 of the bed material and the Manning’s Roughness
Coefficient by the empirical expression:
f = 1.76 √𝑑50
6-24 MANUAL OF IRRIGATION PRACTICE
DESIGN OF UNLINED CANALS
na = 0.0225 f1/4
d50 = median bed material diameter (mm)
Lacey called the variable “na” the absolute rugosity.
The Lacey assumptions for the development of the equations were:
(1) flowing discharge is constant;
(2) Alluvium in which the channel is flowing is incoherent, unlimited and of
the same characteristics as the sediment charge carried by the water.
Incoherent alluvium means the loose granular material which can be
scoured out as easily as it is deposited; and
(3) silt grade and silt charge are constant
The Lacey has classified the regime conditions into True Regime, Initial Regime
and Final Regime. The concept of the regime of the canals as narrated in the
Lacey’s theory is given below:
6.3.4 Classification of Regimes of Canals
According the Lacey the regime conditions i.e. stable conditions viz a viz bed width,
depth and slope, that is zero net erosion, or deposition over a hydrological cycle, shall
be established when:
1. Discharge is constant
2. The alluvium in which the channel is flowing, is incoherent, unlimited and of
the same characteristics as the sediment charge carried by the water.
Incoherent alluvium means the loose granular material which can be
scoured out as easily as it is deposited and
3. Silt grade and silt charge are constant
Obviously all the above requirements are unlikely to be fulfilled in nature, and therefore
regime conditions may not be obtained. Lacey therefore classified the regime
conditions as below:
True Regime
This is obtained when the above conditions are fulfilled. This happens most often in
sandy rivers in alluvial plans which have lateral freedom and by meandering adjust
their length and slope, which is determined solely by discharge and silt grade.
Artificial channel which no freedom of lateral movement can never achieve true
regime. They may achieve initial regime but only rarely final regime.
Initial Regime
Channels excavated in the first instance with defective slopes and with narrow
dimensions, can by immediately throwing down incoherent silt on the bed, increase
their slopes and by the generation of increased velocity achieve a non-silting
equilibrium which may be termed initial regime. Such channels are subject to lateral
restraint in that the scouring of the banks is not allowed. They attain a working stability
and therefore neither silt nor scour but they are not in final regime. Their slopes and
velocities are higher and the cross-section narrower than they would have been if the
sides were not rigid.
MANUAL OF IRRIGATION PRACTICE 6-25
DESIGN OF UNLINED CANALS
Final Regime
If the continuous action of the current eventually overcomes the resistance of the sides
and set up a conditions where the channel adjusts its perimeter, depth and slope
according to discharge and silt grade, final regime conditions are said to have been
achieved.
6.3.5 Simons and Albertson Regime Method (1957):
Simons and Albertson analyzed river and canal data in a wider context that contained
details regarding the bed and bank materials, as well as the rate of sediment transport.
The canals from which some 113 reaches were studied belong to Pakistan and USA.
The range of discharges studied was 5 to more than 9000 cusecs, with an average
sediment discharge of 156 to 8000 ppm. The mean size of the bed material varied
from 0.1 mm to 7.5 mm.
The types of canal bed and banks used by Simons and Albertson are:
1. Sand bed and banks;
2. Sand bed and cohesive banks;
3. Cohesive bed and banks;
4. Coarse non-cohesive material; and
5. Same as for 2, but with heavy sediment loads (2000 to 8000 ppm).
The proposed equations defining the geometry of the alluvial channel are:
P = K1 Q1/2
b = 0.9 P
b = 0.92 B - 2.0
R = K2Q.36
d = 1.21 R for R <= 7 ft.
d = 2 + 0.93 R for R >= 7 ft.
U = K3(R2S)m
The flow resistance equation is given by:
𝑈2 𝑈𝑏 0.37
= 𝐾4 ( )
𝑔𝑑𝑠 𝑣
Where b and B are mean and surface widths, respectively, and
Coefficients and exponents for the above equations are:
Channel Type
Coefficients 1 2 3 4 5
K1 3.5 2.6 2.2 1.75 1.7
K2 0.52 0.44 0.37 0.23 0.34
K3 13.90 16.00 - 17.90 16.00
K4 0.33 0.54 0.87 - -
m 0.33 0.33 - 0.29 0.29
6-26 MANUAL OF IRRIGATION PRACTICE
DESIGN OF UNLINED CANALS
The shear on the bed is approximately equal to γDS and on the sides is 0.76 of this
value. The channel is designed as per Manning and Kutter formula and then the
tractive force on bed is checked which should be less than the permissible value for
that type of soil. The tractive force theory is basically sound insofar as it has been
developed, for clear water conditions in course non-cohesive materials, but the results
obtained in case of sediment-laden water in Pakistan are not so good and the
equations are not considered applicable.
6.3.8 Practice for Design of Canals in Punjab Irrigation Department
In the Punjab Irrigation Department the new unlined canals are mostly designed on
Lacey’s Regime Theory and checked for velocity not to exceed Kennedy’s critical
velocity. The calculated Froude Number shall not exceed 0.3. The selection of the silt
factor is done from the canal system operating in the vicinity of the project to be
designed and is general practice that the value of the silt factor adopted at head of the
canal be suitably decreased towards the tail ends. Most of the stable irrigation canals
in the Punjab have Manning ‘n’ value of 0.022 to 0.0225. The operational
environmental for alluvial canals in Punjab is such that silt deposition takes place in
the high flow season (June to September) and scouring takes place during low flow
season (October to May) due to silt free water. So in this way mostly the behavior of
main canals / branch canals / distributaries is satisfactory. The adopted practice in the
Department is that the beds of distribution system (distributary, minor, sub-minor) are
desilted on yearly basis and their capacity restored during annual closure.
6-28 MANUAL OF IRRIGATION PRACTICE
DESIGN OF UNLINED CANALS
velocity of flow being admitted into the channel. The following sequence of bed forms
can be expected in the channel.
1. Plane Bed with no Sediment Motion
This situation corresponds to the case when the actual shear stress τ0 is less than the
critical shear stress τc. There will be no motion of the sediment and the bed will remain
plane. The friction offered to the flow is due to the resistance of the grains only.
2. Ripples and Dunes
a) Ripples: if the shear stress in the channel is increased (by increasing either
discharge or slope) so that τ0 is moderately greater than τc, the grains in the
bed will move and very soon the bed will be covered by a saw tooth type of
ripple pattern (Fig. 6.4). The height of the ripples will be considerably smaller
than their length. The sediment motion will be considerably smaller than their
length. The sediment motion will be essentially in the form of rolling and sliding
of particles on the ripple bed. The water surface will remain essentially calm
and plane. An interesting feature of the ripples is that they are not formed if the
sediment size is greater than about 0.60 mm.
b) Dunes: As the shear stress on the bed is gradually increased in the
hypothetical laboratory channel, the ripples gradually grow into larger size.
Then a different bed form known as dunes appear with ripples riding over them.
At higher shear stress values the ripples disappear leaving behind only the
dunes pattern on the bed.
Dunes are larger in size than the ripples with small height to length ratios. The
water surface will be wavy and out of phase with the dunes, (Fig. 6.4). The
sediment transport will be larger than in ripples and the dunes advance
downstream through with a velocity much smaller than that of the water flow.
The flow will be in subcritical ranges.
The flow in a channel with ripples and dunes in the bed is characterized by
separation of the flow on the lee side of the bed form. This in turn causes large
energy losses and particularly so in bed with dunes. The shedding of the
vortices from the separation region of the dunes cause ruffing of the free water
surface. In both the ripples and dunes, the bed form gets eroded on the
upstream side and some of this material gets deposited on the lee side of the
bed form in a continuous manner causing the crest of the bed wave pattern to
move downstream.
3. Transition
a) Plane bed with sediment motion: Further increase of the shear stress after
the dune bed pattern phase will lead to a transition phase where the bed
undulations get washed away progressively ultimately to achieve an
essentially plane bed surface (Fig. 6.4). The sediment transport rate would be
considerably larger than in dune phase. The flow, however, will be in subcritical
range with the Froude number of the flow being nearer unity.
b) Standing wave: Further increase in the shear stress beyond the plane bed
stage bringing the Froude number nearer unity and beyond it, would lead to
the formation of symmetrical sand waves with associated water surface
standing wave, (Fig. 6.4). The water surface undulations will be in phase with
the sand waves.
6-30 MANUAL OF IRRIGATION PRACTICE
DESIGN OF UNLINED CANALS
τ0 = τ0I +τ0II
0.10
0.08 Transition
Ripples & Dunes
f 0.06
Plane Bed
0.04
Antidunes
0.02
0.001 0.01 0.10 1.0 1.5
Slope (Percent)
Figure 6.6: Schematic Variation of friction factor ƒ with bed forms [Based on
data on d = 0.28 mm]
fvr= 0.75v2 / R
This equation is applicable only to regime channel for fine silt to boulders.
frs= 0.75R1/3S2/3
This equation is useful in computing a working silt factor and is equally well
applicable for regime as well as non-regime channels.
fm=( fvr x frs)½
fm=mean silt factor
The average values of silt factor relating to bed material type are given below:
Table 6.10: Average Values of Silt Factor
Material Value of Silt Factor (f)
Massive boulders (diameter = 25 inches) 36.60
Large stones 38.60
Large boulders, shingle and heavy sand 20.90
Small boulders, shingle and heavy sand 6.12
Large pebbles and coarse gravel 4.68
Coarse sand 1.56 – 1.49
Medium sand 1.31
Standard Kennedy’s silt (Upper Bari Doab Canal) 1.00
Lower Mississippi Silt 0.357
through setting of barrage gates. Normally the standard still pond and semi still pond
system also control sediment entry into main canals. In distribution system Silt Vanes
are also used and are very helpful.
6.5.1 Sediment Deposition
Sediment deposit may take place in canals which persistently operate a discharge
lower than the design discharge as shown in the figure which also shows canal bays
choked with sediment which results in erosion of banks.
ii) Every critical canal reach and hydraulic structure will be thoroughly
inspected and photographic slides taken of the critical components
requiring urgent repair / rehabilitation. Videos may also be prepared for
demonstration purposes.
iii) The results of the inspections would be properly documented in the
prescribed manner for canals and hydraulic structures.
iv) The repair / rehabilitation needs will be identified along with indicative
cost for each structure / canal.
v) The repair / rehabilitation needs should be prioritized into emergent &
short term / medium to long term measures.
vi) Inspection of structures should be carried out in accordance with the
regime prescribed by specific O&M Manuals. Necessary safety
certificates should be recorded and signed by the Sub Divisional Officer,
Executive Engineer, Incharge and countersigned by the Superintending
Engineer and Chief Engineer.
The implementation of the above instructions should be ensured. The Chief Engineers
should closely monitor the progress in this behalf besides inspecting the sensitive
structures by themselves. These instructions should also be passed on to the Sub
Divisional Officers level and their acknowledgement kept on record.
Check List of Annual Canal Closure:
Documentation (photographs of hydraulic structure and other workers
before, during and on completion),
Sounding and probing plans,
X-Sections at 1 mile interval on Main and Branch Canals,
Installation of mile gauges,
Fixation of Gauges at critical points and tails,
Painting and lettering of data boards / distance marks,
Maintenance of log books for all structures on Main / Branch canals,
Inspection of Structures in accordance with O&M Manual,
Inspection and repair to gates and gearing (regulation gates, hoisting
machinery and other steel structures),
Inspection / checking by CE, SE & XEN,
Inspection / checking by Zonal Committees.
O&M Work Plan,
Technical Sanction of Estimates ,
Tendering / Acceptance of works, (adherence to codal formalities and
departmental instructions)
Quality and quality control (execution of works according to specifications
and provision in the estimate).
6.6 SOLVED DESIGN EXAMPLE FOR EARTHEN CANAL
An earthen channel with full supply discharge of 1,000 cfs is to cross a country whose
grade is 1 : 8000. Lacey’s Silt Factor in the neighboring canal systems calculated from
the observed data comes to 0.9. Compute the hydraulic design parameters of the
canal.
6-38 MANUAL OF IRRIGATION PRACTICE
DESIGN OF UNLINED CANALS
Solution:
F. S. Q. = 1000cs
Adopt lacey Silt Factor ‘f ’ = 0.9
Grade of the country = 1 in 8000
Hydraulic Slope, S
S = 0.0005423 f5/3_
Q1/6
= 0.0005423 (0.9)5/3__
(1000) 1/6
= 0.0001439
S = 1 : 6,950
Since the calculated slope is steeper than the grade of the country, the design is not
feasible. The canal should be designed with the slope close to 1 : 8000. Silt factor
corresponding to the adopted slope comes to 0.83.
S = f5/3
1840 Q 1/6
1 = f5/3
8000 1840 (1000)1/6
f = 0.83
A = 1.26 Q5/6
f½
= 423.9 ft2
P = 2.67 Q½ = 84.4 ft
Adopting Lacey Section with ½ : 1 side slope.
A = BD + ½ D2
P = B + 2.236 D
Using Design Curves developed by WAPDA based on Lacey’s Equation
“Design of earthen channels” which have been included in this manual
for ready reference:
D = 5.7 ft
B = 72 ft
Adopted Parameters:
Bed Width = 72 ft
Full Supply Depth = 5.7 ft
Side Slope = ½:1
Bed Slope = 1 : 8000
MANUAL OF IRRIGATION PRACTICE 6-39
DESIGN OF UNLINED CANALS
Chapter 7
Compiled by
Reviewed by
Table of Content
7 DESIGN OF LINED CANALS ............................................................................... 7-1
7.1 NEED FOR LININGS ........................................................................................... 7-1
7.2 LINING MATERIALS ............................................................................................ 7-1
Causes of Structural Failure of Concrete Lining ......................................... 7-6
Factors Affecting Canal Seepage ............................................................... 7-6
Soil / Cement Linings ................................................................................. 7-6
Asphaltic Concrete Linings ......................................................................... 7-6
Plastic Membranes ..................................................................................... 7-6
Compacted Earth Linings ........................................................................... 7-7
Buried Plastic Film Linings ......................................................................... 7-7
Factors Affecting the Design ...................................................................... 7-7
Side-Slopes ................................................................................................ 7-8
Bed Width of Depth Ratio ....................................................................... 7-8
Coefficient of Roughness ....................................................................... 7-8
7.3 DESIGN OF LINED CANALS ................................................................................. 7-9
Design Discharge ....................................................................................... 7-9
Design Level .............................................................................................. 7-9
Design Methods ......................................................................................... 7-9
Joints in Lining ......................................................................................... 7-10
Departmental Guidelines for Planning and Construction of Lined Canals 7-28
Design Example for Lined Canal .............................................................. 7-28
Diversion during Construction .................................................................. 7-29
7.4 MAINTENANCE OF CANAL LINING ...................................................................... 7-30
Maintenance Categories .......................................................................... 7-30
Role of Design in the Success of Lining ................................................... 7-32
Recommendations for Canal Lining ......................................................... 7-33
7.5 ISSUES FOR CANAL LINING .............................................................................. 7-34
Extent of Water Saving ............................................................................ 7-34
Water Level Fluctuations due to Change in Roughness Coefficient ......... 7-34
Economic Viability of Lining ...................................................................... 7-34
Operation during Construction Phase ...................................................... 7-35
Impact on Ground Water Recharge for Drinking Water Supply ................ 7-35
Sustainability of Lining in High Ground Water Table Areas ...................... 7-35
REFERENCES ........................................................................................................... 7-36
iv MANUAL OF IRRIGATION PRACTICE
DESIGN OF LINED CANALS
List of Tables
TABLE 7.1: VALUE OF COEFFICIENT OF ROUGHNESS......................................................... 7-10
TABLE 7.2: DESIGN CHARACTERISTICS OF LINED CANALS IN PAKISTAN ............................... 7-12
List of Figures
FIGURE 7.1: TYPICAL SECTION OF BRICK LINING ................................................................ 7-2
FIGURE 7.2: TYPICAL PLAIN CEMENT CONCRETE LINING CANAL SECTIONS ........................... 7-3
FIGURE 7.3: TYPICAL CROSS SECTION CONCRETE LINING................................................... 7-4
FIGURE 7.4: TYPICAL CROSS SECTION FOR LINING OF DISTRIBUTION AND MINORS ................ 7-5
FIGURE 7.5: DETAILS OF CONSTRUCTION AND CONTRACTION JOINTS ................................. 7-11
MANUAL OF IRRIGATION PRACTICE 7-1
DESIGN OF LINED CANALS
observed that if laid without forms, the concrete with a slump of one inch to one and a
half inch can be worked to reasonable finish but poses problems in compaction of the
concrete layer.
However if forms are used, a slump of 2 to 3 inches provides adequately dense and
properly finished concrete. The compaction is effected by employing form vibrators.
The forms produced better panels, in density, surface, laying, line and grade. The
concrete mix of 1:2:4 is generally used. Sometimes a layer of Geo-membrane is also
used under the concrete layer to make it stronger against seepage control.
Figure 7.4: Typical Cross Section for Lining of Distribution and Minors
7-6 MANUAL OF IRRIGATION PRACTICE
DESIGN OF LINED CANALS
or polyethylene. The exposed outer mat provides protection for the membrane
beneath which acts as the impermeable barrier. No seepage data was available for
these types of linings.
Plastic membranes are extremely impervious, provided they remain intact. An average
seepage rate for this group of 0.07 m/day, although little detail is available of the canal
on which these measurements were obtained.
Compacted Earth Linings
Compacted earth linings fall into two main groups, thick or thin, which describe the
thickness of the impervious layer. Thick earth linings usually have thickness upwards
of 300 mm of compacted material on the bed and sides of the canal, whilst thin linings
usually have a thickness of 150-300 mm. in general, thick compacted earth linings are
preferred, and FAO state that thin earth linings are limited to situations where a
suitable soil material may not be available locally. Certain constraints usually apply in
the case of thin earth linings, which include low canal velocities to prevent scour, and
operation of the canal to avoid frequent drying cycles.
Soil type and the degree of compaction play an important part in the seepage rates
possible from earth linings, and FAO give details of these based on US practice. An
average seepage rates is 0.02 m/day for compacted earth linings in general, and this
represents results from a number of such linings in America and Canada.
Buried Plastic Film Linings
Plastic membranes used for canal linings include Butyl rubber, polyethylene, polyvinyl
chloride and chlorosulfonated polyethylene rubber. The main difference between the
materials is their cost, resistance to degradation and their strength and creep
characteristics, since they are all extremely impermeable. Tests to define the suitability
of plastic materials for canal linings have been developed by the US Bureau of
reclamation and these include the determination of tensile strength elongation and
bonding strength. Soil burial tests and re-testing of materials used as canal linings
have also been used to determine the effect of degradation of the materials.
Plastic linings are laid on a carefully prepared smooth subgrade, to avoid damage to
the membrane, and are usually covered as quickly as possible with earth of gravel to
minimize possible deterioration by mechanical damage or sun exposure. Adjacent
membrane sheets are bound together to produce a watertight joint, and the method
used depends on the membrane type.
Seepage rates are not generally measured from canals lined with plastic membranes,
since it is often assumed that so long as the lining remains intact seepage is negligible.
However, the seepage measurements from buried plastic membrane lining have an
average seepage rate of 0.01 m/day.
Factors Affecting the Design
Some of the major factors which need a very careful consideration in the design of
lined channels comprise but not limited to the following:
i) Cross-Section
ii) Sub-grade
iii) Sub-grade Sterilization
iv) Coefficient of Roughness
v) Embankments
7-8 MANUAL OF IRRIGATION PRACTICE
DESIGN OF LINED CANALS
problems. So selection of ‘n’ value has to be very judicious, by keeping in view the
present as well as future conditions obtainable in the channels.
7.3 Design of Lined Canals
The design of lined canal is governed by following considerations:
i. Economical section, i.e. maximum cross sectional area for the minimum
wetted perimeter.
ii. Maximum velocity through the section so that the cross sectional area is
the minimum. Higher velocity can be allowed in lined section carrying
water free from sand and silt. However, velocity depends as the slope is
limited from the consideration of command.
iii. Higher silt carrying capacity so that the capacity of lined section is not
reduced by silting.
Design Discharge
The design discharge for a new lined canal is calculated in the same way as of unlined
channel, however if existing channel is lined then due to increased conveyance the
existing discharge can be easily increased for lined canal by 20 to 25 %.
Design Level
The major advantage of lined canal is that very flatter slopes can be adopted and a
very high command can be achieved by adopting higher water levels. The design
water levels are fixed as described in the chapter of unlined channels. The existing
slope is not to be changed for unlined canals are proposed for lining.
Design Methods
Chezy/ Kutter and Manning formulae are usually used in the design of lined channels
sections. In most of the cases, identical results are obtained by either of the formulae.
Generally the Manning formula is adopted which is given below:
1.486
V = R⅔ S½
𝑛
Where:
V = Mean velocity (ft/sec)
R = Hydraulic mean depth (ft)
S = Energy Slope (ft/ft)
n = Coefficient of Roughness
The full supply discharge Q as:
Q = AV
A = Cross Section Area (ft2)
The followings practical guidelines are given below for design of concrete lined canals.
Side Slopes: Side slopes for trapezoidal section a normal side slopes used are 1:1
for major and minor distributaries. For main canal/branch canal the range is 1.5:1 to
2:1 depending upon angle of repose of the soil. The shape can be semi-circle for low
discharges and sub minors.
7-10 MANUAL OF IRRIGATION PRACTICE
DESIGN OF LINED CANALS
Bed Width to Depth Ratio: Small channels will normally have B/D of 1, in case of
larger canals B/D ratio may range 2 to 3.
Freeboard: As defined by FAO in “Irrigation Water Management introduction to
Irrigation” freeboard of the canal is the height of the bank above the highest water level
anticipated. It is required to guard against over topping by waves or unexpected rises
in the water levels. For small canals the recommended free board is 6 inches and for
larger ones the freeboard is in the range of 1to 2 ft depending upon the discharge.
Height of the canal bank above the top of lining arranges from 1 to 2 ft for small and
larger canals respectively.
Thickness of Concrete Lining: 3 inches over 1 ½ lean cement sand plaster (1:6)
both in bed and side slopes. In case of main canals the thickness of lining is 4 inches
over 1 ½ lean cement sand plaster (1:6) both in bed and side slopes.
Range of flow Velocity: the average velocity recommended for lined section is 4 to
4.5 ft/sec but shall not exceed 8 ft / sec so as to avoid lifting of concrete panels due to
uplift and damage from cavitation.
Provision of Joints: ½ inch thick expansion joint at 100 ft interval should be provided
in addition to control or dummy joints at 10.0 ft spacing with joint sealant cement-sand-
bitumen. All joints would be on concrete pad of 6 inch x 3 inches throughout the section
such like a profile.
Joints in Lining
Joints in lining can be of the following four types:
i) Expansion Joints
ii) Contraction Joints
iii) Construction Joints
iv) Construction Grooves
Panel Length: The concrete panel length would be generally of 10.0 ft (i) Compaction
of concrete by vibrator should be ensure. (ii) Proper curing by water may also be
ensured.
Coefficient of Roughness: The roughness Coefficient for design shall be selected
from the type of the lining in the light of the table given below:
Table 7.1: Value of Coefficient of Roughness
Lining Type Value of ‘n’
Portland cement concrete lining 0.012 – 0.014
Asphaltic concrete 0.014
Brick lining covered with cement plaster 0.014-0.016
Soil cement, well finished 0.015
Soil cement, rough as a gravel surface 0.016
Exposed prefabricated asphalt material 0.015
Precast concrete-block lining 0.015-0.017
Brick lining, with exposed brick surface design value (Haveli 0.0146
Canal)
MANUAL OF IRRIGATION PRACTICE 7-11
DESIGN OF LINED CANALS
Actual measured with value of ‘n’ on the same lining after gradual 0.018
deterioration (Haveli Canal)
Shotcrete lining, smoothed 0.016
Shotcrete lining, average 0.017
Compacted earth lining, small canals 0.025
Compacted earth lining, large canals 0.020-0.0225
Normally the practice is to use ‘n’ value of 0.016 for Plain Cement Concrete (PCC)
Lining and 0.018 for the Brick Lining. Only these two types of lining material are being
used for lining of canal in the department.
Sidhani-Mailsi-
Bahawal-SMB Brick 10,100 100 2:1 18.0 1:10,500 4.1 0.0200 --
Link
SMB Link Brick 8,900 90 2:1 17.7 1:10,500 4.0 0.0200 --
SMBLink Brick 4,700 50 2:1 16.0 1:10,500 3.5 0.0200 --
SMBLink Brick 4,000 40 2:1 15.9 1:10,500 3.5 0.0200 --
Thal Main Canal
Upper (Measured Brick 7,250 -- -- 12.2 1:11,700 4.6 -- 0.017
data)
Thal Main Canal
Lower (Measured Brick 4,850 -- -- 10.0 1:10,286 4.9 -- 0.015
data)
Havelli Main Line
Brick 5,200 -- -- 11.4 1:13,193 4.2 0.0146 0.018
(Measured data)
AkramWah
Brick 2,500 -- -- 11.1 1:14,789 3.6 -- 0.014
(measured data)
Concret
CRBC Stage-II 3,600 37 -- 16.0 1:14,4000 3.7 0.0160 --
e
Balloki-
Brick 12,000 112 -- 16.4 1:8,000 5.1 0.0170 0.018
Sulemanki-1-Link
Haveli Main Line Brick 6,000 84 1:1 12.0 -- -- 0.0146 0.018
Precast
Lasbela Main Line Concret 90 -- -- -- -- -- 0.0150 0.022
e Tiles
Pehur High Level
Brick 750 11 -- 10.8 1:5,000 6.5 0.0150 --
Canal
Concret
Warkak Lift Canal 200 9 1.5:1 4.3 1:2,000 4.2 0.0150 --
e
MANUAL OF IRRIGATION PRACTICE 7-13
DESIGN OF LINED CANALS
= 2D2
3.823 D
= 0.522 D
Substituting in Velocity Equation:
1.486
V = R⅔ S½
𝑛
1.486 1 ½
= (0.522 D)⅔ (5000)
0.015
= 0.908 D⅔
Since Q = AV
750 = (2 D2) 0.908 D⅔
750 = 1.816 D8/3
750
D8/3 = 1.816
= 413.0
D = 9.6 ft
and B = 9.6 ft
1.486 1
V = x (0.522 x 9.6)⅔ x
0.015 (5000)1/2
= 4.09 ft /sec.
P = 3.828 D
= 3.828 x 9.6
= 36.75 ft
and A = 2 D2
= 2 x 9.62
= 184.32 sqft
Q = A, V
= 184.32 x4.09
= 753.87 cs
A decision on the precise position of the diversion channel and the alignment of the
minor or distributary between the existing regulation structures would be made by the
Engineer on site to minimize land take, tree loss and construction costs. The preferred
location for the diversion channel would be within the existing land reservation or right
of way.
In closure period longer than 3-4 weeks in the Rabi can be undertaken during these
closure periods.
7.4 Maintenance of Canal Lining
The primary objective in maintenance of both lined and unlined irrigation canals in
Pakistan Irrigation Department are:
To keep the system in top operating conditions at all times through proper
maintenance;
To obtain the longest life and greatest use of the facilities of the system by
providing good maintenance and timely replacements;
To achieve the foregoing objectives at the lowest possible cost through a
proper maintenance programme.
The importance of maintenance for the success of any irrigation system cannot be
underestimated. Preventive maintenance, not only pays dividends in the economical
operation of a smooth working system, but also means the uninterrupted delivery of
water to the command areas.
All structures and facilities are subjected to deterioration in varying degrees with the
passage of time constant vigilance is necessary to identify and correct the potentially
unsafe and unsatisfactory conditions as they develop. Cracks in the lining, general
erosion, and settlement of embankment of structure, encroachment of freeboard,
scour, seepage and damage at animal crossing near to the villages can result in a
major failure of the system if not corrected or repaired without delay. Breaches can be
an expensive failure, not only due to the cost of the repairs, but also for the loss or
damage to the crops of the farmers directly affected as well as those living
downstream, who could be deprived of water.
Many problems that develop may not be of such a serious nature as to cause failure.
But the problem of silt accumulation and lack of inadequate drainage of banks and
side slopes is the most serious and widespread occurrence of failure. These problems
must be given due and timely attention. Experience has shown that if they are not
tackled in time, these problems frequently result in a reduction in the life of lining and
more costly repairs over the years.
Maintenance Categories
The maintenance of all types of irrigation canals in department is usually dived in four
categories, which are:
Regular Routine maintenance
Seasonal repairs
Annual repairs
Emergency repairs
Routine Maintenance: Routine maintenance refers to the day to day work items that
must be accomplished to keep a system operating well. These are, basically,
preventive maintenance functions that are undertaken on a continuous basis to
MANUAL OF IRRIGATION PRACTICE 7-31
DESIGN OF LINED CANALS
prevent the problems to become larger and more expensive. It is the first line of
defense and proves to be extremely cost effective when carried out in a competent
and professional manner. Routine maintenance generally includes the following
functions:
Filing rat holes, rain-cuts and rain-holes when observed.
Promptly removing trees that have fallen into the canal.
Repairing cracks in walls or replacing backfill material where water flows
behind a structure.
Replacing missing stones or bricks in the lining as soon as possible to
prevent additional material from being washed away.
Cleaning weeds and other floating trash from in front of the structures and
from the lining surface.
Removal of weed from the concrete panels.
Proper drainage of canal banks be ensured through catch water drains
Seasonal Repairs: The seasonal maintenance is the light maintenance work, part of
which has to be accomplished during canal closure. The work can be undertaken by
permanent employees or casual labor hired for this purpose. Seasonal work is limited
in extent because of the short time period available during closure and the availability
of staff and casual labor. This work generally includes:
Repairing and resetting of outlets
Repairing damage panels of lining
Removing all obstructions from the bed and the sides.
Completing temporary repairs.
Annual Repairs: The annual maintenance work is the heavy work that is generally
contracted out to private contractors. The annual maintenance program involves the
extraordinary or extensive program of replacing the damaged portions of lining and
embankment slopes. It also includes the occasional large desilting works and a
comprehensive rain-cut repair program when required.
In addition to above the cracks and open joints are raked and filled with cement mortar
and bitumen. Sand grouting is also done behind the cavities formed. A hole of 150 mm
diameter is cut and a mixture of course sand and water is filled into it. The mixture is
poured and is continued till the inflow of sand mixture of sand and water ceases and
the whole cavity is filled.
Emergency Repairs: Emergency repair refer to the repair of serious damages or
failure which, unless prompt action is taken, may entail even more catastrophic
problem concerning canals and farmlands. These damages are not always predictable
with respect to time of occurrence or to their sale. Large scale damages of irrigation
systems may result from any of, or combination, of the following causes:
Floods or heavy rainfall in the area
Careless operation of irrigation facilities, sudden closure or opening of
canal gates at head regulator
Human actions such as stealing water by removing concrete panels, cutting
canal banks, damaging of gates etc.
Destruction of the freeboard, or portion of lining or embankment by animals.
7-32 MANUAL OF IRRIGATION PRACTICE
DESIGN OF LINED CANALS
2. Selection of the type of lining should be done every carefully keeping in view
the availability of materials near the project area, durability and economics
of lining. Short-life lining should never be provided in permanent / perennial
channels.
3. Utmost attention should be paid to compaction of embankments & sub-
grade at-optimum moisture content to 95 percent of maximum Laboratory
density determined with Proctor method.
4. Lining should not be attempted in areas where the groundwater has a rising
trend.
5. For bigger and deeper channels proper drainage of sub-grade and canal
roads of lined channels should be designed and provided. If this is not
possible technically or economically lining should not be attempted.
6. In order to provide a perfectly water-tight lining which will not be a source of
leakage and contribution to groundwater a suggested type of lining could be
as below:
o Precast concrete slab units under laid with flexible Geo-membrane of a
suitable type depending on economics and local availability.
7. There is no need to provide sub-grade drainage for small channels,
especially after provision of a geo-membrane under the lining.
7.5 Issues for Canal Lining
Extent of Water Saving
Canals are lined to control seepage but the lining deteriorates with the time and
significant seepage losses also occur from a lined canal. Providing a perfect lining may
reduce 80% to 90% of the seepage loss in case of plain concrete cement concrete
lining and 70% to 80% in case of Brick Lined canals. The practical life of lining varies
from 50 to 20 Years for concrete and brick lining respectively. The proper maintenance
is essential to take full benefits and filling of cracks in the lining at early stage of
development. The concrete lining should have sufficient structural strength to resist
cracking.
Water Level Fluctuations due to Change in Roughness Coefficient
The proper value of coefficient of roughness or manning’s ‘n’ in the Manning Equation
varies according to the type of lining and the finish obtained during construction. The
selection of the value of n is very sensitive and has to be selected very carefully on
the experience of the designer. It is advisable to adopt a slightly conservative value. If
the selected value is too low then during initial operations the water level would be
lower, which may cause command problems and tails receive more water. If the value
of roughness is high then flatter slopes can be expected with high water levels in the
head reaches. It is, therefore, suggested that value of ‘n’ may be fixed as per initial
and future conditions. For the plain concrete lining a normal recommended value is
0.018.
Economic Viability of Lining
Considering the real value of water for economic growth of the country, the lining of
channels is prime-facie, a viable proposition. The equity of distribution achieved by
improving the hydraulic performance and conveyance capacity of the channel results
in substantial increase in production and socio-economic uplift of the people. Water is
a very valuable commodity and economic impact of water savings through seepage
reduction, and consequent increase in agricultural production of high value crops may
MANUAL OF IRRIGATION PRACTICE 7-35
DESIGN OF LINED CANALS
off - set the lining costs. Generally the lining projects are expected to have reasonable
economic internal rate of return (ElRR). A proper economic analysis is required to
establish the economic viability of a lined canal system.
It is necessary to evaluate actual benefits and to compare the same with the cost of
the construction, if the values of the annual benefits exceed the annual cost of lining,
then the investment on lining can be considered a good one. It is very essential that
the cost incurred on linings is recovered during the life time of the canal.
Operation during Construction Phase
In case of lining of existing perennial unlined canals normally diversion channel is
constructed for continuing the supplies and the preferred location for the diversion
channel would be within the existing government land or right of the way. In case of
non-perennial channels, which are mostly, empty during the Rabi Season (October to
March), the lining can be done during this period without construction of diversion. The
cost of diversion works is included in the lining cost. In case of small irrigation canals
pre-cast concrete slabs can be used during the closure period.
Diversion channel where required has the same discharge capacity as the main
channel. The diversion channel can be either placed away from main channel or cut
in one of the banks depending upon the local conditions. The diversion channel placed
close to the original prism, has the advantage of being constructed in small sections
allowing the use of existing outlets, while the lining work proceeds in reaches between
outlets, but it has the disadvantage of causing seepage into the channel prism which
hampers the lining progress and also effects the quality of lining work.
The diversion placed at a distance from the main channel, eliminates the problems of
seepage in to the original prism, but at the same time, has the disadvantage of more
cost and the necessity of provision of temporary outlets, as the diversion has to be a
continuous channel. The temporary outlets are a source of malpractice and
complaints.
The selection of one of the above alternatives basically depends on the site conditions
prevailing at the time of start of construction.
Impact on Ground Water Recharge for Drinking Water Supply
It has been observed that with the lining the lowering of the ground water table takes
place and it impacts the drinking water supply to shallow wells along the canals, and
in some cases it may reduce the recharge by 50%. The water of shallow wells along
canals is normally of best quality, it is therefore, recommended that the canals passing
in the city areas / towns may not be lined. In case of saline area where channels are
lined, the sallow pumps installed at the head of the water course serves as major
source of drinking water supply for the rural population.
Most efficient irrigation management (concrete lining of the canal) may not serve the
purpose of drinking water supply to surrounding areas, and will have negative impacts
on it. Therefore, in such areas channel may be only side-lined and the bed may be
kept unlined as being practiced.
Sustainability of Lining in High Ground Water Table Areas
It is observed that in such areas where the canal lining is done when the ground water
table is above the bed of the canal, then the canal lining would be subject to uplift
pressures during normal running of the canal. In order to release these pressures
7-36 MANUAL OF IRRIGATION PRACTICE
References
Chapter 8
MAINTENANCE OF CANALS
Compiled by
Reviewed by
???
ii MANUAL OF IRRIGATION PRACTICE
MAINTENANE OF CANALS
MANUAL OF IRRIGATION PRACTICE iii
MAINTENANE OF CANALS
Table of Contents
8 MAINTENANE OF CANALS ........................................................................... 8-1
8.1 IMPORTANCE OF MAINTENANCE .................................................................... 8-1
8.2 ESSENTIAL CONSIDERATIONS OF MAINTENANCE ............................................ 8-1
8.3 MAINTENANCE OF THE DESIGNED SECTION OF A CHANNEL ............................. 8-1
Weathering by wind and rain ................................................................. 8-2
Berms .................................................................................................... 8-3
Banks Constructed With Bad Soil .......................................................... 8-4
Inspection ramps ................................................................................... 8-4
Spoil Banks ........................................................................................... 8-4
Borrowing Earthwork ............................................................................. 8-5
8.4 MAINTENANCE OF THE HYDRAULIC CHARACTERISTICS OF A CHANNEL.............. 8-5
Clean and Smooth Section .................................................................... 8-5
Floating Jungle ...................................................................................... 8-5
Cattle Ghats .......................................................................................... 8-5
Drift sand ............................................................................................... 8-6
Silt movement ........................................................................................ 8-6
8.5 MAINTENANCE OF EQUITABLE DISTRIBUTION OF WATER ................................. 8-6
H. Registers........................................................................................... 8-6
Reading of Gauges ............................................................................... 8-6
Unauthorized use of water..................................................................... 8-7
8.6 MISCELLANEOUS ......................................................................................... 8-7
Jungle Clearance .................................................................................. 8-7
Distance Marks...................................................................................... 8-7
Boundary stone. .................................................................................... 8-7
8.7 RULES FOR THE W ORKING OF DEPARTMENTAL MAINTENANCE GANGS. ............ 8-7
Reaches to be allotted to gangmen. ...................................................... 8-8
Equipment ............................................................................................. 8-8
Leave to Gangmen ................................................................................ 8-8
Working Hours....................................................................................... 8-8
Program of work .................................................................................... 8-9
Duties of Head Gang Man. .................................................................... 8-9
Use of Flags and Number Plates. .......................................................... 8-9
Maintenance of Distributary. .................................................................. 8-9
8.8 ACCIDENTS TO AND ON BARRAGES AND CANALS ............................................ 8-9
Accidents on Barrages ........................................................................ 8-10
Accidents on other Canal Works: ........................................................ 8-11
Compensation for Injury to Personnel ................................................. 8-13
iv MANUAL OF IRRIGATION PRACTICE
MAINTENANE OF CANALS
MANUAL OF IRRIGATION PRACTICE 8-1
MAINTENANE OF CANALS
8 MAINTENANE OF CANALS
8.1 Importance of Maintenance
Large volumes of water are conveyed over long distance by canal systems with the
channels generally made of entirely earth banks. The material of the banks is the soil
available locally. Water levels in the channels are usually much above the countryside,
in some cases by several feet. A failure of the bank of a channel in addition to causing
considerable damage to the countryside and private property, may ruin the crops
grown on that canal system by reason of the interruption to supply. The actual damage
varies with the size and site of the canal and the material of the bank, but it is clear
enough that the efficient maintenance of canal systems is of paramount importance to
the welfare of the province
8.2 Essential Considerations of Maintenance
Evidently, it is essential that the section of a channel shall be maintained always as
close to design conditions as possible. The type cross sections to be adopted for
various classes of channels have been described in paragraphs and the data actually
adopted for each channel is given on the sanctioned longitudinal section of the
channel. It is the duty of Sub-engineers and sub-divisional officers to see that the
actual section as existing is not very much below the standard laid down in the type
cross section. Whenever they find that the banks are worn, whether in width or in
height they must submit proposals and estimates to restore the banks to design
sections. In case of emergencies it is expected that Sub-engineers and Executive
Engineers will take action to restore safe conditions invoking relevant provisions of
PPRA and PWD code. The capacity of a channel to carry its authorized discharge with
authorized supply levels depends on an efficient maintenance of its hydraulic
characteristics. This capacity is of importance in all channels, but is particularly so in
the case of distributaries and minors.
The maintenance of equitable distribution of supplies has next to be considered. This
is very important in the case of distributaries where according to the present Punjab
practice, the further distribution is automatic. With the authorized discharge entering a
particular channel at its head, all off-takes must take their due authorized discharges
and the requisite supplies must reach their heads in the entire length of the channel.
Lastly there are a few miscellaneous items of maintenance, which collectively are
important for the proper upkeep of channels. Main maintenance considerations
mentioned above and discussed below.
8.3 Maintenance of the Designed Section of A Channel
The section of a channel comprises of banks, berms, inspection road of boundary
roads and spoil banks.
Banks
The banks of a channel require attention in two different ways.
(a) From weathering on account of the normal action wind, traffic,
trespass, etc. and watching away of the earth by rain.
(b) On account of a change in the hydraulic features of the channel,
it may be necessary to raise the banks or set them back.
8-2 MANUAL OF IRRIGATION PRACTICE
MAINTENANE OF CANALS
(vii) Rat holes are sometime responsible for breaches. The difficulty about them is
that they are not easy to locate. Rat holes, however, do not extend right into the
channel and if there is a good strong berm, they seldom give trouble. If any rat hole
comes to notice, it must be opened out and properly filled up.
(viii) When a channel is opened for the first time settlement of the banks is bound to
take place. It is generally uneven, depending on the nature of the initial work done. If
the earthwork was full of clods and voids the settlement would be sever, but if the
earthwork had been well carried out and compacted, the subsequent settlement will
be light and even. When a new channel is opened the executive engineer must give
detailed instruction regarding the nature of the watch to be employed and the means
to be adopted to consolidate the banks. It is usual in high filling to have a line of men
pudding the inside bank of a channel with their feet as the water level in the channel
rises.
Berms
A good strong berm ensures the safety of a channel. To start with, there are normally
no berms on new channels. They grow gradually sometimes naturally sometimes as
a result of special efforts to this end. Berms are grown in the following different ways.
(a) By the longitudinal staking and bushing
(b) By cross spurs
(c) By hanging spurs
(d) By a combination of any two or more of the above.
Each of these methods has been described in detail in Chapter 38. The longitudinal
staking and bushing is the useful for small channels up to about 3 to 4 feet depth
beyond which it become very expensive. Cross spurs are usually employees in
channels of more than 4 depth and hanging spurs in very large channels where even
cross spurs are difficult or too expensive to construct.
As berms are formed, they have a normal tendency to grow higher at the lips. This has
to be set right by cutting, the lips and depositing the earth at the back as shown in the
sketch below:
The process has to be repeated a number of times and on completion the berm should
be higher on the bank side by about 6” than on the water side. This ensures that with
small fluctuation in supply the water in the channel does not reach the edge of the
bank. If it does rat holes may come into action and breaches result.
8-4 MANUAL OF IRRIGATION PRACTICE
MAINTENANE OF CANALS
Even after construction with fluctuations in supply there is always a tendency for berms
to rise at the lips and to grow inside the channel. The latter tendency is more marked
in the case of small channels. This must be set right by berm trimming, berm cutting
or lip cutting as described above. In small channels (less then 300 cusecs) berm
trimming once a year is generally necessary. On large channels berm trimming must
be done once in two years and in still larger channels once in three years.
When trimming berms, care must be taken not to cut them too deep. The mean line of
the berm is generally aimed at. If the earth to be obtained from berm trimming is in the
nature of sods, these need not be thrown away but may be deposited in the hollows
in the berms where they soon obtain a firm grip. In some channels due either to the
initial section being tight or to a subsequent increase in the capacity of the channel
berms are eroded by the channel itself. It is then necessary to set back the banks to
obtain artificial berms but artificial berms are a poor substitute for natural berms. It is
only the self-formed berms which are of real service to the safety of the canal.
Banks Constructed With Bad Soil
When the banks of a channel are constructed with soil impregnated with salts,
leakages will occur at the point where the top of the berm meets the inner slope of the
bank. To prevent such leakages a silt pushta should be constructed as shown in the
sketch below.
The minimum top width of the pushta should be 2’ and its minimum height above full
supply level should be 9”. If silt is available in the bed of the channel the pushta should
be constructed with bed silt, but if no bed silt is available the pushta should be
constructed with earth cut from the berm.
Inspection ramps
Inspection ramps should be provided at suitable places by raising the boundary road
to the bank level at a slope of 1:30 and providing a horizontal bank of 50’ length. These
inspection ramps can be provided at the site of outlets and thus saves boundary road
culverts. In any case they should not more than half a mile apart. Inspection ramps
enable an inspecting officer going in a car to get an idea of the shape and hydraulic
features of the channel.
Spoil Banks
Little attention is generally paid towards maintenance of spoil banks. It is the usual
practice to have the spoil banks covered with plantation. It is important, however, to
provide proper drainage of the spoil banks and catch-water drains must be efficiently
maintained. Otherwise the spoil bank does not require much maintenance.
MANUAL OF IRRIGATION PRACTICE 8-5
MAINTENANE OF CANALS
Borrowing Earthwork
It will be noticed from what has been said above that for proper maintenance of canal
banks, it is necessary periodically to obtain additional quantities of earthwork along all
channels. On some, definite widths of land are provided alongside the banks for the
future borrowing of earth; where such Government land does not exist, earth is
obtained from borrow pits in private land in accordance with the instructions contained
in articles 4.10 and 4.11 of the irrigation Manual of Order.
Sometimes earth is obtained by making borrow pits in the bed of a channel. This may
only be done with the permission of the executive engineer who must give detailed
instructions regarding the depth and width of the pits, having regard to the size of
channel, length of closure and to ensure that the full supply level shall not be affected.
Earth can also be obtained by lowering the berms. Whenever this is done the entire
width of the berm should be excavated in uniform layers leaving bars 10’ Wide in every
chain. The depth of digging should not be much, generally about a foot or so, to enable
the berms to reform in next working season. Special attention should be given and
measure taken to assist reformation.
Specifications for earth work are contained in Chapter 17 of CSR Volume: 1
8.4 Maintenance of the Hydraulic Characteristics of a Channel
Clean and Smooth Section
Clean and smooth section of a channel is very important for smooth flow of water. On
the sides, the berms are periodically trimmed to provide a fairly smooth surface. It is
necessary to ensure that no trees or roots project into the channel. As to the bed, it is
essential that all collections of jungle, bricks etc. or silt heaps that may be found during
a canal closure are removed immediately. This is very important in small channels.
Zamindars are in the habit of putting obstructions immediately below their outlets to
divert into their outlet, the supplies available during short supply turns. It is difficult to
stop such practices, but it is very important to remove all such obstructions in every
closure. When doing so, the material obtained should be put as far away as possible.
Sub Divisional Officers are required to make special inspection of channels during
closure to see that the beds and sides of channels are clear of all obstructions.
Floating Jungle
All floating jungle must be removed from a channel immediately it is noticed. The best
place is the head of channel where regulation beldars should usefully employ their
spare time in removing floating jungle, in small channel canal patrols should keep on
removing floating jungle as they go along the channel.
Cattle Ghats
Near village sites or on unabridged road, or even in the neighborhood bridges, there
is always some cattle trespass through the channel. Every effort must be made to
reduce this trespass to the very minimum. Where it is not possible to remove it
altogether, the only thing to do, is to recognize the place as a permanent ghat site and
to make a pucca ghat as per standard instructions and design. Failing this, it is
desirable to provide good long ramps on the sides for the cattle to come up to the
banks and to keep on removing silt from the bed at the ghat site.
8-6 MANUAL OF IRRIGATION PRACTICE
MAINTENANE OF CANALS
Drift sand
Sometimes a channel passes through sandy tracts and drift sand finds its way into it.
Part of the sand is carried along and the rest is deposited on the bed of the channel.
It is necessary to remove this sand periodically, but more permanent measures should
be evolved. One of these is the growing of ‘sarkanda’ or bushes on one side of the
channel so as to the stop the drift sand from entering the channel. In some places high
mud walls are efficient in keeping the blown sand from entering the channel.
Silt movement
An important hydraulic feature of a channel is the water level actually attained as
compared with the designed conditions. This is very closely related to silt movements.
The river conditions at the head of a canal may be such as to induct large quantities
of silt into the canal which, to start with deposit in the upper reaches of the canal.
Subsequent river condition may change or in winter when clear water enters the canal,
this silt is picked up and gradually carried down the canal into distributaries.
Distributaries head regulators are of various designs some are silt selective, others
take a proper share of silt, other are so designed either intentionally or unintentionally
as to take large quantities of silt. As described in chapter 9 the silt drawing capacity of
different types of outlets on the distributary varies considerably. Thus a change in any
of these factors upsets the silt equilibrium of a channel, and this leads bed of the
channel and of the water levels attained in it. Since all the off takes are designed to
take their authorized shares at definite water levels in the distributary, the equitable
distribution of water is upset.
8.5 Maintenance of Equitable Distribution of Water
Apart from the remodeling or silt clearance of channels as semi-permanent remedies
for the maintenance of equitable distribution of supplies there are other methods which
will make silt clearance or remodeling less frequent. These are summarized briefly
below.
H. Registers.
The first of these is the maintenance of H. registers. These registers which are in use
throughout the irrigation Branch maintain a record of the actual depth of water above
the crest of every outlet. By keeping a regular watch on these values the outlets which
draw comparatively large excesses are singled out and adjusted before conditions get
out of control. The detailed instructions regarding maintenance of H. registers are
given in the register itself.
Reading of Gauges
For the purpose of maintaining a proper watch on the equitable distribution of water,
apart from the H. registers, there is a system of observing gauges on the distributaries
of every canal. This system requires the reading of and reporting to the sub divisional
officer, executive engineer and superintending engineer in some cases, of the actual
gauges at the heads, tails and other control points on the distributaries. On certain
channels gauges at every mile are specially read for the purpose. Where the heads
and tails of channels are modular, the gauges at these sites and at the control points
on a channel are a measure of the discharge running in the channel, and a perusal of
these gauges give a correct idea of the actual state of distribution of water on a
distributary. Whenever with full supply running in a channel, any gauge lower down
MANUAL OF IRRIGATION PRACTICE 8-7
MAINTENANE OF CANALS
shows signs of falling short of the designed, it is up to the officer concerned to look
into the matter and take necessary action before the trouble grows acute.
Unauthorized use of water
Another important thing is to prevent all unauthorized use of irrigation water and actual
thefts of supplies. There are a number of ways in which these practices are indulged
in by the cultivators cuts in channels damage to outlets to increase their capacity,
siphoning away water by sheet iron or other pipes from a channel into the nearest
water- course, takkis along side outlets and similar other malpractices are adopted.
They are no doubt difficult to detect but a keen and vigilant eye is very necessary
particularly during the periods of keen demand. A high water level mark in a water-
course, or loose earth near an outlet site, sometimes leads to the discovery of such
practices. Whenever any such malpractice is found, immediate and direct action is
called for. IT is important to remember that the man who steals canal water does not
get additional supplies from the river. He get it only at the expense of the cultivators
lower down.
8.6 Miscellaneous
Jungle Clearance
Jungle must be up-rooted as soon as it shows up. Good maintenance requires that all
jungle in the entire canal length should be kept down. This works is normally done by
gangmen where such are employed. In particular, it must in any case be removed
before it flowers, for if it is not cut, the seed is carried away by water and induces jungle
growth elsewhere. Care should be taken to ensure that the jungle cut is not thrown
into the channel.
Distance Marks
Distance marks are established for the location of any point or work on a channel. To
serve their purpose they must be maintained in proper order. The maintenance of
distance marks usually comprises annual painting and figuring if of metal, and of white-
washing and figuring if of stone; in the latter case it is desirable to do the white-washing
twice or thrice a year . Sometimes a distance mark is broken or badly damaged, when
it must be replaced at once.
A useful practice is that overseers maintain a record of reduced levels at the distance
marks. Where this is done, any dislocation in the distance mark should be specially
looked into and the R.L. corrected.
Boundary stone.
Boundary stones are similarly fixed to demarcate the land width belonging to Irrigation
Branch. These should be white-washed at least once a year after the rainy season but
before the end of October. It is important to prevent encroachments by private persons
on canal lands. These encroachments are generally made by the adjoining cultivators
and for this reason the instructions contained in paragraph 4.6 of the Irrigation Manual
of Orders must be carefully followed.
8.7 Rules for the Working of Departmental Maintenance Gangs.
In every sub-division which has charge of irrigation channels or drains there is usually
a large establishment employed on regular basis for maintenance work, (the term
canal patrol includes gangmen employed for maintenance). For proper control of this
establishment, it is necessary to lay down a definite procedure to ensure that full value
8-8 MANUAL OF IRRIGATION PRACTICE
MAINTENANE OF CANALS
is obtained from every man so employed. The exact instructions may vary from place
to place depending on the nature of work to be done. The following are, however,
given as a guide. The detailed rules for adoption in each sub-division may be prepared
by the sub-divisional officer concerned in consultation with his executive engineer.
Two systems are in vogue in the Irrigation Branch. In the first, all gangmen work
together under the directions of the head gangman (Mate or Mistry). In this system,
the head gangman is in charge of the progress and quality of the work done and the
individual gangmen do not carry any responsibility in the matter. The amount of work
done thus depends on the integrity and enthusiasm displayed by the head gangman.
In the other system, definite reaches of channels are allocated to individual gangmen
who are made responsible for the standard of maintenance in their reaches. The duties
of the head gangman are in this case to guide and instruct the gangmen and see that
they do their work properly. The later system is generally to be preferred and the
detailed instructions that follow are applicable to the latter system. This system is to
be adopted unless the executive engineer concerned decides otherwise.
Reaches to be allotted to gangmen.
Every gangman should work either individually or in pairs. Each individual or pair
should be allotted a definite reach of the channel to look after. The length of the reach
will depend upon the standard of maintenance required on the channel and upon the
nature of soil of the reach, and will be determined by the sub-divisional officer in
consultation with the executive engineer. No gangmen may be ordered to work outside
their allotted reaches except in emergencies.
Equipment
The gangmen should be given serial numbers with No.1 to the gangman at the head
of a channel. These numbers should be painted on both sides of the sheet iron disc
9” diameter. Each gangman is to be supplied with his number plate fixed on M S bar
and also to be supplied with the following tools depending on the nature of his work:-
1. A kassi and a basket.
2. A bucket for watering.
3. A khurpa.
4. Ring and patti.
5. Red flag. The flag should be rectangular,2 ft. long and 1 ft. wide.
6. Sickle.
7. Small axe.
8. String hundred feet long.
9. One lantern.
10. One kundi, fixed to a 6’-12’ long bamboo pole per gang.
The gangman should be provided with green turbans by the Department. The head
gangmen and mates should wear red turban to identify themselves.
Leave to Gangmen
Gangmen may be given leave on Sundays twice a month. But all the gangmen should
never be absent from a channel at one time. Half the gangmen may be given leave on
alternate Sundays.
Working Hours.
The working hours for gangmen will be as follows:
MANUAL OF IRRIGATION PRACTICE 8-9
MAINTENANE OF CANALS
area. Report of accident should be submitted to the higher authorities as per orders
contained in Paras 1.64 and 2.101 of the PWD Code.
Accidents on Barrages
Nature of Accidents: A serious accident to a canal head-works may necessitate the
closure of or the reduction of the supply in a canal at a time when the demand of
irrigation water is very keen, so every precaution must be taken to prevent accidents.
Accidents that do occur can generally be attributed to one of the following causes.
a. Failure to comply with the rules and regulations framed for the control and
maintenance of the head-works.
b. Defective gates, shutters and regulating machinery
c. Use of unserviceable boats and employment of in-efficient boatman.
d. Failure to maintain embankment in good order and to patrol them during
floods
8.8.1.1 Suggestions for the Prevention of Accidents on Barrages
Rules and regulations for the control and maintenance of Barrages: These rules
are carefully prepared, and if they are rigorously followed, accidents will be few. Any
accident which is found to be due to non-compliance with any of the rules and
regulations will be classed as due to gross negligence concerned. Copies of these
rules, both in English and Urdu should be available on the head-works at all times and
a copy should be in the possession of the Executive Engineer, Sub Divisional Officer,
Sub Engineer, Head Jamadar and all Naib Jamadars. The main points requiring
attention are recorded below.
I. Staff recruitment, training and discipline: At the time of recruitment of staff,
it should be ensured that the selectees should be healthy, able bodies and
strong swimmers. The new incumbents should be properly trained and should
know what their duties are?
II. Soundings and probing: The regular observation of soundings and probing is
most important as they show any subsidence in concrete block and loose stone
protection and enable the officer incharge to put in additional protection before
an accident occurs.
III. The Standing Wave: marks should be made on piers and abutments to indicate
a line below which the Standing Wave should not be allowed to form. If the wave
forms below this line a deep scour hole may occur into which the loose stone
protection and concrete blocks may subside. The position of the Standing Wave
can be regulated by adjusting the openings of the gates.
IV. Observations in Pressure Pipes: observations in pressure pipes indicate the
upward pressure on the floor of a structure. Such observations are important as
they enable action to be taken to strengthen the floor before it blows up.
Pressure pipes are liable to become chocked with sand or silt which must be
removed before observations are made.
V. Regulation during floods: The Executive Engineer or the Sub Divisional
Officer must be present on the head-works during the passage of floods. Other
suggestions for the prevention of accidents during the passage of floods are:
a. Reduce cross flow in the vicinity of the works to a minimum. Pay
special attention to the flow around noses of spurs and groynes.
b. Distribute the flood discharge over the width of the weir in such a way
as to reduce severe action in the vicinity of the works to a minimum.
MANUAL OF IRRIGATION PRACTICE 8-11
MAINTENANE OF CANALS
c. Comply strictly with the rules regarding closing the canal during the
flood and re-opening after the flood has passed.
Maintenance of machinery on Barrages: To prevent accidents special attention
should be paid to the moving parts of the machinery and regular inspections by
competent mechanics should be carried out.
Boats: Local rules should be framed for the use and maintenance of boats. The rules
should inter alia, contain instructions regarding:
a. Recruitment and training of boatman.
b. Equipment of boats
c. Selection of sites for mooring boats
d. Use of only serviceable boats,
e. Use of boats for making observations in the vicinity of the gates of a barrage or
a regulator.
f. Controlling the navigation of country boats across a head works
g. Controlling the movement of country boats around a head works
h. Controlling the movement of boats used for crossing a canal in the absence of
bridge at a site of canal.
* for more details, consult Chapter 5 on Barrages
Maintenance of Flood Embankments: For controlling accidents to the embankments
it is essential to maintain them in proper condition. This requires that
a. Trespassing over the embankment should be controlled
b. A gang of beldars should regularly do petty repairs such as filling rain cuts, rat
holes and rooting out rank vegetation on the side slopes and for a distance of
5 feet from the toe of the embankment.
c. Grass growth on side slopes should be encouraged for protection against wave
wash on river side and guttering on land side.
d. Road crossings should be made 12 feet wide and with longitudinal ramp slopes
up and down the embankment of not less than 1 in 6 for cattle and 1 in 20 for
cart traffic. Where a cattle path or a road crosses at right angles, the ramp slope
should start atleast 10 feet from each of core lines, to preserve the top width of
bank from being reduced by traffic.
e. In reaches where water is available, and plantation would grow, pilchi,
sarkanda, kikar or willow should be planted for a width of about 100 feet in front
of the toe of embankment as the existence of this plantation breaks the force of
waves.
f. In reaches where water is not available and grass cannot be planted on slopes,
pilchi farash or sarkanda mattress should be provided on river side slope for
protection against wave action.
g. Leakages should be stopped from the upstream side by cutting off the
penetrating water at its source. Spare good earth should be available on the
embankment, which should be used to plug the source of leakage.
h. Leakages can also be closed by throwing saw dust, bran, powdered dung etc
just upstream of them. The stuff is carried by water into the leaks, where it
swells and stops the leaks.
Accidents on other Canal Works:
Accidents to and on other canal works can generally be attributed to one of the causes
noted below.
8-12 MANUAL OF IRRIGATION PRACTICE
MAINTENANE OF CANALS
causes wave or eddy action. Sub Divisional Officers and Sub Engineers should from
time to time show the regulating staff how to reduce such action to a minimum.
If the scour hole develops to such an extent as to endanger the structure; temporary
measures must be taken to protect it until the canal can be closed.
Accidents due to pumping: In order to prevent silt or sand being sucked out from
below the foundations of a structure, the officer in-charge of the work should fix a level
below which water in the foundation pit should not be lowered by pumping during the
execution of alterations or repairs.
Accidents to Siphons and Culverts: Serious accidents have occurred due to the
outfall channel of siphons and culverts becoming blocked by silt or detritus or by sand
being drawn out from below the foundations by the action of springs. Siphons and
culverts should be divided into three categories, viz
a. There should be a space of at least 50 ft between huts. No individual hut should
occupy more than 200 ft.
b. Bamboos fitted with iron hooks should be kept at suitable places in the camp
so that, in case of fire a burning hut can be quickly pulled down. Heaps of dry
sand should also be available at suitable places in the camp.
c. Endeavors should be made to persuade the labour not to smoke or cook their
food inside the huts.
Compensation for Injury to Personnel
The personnel suffering from accidents may have minor or serious/ fatal injuries which
entitle him compensation according to labour laws. The key law protecting the workers
and allowing compensation for injuries by accident is the Workmen’s Compensation
Act (WCA) 1923.
Employer's liability for compensation — If personal injury is caused to a workman
by accident arising out of and in the course of his employment, his employer shall be
liable to pay compensation in accordance with the provisions of WCA.
The Employees Social Security Ordinance (ESSO), 1965: This ordinance
introduces a scheme of social security for providing benefits/compensation to certain
employees or their departments in the event of sickness, maternity, employment injury
or death and related matters. This ordinance also defines critical issues such as
“disablement”:
It is also important to note that both the WCA and ESSO are in addition to each other
and not in derogation of each other as the affective person / employee may get
compensation under the law of his choice or under the both statutes simultaneously.”
Procedure to be followed in the Event of an Accident Causing Injury to
Government Employees /Workers
I. In the event of an accident, the injured person should be given first aid at site
and subsequently sent to the nearest dispensary or hospital for further
treatment if considered necessary.
II. In case the injury is of such a nature that the workman will be unable to return
to work within 48 hours, a report of accident should be made immediately by
the Sub Divisional Officer and sent to the Executive Engineer (XEN) and
Superintending Engineer (SE) in-charge. The report should be dispatched in
8-14 MANUAL OF IRRIGATION PRACTICE
MAINTENANE OF CANALS
In the case of an accident resulting in death or serious injury which is likely to result
in a claim for compensation under the WCA, an official enquiry should be held within
24 hours of the occurrence by an officer not below the rank of a Sub Divisional
Officer. The enquiry should be held at site of accident and the report should bring
out facts whether the accident was due to negligence on the part of the
injured/deceased person or due to willful disregard of any rules /safety instructions
or due to a mishap beyond the control of the injured/deceased. The report should
also record statements of witnesses and a medical report of the doctor about the
injury, disablement if any or death. In case of death of a workman, the official enquiry
report should be sent to the Chief Engineer and the Administrative Department so
as to pay compensation to the deceased’s family as per applicable laws.
Reference(s):
- MIP 1963
MANUAL OF IRRIGATION PRACTICE i
OUTLETS
Chapter 9
OUTLETS
Compiled by
Table of Contents
9 OUTLETS ........................................................................................................ 9-1
9.1 INTRODUCTION ............................................................................................ 9-1
9.2 CONSIDERATIONS FOR THE DESIGN OF AN OUTLET......................................... 9-1
9.3 ESSENTIAL CONSIDERATIONS TO BE SATISFIED .............................................. 9-2
9.4 MAJOR TYPES OF OUTLETS .......................................................................... 9-2
9.5 CLASSIFICATION OF OUTLETS ....................................................................... 9-3
9.6 SOME IMPORTANT TERMS ............................................................................ 9-3
Flexbility ................................................................................................ 9-4
Setting: This is the ratio of the head (H) acting on the outlet to the depth
of water (D) in the distributary. Thus ................................................................ 9-4
Proportionality: ...................................................................................... 9-4
Sensitivity(s): ......................................................................................... 9-6
Efficiency: .............................................................................................. 9-7
Drowning Ratio ...................................................................................... 9-7
Minimum Modular Head (MMH) ............................................................ 9-7
Modular Limits ....................................................................................... 9-7
Modular Range ...................................................................................... 9-7
Adjustability........................................................................................ 9-7
9.7 SELECTION OF TYPES OF OUTLETS ................................................................ 9-7
9.8 POPULAR OUTLETS IN PAKISTAN................................................................... 9-8
9.9 TYPES OF SEMI-MODULAR OUTLETS ............................................................. 9-9
Pipe Outlet Discharging Free ................................................................ 9-9
Open Flume Outlet .............................................................................. 9-11
Orifice Semi Modular Outlet (A.O.S.M)................................................ 9-18
Crump’s Adjustable proportional Module ............................................. 9-19
Adjustable Orifice Semi Module (A.O.S.M) as used presently ............. 9-21
Scratchley Outlet ................................................................................. 9-22
Departmental Procedure for Selecting Types of Outlets ..................... 9-24
Selection of the Class and Type of Outlet ........................................... 9-27
Special Requirements of the Non-Perennial Channels of the Sutlef Valley
Canals (Proportioanl Outlets) ......................................................................... 9-28
List of Tables
TABLE 9.1 ............................................................................................................... 9-23
List of Figures
FIGURE 1: PIPE SEMI MODULE .................................................................................... 9-9
FIGURE 2: PIPE OUTLET (NON-MODULAR TYPE) .......................................................... 9-10
FIGURE 3: CRUMP'S OPEN FLUME OUTLET ................................................................ 9-12
FIGURE 4: PUNJAB OPEN FLUME OUTLET .................................................................. 9-14
FIGURE 5: TAIL CLUSTER ......................................................................................... 9-17
FIGURE 6: CRUMP’S ADJUSTABLE PROPORTIONAL MODULE ........................................ 9-21
iv MANUAL OF IRRIGATION PRACTICE
OUTLETS
MANUAL OF IRRIGATION PRACTICE 9-1
OUTLETS
9 OUTLETS
9.1 Introduction
An outlet is a structure at the head of a watercourse, which connects it with the
distributary. In Pakistan, the Irrigation channels are under control of the Provincial
Irrigation Departments. Thus an outlet is the connecting link between the canal
operator representing the Government and the farmer or user. It follows that the design
and operation of the outlet must satisfy the needs of both the parties as far as possible.
For example, the farmer will want to be satisfied that he receives his due share of the
water at the right time and the operator will want to be satisfied that the outlet
structures ensures effective control over the distribution of supplies equitably.
Throughout the irrigated areas in the world, the engineers, farmers and others have
invented or designed various kinds of outlets for particular conditions. Some of the
ideas never came to fruition but a large number of them have proved satisfactory and
have stood the test of time. For example, the Adjustable Orifice Semi-Module,
developed in the Punjab and the Jamrao type Orifice Semi-Module, developed in Sind,
even though developed independently are interchangeable. Thus, abundant
experience has been accumulated in the sub-continent on which to base choice of the
best type of outlet to suit local condition. However, this does not preclude the possibility
of improving existing outlets or evolving new types which may be superior structurally,
hydraulically and economically. In fact a great deal of research remains to be done on
this subject.
There are much more outlets than other structures in an irrigation system and,
therefore, these have a decisive influence on the functioning and performance of a
system. For example in the U.S.A. in 1960, there were some 160,000 outlets on
irrigation systems. In Punjab there are about 58,000 outlets at present.
It is experienced that the field staff have to remodel and design the outlets themselves
frequently and as such this topic has been dealt with thoroughly so that full
understanding may be developed for design of the outlets
9.2 Considerations for the Design of an Outlet
As far back as 1906, Mr. Kennedy set forth desiderata for the efficient design of an
irrigation outlet quoted as below.
(a) To keep the discharge automatically constant as adjusted, and indicated,
notwithstanding (within working limits) the water levels may vary in the
distributary or in the watercourse, or in both at once.
(b) To allow adjustment in case of variations in the discharges, so as to avoid the
need of removing and replacing the outlet,
(c) To work with high heads as well as low - down to three inches or so
(d) To be free from derangement by silt or weeds.
(e) To be cheap and durable, with no complicated or moving mechanism.
(f) To be immune from outside interference or derangement in working.
(g) To be capable of being opened or closed off entirely by the cultivators from
outside.
9-2 MANUAL OF IRRIGATION PRACTICE
OUTLETS
(h) To indicate from outside when the working head is insufficient to give the full
discharge and, therefore, there is necessity for clearance of the watercourse.
(i) If so desired and adjusted, to work as a module, only within certain limits of
level in the distributary, above and below these limits to give proportionately
increased or decreased discharges. (This is with special reference to farmers'
canals, where each man is entitled to a proportion of the whole available
supply).
9.3 Essential Considerations to be Satisfied
Of course, it is not possible to satisfy all the conditions enumerated by Kennedy in any
one type of outlet. However, it i s highly desirable that:
i. Every outlet should be strong and so designed that it cannot easily be
tampered with.
ii. The cost of construction should be low, using local materials whenever
available,
iii. These should be standardized as far as possible.
iv. In areas of only less slope, the outlet should work efficiently with a small
working head.
v. The outlet should draw its fair share of the silt from the distributary
vi. It should not be blocked with weeds or debris.
vii. It should be adjustable easily in case of alteration in design discharge.
viii. For inspection, it may be closed easily
ix. It should be tamper proof as far as possible
x. It should work efficiently with small working head
xi. The optimum size of an outlet should be the discharge which a cultivator can
handle efficiently and easily and the absorption losses in the watercourse are
minimum.
Working out design discharge of an outlet has been explained under the Chapter,
“Design of Unlined Canal” (Chapter 6).
9.4 Major Types of Outlets
Following is a list of major types of outlets utilized in the countries having artificial
irrigation
i. Constant-Head Orifice Farm Turnout (U. S. A.)
ii. Orifice Module (France)
iii. Double Orifice Module or Syphon Module Outlet (France)
iv. Dethridge Meter (Australia)
v. Plastic Syphon Outlet Fitted With an Intake Tube (Turkey)
vi. Open Flume Farm Outlet (India and Pakistan)
vii. Adjustable Orifice Semi- Module (India and Pakistan )
viii. Jamrao Type Orifice Semi-Module (Sind, Pakistan)
ix. Pipe Semi-Module (India and Pakistan)
x. Fayoum Standard Weir Farm Outlet (Egypt)
xi. Scratchley Outlet (India and Pakistan)
xii. Pipe Outlet (India and Pakistan)
xiii. Farm Outlet to a Temporary Feed Ditch (U. S. S. R.)
xiv. Pre-Cast Farm Turnout (Turkey)
xv. Adjustable Weir Farm Outlet (Malaysia)
xvi. PVC Pipe Turnout (Republic of Korea)
MANUAL OF IRRIGATION PRACTICE 9-3
OUTLETS
a. Flexibility
b. Setting
c. Proportionality
d. Sensitivity
e. Efficiency
f. Drowning Ratio
g. Minimum Modular Head
h. Modular Limits
i. Modular Range
j. Adjustability
Flexbility
The flexibility of an outlet is defined as the ratio of change of discharge of the outlet to the
rate of change of discharge of the distributary. Thus
𝑑𝑞
( )
……………….(i)
𝑞
F= 𝑑𝑄
( )
𝑄
Where:
F = Flexibility of the outlet
q = Discharge through the outlet
dq = Change in discharge of the outlet
Q = Discharge of the distributary
dQ = Change in discharge of the distributary
By analysis, it can be shown that
𝑚 𝐷
F= . ……………………..(ii)
𝑛 𝐻
𝑑𝑄 𝑑𝐷
= 𝑛. ( 𝐷 )……………….(iia)
𝑄
Where:
m= Outlet discharge index
n = Distributary Index
D= Depth of water in the distributary
H= Head acting on the outlet
Obviously for modular outlet, flexibility is zero, hence it is called rigid module. For semi
modular outlet it is never zero
Setting: This is the ratio of the head (H) acting on the outlet to the depth
of water (D) in the distributary. Thus
H
Setting= D……………….(iii)
Where H= head acting i.e., depth of crest below FSL in the distributary. (For a Semi-
modular pipe outlet, it is depth of center line of pipe below FSL).
Proportionality:
An outlet is said to be proportional when its flexibility (F) is equal to unity. In other
words, for a proportional outlet, the rate of change of discharge of the outlet is equal
to the rate of change of discharge in the distributary. Thus form equation (i), for F=1,
dq dQ
=Q
q
m D
. =1
n H
H m
Or =
D n
H
As already mentioned, D is known as setting. Thus for a proportional outlet, the setting
is equal to the ratio of the outlet index (m) to the channel index (n)
Now for a wide trapezoidal channel in an alluvial soil, the discharge Q is approximately
proportional to D5/3. Thus for Open Flume Outlet:
As, q∞H3/2 (Q=C,B,H3/2)
H
From eq. (ii) =
3/2
= 0.90D
D 5/3
In other words, for proportionality, an Open Flume Outlet should be set such that the
crest is 0.9 times the depth (D) below the FSL in the distributary (i.e., the crest is at a
height of 0.1D from bed of the distributary)
For pipe outlet or orifice type outlet:
In this case, q∞ H1/2
Therefore, m= ½
H
From eq. (ii) ==
1/2
D 5/3
Or H= 0.3 D
In other words, for an orifice or pipe outlet to be proportional, it should be set such that
its center is at a depth of 0.3 D below FSL in the distributary, i.e., at a height of 0.7 D
above the bed. Thus an orifice outlet has to be set much higher than the Open Flume
Outlet for proportionality.
9.6.3.1 Hyper – Proportional Outlets:
An outlet is said to be hyper- proportional when its flexibility is greater than unity. In
other words, the rate of change of discharge through the outlet is greater than the rate
of change of discharge in the distributary.
dq dQ
Thus from Eq. (i), for F>1, >
q Q
Thus if the head over a proportional outlet is increased, it becomes sub- proportional.
In other words, as the setting is increased, a proportional outlet becomes sub-
proportional.
For illustration of the proportional, hyper- proportional and sub- proportional outlets,
let us consider a pipe ( or orifice) outlet in a distributary with D=1 m. For the outlet to
be proportional
m
H=0.30 m, as already proved, and =0.3
n
H m
a. When H= 0.20 m, D=0.2/1 = 0.2 < n …………it works as hyper-proportional outlet.
H m
b. When H= 0.40 m, D= 0.4/1= 0.4 > n ……..…it works as sub-proportional outlet
Sensitivity(s):
It is the ratio of rate of change of discharge of an outlet to the rate of change in Water
level in the distributary referred to the normal depth of flow (D) of the channel. Thus
dq dG
Sensitivity (S)= / ……………iv
q D
Where, dG is the change in gauge reading which is equal to the change in the water
level of the distributary.
A gauge is usually set on the distributary such that when the discharge through the
outlet is zero, the gauge reading is zero. Let G be the reading on the gauge when
discharge in the distribury is Q. Hence, the change in the depth of flow (dD) will be
equal to the change in the gauge reading (dG).
dq dD
Thus equation iv may be written as S= / ……………………………v
q D
Eq. (v) indicates that the greater the variation in the rate of change of discharge of the
outlet for a given change in the water level of the distributary, the larger is the
sensitivity.
If the rate of change of discharge in an outlet for a given change in water level of the
distributary is zero, the module is insensitive. Such a model is called Rigid Module.
Thus, sensitivity of a rigid model is zero because the discharge passing through the
outlet is constant, irrespective of the variation in the water level of the distributary.
9.6.4.1 Relationship between Sensitivity and Flexibility:
A relation between sensitivity and flexibility can be obtained as follows :
𝑑𝑞 𝑑𝑄
From Eq (i), F= /.
𝑞 𝑄
𝑑𝑄 𝑑𝐷
From Eq. (iia) 𝑄
= 𝑛. ( 𝐷 )
𝑑𝑞 𝑑𝐷
Therefore, F= /𝑛 ………(a)
𝑞 𝐷
MANUAL OF IRRIGATION PRACTICE 9-7
OUTLETS
𝑑𝑞 𝑑𝐷
From Eq. (vi), S= /. ……….(b)
𝑞 𝐷
near the bed level of the channel (0.96 y for proportional discharge), provided the
necessary head is available. If sufficient head is not available, an open flume fitted
with a roof block having a similar setting may be used. These outlets are popular in
the Sind Province.
Scratchley Outlet – These are used if it is not desirable to install any other type of
semi-module.
Pipe Semi Module - When banks of the distributary are very wide, pipe is used with
the modules. The setting of the module will be as indicated in supra for the respective
conditions. In cases where crest of the outlet cannot be placed at or near the bed level,
pipe semi-module of the lowest possible flexibility may be used. A typical such open
flume outlet is shown in Fig-1
exit level is higher than the water level in the watercourse, the head (h) acting on the
outlet is measured from water level in the distributary to the center of the outlet pipe.
The discharge formula is:
Q=C.A.√2gHw
Where,
Q = discharge (in cms)
C = coefficient of discharge, generally taken as 0.62,
A = cross section area of the pipe (m2)
Hw = working head (in m).
Because the discharge is proportional to h1/2, the value of the outlet index (m) is 0.50.
As already shown in the preceding sections, the outlet will act as proportional outlet if:
H m
= = (1/2)/(5/3)= 0.30.
𝐷 n
In other words, it will act as proportional outlet if it is set such that the center of the
pipe exit is 0.3 times the depth (D) below water surface in the distributary. In practice,
the pipe outlet is generally set at a level lower than 0.3D and therefore it acts as sub-
proportional outlet because the head over the outlet is increased.
To obtain free flow condition, the pipe is sometimes laid with upstream end at bed level
of the distributary and its axis sloping upward through the bank such that its pipe exit
at least 15 cm above the highest water level in the watercourse. However to avoid
practical difficulties, the slope should not exceed 1 in 12.
Merits:
a. The efficiency of a pipe outlet discharging free is high
b. It has the best silt conduction properties
c. Tempering is difficult, as whole pipe has to be changed for increasing
flow, which can readily be detected by the field staff
d. Very simple to construct.
e. Economical construction
A pipe outlet with exit end of the pipe submerged in water in the water course works
as a non- modular outlet (Fig. 2). The pipes are placed horizontally and at right angles
to the center line of the distributing channel. Discharge through the pipe outlet is given
by the same formula except that h is the difference between water level in the
distributary and the watercourse.
ii. It is very suitable for proportional distributors, and for outlets within 300
m(1000ft) of a control point, in tail reach clusters and even in head reaches of
a channel when the working head available is small.
iii. The structure requires no manual control.
iv. The water surface level in the supply canal above the crest of the outlet can be
read and the corresponding discharge obtained from the prescribed formula.
9.9.2.2 Disadvantages of Open Flume Outlet
i. It is not provided with any gate arrangement and it is not possible to shut it for
inspection when the channel is running.
ii. This outlet has been developed for systems in which channels are run at full
supply level with little fluctuation of discharge in the supply. These systems are
usually not equipped with check structures and, therefore, in the case of low
discharges, the outlets would not draw their design discharge.
iii. In many cases the open flume outlet has to be either deep or narrow (in which
case it is easily blocked) or shallow and wide (in which case it is hyper
proportional and also fails to draw its fair share of silt). To overcome the defect
of high flexibility, a roof block is fitted in the gullet of an open flume, at the vena
contracta, clear of the water surface in the gullet when the outlet is drawing its
full supply discharge.
iv. This outlet can be tampered by placing a thin wooden plank, fitting the throat,
half way between the crest and the water level. This increases the discharge
by 16% if the outlet is working as a free fall.
9.9.2.3 Crump’s Open Flume Outlet
This type was first constructed on the Bari Doab Canal in Punjab (Fig- 3). Later on,
this type was modified slightly and a standardized Punjab open flume outlet was
evolved and widely adopted.
It is a weir with contracted throat followed by an expanding flume on the downstream.
The length of weir crest is 2.5 G, where G is the head over weir crest in m.
Due to fluming, hypercritical velocity is generated on the downstream of the crest and
hydraulic jump occurs. It is, therefore, independent of the water level in the
watercourse. Upstream wing wall is made smaller by the distance equal to width of
opening of the outlet at its mouth. If it is equal to W, wing wall is set back by W and its
value is given by
W = q/Q.
The set back is provided to enable the outlet to take fair share of silt.
The length of flume downstream of crest will naturally be equal to the horizontal length
of the distributary bank. The slope of downstream glacis depends on the bed level in
water course.
The discharge of outlet is given by equation
q = K.B.G3/2
Where G = Head over crest in m or (ft)
K = Coefficient of discharge having theoretical value of 3.087 ( 1.77
in MKS)
Due to enterance losses for different widths of throat, value of K differs and can be
taken as follows:
B in Ft K
0.2 ft t0 0.29 ft 2.90
0.3 ft to 0.39 ft 2.95
More than 0.4 ft 3.00
The minimum value of B should be 0.20 ft to avoid choking of throat due to debris. The
coefficient remains constant for all discharges as long as minimum modular head is
available. Modularity can be checked visually by seeing the formation of hydraulic
jump.
For MKS system
As already mentioned, the outlet will be proportional if the crest is set such that H/D=
0.90. If the outlet is set higher than this, the outlet is hyper proportional and if lower,
the outlet is sub proportional. The efficiency of the outlet is between 80 and 90%
As the minimum throat width of the outlet is usually specified as 0.20ft or 0.06m to
avoid choking by floating debris. Therefore, for small discharges, a higher setting of
crest would be required which results in poor silt conduction.
9-14 MANUAL OF IRRIGATION PRACTICE
OUTLETS
Solution
Minimum Modular Hear required, MMH = 0.2×H
Available working Head Hw = 0.15 m (0.49 ft)
Therefore, 0.2 H= 0.15, or H = 0.75 m (2.45ft)
This is thus maximum value of H (head over crest) to be adopted for semi modular
working of the outlet.
Adopt the minimum value of the throat width= 0.61 cm (0.20ft)
Now Q = C.B. H3/2
1.77 = 2.9×(0.20)×H3/2 ( 1.77=3.03*0.2*H^3/2)
Required by MMH….ok
Or, H =2.03ft< 2.45 ft i.e., head over crest is less than that
required MMH…..OK
Setting (S)= H/D= 2.03/2.62= 0.80 <0.90 (required for
proportionality)
The setting is slightly lower than that required for proportional outlet. The outlet will act
as a hyper proportional outlet, and it will not take its fair share of silt.
Example 3
Design an open flume outlet, with a discharge of 50 liters per second, for a distributary
with a full supply depth of 100 cm. The working head available for the outlet is 15 cm.
Q = 50 l/s (1.77 cfs)
Y1 = 100 cm (3.28 ft)
Hw =15 cm (0.49 ft)
Since MMH for an open flume outlet is 0.2 H, the maximum H for the outlet can be
2.45 ft i.e. 0.49/ 0.20. OR 75 cm (15/0.2).
With H = 2.45ft, and Q = 1.77 cfs, the width B will be 0.15 ft, (i. e. less than 0.20 ft).
Adopt the minimum value of B = 0.20ft
Then 1.77 = 2.90× 0.20 ×H^3/2
or H3/2= 1.77/2.90x0.20
or H= 2.10 ft
For which, MMH=0.42 (2.1×0.2) against 0.49 ft available….OK
Setting= 2.10/ 3.28=0.64%
The design is suitable but setting of the outlet is high (0.64 vs. 0.90 required). This is
not too high but the outlet will not take its fair share of silt. Should it be necessary to
conduct silt effectively, it is possible though costly, to build a combined pipe and open
flume outlet with pipe setting at bed level.
Example 4 - Assume the outlet in Example 3 is located just above or within a short
distance of a fall in the channel which has a depth over crest under full supply condition
of 1.65 ft. Let the available working head of the outlet be 2.30 ft cm. Design a suitable
outlet.
9-16 MANUAL OF IRRIGATION PRACTICE
OUTLETS
Hw= 2.30 ft
Since the outlet is above or close to a control point in the channel, H of the open flume
outlet should be the same as that of the fall, viz: 1.65ft. This will ensure proportional
distribution
Thus Q= 50 l/s (1.77 cfs)
H= 50 cm (1.65 ft.)
Q= CB.H^3/2
Or 1.77= 2.95 ×B×(1.65)3/2
Then B= 0.28 ft
The minimum working head required for this size is 0.33 ft (1.65×0.2), which is much
less than the available working head. If proportionality is not necessary, a more rigid
outlet can be considered by designing an orifice semi-module.
9.9.2.6 Tail Clusters
Three standard designs for open flume outlets in tail clusters are shown in Fig- 5. The
crests of the outer flumes in a tail cluster (three-way and four- way) are sometimes
built 0.06 cm lower than the inner flume to compensate for velocity of approach. The
standard 30 cm gauge should in such cases be fixed with its zero at the crest level of
the inner flume. With this arrangement the widths of the flume above the full supply
level are made proportional to the designed width of the flume below the full supply
level in order to distribute benefits of any excess water reaching the tail of the canal
proportionately to all the outlets.
MANUAL OF IRRIGATION PRACTICE 9-17
OUTLETS
An examination of the available working heads of the three outlets show that if H be
0.98 ft, all the outlets will work modularly.
MMH= 0.98×0.2= .196 ft
Then for tail right outlet
Q= C.B.H3/2
Or 1.77= 2.95×B ×(1.00)3/2
Or B= 0.6 ft
Adopt Crest Level= 99.00 (100- 1.00)
Tail Center Outlet
Q=C,B.H3/2
2.83= 2.95×B.×1.003\2
Or B= 0.95 ft
Crests level= 99.00 (axis assumed parallel to flow in parent channel)
Tail Left Outlet
Q=C,B.H3/2
1.06=2.95xBx 1.003/2
B= 0.35 ft
Adopt crest level= 99.00ft
In case of three and four-way clusters, the crest of the central outlet with its axis
parallel to the flow in the supply canal will be 0.196 ft higher than the other two or three
side outlets.
Orifice Semi Modular Outlet (A.O.S.M)
An Orifice Semi Modular Outlet consists of an orifice with gradually expanding flume
on its downstream side. The flow through the orifice produces a super critical velocity
which results in the formation of a hydraulic jump. This makes the discharge through
the outlet independent of the water level in the watercourse, and the outlet acts as
semi modular. Adjustable orifice semi-module outlets are widely used in Pakistan.
There are various forms of these outlets but the earliest of those is the one introduced
by E. S. Crump in 1922 and called the "Adjustable Proportional Module" (APM).
Crump’s s design aimed at fixing the crest at a setting of 0.6 of the supply depth in the
parent channel, which ensured exact proportionality. However, according to past
experience in Punjab with APM fitted, the distributaries silted up badly. The problem
was that it could not draw its fair share of silt, an essential requirement for those
irrigation systems which draw their supplies from the rivers.
Thus the APM has now been replaced in the sub- continent the Adjustable Orifice
Semi-Module (A.O.S.M) which is neither proportional nor fully modular, but ensures
fair distribution of silt. (See Figure ).
9.9.3.1 Structural and Design Charactersitics
Structurally, the A.O.S.M may be regarded as a long throated flume with a roof block
capable of vertical adjustment in the upstream end of the parallel throat. It differs from
the open flume outlet as regards the length of throat and also in that the upstream
water level in the supply canal is more than one third above the bottom of the roof
block.
MANUAL OF IRRIGATION PRACTICE 9-19
OUTLETS
The upstream face wall or upstream wing wall on the supply canal is curved and flared.
The curvature ends 7.5 cm upstream of start of the crest. The downstream face wall,
or downstream wing wall on the supply canal, is set forward inside the canal by a
distance, which is, generally equal to:
𝑄2
(B+y1/2)
𝑄1
where
Q2 = Discharge through outlet,
Q1 = Discharge of channel
B = Bed width of distributary
Y = Depth of Distributary upstream of the outlet
Setting forward should only be done when the bed width of the canal is reduced below
the outlet, keeping the downstream wing wall at the downstream end and the upstream
wing wall at the upstream toe slope. The length of the parallel throat is2.00 ft or 60 cm
for all cases. There is no horizontal crest portion of the throat and a glacis sloping at
1 in 15 starts right from the upstream end of the parallel sides of the throat.
Crump’s Adjustable proportional Module
Generally abbreviation APM is used for this type of outlet. It is also called Adjustable
Orifice Semi-Module (A.O.S.M.). The outlet is shown in Fig- 6. In this type a cast iron
roof block is provided by bolts in masonry at the entrance end which can be adjusted
so that the orifice opening can be changed. The roof block is fixed to two check plates
on either side by bolts which can be removed to adjust depth of the outlet after the
masonry has been dismantled. This block is given curve at the lower end on the
entrance side. It is given a tilt of 1 in 7. At the sill also a cast iron base is provided. A
check plate 0.3 m wide is also provided.
The base plates and the roof blocks are manufactured in standard sizes such as
B=6.1, 7.6, 9.9, 12.2, 15.4, 19.5, 24.4 and 30.5 cm. These standard sizes are used to
obtain the desired discharges through the outlet by adjusting the orifice opening. In
order to enable outlet to take fair share of silt, the upstream wing wall of the outlet is
set back by a distance W, given by
𝑘
W= K(𝑄). (Bu+ 0.5D)
Where:
Bu= Width of the distributary upstream of the outlet
K= Constant, the value depends upon the discharge in the distributary
as follows:
Discharge (Q) Less than 0.283 0.283- 1.415 1.415- 5.66 Greater than 5.55
cumec
To facilitate smooth water entry, upstream wing-wall is made smaller in length. There
is a throat of uniform length for about 0.60 m. The side walls diverge out with a radius
of 7.625 m. The bed of the outlet is laid with a slope of 1 in 15 till it joins the bed of
watercourse. Whole outlet is constructed with masonry. Thus, this outlet is perfectly
rigid once the roof block is fixed. But at the same time after dismantling the masonry
slightly the opening can be adjusted by lowering or raising the roof block. Velocity of
9-20 MANUAL OF IRRIGATION PRACTICE
OUTLETS
water in the outlet is super critical. As a result hydraulic jump occurs on the sloping
bed of the outlet downstream of the crest. This makes the outlet discharge
independent of the flow conditions in the watercourse.
The discharge through the outlet is given by formula
Q = 7.3 B.Y.√Hs
Q = 4.04 B.Y.√Hs in MKS
where
Q = outlet discharge in cfs or cumecs
B = width of outlet opening in ft or meter
Y = height of outlet opening above crest in ft or meters
Hs = working head in ft= distance between FSL in distributary
and lowest point of the roof block in m= H- Y
The ratio (Hs/D) should be exactly equal to 0.3 for the outlet to be proportional and to
draw fair share of silt. Crump ensured the proportionality of outlet and hence the outlet
is generally called “Adjustable Proportional Module” or APM.
Advantage of the Outlet:
i. The roof block can be raised or lowered at a small cost by dismantling the
masonry in which the bolts are fixed. Thus the discharge can be adjusted
easily
ii. Any tampering of the outlet can easily be detected and corrected.
Disadvantage of the outlet:
i. The waterway is either very deep and narrow or very wide and shallow. In
both cases, it is not desirable. In the first case, it causes blocking whereas
in second case it does not draw its due silt share.
ii. A channel fitted with these types of outlets get badly silted up
MANUAL OF IRRIGATION PRACTICE 9-21
OUTLETS
iv. There is no horizontal portion of the throat. The glacis is given a slope of
1: 15 until it meet the bed of watercourse.
v. The base of the roof block is shaped to a leminiscate curve with a tilt of
1 in 7.5. This ensures smooth flow conveyance.
The MMH is given by:
hm=0.82 Hs-0.5Lt
The outlet is not proportional. However, it becomes proportional when the roof is set
at 0.3D. With a rise in FSL, flexibility is reduced and the outlet becomes sub
proportional. On the other hand with a fall in FSL., the flexibility is increase and the
output becomes hyper proportional. When the outlet is set at bed level, the flexibility
becomes 0.3 and it remains constant.
Example- 6
Design an AOSM, with the following data:
Discharge of outlet Q = 0.22 cms (7.77 cfs)
Working Head, Hw = 0.70 m (2.30 ft)
FSL in Distributary = 101.40 m (332.68 ft)
Bed level of distributary = 100 m (328.084 ft)
Solution
Assume B = 0.50 ft
Depth of channel, D =332.68- 328.084= 4.6 ft
Assume setting S = 8/10
Now, H/D= 8/10
` or H/4.6= 8/10
or H= 3.60 ft
Let Hs= 2.30
As Hs= H- Y
Or Y= H- Hs= 3.60- 2.30= 1.30ft<0.5 H
Now, Q = 7.3 B.Y.√Hs
= 7.3×0.5×1.30×.√2.30= 7.20 cfs vs. is less than 7.77cfs
so increase to .54ft
Now Q = 7.3x0.54x1.3x2.3^1/2 = 7.77 cfs its OK
Now MMH = 0.82Hs-0.5B
= 0.8×(2.3)- 0.5×(0.54)= 1.57ft< 2.3 ft working head available…OK
Scratchley Outlet
This type of outlet differs from the pipe outlet only at its downstream end. In the
Scratchley Outlet, the pipe opens into a Cistern 2 ft2 (0.6 m2) or 3 ft2 (1.0 m2). At the
other end of the cistern is fixed a cast iron or stone orifice of the correct dimensions
required for the authorized discharge of the outlet. While the pipe is fixed at bed level,
the orifice can be fixed at a higher level to ensure semi-modularity (free flow). If,
however, the orifice is submerged, it functions in the same manner as the non-modular
pipe outlet.
The main objection to this type of outlet is that if the orifice is not built in stone or cast
iron, the farmers would try to tamper and enlarge it. By merely rounding the lips, they
can increase the discharge considerably. Another disadvantage is the possibility of
farmers making a hole in the cistern wall and thus taking additional unauthorized
MANUAL OF IRRIGATION PRACTICE 9-23
OUTLETS
discharge into the watercourse. However, the outlet is easily open to inspection at all
times and these objections are not of great importance.
The size of the cross section of the pipe (or barrel) should be large enough to pass the
required discharge at a nominal head loss. The recommended size of the cross section
of the orifice and the corresponding cross section of the barrel are as given in Table
9.1.
Table 9.1
Cross section of orifice ( Ft^2) Breadth (ft) Height (ft)
9.9.6.2 Disadvantages
i. The main disadvantage of the Scratchley Outlet is that it is not immune from
tampering. The discharge can be increased by: lowering the water level in the
watercourse; rounding the edges of the orifice and making holes in the cistern
wall.
ii. When the orifice is set for free flow conditions, a comparatively large working
head is required. Farmers could thus raise the water level in the watercourse
and render the orifice partially submerged. This would result in some increase
in the discharge. However, tampering can be fairly easily detected in this type
of outlet.
Design Formula
Q=C.A.√Hs
Where Q = discharge of the outlet in l/ s (Cusecs)
A = cross-sectional area of the orifice, in cm ( FT^2)
Hw = working head, i. e. the difference in water levels of the cistern and
the watercourse, in cm( Ft)
C = coefficient of discharge = 0.0354 (6.4 )
hl = loss of head through barrel or pipe= 926×Q2/a2 generally
Where, ‘a’ is cross sectional area of the barrel or pipe. In working out hl, it would be
better to use this formula directly.
Example- 7
Design a Scratchley oulet for the following data:
Discharge, Q = 34 l/s (1.2Cfs )
Y1= 90 cm
Working Head, Hw = 15 cm ( 0.50 Ft )
Assume water level in the distributary= 200.00 ft
Solution:
Water level in watercourse= 200.00- 0.50= 199.50 m
As an approximation, assume in the first instance a loss of head of 0.1 ft through barrel.
The working head available for the orifice will then be 0.40 ft ( 0.5- 0.1). For the
drowned conditions,
As Q =C.A.√hw
Or 1.20 = 6.4 A. √0.4
Or A = 0.296 sq ft = 42.63 sq in
Adopt size of the orifice as 7 in× 7 in(=49 sq in). According to the table, the cross
section of the barrel will be 12 in× 12 in.
Departmental Procedure for Selecting Types of Outlets
Although selection criteria has been given in above section, yet it is found advisable
to include some excerpts from previous MIP to reiterate this aspect in view of improve
of equitable distribution of water, which depends principally on right selection of an
outlet by the irrigation engineer for the given data. The following are excerpts from MIP
first edition, reprint 1963.
MANUAL OF IRRIGATION PRACTICE 9-25
OUTLETS
minimum drop of 9” may generally be regarded as essential for the efficient working
of a control point.
Where control points cannot be introduced, it is necessary to design outlets in such a
manner that they are least affected by temporary or permanent changes in the regime
of channels.
9.9.7.3 Silt conduction by outlets
An important condition to be satisfied by an outlet is that it must draw its fair share of
the silt carried by the parent channel. It may be remembered that water is continually
percolating through the wetted perimeter in the entire length of the distributary. The
steady reduction of the total discharge on this account is not accompanied by a
proportional removal of the silt charge with the result that on a distributary the silt load,
if it does not deposit in the head reach, actually increases as the water progresses
further down the system, unless the outlets in the head reach are so designed that
they draw a large proportion of the silt charge in the channel. In a distributary system,
the absorption generally varies from 10 to 15 per cent. The silt charge in the water so
lost must be removed by the off taking outlets, or, in other words if the silt charge in a
channel is 100 per cent to 115 per cent to enable them to draw their share of the silt
charge.
The silt draw in an outlet depends on the following factors:
a- Position of entrance relative to the silted bed.
b- Shape of entrance.
c- Velocity through the outlet near its upstream end.
d- Inclination of the pipe in the case of a pipe outlet.
No extensive observations have so far been carried out to determine the absolute or
relative merits of the various types of outlets for silt conduction. Axiomatically, the
lower the setting of the outlet the better the silt draw-off. There is a general belief,
however, that pipe outlets draw off more silt than any other type of outlet set at the
same level.
A watercourse should be given only as much silt as it can carry depending on the
slopes available in it and the low silt induction capacity on some outlets should be
compensated for by giving more than their due share of silt to other outlets, where
conditions of command permit this being done.
When it is not possible to dispose of all the silt brought into a channel through its
outlets on account of constantly poor command on most of the outlets the only solution
is to raise the full supply level I the channel or alternatively to provide a silt selective
head so that the total quantity of silt entering the channel is reduced.
9.9.7.4 Proportionality versus Rigidity
Without entering into the details of this controversy it may be stated here that
experience has shown that proportional distribution of supplies by outlets is neither
necessary nor feasible. Proportional distribution is necessary among the different
channels of a distributary system but its application to outlets creates serious
difficulties in the working of the system. The requirements of the cultivator do not make
it necessary to adopt this method of distribution except on some channels where the
conditions of supply are peculiar. On all other channels rigidity, should be aimed at.
MANUAL OF IRRIGATION PRACTICE 9-27
OUTLETS
Chapter 10
COMPUTERIZED
MONITORING SYSTEM FOR
CANAL OPERATION
Compiled by
Table of Contents
10 COMPUTERIZED MONITORING SYSTEM FOR CANAL OPERATION ...... 10-1
10.1 INTRODUCTION .......................................................................................... 10-1
10.2 MONITORING AND IMPLEMENTATION ARRANGEMENTS ................................... 10-2
10.3 DATABASE DEVELOPMENT AND MANAGEMENT ............................................. 10-2
10.3.1 Introduction ...................................................................................... 10-2
10.3.2 Irrigation Management Information System (IMIS) Code ................. 10-3
10.4 COMPONENTS OF IRRIGATION MANAGEMENT INFORMATION SYSTEM (IMIS) ... 10-4
10.4.1 Keeping in view the abovementioned objectives, PMIU started
developing Irrigation Management Information System (IMIS) for decision
making in Irrigation Department. Followings are the components / tools which
have been developed so far under IMIS: ....................................................... 10-4
10.5 INSTRUCTIONS REGARDING CHANNEL OPERATIONS ..................................... 10-5
10.5.1 Surprise Checking of Outlets (Moghas) ........................................... 10-8
10.5.2 Instructions Regarding Alteration of Outlets..................................... 10-9
10.5.3 Instructions Regarding Discharge Observation and Calibration of
Gauges ....................................................................................................... 10-11
10.6 ATTENDANCE AND PROCESSING OF COMPLAINTS ....................................... 10-12
10.7 MONITORING TOOLS FOR CANAL OPERATIONS........................................... 10-13
10.7.1 Water Entitlements and Deliveries ................................................. 10-13
10.7.2 Tools for Equitable Distribution of Canal Supply ............................ 10-13
10.7.3 Daily Analysis Report regarding Channel Operations .................... 10-14
10.7.4 Performance Analysis Report (PAR).............................................. 10-14
10.7.5 Development of Software to Calculate Un-Accounted Water......... 10-14
10.8 WATER RESOURCE MANAGEMENT INFORMATION SYSTEM (W RMIS)............. 10-15
10.9 REAL TIME FLOW MONITORING SYSTEM .................................................... 10-15
10.10 DISCHARGE MEASUREMENT ................................................................. 10-16
10.10.1 Introduction .................................................................................... 10-16
10.10.2 Discharge Measurement Methods ................................................. 10-16
10.10.3 Computation of Discharge ............................................................. 10-19
10.10.4 Site Selection ................................................................................. 10-23
10.10.5 Calibration of Current Meter........................................................... 10-25
10.10.6 Methods of Using Current Meters .................................................. 10-26
List of Figures
FIGURE 1: COMPARISON OF DATA TRANSMISSION BEFORE AND AFTER ESTABLISHMENT OF
PMIU .............................................................................................................. 10-3
FIGURE 2: DEVELOPMENT OF IMIS CODE .................................................................. 10-4
FIGURE 3: COMPLETE OVERVIEW OF THE RTFM SYSTEM ......................................... 10-16
FIGURE 4: DISCHARGE OBSERVATION BY USING FLUME METHOD ................................ 10-23
FIGURE 5: PRACTICAL DEMONSTRATION OF UTILIZING THE CURRENT METER BY WADING
METHOD ......................................................................................................... 10-27
FIGURE 6: DISCHARGE OBSERVATION BY USING BOAT METHOD .................................. 10-27
iv MANUAL OF IRRIGATION PRACTICE
COMPUTERIZED MONITORING SYSTEM FOR CANAL OPERATION
MANUAL OF IRRIGATION PRACTICE 10-1
COMPUTERIZED MONITORING SYSTEM FOR CANAL OPERATION
Each irrigation division maintains its respective channels data (designed & current) on
a register. This practice has been followed since the creation of Irrigation Department.
Only specific data of 25 Main Canals was transmitted to higher administration of
Irrigation Department for their information. The data of each channel including minors,
sub-minors were not publically available until anybody requested for it. The data
storage was only register, which was not centralized and was also risky.
Database Management System (DBMS) was essentially required for Irrigation
Department to make data storage on database server. This data has been retrieved
by the Irrigation Officials through different applications (software) for analysis.
Moreover, the discharge data of channels was stored in registers before the
deployment of DBMS and it was directly accessible to the specific field staff and
provided to the officials on request.
Now, PMIU is using DBMS for providing the comprehensive reports on daily basis
regarding channels operations at all levels including Secretary, Chief Engineers,
Superintending Engineers and Executive Engineer. Data is stored in centralized
database which is accessible to all authorized users. A pictorial view of data
transmission before and after establishment of PMIU is provided in Figure 1.
Department. Followings are the components / tools which have been developed so far
under IMIS:
Development of Database Management System
Development of Website for Irrigation Department
Development of Analysis Tools
Functional Prototype Development for Irrigation Department.
10.5 Instructions Regarding Channel Operations
In view of notification issued by Administrative Department regarding instruction
Channel Operations/ Water Theft Cases & Daily Analysis Reports vide no.
PS/SECY.ID/PMIU/2014 dated 24.01.2014 wherein role and responsibilities of
officers/ officials have been identified and the same is elaborated below;
i. Chief Engineer (CE), Superintending Engineer (SE) and Executive Engineer
(XEN) should pursue the daily analysis report regarding channel operation and
use the information for improvement of system efficiency and performance
evaluation of their staff.
ii. XEN and SDO should ensure that accurate gauge discharge data as per ground
reality is furnished to PMIU on daily basis. SE to review the daily analysis report
to see if there is found any difference of gauges between PMIU and field staff,
he should take action to rectify the problem of difference of gauges.
iii. XEN should also ensure checking of those channels where wrong gauges were
conveyed by his staff and initiate action against the SBE and Gage Reader
(GR) responsible for sending the fictitious data.
iv. SE should evaluate the performance of XEN & SDO on the basis of
improvement made regarding equity and accuracy of the data fortnightly.
v. All the missing gauges pointed out by PMIU should be installed within 3 days
and in case the same is not installed within 3 days then action should be
initiated against the officers / officials as per following mechanism.
Gauge not fixed within 5 days SBE
Gauge not fixed within 7 days SDO / SBE
Gauge not fixed within 15 days XEN/SDO/SBE
vi. All the discharge tables issued by PMIU are implemented at site and same
should be available with the SBE / GR duly laminated with the plastic sheet.
vii. PMIU will convey the status of the dry and short tail upto the CE and SE
respectively on the same day of the checking through SMS for immediate
appropriate action by the field staff to improve the supply at tails.
viii. XEN should sort out the reasons for the dry, short and excessive tails on daily
basis. SE to review the dry / short tail report of the channel and ensure to feed
the channel within 10 days as per its authorized tail discharge. In case tails are
not improved within 15 days, action will be initiated against the SDO/SBE.
ix. It should be ensured that all the channels should run as per their authorized
discharge from the head. Actions will be initiated against the officers / officials
involved in excessive running of the channel from the head.
Channel found running more than 10% GR
excess than its authorized discharge
Channel found running more than 15% SBE / GR
excess than its authorized discharge
10-6 MANUAL OF IRRIGATION PRACTICE
COMPUTERIZED MONITORING SYSTEM FOR CANAL OPERATION
xiv. XEN to ensure that material required for repairing the outlets is available with
the SBE so that the outlet is repaired departmentally without delay. If the outlet
is not repaired within 3 days then XEN has to give reasons for not repairing of
the outlet in time.
xv. In case of tampered outlets, the main beneficiaries and the irrigators in whose
turn the outlet is tampered should be nominated in the FIR and report for
registration of water theft cases should be sent to the police station within 3
days of the occurrence of incidence.
xvi. Cases of special charges of water theft be processed and finalized within the
prescribed time limit.
xvii. SBE to physically observe the outlets in each month. Hard copy of the Outlet
Performance Register be checked & signed by the field officers (CE, SE, XEN
and SDO) during the field tours. The soft copy of the same be conveyed to
PMIU on monthly basis.
xviii. All the water theft SMS conveyed by the PMIU through SMS Transmission
System (STS) and Complaint Management System (CMS) to the canal
operators should immediately be taken up by the XEN who will respond the
detail of action including date of reporting, date of repairing of water theft site
and Robkar number sent to Police to PMIU within 5 days through CMS.
xix. XEN should ensure that the field staff (SDO/SBE) should accompany the
Monitoring Team (ADM/MA) at the time of checking of the outlets. In case
SDO/SBE does not join the monitoring team without any solid reason, it will be
presumed that they avoided the joint checking intentionally. Monitoring Teams
will also record statements of SDO/SBE to know the detail of action already
taken by field staff regarding water theft found at the time of inspection.
xx. In case any disciplinary action is initiated against field staff on account of water
theft, their defense reply only on the basis of canal wire will not be accepted.
Enquiry Officers conducting the enquiries of water theft cases will obtain report
of the water theft SMS from the PMIU to ascertain the authenticity of the canal
wires issued by the SDO / SBE / Signaler. No excuse will be entertained
regarding training of the SDO / SBE / Signaler for sending SMS to the database.
xxi. SE should properly pursue canal wires regarding water theft and outlet
tampering incidents issued by the ADM on the basis of checking of PMIU field
staff (Assistant Director Monitoring/ Monitoring Assistant). He should
investigate the matter and submit detail report to PMIU within 5 days by
consulting the following record.
o Water theft SMS sent by SDO, SBE and Signaller.
o SMS sent by SDO, SBE and Signaller regarding repairing of the outlets/
water theft sites.
o Water theft SMS sent by the PMIU
o Data entry of the water theft cases into the software by the Canal
Division
o Robkar referred to Police.
o FIR Number if case registered.
o Status of the case of Special Charges and submit statement of
allegations against the delinquents by fixing responsibilities on the
officers / officials as per following mechanism.
10-8 MANUAL OF IRRIGATION PRACTICE
COMPUTERIZED MONITORING SYSTEM FOR CANAL OPERATION
iii. Zero RL of head gauge is checked with the help of levelling equipment;
iv. During the checking of outlets if there found any Ghurlu, Crest and Wing wall
tempering or removal of Roof Block or total collapse of the structure and
accordingly outlet draw excessive discharge, then outlet considered to be
“Badly Tempered”;
v. During the checking of outlets, in case of oversize, undersize, difference in
sizes (one parameter is larger and other is smaller than design parameters or
vice versa), lowering of the crest and the outlet drew excessive discharge. So,
it has been considered as “Defective”; and
vi. Discharge of the outlet is calculated and highlighted in the report.
a. After the inspection of outlets, following procedure is adopted for
reporting of the same:
vii. In the preparation of inspection report, prime importance is given to the secrecy;
viii. After the inspection, Mobile Monitoring Team immediately forwarded the
inspection report to Head office of PMIU through e-mail;
ix. All the offences are reported through evidence based smart monitoring system
by using android phones
x. After receiving the data, PMIU forwarded a comprehensive report to Secretary
Irrigation Department by pin pointing the responsible officers/ officials to initiate
inquiry proceedings against them;
xi. In case of small-scale tempering / defectiveness of the outlets, only Sub-
Engineer be made responsible;
xii. In case of medium scale tempering / defectiveness of the outlets, Sub Divisional
Officer is made responsible along with the Sub-Engineer;
xiii. In case of large-scale tempering / defectiveness of the outlets, Executive
Engineer is also made responsible along with the Sub-Divisional Officer and
Sub-Engineer;
xiv. After receiving the inspection report to Secretary Irrigation Department, Section
Officer E-V issued the enquiry orders against the responsible officers/ officials
on the behalf of Secretary Irrigation Department; and
xv. Assistant Directors Monitoring of PMIU are appointed as Departmental
representatives (DRs) to defend on the behalf of Department.
iii. CHD will put up all the documents / reports to SE within 7 days for review /
order. If justified, SE will send the case to XEN for observation of hydraulic data
of the outlet to the field formation.
iv. Sub Engineer will observe 7-days hydraulics data. He should check working
head and discharge etc. of the outlet. He should ensure that during observation,
no obstruction is placed in the water course. He will submit the case to the SDO
within 21 days.
v. SDO is required to check the field data, especially during days of minimum
working head of the outlet, and record his report stating whether he
recommends the change or not. He will send the case to XEN will verify the
outlet data within 15 days.
vi. On receipt of case from SDO, XEN will verify the outlet data within 15 days and
certify that no obstruction has been made in the water course during data
observations. He will then send the case to SE in either case.
vii. SE will send the same data alongwith relevant record to PMIU for confirmation
of the hydraulic data at site.
viii. PMIU will check the working head and discharge of outlets within two days from
the Outlet Performance Register already available in the database and will send
the case to Assistant Director Monitoring for confirmation of data at site.
ix. ADM, PMIU will make the surprise field visit and verify the data. He will also
ensure that no obstruction is placed during verification of data in the water
course. ADM then send the case to SE as well as PMIU for updation of data in
the database within 7 days.
x. After that, SE will discuss the outlet alteration case in a meeting comprising of
the following;
o Superintending Engineer Convener
o Executive Engineer Member
o Assistant Director Monitoring, PMIU Member
SE will make the technical decision after hearing the lower riparian of
four outlets and the committee members. The committee members will reserve
the right to give a dissenting note; in case they disagree with the decision of the
SE. In case where dissenting note is given by any of the member, the case will
be sent to Chief Engineer (CE) for his decision. CE will reserve the right either
to confirm, reject or alter on technical grounds. Minutes of the meeting / decision
of CE will be sent to PMIU for information and updation in the database.
xi. After decision, the implementation regarding adjustment of outlet will be made
jointly by SDO and SBE. SDO will also notify the adjustment of outlet carried at
site through canal wire and will ensure the submission of the A-Forms to the
Divisional Office within 3 days.
xii. After notification by the SDO, ADM will make the surprise check of the outlet
within 15 days and submit report to PMIU for updation in the database.
MANUAL OF IRRIGATION PRACTICE 10-11
COMPUTERIZED MONITORING SYSTEM FOR CANAL OPERATION
7. E.I. gauges installed should be projected upto the top of the Gauge
Wells.
8. Reduced level of the top of the Gauge Wells must be engraved on
the top of its masonry work.
9. Red painted line should be placed showing the FSL + 1.0 feet at each
control point ( Head Regulators, Falls, Bridges, Tail Clusters ) on the
non-petrol bank side so as to be easily visible during inspection.
10. Body of the E.I. gauges should be painted with blue colors and
gradation be made of 1/10th of a feet with white colors and at every
feet with red colors.
11. Gauges be installed on main canals and branches at every canal mile
by showing the gradation in feet and also the RL be given at every
feet.
12. Discharge books should be maintained and updated on monthly
bases in the divisions and soft copy of same may also be sent to the
PMIU on the 5th of each months.
13. Zero RL of the gauge and reference authenticated bench mark
should be written on the discharge table which should be available at
the head of the channel in the laminated cover sheet.
14. Gauge register should be properly maintained and every officer
should sign the gauge register during his field visit.
15. Gauge Huts should be properly repaired during coming annual
closure.
16. Each division will issue the programme for discharge measurement
by different tiers in advance on the 25th of each month and copy of
the same will be sent to PMIU so that the actual discharge
measurement be checked at site by the PMIU Staff.
Sd/-15/11/06
Arif Nadeem
Secretary
CC
Chief Monitoring PMIU
10.6 Attendance and Processing of Complaints
When a complaint is received from an irrigator/complainant, the information regarding
type of complaint, division name, channel name and related information along with the
contact number of the irrigator/complainant are collected and accordingly registered
in the complaint register. After lodging, the complaint number is issued. The same
information is also uploaded in the database through Complaint Management System
(CMS). Contents of complaint are published in web accounts of XENs, SEs & Chief
Engineers on Irrigation Web Site (http://irrigation.punjab.gov.pk). Field operators are
bound to respond within four days.
MANUAL OF IRRIGATION PRACTICE 10-13
COMPUTERIZED MONITORING SYSTEM FOR CANAL OPERATION
The replies received from the field operators are evaluated in the light of the rules and
discussions with the complainant. Before resolving the public complaint, the
complainant is called to check whether his grievances are properly addressed or not.
If not, then concerned Executive Engineer is instructed for joint inspection of the
complainant site. Search and Track system is also available that will help searching
the specific complaint by mentioning its respective village name or complaint number.
Furthermore, the history of activities taken on the complaint by field division and PMIU
is also maintained. Computer generated auto-reminders are also issued to field
division for quick replies. The complaints are received on the toll free helpline lodged
by the farmers as well as Monitoring Assistants (MA), field staff of PMIU mainly related
to dry & short tail, water theft and missing gauges etc.
10.7 Monitoring Tools for Canal Operations
The IMIS and DSM have been developed to provide support to higher management
to monitor the key indicators of the system operations including the discharge of
various canals and distributaries, etc. The system is facilitating decision-making
regarding water distribution, and scheduling more transparently with the objective of
providing canal water to all farmers as per their entitlements with emphasis on
providing authorized supply to the tail enders. The live data of all the channels of
Punjab is captured daily and static data of all canal systems has also been captured.
The live data is updated daily on the website http://irrigation.punjab.gov.pk to make
the information available to the end users. Decision Support Model (DSM) is also
facilitating the higher management in monitoring the key indicators of the system
including the discharges at various main and branch canals and distributaries. It also
helps decision-making regarding equitable and transparent water distribution and
scheduling.
Following are the major tasks/achievements accomplished so far;
10.7.1 Water Entitlements and Deliveries
Indus Water Treaty (IWT) develops distribution program of 25 main canals (12 main
canal systems of Terbela command and 13 main canal systems of Mangla command)
for each crop season. In this distribution program, the canal water is distributed in each
main canal system according to its authorized share at 10/5-daily basis. This
information was not publically published at any forum. PMIU started displaying this
information on the website in user-friendly way. This module helps users to view the
previous, current and future entitlements of canal water in all main canal systems.
10.7.2 Tools for Equitable Distribution of Canal Supply
10.7.2.1 Relative Delivery Performance Ratio
Delivery performance ratio (DPR) is the ratio of actual discharge to designed
discharge. It may also be used as deliverable or scheduled water in order to asses,
not only the performance of the overall system, but also the contribution of the
structural and management components of the system to the performance.
Delivery Performance Ratio (DPR) is the most important hydraulic performance
indicator. In fact, the delivery performance ratio is generally be considered to be the
ratio of actual discharge to designed discharge (DPR = Q a / Qd). Relative Delivery
Performance Ratio was used to measure Equity Performance Indicator. The relative
Delivery Performance Ratio can mathematically be expressed as:
10-14 MANUAL OF IRRIGATION PRACTICE
COMPUTERIZED MONITORING SYSTEM FOR CANAL OPERATION
Td
DPR at Tail (A) = ATd
Hd
DPR at Head (B) = Dd
Where
Td = the actual tail discharge
ATd = the authorized tail discharge
Hd = the actual head discharge
Dd = the designed discharge at head
Relative DPR = A / B
Relative DPR has an ideal value of 1, which means that every changed flow conditions
at sub-system head are proportionately distributed among the shareholders
regardless of their location along the distributaries.
10.7.3 Daily Analysis Report regarding Channel Operations
Analysis of channel operations was not done before on regular basis (daily basis) in
the history of Irrigation Department before the establishment of PMIU. It was only done
when required for some reporting purpose. PMIU started analyzing channel’s
operations and complaints status on daily basis right after the deployment of
databases (DBMS). Once PMIU collected all required data and managed it through
DBMS, it become easy and time saves to analyze the channels of entire Punjab. A
report is issued, which depicts status of complaints and analysis report regarding
channel operations at zonal level.
10.7.4 Performance Analysis Report (PAR)
To ensure equitable water distribution and foster up the purpose of implementation,
PMIU has taken the initiative to relatively compare the canal divisions on the basis of
channel operations data received from field and PMIU staff. This evaluation report is
compiled from the channel operations data for each fifteen day interval, thence two
reports for each month.
10.7.5 Development of Software to Calculate Un-Accounted Water
Irrigation system in Punjab consists of 56 canal divisions and 25 main canal systems.
These main canals pass through one or more divisions to provide water for irrigation.
Each division has its authorized share of water form main canal. The division in which
main canal starts is called upper division and it delivers water to subsequent divisions,
which are called lower division/divisions. It has been tradition in irrigation systems that
lower divisions, most of the time, blame upper divisions for not getting water according
to their authorized share.
PMIU developed Database Management System (DBMS) and started monitoring of
the water delivery from upper division to lower through the channels on the critical
gauges. These critical points are available on website for XENs where they enter
discharge data (gauge, discharge and indent) on daily basis. SEs can also view the
discharges of their respective channels on the critical points of divisions and sub-
divisions. This information gives glimpse to the distribution of canal water between
divisions and sub-divisions at circle level.
PMIU started calculating un-accounted water at division level to ensure the equitable
distribution of water and to minimize the water theft. This calculation gives idea that
MANUAL OF IRRIGATION PRACTICE 10-15
COMPUTERIZED MONITORING SYSTEM FOR CANAL OPERATION
how much water a division receives, utilizes and delivers to sub-sequent division. This
exercise pin point followings:
False reporting of daily gauges data;
Water theft;
Tempered outlets drawing excessive discharge; and
Discharges reported through outdated discharge tables.
Un-accounted water (water losses) is also the major input in performance evaluation
report, which is generated after every 15 days. This shows the management skills of
field operators regarding canal water distribution and responsibility for transmitting
correct information to PMIU office.
Calculation of Un-Accounted Water (Water Losses): The general formula for this
calculation is given below:
Un-accounted Water = (total water received – water utilized – total water delivered (if
any))
10.8 Water Resource Management Information System (Wrmis)
To make the present irrigation management system more efficient, there is a
requirement of development of a decision support system (DSS) incorporating the
intelligence of existing canal operators supported by scientific tools like flow
forecasting tools, simulation models for rivers and canals: facilitating the operator in
equitable management of precious irrigation flows throughout the system. In this
regard, hydrological and hydraulic models are developed to link with Decision Support
System (DSS). Further, the DSS are linked with Irrigation Management Information
System (IMIS) for handing large data sets, and provide facility for storage and retrieval
of canal and river data, required by the models. The complete application would be
Water Resources Management Information System (WRMIS) which will facilitate the
decision makers in making informed decisions regarding water availability and system
response against various management scenarios.
The overall objective of the WRMIS is to develop interactive, graphical; web based
system along with Decision Support System. The system will comprised of following
sub-components.
i) Review / upgrading of Water Resources Management Information System
(WRMIS) and integration with Decision Support System (DSS).
ii) Hydrological Modelling for Forecast of Water Availability and Determination
of Punjab’s Share.
iii) Development of a Real-Time Operations Model.
iv) Determination and Mapping of Water Table Fluctuations.
v) Development of Hydraulic Models of all Main and Branch Canals of Punjab
Irrigation System.
(PID’s) central office. It will facilitate the process of making rational decisions with the
help of informed judgment on regulation, allocation and water accounting in the Punjab
Irrigation System.
rod or sounding line. As the depth is measured, observations of velocity are obtained
with the current meter at one or more points in the vertical. The measured widths,
depths and velocities permit computation of discharge for each sub-area of the cross-
section. The summation of these sub-area discharges is the total discharge.
Discharge measurements by the current meter method are made using a boat along
the cable or bridge or by wading the stream. The measurement need not to be made
at the exact location of the gauge because a reach of channel in the general vicinity
of the gauge.
Discharge measurements of the highest accuracy will be obtained at the cross-
sections having the following characteristics:
a) The velocities of all points are parallel to one another and at right-angles to the
cross-section of the stream.
b) The curves of distribution of velocity in the section are regular in the vertical
and horizontal planes.
c) The bed of the channel is regular and stable.
d) The stream does not overflow the banks of the channel.
e) There is no aquatic growth.
It is usually not possible to find a site with all of these characteristics. A satisfactory
measurement can still be made at most sections by increasing the number of
observation points or by using special equipment.
10.10.2.2 Accuracy of Discharge Measurement
Accuracy of a discharge measurement depends, in particular, on the number of
vertical strips at which observations of depth and velocity area obtained. In general,
the interval between any two verticals should not be greater than 1/20-th of the total
width, and the discharge between any two verticals should not be more than 5 percent
of the total discharge. Observation at vertical points should be located so as to best
define the variation in elevation of the stream bed and the horizontal variation in
velocity. Fewer verticals are required on very small streams, since the interval
between any two verticals must be greater than the diameter of the current-meter
propeller / rotor. The number of verticals should be increased for the first few
measurements at a new site for establishing gauge discharge relationship.
Discharge accuracy depends on the reliability of the meter rating, conditions of flow,
number of depth and velocity obtained. New and factory calibrated current meters
should be used for flow measurements.
10.10.2.3 Width Measurement
Channel width and the distance between verticals should be obtained by measuring
from a fixed reference point, which should be in the same plane as the cross-section.
Normally, the distance between verticals is determined from a beaded wire or
graduated tagline temporarily stretched across the stream or from semi-permanent
marks painted on a bridge hand-rail or a suspension cable.
10.10.2.4 Depth Measurement
A graduated rod or a drum-wire-weight system is used for measurement of depth of
flow. The effect of drag on a sounding wire may be reduced by using a streamlined
weight on the end of a fine wire. If the wire is not normal to the water surface, the
angle of departure should be measured with a protractor.
10-18 MANUAL OF IRRIGATION PRACTICE
COMPUTERIZED MONITORING SYSTEM FOR CANAL OPERATION
Depth may be read directly on a graduated rod set on the stream bed if the
measurement is done by wading. If the drum-wire-weight system is used for
measurement, the meter and weight are lowered until the bottom of the weight just
touches the water surface, and the depth dial reading is set at zero; the weight is then
lowered until its rests on the stream bed, and the depth is read on the dial. Caution is
necessary in alluvial streams to prevent the weight from settling through soft bed
material. If the weight on the sounding line is not sufficient to keep the line within 5 o of
the perpendicular to the water surface, the angle between the line and the vertical
should be measured to the nearest degree with a protractor in order to calculate
accurate depths of flow.
The angle should not exceed 30ᵒ. Methods of correcting the observed depths for angle
of sounding line are available. However, the accuracy of the measurement is
increased if sufficient weight can be used to maintain the line in a nearly vertical
position.
10.10.2.5 Measurement of Velocity
Velocity of flow at a point is usually measured by counting revolutions of a current
meter rotor during a short time period measured with a stop-watch. The current meter
is suspended in the flow on a rod or on a wire. Two types of current meter rotors are
in general use: the cup type with a vertical shaft, and the propeller type with a
horizontal shaft. Both types use a make-and break wire contact to generate an electric
pulse for indicating the revolutions of the rotor.
A current meter measures velocity at a point. The method of making discharge
measurements at a cross-section requires determination of the mean velocity in each
of the selected verticals. The mean velocity in a vertical is obtained from velocity
observations at many points in that vertical. The mean can be approximated by
making a few velocity observations and using a known relation between those
velocities and the mean in the vertical. Various methods of measuring velocity are:
a. Two-point.
b. Six-tenths depth.
c. Two-tenth depth.
d. Three-point.
However, in irrigation canals, velocity measurement methods at b and c are the
choices to consider depending upon the situation.
10.10.2.5.1 Two Point Method
In the two-point method of measuring velocities, observations are made in each
vertical at 0.2 and 0.8 of the depth below the surface. The average of these two
observations is taken as the mean velocity in the vertical. This method is based on
many studies of actual observation and mathematical analysis. Experience has shown
that this method gives more consistent and accurate results than any of the other
methods.
The two-point method is not used at depths less than 2.5 feet (75cm) because the
current meter would be too close to the water surface and to the stream bed to give
dependable results.
10.10.2.5.2 Six-tenth Depth Method
In six-tenth depth method, an observation of velocity at 0.6 of the depth below the
MANUAL OF IRRIGATION PRACTICE 10-19
COMPUTERIZED MONITORING SYSTEM FOR CANAL OPERATION
surface in the vertical is used as the mean velocity in the vertical. Actual observation
supported by mathematical analyses have shown that 0.6 depth method gives reliable
results and is used under the following conditions:
a. Whenever the depth is less than 2.5 feet (75cm)
b. When large amount of slush ice or debris make it impossible to observe the
velocity accurately at the 0.2 depth (This condition prevents the use of the two
point method).
c. When the meter is placed a distance above the sounding weight which makes
it impossible to place the meter at the 0.8 depth. (This also prevents the use of
the two-point method).
d. When the stage in a stream is changing rapidly and a measurement must be
made quickly.
10.10.2.5.3 Three-Points Method
This method is used when the velocities in the vertical appear to be abnormally
distributed, such as having an unusual velocity distribution. The three-point method
combines both the two-point method and the six-tenths depth method. Therefore,
current meter measurements are taken at 0.2, 0.6 and 0.8 of the flow depth. The mean
velocity in the vertical is obtained by first averaging the velocities measured at 0.2 and
0.8 of the flow depth (two points method); then, averaging this result with the velocity
measured at 0.6 flow depth. Thus, the mean velocity, V in the vertical would be:
(VO.2 + VO. 8 ) / 2 +VO.6
Vavg =
2
Where
Vavg = the mean velocity in the given vertical (ft/s);
V0.2 = the velocity at 0.2 of flow depth (ft/s);
V0.6 = the velocity at 0.6 of flow depth (ft/s); and
V0.8 = the velocity at 0.8 of flow depth (ft/s).
This method is applied where the flow depth is greater than 2.5 feet.
10.10.3 Computation of Discharge
Discharge is computed either arithmetically or graphically depending upon field
procedure used to obtain the observation. There are two arithmetic methods for
computing the discharge, i.e. the mean section method and mid-section method. Of
these methods, the mid-section method has less procedural error; therefore, it is used
for computing canal discharges.
10.10.3.1 Mid-Section Method
In the Mid-Section Method of computing a current meter measurement, the
velocity is measured at mid point of each section. The section area is obtained by
multiplying width of section to its mean depth. The discharge is then computed for any
section at vertical x by use of the equation,
qx = Vx[bx – b(x-1)][dx + dx-1]/2
Where
qx = Discharge at section x;
Vx = Velocity at mid point of section x;
b(x-1) = Distance from initial point to start point of section x;
10-20 MANUAL OF IRRIGATION PRACTICE
COMPUTERIZED MONITORING SYSTEM FOR CANAL OPERATION
22 Hc/L
23 Type of Weir 18 n
24 Cd 19 k
25 Q theoratical (In case of MF) 20 BM Value
26 BM Value 21 Description of BM
27 Description of BM
28 22 Remarks
Remarks
10-21
10-22 MANUAL OF IRRIGATION PRACTICE
COMPUTERIZED MONITORING SYSTEM FOR CANAL OPERATION
n AUTHORIZED
1.67
20
= DISCHARGE =
K DISCHARGE
5.10
1.83
= (Q) = KDn MEAN DEPTH (D) =
BED
0.56
SILTE F
731
D= t DESIGN BED LEVEL =
DATE OF
OBSERVATION = ZERO RL OF GAUGE
731
25/05/2016 TO BE FIXED AT =
BM VALUE &
Top of Lining at Left side of
LOCATION =
Pull Disty at RD 0+105
734.98
Gauge
0.05
0.15
0.25
0.35
0.45
0.55
0.65
0.75
0.85
0.95
0.1
0.2
0.3
0.4
0.5
0.6
0.7
0.8
0.9
0
0
0
0
0
0
0
0
0
0
0
0
0
0
0
0
0
0
0
1
1
1
1
1
2
2
2
2
3
3
3
4
4
5
5
5
6
6
7
7
8
8
9
10
10
11
12
12
13
13
14
15
15
16
17
17
18
19
20
20
21
22
2
9
23
23
24
25
26
27
27
28
29
30
31
32
33
34
34
35
36
37
38
39
3
Gauge
0.00
0.05
0.10
0.15
0.20
0.25
0.30
0.35
0.40
0.45
0.50
0.55
0.60
0.65
0.70
0.75
0.80
0.85
0.90
0.95
10
12
15
17
19
22
24
27
30
32
35
38
0
0
0
1
2
4
5
7
9
100
104
108
112
41
44
48
51
54
58
61
65
68
72
76
80
84
88
92
96
1
117
121
126
130
135
139
144
149
154
158
163
168
173
178
183
188
193
199
204
209
2
215
220
225
231
236
242
248
253
259
265
270
276
282
288
294
300
306
312
318
324
3
330
337
343
349
355
362
368
375
381
388
394
401
407
414
421
427
434
441
448
455
4
462
469
476
483
490
497
504
511
518
525
533
540
547
554
562
569
577
584
592
599
5
607
614
622
630
637
645
653
661
668
676
684
692
700
708
716
724
732
740
748
756
6
765
773
781
789
798
806
814
823
831
840
848
857
865
874
882
891
899
908
917
925
7
1005
1014
1023
1032
1041
1050
1059
1069
1078
1087
1096
1105
934
943
952
961
969
978
987
996
8
1115
1124
1133
1143
1152
1162
1171
1180
1190
1199
1209
1219
1228
1238
1247
1257
1267
1276
1286
1296
9
1306
1315
1325
1335
1345
1355
1365
1375
1385
1395
1405
1415
1425
1435
1445
1455
1465
1476
1486
1496
10
* For more detail on current meter refer to User Manual of Rickly Hydrological
Instruments
10.10.5.1 Equipment Care
Accuracy in velocity measurements can only be ensured when the equipment is
properly assembled, adjusted, and maintained. The current meter should be treated
as a delicate instrument that needs meticulous care and protective custody, both
during its usage and transportation. The required treatment of a current meter is also
analogous to a surveyor’s careful attention with a transit or level.
The current meter necessarily receives a certain amount of hard usage that may result
in damage, such as a broken pivot, chipped bearing, or bent shaft that will result in the
current meter giving velocity readings that are lower than actual velocities.
Observations of velocities near bridge piers and abutments, water depth readings
taken at cross-sections having irregular bed profiles with the current meter attached
to the measuring line, and the periodic occurrence of floating debris causes the
greatest hazards to the equipment.
Damage to current meter equipment during transportation is generally due to careless
packing or negligence in protection. A standard case is provided by all manufacturers
of current meter equipment, which should always be employed before and after taking
a discharge measurement. In particular, the equipment case should always be used
when transporting the current meter, even when the distance is relatively short.
Transportation of assembled equipment from one location to another is one of the
most common sources of damage. Research shows that 30 percent variation in
velocity measurements is as a result of improper care and protection.
The following instructions are useful for providing better performance and enhancing
the longevity of the current meter:
The equipment case must always be used when transporting the current
meter;
The stop watch should always be carried in a container;
If several sounding weights are to be carried, a box should be used with
separate compartments;
The revolution counter's battery has to be in good form;
Protect the digital-type current meters from water, sunlight and heat;
Check all of the cable connections to be sure that they are properly adjusted;
The head set assembly should be packed carefully to avoid an accidental
short circuit, which may discharge the battery; and
The pivot and pivot bearing of the current meter must be protected to insure
proper results when using this instrument.
10.10.6 Methods of Using Current Meters
10.10.6.1 Wading Method
The wading method involves having the hydrographer stand in the water
holding a wading rod with the current meter attached to the rod. The wading
rod is graduated so that the water depth can be measured. The rod has a metal
foot pad which sets on the channel bed. The current meter can be placed at
MANUAL OF IRRIGATION PRACTICE 10-27
COMPUTERIZED MONITORING SYSTEM FOR CANAL OPERATION
any height on the wading rod and is readily adjusted to another height by the
hydrographer while standing in the water;
A tag line is stretched 'from one bank to the other, which can be a cloth or metal
tape. This tag line is placed perpendicular to the flow direction. The zero length
on the tag line does not have to correspond with the edge of the water on one
of the banks. This tag line is used to define the location of the wading rod each
time that a current meter measurement is made;
The channel cross-section is divided into smaller segments. Tin pendants
should be attached to the section ropes at all the points of the main soundings
which are also velocity stations; and
The wading rod is held at the tag line. The hydrographer stands sideways to
the flow direction and facing towards one of the banks. The hydrographer
stands 5-10 cm downstream from the tag line and approximately 50 cm aside
from the wading rod in order to ensure free flow. During the measurement, the
rod needs to be held in a vertical position and the current meter must be parallel
with the flow direction. Usually, the note keeper can signal to the hydrographer
whether or not the rod is vertical in relation to the flow direction.
The site for discharge measurement should be selected that contains the following
characteristics.
A straight reach with the threads of velocities (streamlines) parallel to each
other;
Stable stream bed free of weeds and protruding obstructions such as piers,
which would create turbulence; and
A flat stream bed profile to eliminate vertical components of velocity.
Usually, all of these conditions cannot be satisfied. Select the best possible reach
using these criteria and then select an appropriate cross-section. After the cross-
section has been selected, determine the width of the stream. String the tag line at the
measuring section by un-reeling the line as the boat moves across the stream. Some
tag-line reels are equipped with brakes to control the line tension while unreeling. After
a tag line has been stretched without a brake across the stream, remove the sag by
means of a block and tackle attached to the reel and to an anchorage support on the
banks. Following steps need to be followed for velocity measurement;
The total width of the channel is divided into 25 to 30 sections but the first and
last sections must be at least 2.5 feet for the case of a boat, width of 5 feet (i.e.
half of the boat width);
The total width of the channel is divided into 25 to 30 sections but the first and
last sections must be at least 2.5 feet for the case of a boat, width of 5 feet (i.e.
half of the boat width);
Before taking the depth, check the counter reading, which should be zero at the
point where the centerline of the current meter cups is touching the water
surface;
Add the height between the bottom of the weight and the center of the current
meter cups in the depth;
The weight attached to the current meter should be 0.5 to 1.0 ft lower depending
upon the depth of channel. If the distance from the weight to the current meter
is less than 0.5 feet, erratic results may occur;
A rule of thumb is that the weight of the fish in pounds should be greater than
the maximum product of velocity and depth in the cross-section. Usually, in
medium canals, a 40-50 pound weight is used;
A gauge at site (discharge measurement) should be firmly installed to check
the fluctuations in water level (decrease or increase) passing through the
section;
For the structure, the upstream and downstream water depths must be noted
together with the gate position with reference to bench (white mark). It is worth
mentioning here that the structure gates should not be moved at least 3/4 hour
prior to beginning the discharge measurement. The upstream and downstream
water depths must be noted after every half an hour until the discharge
measurement is completed;
The velocity measurement starts from the left edge of water (LEW), keeping in
mind that at each section which method will be applied (one/two point-method);
Each measurement must be listed instantaneously in the discharge
measurement proforma; and
After completing all the measurements, calculations must be completed in the field.
Any procedural mistake can be identified at the site, and then corrected, which will
bring precision in the calculations as well as save time.